617792
533
Zoom out
Zoom in
Vorherige Seite
1/561
Nächste Seite
Contents
This owner’s manual should be considered a permanent part of the
vehicle and should remain with the vehicle when it is sold.
This owner’s manual covers all models of your vehicle. You may find
descriptions of equipment and features that are not on your
particular model.
Images throughout this owner’s manual (including the front cover)
represent features and equipment that are available on some, but
not all, models. Your particular model may not have some of these
features.
This owner’s manual is for vehicles sold in the United States and
Canada.
The information and specifications included in this publication were
in effect at the time of approval for printing. Honda Motor Co., Ltd.
reserves the right, however, to discontinue or change specifications
or design at any time without notice and without incurring any
obligation.
2 Safe Driving P. 31
For Safe Driving P. 32 Seat Belts P. 36 Airbags P. 43
2 Instrument Panel P. 71
Indicators P. 72 Gauges and Multi-Information Display P. 92
2 Controls P. 109
Clock P. 110 Locking and Unlocking the Doors P. 112
Opening and Closing the Moonroof
*
P. 132
Adjusting the Seats P. 148
2 Features P. 169
Audio System P. 170 Audio System Basic Operation P. 175, 197, 230
Customized Features P. 293 HomeLink® Universal Transceiver
*
P. 331
2 Driving P. 409
Before Driving P. 410 Towing a Trailer P. 415
Refueling P. 459 Fuel Economy P. 461
2 Maintenance P. 463
Before Performing Maintenance P. 464 Maintenance Minder
TM
P. 467
Checking and Maintaining Wiper Blades P. 491
Climate Control System Maintenance P. 504
2 Handling the Unexpected P. 509
If a Tire Goes Flat P. 510 Power System Won’t Start P. 519
Overheating P. 525 Indicator, Coming On/Blinking P. 528
2 Information P. 537
Specifications P. 538 Identification Numbers P. 540
Emissions Testing P. 543 Warranty Coverages P. 545
Main Menu
2014 ACCORD HYBRID Online Reference Owner's Manual
Contents
Child Safety P. 56 Exhaust Gas Hazard P. 68 Safety Labels P. 69
Opening and Closing the Trunk P. 122 Security System P. 126 Opening and Closing the Windows P. 129
Operating the Switches Around the Steering Wheel P. 133 Adjusting the Mirrors P. 146
Interior Lights/Interior Convenience Items P. 155 Climate Control System P. 165
Audio Error Messages P. 283 General Information on the Audio System P. 289
Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink® P. 333, 370
When Driving P. 416 Braking P. 452 Parking Your Vehicle P. 456
Accessories and Modifications P. 462
Maintenance Under the Hood P. 471 Replacing Light Bulbs P. 484
Checking and Maintaining Tires P. 493 12-Volt Battery P. 502 Remote Transmitter Care P. 503
Cleaning P. 505
Jump Starting P. 522 Shift Lever Does Not Move P. 524
Fuses P. 532 Emergency Towing P. 535
Devices that Emit Radio Waves P. 541 Reporting Safety Defects P. 542
Authorized Manuals P. 547 Customer Service Information P. 548
Quick Reference Guide
P. 2
Safe Driving
P. 31
Instrument Panel
P. 71
Controls
P. 109
Features
P. 169
Driving
P. 409
Maintenance
P. 463
Handling the Unexpected
P. 509
Information
P. 537
Index
P. 552
Note: All page numbers referenced in this document are hyperlinked.
2014 ACCORD HYBRID Online Reference Owner's Manual
2
Quick Reference Guide
Quick Reference Guide
Visual Index
System Indicators (P 72)
Gauges (P 92)
Navigation System
*
() See Navigation System Manual
Audio System (P 175, 197, 230)
POWER Button (P 133)
Rear Window Defogger (P 142)
Front Seat Heater Switches
*
(P 163)
ECON Button (P 422)
Multi-Information Display (P 94)
Heated Mirror Button (P 142)
Climate Control System (P 165)
Lane Departure Warning (LDW) Button
*
(P 441)
Hazard Warning Button
Audio with Touch Screen
*
(P 198, 231)
Audio/Information Screen
(P 176, 201, 233)
Acoustic Vehicle Alerting System Button
*
(P 423)
(Vehicle Stability Assist (VSA®) System OFF) Button (P 444)
3
Quick Reference Guide
(+ / (- / / Buttons (P 174)
SOURCE Button (P 174)
Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink® System
Voice Control Buttons
(P 333, 370)
Navigation System Voice Control Buttons
*
(P 239), () See Navigation System Manual
Steering Wheel Adjustments (P 145)
SEL/RESET Button (P 95)
(Information) Buttons (P 94)
Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC) Buttons
*
(P 427)
Cruise Control Buttons
*
(P 424)
Wipers/Washers (P 140)
Brightness Control (P 141)
(Select/Reset) Knob (P 141)
Horn (Press an area around .)
(Display) Button (P 176, 201, 233)
LaneWatch
TM
(P 445)
Headlights/Turn Signals (P 136)
* Not available on all models
Visual Index
4
Quick Reference Guide
Door Mirror Controls (P 147)
Passenger's Front Airbag
(P 46)
Parking Brake (P 452)
Glove Box (P 157)
Rearview Mirror (P 146)
Hood Release Handle (P 472)
Power Door Lock Master Switch (P 120)
Power Window Switches (P 129)
Interior Fuse Box (P 533)
Driver's Front Airbag (P 46)
Trunk Main Switch (P 124)
Fuel Fill Door Release Handle (P 460)
Trunk Release (P 122)
Shift Lever
Transmission
(P 420)
USB Port (P 171)
Auxiliary Input Jack (P 172)
Accessory Power Socket
(P 160)
EV Button (P 10)
5
Quick Reference Guide
Seat Belt to Secure a Child Seat (P 65)
Sun Visors
Vanity Mirrors
Map Lights (P 156)
Front Seat (P 148)
Seat Belts (P 36)
LATCH to Secure a Child Seat (P 61)
Side Curtain Airbags (P 52)
Grab Handle
Ceiling Light (P 155)
Coat Hook (P 161)
Seat Belt (Installing a Child Seat) (P 63)
Rear Seat
Accessory Power
Socket
(P 160)
Side Airbags (P 50)
Sunglasses Holder
(P 162)
Moonroof Switch
*
(P 132)
* Not available on all models
Visual Index
6
Quick Reference Guide
Maintenance Under the Hood (P 471)
Windshield Wipers (P 140, 491)
Tires (P 493, 510)
Door Lock/Unlock Control (P 114)
Power Door Mirrors (P 147)
Headlights (P 136, 484)
How to Refuel (P 460)
High-Mount Brake Light (P 490)
Emergency Trunk Release Lever (P 125)
Opening/Closing the Trunk (P 122)
Parking Lights (P 136, 487)
Front Turn Signal/Side Marker Lights (P 136, 487)
Multi-View Rear Camera (P 457)
Trunk Release Button (P 123)
Back-Up Lights (P 489)
Taillights (P 489)
Brake/Taillights (P 488)
Rear Turn Signal/Side Marker Lights (P 488)
Rear Camera (P 458)
7
Quick Reference Guide
SPORT HYBRID i-MMD (intelligent Multi Mode
Drive)
Your SPORT HYBRID i-MMD vehicle uses both an electric motor and a gasoline engine as propulsion sources, with the electric motor
receiving electricity from an internal High Voltage battery or internal generator. The High Voltage battery can be charged from the
generator driven by the engine or regenerative braking.
When driving, your vehicle is propelled exclusively by the electric motor, exclusively by the gasoline engine, or by a combination of two. The
system selects which propulsion source is most appropriate and automatically switches to it. Under certain circumstances, pressing the EV
button can manually enable EV (driven only on electricity) mode.
Energy efficiency
As with a gasoline-powered vehicle, hybrid vehicle fuel efficiency and driving range is most impacted by your driving style. Aggressive
acceleration and high-speed driving can easily trigger the system to switch the propulsion source to the gasoline-powered engine.
In addition, heavy climate control system use negatively affects vehicle range and efficiency. Either of these use patterns will more quickly
reduce the High Voltage battery's state of charge.
Battery types
There are two types of batteries used in this vehicle; a standard 12-volt battery that powers the airbags, the interior and exterior lights, and
other standard 12-volt systems; and a high voltage battery that is used to power the propulsion motor and recharge the 12-volt battery.
8
Quick Reference Guide
SPORT HYBRID i-MMD SYSTEM MAIN COMPONENTS
Gasoline Engine– Provides propulsion to drive the wheels
under certain driving conditions, and turns the generator.
Generator– Starts the engine and generates electric power
when driven by the gasoline engine to supply electricity to
power the electric motor and/or to charge the High Voltage
battery.
Electric Motor– Provides propulsion to drive the wheels in
conjunction with the gasoline engine in certain conditions, and
provides electricity to the High Voltage battery through
regenerative braking.
High Voltage Battery– Provides electrical storage and serves
as a power source for the electric motor.
Learning about the High Voltage battery’s characteristics will
help you get the best handling and maximize the range of your
electric vehicle. (P451)
High Voltage Battery Charge Level Indicator– Displays
battery state of charge.
When the indicator:
Displays two or less segments, EV mode is no longer available.
Displays eight segments, battery charge level is full.
High
Voltage
Battery
Generator & Electric Motor
Gasoline Engine
9
Quick Reference Guide
Operating
mode
Electric Vehicle (EV) Hybrid (HV) Engine (Direct Drive) Regeneration
Vehicle
Speed
Stopped or driven at low speeds:
Only the electric motor
provides propulsion to the
wheels.
Driven in high-load conditions
(e.g., when accelerating, going
uphill):
The Electric Motor provides
propulsion to the wheels.
The gasoline engine drives the
generator, supplying
electricity to the electric
motor for added propulsion
or to the High Voltage battery
for charging.
Driven in high-speed, low-load
conditions:
The gasoline engine provides
propulsion to the wheels.
The High Voltage battery
supplies electricity to the
electric motor for added
propulsion.
The electric motor provides
electricity to the High Voltage
battery through regenerative
braking.
Decelerating, without
accelerator being depressed.
The electric motor provides
electricity to the High Voltage
battery through regenerative
braking.
Power Flow
Monitor
Electric Motor
Stopped/Running Running Generating/Running Regenerating
Generator Stopped Generating No Output Stopped/No Output
Gasoline
Engine
Stopped Running Running Stopped/No Output
Battery Discharge Charging/Discharge Charging/Discharge Charging
Vehicle
Speed
Time
10
Quick Reference Guide
EV Button
EV mode is enabled by pressing the EV button near the shift lever.
The EV mode indicator comes on in the instrument panel when EV
mode is enabled.
Press the EV button again to switch back to HV mode.
Some conditions, such as a low High Voltage battery level and a
high vehicle speed, may keep the system from manually switching
into EV mode. The beeper sounds and a message appears on the
multi-information display with the button pressed when EV mode is
disabled.
Shifts in vehicle, driving or road conditions may automatically
cancel EV mode and switch back to HV mode.
Press
11
Quick Reference Guide
Regenerative Energy and Regenerative Braking
When decelerating without the accelerator being depressed or the brake pedal being applied, or
while driving downhill, the electric motor acts as a generator that recovers a portion of the
electrical energy that was used to accelerate the vehicle. This regenerative braking slows the
vehicle in a manner similar to engine braking in a gasoline-powered vehicle. This function is
enhanced when the shift lever is moved to .
Auto Engine Stop/Start
Your vehicle's gasoline engine automatically stops running during vehicle operation or restarts while the vehicle is stationary when it is
appropriate.
In the following cases, however, auto engine stop may not activate.
The vehicle momentarily needs additional power for aggressive acceleration, or driving uphill or at high speed.
The climate control system is in heavy use.
The High Voltage battery temperature is high or low.
Sounds Unique to the SPORT HYBRID i-MMD System
When you first start driving this vehicle, you likely will hear some unfamiliar sounds, particularly when you first turn on the power system,
while driving, and just after parking. Some of these sounds are unique to this vehicle‘s powertrain, fuel, and climate control systems; others
are similar to sounds generated by conventional automobiles that typically are masked by louder noises absent from a vehicle of this design.
These sounds are not a cause for concern, and you will soon recognize them as normal and thus be able to detect any new or unusual noise
should one develop.
When regenerative braking is in
operation
Motor
High
Voltage
Battery
B
12
Quick Reference Guide
Safety Precautions
Do not touch the High Voltage system
Attempting to take a High Voltage system component apart or disconnect one of its wires
can cause severe electrical shock. If the High Voltage system needs maintenance or repair, it
should be performed at a dealer.
If a crash occurs
Be careful of electric shock hazard.
uIf a severe crash damages your vehicle’s High Voltage system, there is a possibility of
electrical shock due to exposed High Voltage components or wires. If this happens, do not
touch any of the High Voltage system components or any of its orange wires.
Avoid contact with High Voltage battery fluid.
uThe High Voltage battery contains a flammable electrolyte that could leak as a result of
a severe crash. Avoid any skin or eye contact with the electrolyte as it is corrosive. If you
accidentally touch it, flush your eyes or skin with a large quantity of water for at least five
minutes, and seek medical attention immediately.
Use a fire extinguisher for an electrical fire.
uAttempting to extinguish an electrical fire with a small quantity of water, from a garden
hose for instance, can be dangerous.
Anytime the vehicle is damaged in an accident, have it repaired by a dealer.
Emergency Shutdown System for the High Voltage System
The emergency shutdown system may activate when the vehicle is impacted by some
incident such as a crash. When this system activates, the High Voltage system automatically
shuts down, and your vehicle no longer will move under its own power. To return the High
Voltage system back to normal operation, consult a dealer.
Honda collects and recycles High Voltage batteries used in its vehicles – consult a dealer for
more information.
Do not cover the air intake.
If the air intake is obstructed
during vehicle operation, the High
Voltage battery can become too
hot. To protect the battery, the
system may start to limit the
battery’s output and cause the
power system and 12-volt battery
charging system indicators to come
on.
Air Intake
13
Quick Reference Guide
Eco Assist System (P 422)
Ambient Meter
Changes color to reflect your driving
style.
Green: Fuel efficient driving
Blue green: Moderate acceleration/
deceleration
Blue: Aggressive acceleration/
deceleration
The ambient meter color changes in
accordance with your brake or
accelerator pedal operation.
ECON Button (P 422)
Helps maximize fuel economy.
ECON Mode Indicator (P 83)
Comes on when the ECON button is pressed.
The message is displayed for a few seconds
when the ECON button is pressed.
Ambient Meter
14
Quick Reference Guide
Drive Cycle Score/Lifetime Points
Comes on when the power mode is in VEHICLE OFF (LOCK).
Eco Drive Display (P99)
Keep the vehicle icon near the center of the circle.
Aggressive
Deceleration
Fuel economy is:
Best
Drive
Cycle
Score
Lifetime Points
Worse WorseBetter Better
Moderate
Deceleration
Slow
Acceleration/
Deceleration
Aggressive
Acceleration
Moderate
Acceleration
15
Quick Reference Guide
Safe Driving (P 31)
Airbags (P 43)
Your vehicle is fitted with airbags to help protect you and
your passengers during a moderate-to-severe collision.
Child Safety (P 56)
All children 12 and younger should be seated in the rear seat.
Smaller children should be properly restrained in a forward-facing child seat.
Infants must be properly restrained in a rear-facing child seat.
Exhaust Gas Hazard (P 68)
Your vehicle emits dangerous exhaust gases that contain carbon
monoxide. Do not run the engine in confined spaces where carbon
monoxide gas can accumulate.
Before Driving Checklist (P 35)
Before driving, check that the front seats, head restraints,
steering wheel, and mirrors have been properly adjusted.
Seat Belts (P 36)
Fasten your seat belt and sit upright well
back in the seat.
Check that your passengers are wearing
their seat belts correctly.
Fasten your lap belt as
low as possible.
16
Quick Reference Guide
Instrument Panel (P 71)
Canada
U.S.
Low Fuel Indicator
Anti-lock Brake
System (ABS)
Indicator
Parking Brake
and Brake System
Indicator (Red)
Canada
U.S.
READY Indicator
System Indicators
Malfunction
Indicator Lamp
Low Oil Pressure
Indicator
12-Volt Battery
Charging System
Indicator
Vehicle Stability
Assist (VSA®) System
Indicator
VSA® OFF Indicator
Low Tire Pressure/
TPMS Indicator
Electric Power
Steering (EPS) System
Indicator
Lights Indicators
Lights On Indicator
High Beam Indicator
Immobilizer System
Indicator
Seat Belt Reminder
Indicator
EV Indicator
POWER/CHARGE
Gauge
Speedometer
Fuel Gauge
Security System
Alarm Indicator
Shift Lever Position
Indicator
Gauges (P 92)/Multi-Information Display (P 94)/System Indicators (P 72)
Turn Signal and
Hazard Warning
Indicators
System Indicators
High Voltage Battery
Charge Level Gauge
POWER SYSTEM
Indicator
Smart Entry System
Indicator
System Message
Indicator
ECON mode
Indicator
Forward Collision
Warning (
FCW
) Indicator
*
Lane Departure Warning
(
LDW
) Indicator
*
Brake System
Indicator (Amber)
Supplemental
Restraint System
Indicator
EV Mode Indicator
System Indicators
Multi-Information Display
17
Quick Reference Guide
Controls (P 109)
Clock (P 110)
a Enter the Clock Adjustment screen.
2 Adjusting the Clock (P 110)
b Rotate to change hour, then press
.
c Rotate to change minute, then
press .
The navigation system receives signals from
GPS satellites, updating the clock
automatically.
Models without navigation system
Models with navigation system
POWER Button (P 133)
Press the button to change the vehicle’s
power mode.
Turn Signals (P 136)
Turn Signal Control Lever
Right
Left
Lights (P 136)
Wipers and Washers
(P 140)
Light Control Switches
Low Beam
High Beam
Flashing
Wiper/Washer Control Lever
Adjustment Ring
: Long Delay
: Short Delay
MIST
OFF
INT: Low speed with intermittent
LO: Low speed wipe
HI: High speed wipe
Pull toward
you to spray
washer fluid.
* Not available on all models
18
Quick Reference Guide
Steering Wheel (P 145)
To adjust, pull the adjustment lever
towards you, adjust to the desired
position, then lock the lever back in place.
Unlocking the Front
Doors from the Inside
(P 118)
Pull either front door inner handle to
unlock and open it at the same time.
Unlocking and opening the driver’s door
from the inner handle unlocks all the
other doors.
Trunk (P 122)
To unlock and open the trunk:
Pull the trunk release.
Press the trunk release button on the remote
transmitter or the smart entry remote.
Press the trunk release button on the
trunk lid.
Power Door Mirrors
(P 147)
With the power mode in ON, move the
selector switch to L or R.
Push the appropriate edge of the
adjustment switch to adjust the mirror.
Trunk Release
Selector Switch
Adjustment Switch
Power Windows (P 129)
With the power mode in ON, open and
close the power windows.
If the power window lock button is in the
off position, each passenger's window
can be opened and closed with its own
switch.
If the power window lock button is in the
on position (indicator is on), each
passenger's window switch is disabled.
Power Window Lock Button
Window
Switch
Indicator
19
Quick Reference Guide
Climate Control System (P 165)
Press the AUTO button to activate the climate control system.
Press the button to turn the system on or off.
Press the button to defrost the windshield.
The climate control system is voice operable. (P 239)
Models with navigation system
Driver’s Side
Temperature Control
Buttons
(Rear Window Defogger/Heated Mirror)
Button
(Windshield Defroster) Button
SYNC (Synchronized) Button
Air flows from floor and windshield
defroster vents.
Air flows from floor vents.
Air flows from floor and dashboard
vents, and back of the center console.
Air flows from dashboard vents and
back of the center console.
AUTO Button
(On/Off) Button
(Recirculation) Button
MODE Control Button
/ (Fan Control) Buttons
A/C (Air Conditioning) Button
Passenger’s Side Temperature Control Buttons
20
Quick Reference Guide
Features (P 169)
Audio Remote Controls
(P 174)
(+ / (- Button
Press to adjust the volume up/down.
SOURCE Button
Press to change the audio mode: FM/AM/
CD/XM®
*
/HDD
*
/USB/iPod/Bluetooth/
Pandora®
*
/Aha
TM*
/AUX.
/ Button
Radio:Press to change the preset station.
Press and hold to select the next or
previous strong station.
CD/HDD
*
/USB device:
Press to skip to the beginning of
the next song or return to the
beginning of the current song.
Press and hold to change a folder.
(+ / (- / / Button
SOURCE
Button
Audio System (P 175, 197, 230)
(P 175)
Models with one display
Audio/Information
Screen
BACK Button
FM/AM Button
(Skip/Seek)
Button
Selector Knob
Button
VOL/
(Volume/Power)
Knob
CD Button
AUX Button
CD Slot
(CD Eject)
Button
Preset Buttons
(1-6)
SETTINGS Button
(Skip/Seek)
Button
PHONE Button
MENU Button
DISP Button
21
Quick Reference Guide
*1: Icons that appear on the screen vary by the source selected.
CD Slot
(CD Eject) Button
BACK Button
Selector Knob
(Tune Down) Icon
*1
(Skip/Seek) Icon
*1
(P 197)
Models with two displays
Audio/Information Screen
Audio with Touch Screen
Button
Source
*1
VOL/ (Volume/Power)
Knob
(Skip/Seek) Icon
*1
Presets
*1
Phone
*1
Clock/Screen
*1
DISP Button
(Tune Up) Icon
*1
More
*1
* Not available on all models
22
Quick Reference Guide
*1: Icons that appear on the screen vary by the source selected.
CD Slot
(CD Eject) Button
MENU Button
Interface Dial/ENTER Button
(Skip/Seek) Icon
*1
(P 230)
Models with navigation system
Audio/Information Screen
Audio with Touch Screen
Button
Source
*1
VOL (Volume) Knob
(Skip/Seek) Icon
*1
Presets
*1
(Tune Up) Icon
*1
More
*1
(Power) Button
(Tune Down) Icon
*1
INFO Button
AUDIO Button
SETTINGS Button
BACK Button
NAV Button
PHONE Button
23
Quick Reference Guide
Driving (P 409)
Transmission (P 420)
Shift to
(P and depress the brake pedal when turning on the power.
Shifting
Park
Used when parking or turning the power on or off.
Neutral
Propulsion power is not transmitted to wheels.
Drive (B)
Used when driving down a long hill.
Used to increase regenerative braking.
Depress the brake pedal and press the
release button to move out of
(P .
Press the release button to move
the shift lever.
Move the shift lever without
pressing the release button.
Reverse
Used when reversing.
Drive
Used for normal driving.
Shift Lever
Release Button
Vehicle Stability Assist
(VSA®)
(P 443)
The vehicle stability assist (VSA®) system
helps stabilize the vehicle during
cornering, and helps maintain traction
while accelerating on loose or slippery
road surfaces.
To turn VSA® on or off, press and hold
the button until you hear a beep.
VSA® comes on automatically every time
you turn on the power system.
Cruise Control (P 424)
Cruise control allows you to maintain a
set speed without keeping your foot on
the accelerator pedal.
To use cruise control, press the CRUISE
button, then press the –/SET button once
you have achieved the desired speed
(above 25 mph or 40 km/h).
Tire Pressure Monitoring
System (TPMS) (P 447)
Detects a change in tire conditions and
overall dimensions due to decrease in tire
pressures.
The TPMS is turned on automatically
every time you turn on the power system.
A calibration procedure must be
performed when certain conditions arise.
24
Quick Reference Guide
Refueling (P 459)
Fuel recommendation: Unleaded gasoline with a pump octane number 87
or higher required
Fuel tank capacity: 15.8 US gal (60 L)
a Push the fuel fill
door release
handle.
b Turn the fuel fill
cap slowly to
remove the cap.
c Place the cap in
the holder on the
fuel fill door.
d After refueling,
screw the cap
back on until it
clicks at least
once.
25
Quick Reference Guide
Maintenance (P 463)
Under the Hood (P 471)
Check engine oil, engine coolant, inverter coolant, and
windshield washer fluid. Add when necessary.
Check brake fluid.
Check the 12-volt battery condition monthly.
a Pull the hood release handle under the corner of the
dashboard.
b Locate the hood latch lever, pull the lever up, and lift up
the hood.
c When finished, close the hood and make sure it is firmly
locked in place.
Lights (P 484)
Inspect all lights regularly.
Wiper Blades (P 491)
Replace blades if they leave streaks
across the windshield.
Tires (P 493)
Inspect tires and wheels regularly.
Check tire pressures regularly.
Install snow tires for winter
driving.
26
Quick Reference Guide
Handling the Unexpected (P 509)
Flat Tire (P 510)
Park in a safe location and repair the flat
tire using the tire repair kit in the trunk.
Indicators Come On
(P 528)
Identify the indicator and consult the
owner's manual.
Power System Won't
Start (P 519)
If the 12-volt battery is dead, jump start
using a booster battery.
Blown Fuse (P 532)
Check for a blown fuse if an electrical
device does not operate.
Overheating (P 525)
Park in a safe location. If you do not see
steam under the hood, open the hood,
and let the power system cool down.
Emergency Towing
(P 535)
Call a professional towing service if you
need to tow your vehicle.
27
Quick Reference Guide
What to Do If
The power mode does not
change from VEHICLE OFF
(LOCK) to ACCESSORY.
Why?
The steering wheel may be locked.
Move the steering wheel left and right while
pressing the POWER button at the same time.
The power mode does not
change from ACCESSORY
to VEHICLE OFF (LOCK).
Why?
The shift lever should be moved to (P.
Why does the brake pedal
pulsate slightly when
applying the brakes?
This can occur when the ABS activates, and does not indicate a
problem. Apply firm, steady pressure on the brake pedal. Never
pump the brake pedal.
The rear door cannot be
opened from inside the
vehicle. Why?
Check if the childproof lock is in
the lock position. If so, open the
rear door with the outside door
handle.
To cancel this function, push the
lever to the unlock position.
28
Quick Reference Guide
Why do the doors lock
after I unlocked the doors
using a remote
transmitter?
If you do not open the doors within 30 seconds, the doors are
relocked automatically for security.
Why does the beeper
sound when I open the
driver's door?
The beeper sounds when:
The power mode is in ACCESSORY.
The exterior lights are left on.
Why does the beeper
sound when I start driving?
The beeper sounds when:
Driver and/or front passenger are not wearing their seat belts.
The parking brake lever is not fully released.
Why do I hear a screeching
sound when I apply the
brake pedal?
The brake pads may need to be replaced. Have your vehicle
inspected by a dealer.
29
Quick Reference Guide
California Proposition 65 Warning
Event Data Recorders
This vehicle is equipped with an event data recorder (EDR).
The main purpose of an EDR is to record, in certain crash or near
crash-like situations, such as an air bag deployment or hitting a
road obstacle, data that will assist in understanding how a vehicle’s
systems performed. The EDR is designed to record data related
to vehicle dynamics and safety systems for a short period of
time, typically 30 seconds or less. The EDR in this vehicle is
designed to record such data as:
How various systems in your vehicle were operating;
Whether or not the driver and passenger safety belts were
buckled/fastened;
How far (if at all) the driver was depressing the accelerator
and/or brake pedal; and,
How fast the vehicle was traveling.
These data can help provide a better understanding of the
circumstances in which crashes and injuries occur. NOTE: EDR data
are recorded by your vehicle only if a non-trivial crash situation
occurs; no data are recorded by the EDR under normal driving
conditions and no personal data (e.g., name, gender, age, and
crash location) are recorded. However, other parties, such as law
enforcement, could combine the EDR data with the type of
personally identifying data routinely acquired during a crash
investigation.
WARNING: This product contains or emits
chemicals known to the state of California to cause
cancer and birth defects or other reproductive
harm.
To read data recorded by an EDR, special equipment is required,
and access to the vehicle or the EDR is needed. In addition to the
vehicle manufacturer, other parties, such as law enforcement, that
have the special equipment, can read the information if they have
access to the vehicle or the EDR.
The data belongs to the vehicle owner and may not be accessed by
anyone else except as legally required or with the permission of the
vehicle owner.
Service Diagnostic Recorders
This vehicle is equipped with service-related devices that record
information about powertrain performance. The data can be used
to verify emissions law requirements and/or help technicians
diagnose and solve service problems. It may also be combined with
data from other sources for research purposes, but it remains
confidential.
California Perchlorate Contamination Prevention Act
The airbags, seat belt tensioners, and CR type batteries in this
vehicle may contain perchlorate materials - special handling may
apply. See www.dtsc.ca.gov/hazardouswaste/perchlorate/
As you read this manual, you will find information that is preceded
by a symbol. This information is intended to help you avoid
damage to your vehicle, other property, or the environment.
NOTICE
30
Quick Reference Guide
A Few Words About Safety
Your safety, and the safety of others, is very important. And
operating this vehicle safely is an important responsibility.
To help you make informed decisions about safety, we have
provided operating procedures and other information on labels and
in this manual. This information alerts you to potential hazards that
could hurt you or others.
Of course, it is not practical or possible to warn you about all the
hazards associated with operating or maintaining your vehicle. You
must use your own good judgement.
You will find this important safety information in a variety of forms,
including:
Safety Labels - on the vehicle.
Safety Messages - preceded by a safety alert symbol
3 and
one of three signal words: DANGER, WARNING, or CAUTION.
These signal words mean:
Safety Headings - such as Important Safety Precautions.
Safety Section - such as Safe Driving.
Instructions - how to use this vehicle correctly and safely.
This entire book is filled with important safety information - please
read it carefully.
3DANGER
You WILL be KILLED or SERIOUSLY HURT if
you don't follow instructions.
3WARNING
You CAN be KILLED or SERIOUSLY HURT if
you don't follow instructions.
3CAUTION
You CAN be HURT if you don't follow
instructions.
31
Safe Driving
You can find many safety recommendations throughout this chapter, and throughout this manual.
For Safe Driving
Important Safety Precautions ............. 32
Your Vehicle's Safety Features............ 34
Seat Belts
About Your Seat Belts........................ 36
Fastening a Seat Belt.......................... 39
Seat Belt Inspection............................ 42
Airbags
Airbag System Components............... 43
Types of Airbags ................................ 46
Front Airbags (SRS) ............................ 46
Side Airbags....................................... 50
Side Curtain Airbags.......................... 52
Airbag System Indicators.................... 53
Airbag Care....................................... 55
Child Safety
Protecting Child Passengers ............... 56
Safety of Infants and Small Children .......58
Safety of Larger Children ................... 66
Exhaust Gas Hazard
Carbon Monoxide Gas....................... 68
Safety Labels
Label Locations.................................. 69
Main Menu
32
Safe Driving
For Safe Driving
The following pages explain your vehicle's safety features and how to use them
properly. The safety precautions below are ones that we consider to be among the
most important.
Important Safety Precautions
Always wear your seat belt
A seat belt is your best protection in all types of collisions. Airbags are designed to
supplement seat belts, not replace them. So even though your vehicle is equipped
with airbags, make sure you and your passengers always wear your seat belts, and
wear them properly.
Restrain all children
Children ages 12 and under should ride properly restrained in a back seat, not the
front seat. Infants and small children should be restrained in a child seat. Larger
children should use a booster seat and a lap/shoulder seat belt until they can use the
belt properly without a booster seat.
Be aware of airbag hazards
While airbags can save lives, they can cause serious or fatal injuries to occupants
who sit too close to them, or are not properly restrained. Infants, young children,
and short adults are at the greatest risk. Be sure to follow all instructions and
warnings in this manual.
Don't drink and drive
Alcohol and driving don't mix. Even one drink can reduce your ability to respond to
changing conditions, and your reaction time gets worse with every additional drink.
So don't drink and drive, and don't let your friends drink and drive, either.
1Important Safety Precautions
Some states, provinces and territories prohibit the use
of cell phones other than hands-free devices by the
driver while driving.
Table of Contents
33
uuFor Safe DrivinguImportant Safety Precautions
Safe Driving
Pay appropriate attention to the task of driving safely
Engaging in cell phone conversation or other activities that keep you from paying
close attention to the road, other vehicles, and pedestrians could lead to a crash.
Remember, situations can change quickly, and only you can decide when it is safe to
divert some attention away from driving.
Control your speed
Excessive speed is a major factor in crash injuries and deaths. Generally, the higher
the speed, the greater the risk, but serious injuries can also occur at lower speeds.
Never drive faster than is safe for current conditions, regardless of the maximum
speed posted.
Keep your vehicle in safe condition
Having a tire blowout or a mechanical failure can be extremely hazardous.
To reduce the possibility of such problems, check your tire pressures and condition
frequently, and perform all regularly scheduled maintenance.
Table of Contents
34
uuFor Safe DrivinguYour Vehicle's Safety Features
Safe Driving
Your Vehicle's Safety Features
The following checklist will help you take an active role in protecting yourself and
your passengers.
1Your Vehicle's Safety Features
Your vehicle is equipped with many features that
work together to help protect you and your
passengers during a crash.
Some features do not require any action on your part.
These include a strong steel framework that forms a
safety cage around the passenger compartment,
front and rear crush zones, a collapsible steering
column, and tensioners that tighten the front seat
belts in a sufficient crash.
However, you and your passengers cannot take full
advantage of these features unless you remain seated
in the correct position and always wear your seat
belts. In fact, some safety features can contribute to
injuries if they are not used properly.
6
7
8
9
10
11
Safety Cage
Crush Zones
Seats and Seat-Backs
Head Restraints
Collapsible Steering Column
Seat Belts
Front Airbags
Side Curtain Airbags
Door Locks
Side Airbags
Seat Belt Tensioners
7
7
99
8
8
10
10
6
11
Table of Contents
35
uuFor Safe DrivinguYour Vehicle's Safety Features
Safe Driving
For the safety of you and your passengers, make a habit of checking these items
each time before you drive.
After everyone has entered the vehicle, be sure all doors are closed and locked.
Locking the doors helps prevent an occupant from being ejected and an outsider
from unexpectedly opening a door.
2 Locking/Unlocking the Doors from the Inside P. 118
Adjust your seat to a position suitable for driving. Be sure the front seats are
adjusted as far to the rear as possible while allowing the driver to control the
vehicle. Sitting too close to a front airbag can result in serious or fatal injury in a
crash.
2 Adjusting the Seats P. 148
Adjust head restraints to the proper position. Head restraints are most effective
when the center of the head restraint aligns with the center of your head. Taller
persons should adjust their head restraint to the highest position.
2 Adjusting the Head Restraints P. 151
Always wear your seat belt, and make sure you wear it properly. Confirm that any
passengers are properly belted as well.
2 Fastening a Seat Belt P. 39
Protect children by using seat belts or child seats according to a child's age, height
and weight.
2 Child Safety P. 56
Safety CheckList
1Safety CheckList
If the Door Open or Door And Trunk Open
message appears on the multi-information display, a
door and/or the trunk is not completely closed. Close
all doors and the trunk tightly until the message
diappears.
2 Multi-Information Display Warning and
Information Messages P. 84
Table of Contents
36
Safe Driving
Seat Belts
About Your Seat Belts
Seat belts are the single most effective safety device because they keep you
connected to the vehicle so that you can take advantage of many built-in safety
features. They also help keep you from being thrown against the inside of the
vehicle, against other passengers, or out of the vehicle. When worn properly, seat
belts also keep your body properly positioned in a crash so that you can take full
advantage of the additional protection provided by the airbags.
In addition, seat belts help protect you in almost every type of crash, including:
- frontal impacts
- side impacts
- rear impacts
- rollovers
Lap/shoulder seat belts
All five seating positions are equipped with lap/shoulder seat belts with emergency
locking retractors. In normal driving the retractor lets you move freely while keeping
some tension on the belt. During a collision or sudden stop the retractor locks to
restrain your body. The rear seat belts also have a lockable retractor for use with
child seats.
2 Installing a Child Seat with a Lap/Shoulder Seat Belt P. 63
1About Your Seat Belts
Seat belts cannot completely protect you in every
crash. But in most cases, seat belts can reduce your
risk of serious injury.
Most states and all Canadian provinces and territories
require you to wear seat belts.
3
WARNING
Not wearing a seat belt properly increases
the chance of serious injury or death in a
crash, even though your vehicle has
airbags.
Be sure you and your passengers always
wear seat belts and wear them properly.
Table of Contents
Continued
37
uuSeat BeltsuAbout Your Seat Belts
Safe Driving
Proper use of seat belts
Follow these guidelines for proper use:
All occupants should sit upright, well back in the seat, and remain in that position
for the duration of the trip. Slouching and leaning reduces the effectiveness of
the belt and can increase the chance of serious injury in a crash.
Never place the shoulder part of a lap/shoulder seat belt under your arm or
behind your back. This could cause very serious injuries in a crash.
Two people should never use the same seat belt. If they do, they could be very
seriously injured in a crash.
Do not put any accessories on the seat belts. Devices intended to improve comfort
or reposition the shoulder part of a seat belt can reduce the protective capability
and increase the chance of serious injury in a crash.
Your vehicle monitors front seat belt use. If
the power mode is set to ON before the
driver's seat belt is fastened, the beeper will
sound and the indicator will blink. If the driver
does not fasten the belt before the beeper
stops, the indicator will remain on.
The beeper will also periodically sound and
the indicator will blink while driving until the
driver's and front passenger’s seat belts are
fastened.
Seat Belt Reminder
1About Your Seat Belts
If a rear seat passenger moves around and extends
the seat belt, the lockable retractor may activate. If
this happens, release the retractor by unfastening the
seat belt and allow the belt to retract completely.
Then refasten the belt.
1Seat Belt Reminder
The indicator will also come on if a front passenger
does not fasten their seat belt within six seconds after
the power mode is set to ON.
When no one is sitting in the front passenger's seat,
the indicator will not come on and the beeper will not
sound. The indicator also may not come on and the
beeper may not sound when the occupant is not
heavy enough to trigger the weight sensor. Such
occupants (e.g., infants and smaller children) should
be moved to the rear seat as a deploying front airbag
likely will injure or kill them.
2 Protecting Child Passengers P. 56
Table of Contents
uuSeat Belts uAbout Your Seat Belts
38
Safe Driving
The front seats are equipped with automatic seat belt tensioners to enhance safety.
The tensioners automatically tighten the front seat belts during a moderate-to-
severe frontal collision, sometimes even if the collision is not severe enough to
inflate the front airbags.
Automatic Seat Belt Tensioners
1Automatic Seat Belt Tensioners
The seat belt tensioners can only operate once.
If a tensioner is activated, the SRS indicator will come
on. Have a dealer replace the tensioner and
thoroughly inspect the seat belt system as it may not
offer protection in a subsequent crash.
During a moderate-to-severe side impact, the
tensioner on that side of the vehicle also activates.
Table of Contents
39
uuSeat BeltsuFastening a Seat Belt
Continued
Safe Driving
Fastening a Seat Belt
After adjusting a front seat to the proper position, and while sitting upright and well
back in the seat:
2 Adjusting the Seats P. 148
1. Pull the seat belt out slowly.
2. Insert the latch plate into the buckle, then
tug on the belt to make sure the buckle is
secure.
u Make sure that the belt is not twisted or
caught on anything.
1Fastening a Seat Belt
No one should sit in a seat with an inoperative seat
belt or one that does not appear to be working
correctly. Using a seat belt that is not working
properly may not protect the occupant in a crash.
Have a dealer check the belt as soon as possible.
Never insert any foreign objects into the buckle or
retractor mechanism.
Pull out slowly.
Correct
Seated
Posture.
Latch
Plate
Buckle
Table of Contents
uuSeat Belts uFastening a Seat Belt
40
Safe Driving
3. Position the lap part of the belt as low as
possible across your hips, then pull up on
the shoulder part of the belt so the lap part
fits snugly. This lets your strong pelvic
bones take the force of a crash and reduces
the chance of internal injuries.
4. If necessary, pull up on the belt again to
remove any slack, then check that the belt
rests across the center of your chest and
over your shoulder. This spreads the forces
of a crash over the strongest bones in your
upper body.
The front seats have adjustable shoulder anchors to accommodate taller and shorter
occupants.
1. Move the anchor up and down while
holding the release button.
2. Position the anchor so that the belt rests
across the center of your chest and over
your shoulder.
1Fastening a Seat Belt
To release the belt, push the red PRESS button then
guide the belt by hand until it has retracted
completely.
When exiting the vehicle, be sure the belt is out of
the way and will not get caught by closing the door.
3
WARNING
Improperly positioning the seat belts can
cause serious injury or death in a crash.
Make sure all seat belts are properly
positioned before driving.
Lap belt as
low as
possible
Adjusting the Shoulder Anchor
1Adjusting the Shoulder Anchor
The shoulder anchor height can be adjusted to four
levels. If the belt contacts your neck, lower the height
one level at a time.
After an adjustment, make sure that the shoulder
anchor position is secure.
Push
Table of Contents
41
uuSeat BeltsuFastening a Seat Belt
Safe Driving
If you are pregnant, the best way to protect yourself and your unborn child when
driving or riding in a vehicle is to always wear a seat belt and keep the lap part of the
belt as low as possible across the hips.
Advice for Pregnant Women
1Advice for Pregnant Women
Each time you have a checkup, ask your doctor if it is
okay for you to drive.
To reduce the risk of injuries to both you and your
unborn child that can be caused by an inflating front
airbag:
When driving, sit upright and adjust the seat as far
back as possible while allowing full control of the
vehicle.
When sitting in the front passenger's seat, adjust
the seat as far back as possible.
Wear the shoulder belt
across the chest avoiding
the abdomen.
Wear the lap part of the
belt as low as possible
across the hips.
Table of Contents
42
uuSeat Belts uSeat Belt Inspection
Safe Driving
Seat Belt Inspection
Regularly check the condition of your seat belts as follows:
Pull each belt out fully, and look for frays, cuts, burns, and wear.
Check that the latches work smoothly and the belts retract easily.
u If a belt does not retract easily, cleaning the belt may correct the problem. Only
use a mild soap and warm water. Do not use bleach or cleaning solvents. Make
sure the belt is completely dry before allowing it to retract.
Any belt that is not in good condition or working properly will not provide proper
protection and should be replaced as soon as possible.
A belt that has been worn during a crash may not provide the same level of
protection in a subsequent crash. Have your seat belts inspected by a dealer after
any collision.
1Seat Belt Inspection
3
WARNING
Not checking or maintaining seat belts can
result in serious injury or death if the seat
belts do not work properly when needed.
Check your seat belts regularly and have
any problem corrected as soon as possible.
Table of Contents
43
Continued
Safe Driving
Airbags
Airbag System Components
6
7
8
9
8
8
8
8
8
10
11
12
Table of Contents
44
uuAirbagsuAirbag System Components
Safe Driving
The front, front side, and side curtain
airbags are deployed according to the
direction and severity of impact. Both side
curtain airbags are deployed in a rollover.
The airbag system includes:
a Two SRS (Supplemental Restraint System)
front airbags. The driver's airbag is stored
in the center of the steering wheel; the
front passenger's airbag is stored in the
dashboard. Both are marked SRS
AIRBAG.
b Two side airbags, one for the driver and
one for a front passenger. The airbags are
stored in the outer edges of the seat-
backs. Both are marked SIDE AIRBAG.
c Two side curtain airbags, one for each
side of the vehicle. The airbags are stored
in the ceiling, above the side windows.
The front and rear pillars are marked
SIDE CURTAIN AIRBAG.
d An electronic control unit that continually
monitors and records information about
the sensors, the airbag activators, the
seat belt tensioners, and driver and front
passenger seat belt use when the power
mode is in ON.
e Automatic front seat belt tensioners. The
driver's and front passenger's seat belts
incorporate sensors that detect whether
or not they are fastened.
f A driver's seat position sensor. If the seat
is too far forward, the airbag will inflate
with less force.
g Weight sensors in the front passenger's
seat. The front passenger's airbag will be
turned off if the weight on the seat is 65
lbs (29 kg) or less (the weight of an infant
or small child).
h Impact sensors that can detect a
moderate-to-severe front or side impact.
i An indicator on the dashboard that alerts
you that the front passenger's front
airbag has been turned off.
j An indicator on the instrument panel that
alerts you to a possible problem with your
airbag system or seat belt tensioners.
k Safing Sensor
l A rollover sensor that detects whether
the vehicle is about to roll over.
Table of Contents
45
uuAirbagsuAirbag System Components
Safe Driving
Airbags can pose serious hazards. To do their job, airbags must inflate with
tremendous force. So, while airbags help save lives, they can cause burns, bruises,
and other minor injuries, sometimes even fatal ones if occupants are not wearing
their seat belts properly and sitting correctly.
What you should do: Always wear your seat belt properly, and sit upright and as
far back from the steering wheel as possible while allowing full control of the
vehicle. A front passenger should move their seat as far back from the dashboard as
possible.
Remember, however, that no safety system can prevent all injuries or deaths that
can occur in a severe crash, even when seat belts are properly worn and the airbags
deploy.
Do not place hard or sharp objects between yourself and a front airbag.
Carrying hard or sharp objects on your lap, or driving with a pipe or other sharp
object in your mouth, can result in injuries if your front airbag inflates.
Do not attach or place objects on the front airbag covers. Objects on the
covers marked SRS AIRBAG could interfere with the proper operation of the airbags
or be propelled inside the vehicle and hurt someone if the airbags inflate.
Important facts about your airbags
1Important facts about your airbags
Do not attempt to deactivate your airbags. Together,
airbags and seat belts provide the best protection.
When driving, keep hands and arms out of the
deployment path of the front airbag by holding each
side of the steering wheel. Do not cross an arm over
the airbag cover.
Table of Contents
46
uuAirbagsuTypes of Airbags
Safe Driving
Types of Airbags
Your vehicle is equipped with three types of airbags:
Front airbags: Airbags in front of the driver's and front passenger's seats.
Side airbags: Airbags in the driver's and front passenger's seat-backs.
Side curtain airbags: Airbags above the side windows.
Each is discussed in the following pages.
Front Airbags (SRS)
The front SRS airbags inflate in a moderate-to-severe frontal collision to help protect
the head and chest of the driver and/or front passenger.
SRS (Supplemental Restraint System) indicates that the airbags are designed to
supplement seat belts, not replace them. Seat belts are the occupant's primary
restraint system.
The front airbags are housed in the center of the steering wheel for the driver, and
in the dashboard for the front passenger. Both airbags are marked SRS AIRBAG.
Housing Locations
1Types of Airbags
The airbags can inflate whenever the power mode is
in ON.
After an airbag inflates in a crash, you may see a
small amount of smoke. This is from the combustion
process of the inflator material and is not hamful.
People with respiratory problems may experience
some temporary discomfort. If this occurs, get out of
the vehicle as soon as it is safe to do so.
1Front Airbags (SRS)
Dual-Stage, Multiple-Threshold Front Airbags
(SRS)
Your vehicle is equipped with dual-stage, multiple-
threshold front airbags (SRS).
During a frontal crash severe enough to cause one or
both front airbags to deploy, the airbags can inflate
at different rates, depending on the severity of the
crash, whether or not the seat belts are latched, and/
or other factors. Frontal airbags are designed to
supplement the seat belts to help reduce the
likelihood of head and chest injuries in frontal
crashes.
Table of Contents
Continued
47
uuAirbagsuFront Airbags (SRS)
Safe Driving
Front airbags are designed to inflate during moderate-to-severe frontal collisions.
When the vehicle decelerates suddenly, the sensors send information to the control
unit which signals one or both front airbags to inflate.
A frontal collision can be either head-on or angled between two vehicles, or when a
vehicle crashes into a stationary object, such as a concrete wall.
While your seat belt restrains your torso, the
front airbag provides supplemental protection
for your head and chest.
The front airbags deflate immediately so that
they won't interfere with the driver's visibility
or the ability to steer or operate other
controls.
The total time for inflation and deflation is so fast that most occupants are not
aware that the airbags deployed until they see them lying in front of them.
Operation
How the Front Airbags Work
1How the Front Airbags Work
Although the driver's and front passenger's airbags
normally inflate within a split second of each other, it
is possible for only one airbag to deploy. This can
happen if the severity of a collision is at the margin,
or threshold, that determines whether or not the
airbags will deploy. In such cases, the seat belt will
provide sufficient protection, and the supplemental
protection offered by the airbag would be minimal.
Table of Contents
48
uuAirbagsuFront Airbags (SRS)
Safe Driving
When front airbags should not deploy
Minor frontal crashes: Front airbags were designed to supplement seat belts and
help save lives, not to prevent minor scrapes, or even broken bones that might occur
during a less than moderate-to-severe frontal crash.
Side impacts: Front airbags can provide protection when a sudden deceleration
causes a driver or front passenger to move towards the front of the vehicle. Side
airbags and side curtain airbags have been specifically designed to help reduce the
severity of injuries that can occur during a moderate-to-severe side impact which
can cause the driver or passenger to move towards the side of the vehicle.
Rear impacts: Head restraints and seat belts are your best protection during a rear
impact. Front airbags cannot provide any significant protection and are not designed
to deploy in such collisions.
Rollovers: Seat belts and, in vehicles equipped with a rollover sensor, side airbags
and side curtain airbags offer the best protection in a rollover. Because front airbags
could provide little if any protection, they are not designed to deploy during a
rollover.
When front airbags deploy with little or no visible damage
Because the airbag system senses sudden deceleration, a strong impact to the
vehicle framework or suspension might cause one or more of the airbags to deploy.
Examples include running into a curb, the edge of a hole, or other low fixed object
that causes a sudden deceleration in the vehicle chassis. Since the impact is
underneath the vehicle, damage may not be readily apparent.
When front airbags may not deploy, even though exterior damage
appears severe
Since crushable body parts absorb crash energy during an impact, the amount of
visible damage does not always indicate proper airbag operation. In fact, some
collisions can result in severe damage but no airbag deployment because the airbags
would not have been needed or would not have provided protection even if they
had deployed.
Table of Contents
49
uuAirbagsuFront Airbags (SRS)
Safe Driving
Your front airbags have advanced features to help reduce the likelihood of airbag
related injuries to smaller occupants.
The driver's advanced front airbag system
includes a seat position sensor.
If the seat is too far forward, the airbag
inflates with less force, regardless of the
severity of the impact.
The passenger's advanced front airbag system
has weight sensors.
Although we recommend against carrying an
infant or small child in front, if the sensors
detect the weight of a child (up to about 65
lbs or 29 kg), the system will automatically
turn off the passenger's front airbag.
Advanced Airbags
1Advanced Airbags
If there is a problem with the driver's seat position
sensor, the SRS indicator will come on and the airbag
will inflate with full (normal) force, regardless of the
driver's seating position.
For both advanced front airbags to work properly:
Do not spill any liquid on or under the seats.
Do not put any object under the passenger’s seat.
Make sure any objects are positioned properly on
the floor. Improperly positioned objects can
interfere with the advanced airbag sensors.
All occupants should sit upright and wear their seat
belts properly.
Do not place any cover over the passenger side
dashboard.
Driver’s
Seat
Position
Sensor
Passenger’s
Seat
Weight
Sensors
Table of Contents
50
uuAirbagsuSide Airbags
Safe Driving
Side Airbags
The side airbags help protect the torso and pelvis of the driver or a front passenger
during a moderate-to-severe side impact.
The side airbags are housed in the outside
edge of the driver's and passenger's seat-
backs.
Both are marked SIDE AIRBAG.
When the sensors detect a moderate-to-
severe side impact, the control unit signals the
side airbag on the impact side to immediately
inflate.
Housing Locations
1Side Airbags
Make sure you and your front seat passenger always
sit upright. Leaning into the path of a side airbag can
prevent the airbag from deploying properly and
increases your risk of serious injury.
Do not attach accessories on or near the side airbags.
They can interfere with the proper operation of the
airbags, or hurt someone if an airbag inflates.
If the impact is on the passenger side, the airbag
deploys even if there is no passenger in the passenger
seat.
Do not cover or replace the front seat-back covers
without consulting a dealer.
Improperly replacing or covering front seat-back
covers can prevent your side airbags from properly
deploying during a side impact.
Housing
Location
Operation
When
inflated
Side
Airbag
Table of Contents
51
uuAirbagsuSide Airbags
Safe Driving
When a side airbag deploys with little or no visible damage
Because the airbag systems senses sudden acceleration, a strong impact to the side
of the vehicle's framework can cause a side airbag to deploy. In such cases, there
may be little or no damage, but the side impact sensors detected a severe enough
impact to deploy the airbag.
When a side airbag may not deploy, even though visible damage appears
severe
It is possible for a side airbag to not deploy during an impact that results in
apparently severe damage. This can occur when the point of impact was towards
the far front or rear of the vehicle, or when the vehicle's crushable body parts
absorbed most of the crash energy. In either case, the side airbag would not have
been needed nor provided protection even if it had deployed.
Table of Contents
52
uuAirbagsuSide Curtain Airbags
Safe Driving
Side Curtain Airbags
The side curtain airbags help protect the heads of the driver and passengers in outer
seating positions during a moderate-to-severe side impact. The side curtain airbags
equipped in this vehicle are also designed to help reduce the likelihood of partial and
complete ejection of vehicle occupants through side windows in crashes, particularly
rollover crashes.
The side curtain airbags are located in the
ceiling above the side windows on both sides
of the vehicle.
The side curtain airbag is designed to deploy
in a rollover or a moderate-to-severe side
impact.
Housing Locations
1Side Curtain Airbags
If the SRS control unit senses that your vehicle is
about to rollover, it immediately deploys both side
curtain airbags and activates both front seat belt
tensioners.
If the impact is on the passenger’s side, the
passenger’s side curtain airbag will inflate even if
there are no occupants on that side of the vehicle.
To get the best protection from the side curtain
airbags, occupants should wear their seat belts
properly and sit upright and well back in their seats.
Do not attach any objects to the side windows or roof
pillars as they can interfere with the proper operation
of the side curtain airbags.
Side Curtain Airbag Storage
Operation
Deployed Side Curtain Airbag
Table of Contents
Continued
53
uuAirbagsuAirbag System Indicators
Safe Driving
When side curtain airbags deploy in a frontal collision
One or both side curtain airbags may inflate in a moderate-to-severe angled frontal
collision.
In this case, the side curtain airbags will deploy slightly after the front airbags.
Airbag System Indicators
If a problem occurs in the airbag system, the SRS indicator will come on and a
message appears on the multi-information display.
When the power mode is set to ON
The indicator comes on for a few seconds,
then goes off. This tells you the system is
working properly.
If the indicator comes on at any other time, or does not come on at all, have the
system checked by a dealer as soon as possible. If you don't, your airbags and seat
belt tensioners may not work properly when they are needed.
SRS (Supplemental Restraint System) Indicator
1SRS (Supplemental Restraint System) Indicator
3
WARNING
Ignoring the SRS indicator can result in
serious injury or death if the airbag systems
or tensioners do not work properly.
Have your vehicle checked by a dealer as
soon as possible if the SRS indicator alerts
you to a possible problem.
Table of Contents
uuAirbagsuAirbag System Indicators
54
Safe Driving
When the passenger airbag off
indicator comes on
The indicator comes on to alert you that the
passenger's front airbag has been turned off.
This occurs when the front passenger’s weight
sensors detect 65 lbs (29 kg) or less, the
weight of an infant or small child, on the seat.
Infants and small children should always ride properly restrained in a back seat.
2 Child Safety P. 56
Objects placed on the seat can also cause the indicator to come on.
If the front passenger seat is empty, the passenger's front airbag will not deploy and
the indicator will not come on.
Passenger Airbag Off Indicator
1Passenger Airbag Off Indicator
If the indicator comes on with no front passenger and
no objects on the passenger’s seat, or with an adult
riding there, something may be interfering with the
weight sensors, such as:
An object hanging on the seat or in the seat-back
pocket.
A child seat or other object pressing against the
rear of the seat-back.
A rear passenger pushing or pulling on the back of
the front passenger's seat.
The front seat or seat-back is forced back against
an object on the seat or floor behind it.
An object placed under the front passenger's seat.
If none of these conditions exist, have your vehicle
checked by a dealer as soon as possible.
The passenger airbag off indicator may come on and
goes off repeatedly if the total weight on the seat is
near the airbag cutoff threshold.
U.S. Canada
Table of Contents
55
uuAirbagsuAirbag Care
Safe Driving
Airbag Care
You do not need to, and should not, perform any maintenance on or replace any
airbag system components yourself. However, you should have your vehicle
inspected by a dealer in the following situations:
When the airbags have deployed
If an airbag has inflated, the control unit and other related parts must be replaced.
Similarly, once an automatic seat belt tensioner has been activated, it must be
replaced.
When the vehicle has been in a moderate-to-severe collision
Even if the airbags did not inflate, have your dealer inspect the following: the driver’s
seat position sensor, weight sensors in the passenger’s seat, front seat belt
tensioners, and each seat belt that was worn during the crash.
Do not remove or modify a front seat without consulting a dealer
This would likely disable the driver's seat position sensor or the weight sensors in the
passenger's seat. If it is necessary to remove or modify a front seat to accommodate
a person with disabilities, contact a dealer, or for U.S. vehicles, American Honda
Automobile Customer Service at 800-999-1009 and for Canadian vehicles, Honda
Canada Customer Relations at 888-9-HONDA-9.
1Airbag Care
We recommend against the use of salvaged airbag
system components, including the airbag, tensioners,
sensors, and control unit.
Table of Contents
56
Safe Driving
Child Safety
Protecting Child Passengers
Each year, many children are injured or killed in vehicle crashes because they are
either unrestrained or not properly restrained. In fact, vehicle accidents are the
number one cause of death of children ages 12 and under.
To reduce the number of child deaths and injuries, every state, Canadian province
and territory requires that infants and children be properly restrained when they ride
in a vehicle.
Children should sit properly restrained in a rear seat. This is because:
An inflating front or side airbag can injure
or kill a child sitting in the front seat.
A child in the front seat is more likely to
interfere with the driver's ability to safely
control the vehicle.
Statistics show that children of all sizes and
ages are safer when they are properly
restrained in a rear seat.
1Protecting Child Passengers
The National Highway Traffic Safety Administration
and Transport Canada recommend that all children
ages 12 and under be properly restrained in a rear
seat. Some states or provinces/territories have laws
restricting where children may ride.
3
WARNING
Children who are unrestrained or
improperly restrained can be seriously
injured or killed in a crash.
Any child too small for a seat belt should be
properly restrained in a child seat. A larger
child should be properly restrained with a
seat belt, using a booster seat if necessary.
Table of Contents
57
uuChild SafetyuProtecting Child Passengers
Safe Driving
Any child who is too small to wear a seat belt correctly must be restrained in an
approved child seat that is properly secured to the vehicle using either the lap belt
portion of the lap/shoulder belt or the lower anchors of the LATCH system.
Never hold a child on your lap because it is impossible to protect them in the
event of a collision.
Never put a seat belt over yourself and a child. During a crash, the belt would
likely press deep into the child and cause serious or fatal injuries.
Never let two children use the same seat belt. Both children could be very
seriously injured in a crash.
Do not allow children to operate the doors, windows or seat adjustments.
Do not leave children in the vehicle unattended, especially in hot weather when
the inside of the vehicle can get hot enough to kill them. They could also activate
vehicle controls causing it to move unexpectedly.
1Protecting Child Passengers
To deactivate a lockable retractor, release the buckle
and allow the seat belt to wind up all the way.
To remind you of the passenger's front airbag
hazards and child safety, your vehicle has warning
labels on the dashboard (U.S. models) and on the
front visors. Please read and follow the instructions
on these labels.
2 Safety Labels P. 69
3
WARNING
Allowing a child to play with a seat belt or
wrap one around their neck can result in
serious injury or death.
Instruct children not to play with any seat
belt and make sure any unused seat belt a
child can reach is buckled, fully retracted,
and locked.
Table of Contents
58
uuChild SafetyuSafety of Infants and Small Children
Safe Driving
Safety of Infants and Small Children
An infant must be properly restrained in a rear-facing, reclining child seat until the
infant reaches the seat maker's weight or height limit for the seat, and the infant is
at least one year old.
Positioning a rear-facing child seat
Child seats must be placed and secured in a
rear seating position.
When properly installed, a rear-facing child seat may prevent the driver or a front
passenger from moving their seat all the way back, or from locking their seat-back
in the desired position.
It can also interfere with proper operation of the passenger's advanced front airbag
system.
2 Airbags P. 43
If this occurs, we recommend that you install the child seat directly behind the front
passenger's seat, move the seat as far forward as needed, and leave it unoccupied.
Or, you may wish to get a smaller rear-facing child seat.
Protecting Infants
1Protecting Infants
Rear-facing child seats should never be installed in a
forward facing position.
Always refer to the child seat manufacturer’s
instructions before installation.
3
WARNING
Placing a rear-facing child seat in the front
seat can result in serious injury or death
during a crash.
Always place a rear-facing child seat in the
rear seat, not the front.
Table of Contents
Continued
59
uuChild SafetyuSafety of Infants and Small Children
Safe Driving
If a child is at least one year old and within the weight range indicated by the child
seat manufacturer, the child should be properly restrained in a firmly secured
forward-facing child seat.
Forward-facing child seat placement
We strongly recommend placing a forward-
facing child seat in a rear seating position.
Placing a forward-facing child seat in the front seat can be hazardous, even with
advanced front airbags that automatically turn the passenger's front airbag off. A
rear seat is the safest place for a child.
Protecting Smaller Children
1Protecting Smaller Children
Educate yourself about the laws and regulations
regarding child seat use where you are driving, and
follow the child seat manufacturer's instructions.
Many experts recommend use of a rear-facing seat
for a child up to two years old if the child’s height and
weight are appropriate for a rear-facing seat.
3
WARNING
Placing a forward-facing child seat in the
front seat can result in serious injury or
death if the front airbag inflates.
If you must place a forward-facing child
seat in front, move the vehicle seat as far
back as possible, and properly restrain the
child.
Table of Contents
uuChild SafetyuSafety of Infants and Small Children
60
Safe Driving
Most child seats are LATCH-compatible (Lower Anchors and Tethers for CHildren).
Some have a rigid-type connector, while others have a flexible-type connector. Both
are equally easy to use. Some existing and previously owned child seats can only be
installed using the seat belt. Whichever type you choose, follow the child seat
manufacturer's use and care instructions as well as the instructions in this manual.
Proper installation is key to maximizing your child's safety.
In seating positions and vehicles not equipped with LATCH, a LATCH compatible
child seat can be installed using the seat belt and a top tether for added security.
This is because all child seats are required to be designed so that they can be secured
with a lap belt or the lap part of a lap/shoulder belt. In addition, the child seat
manufacturer may advise that a seat belt be used to attach a LATCH-compatible seat
once a child reaches a specified weight. Please read the child seat owner’s manual
for proper installation instructions.
Important consideration when selecting a child seat
Make sure the child seat meets the following three requirements:
The child seat is the correct type and size for the child.
The child seat is the correct type for the seating position.
The child seat is compliant with Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standard 213 or
Canadian Motor Vehicle Safety Standard 213.
Selecting a Child Seat
1Selecting a Child Seat
Installation of a LATCH-compatible child seat is
simple.
LATCH-compatible child seats have been developed
to simplify the installation process and reduce the
likelihood of injuries caused by incorrect installation.
Table of Contents
61
uuChild SafetyuSafety of Infants and Small Children
Continued
Safe Driving
A LATCH-compatible child seat can be installed in either of the two outer rear seats.
A child seat is attached to the lower anchors with either the rigid or flexible type of
connectors.
1. Locate the lower anchors under the marks.
2. Place the child seat on the vehicle seat then
attach the child seat to the lower anchors
according to the instructions that came
with the child seat.
u When installing the child seat, make sure
that the lower anchors are not
obstructed by the seat belt or any other
object.
Installing a LATCH-Compatible Child Seat
Marks
Rigid Type
Lower Anchors
Flexible Type
Table of Contents
uuChild SafetyuSafety of Infants and Small Children
62
Safe Driving
3. Open the tether anchor cover behind the
head restraint.
4. Raise the head restraint to its highest
position, then route the tether strap
between the head restraint legs, and secure
the tether strap hook onto the anchor.
5. Tighten the tether strap as instructed by the
child seat maker.
6. Make sure the child seat is firmly secured by
rocking it forward and back and side to
side; little movement should be felt.
7. Make sure any unused seat belt that a child
can reach is buckled, the lockable retractor
is activated, and the belt is fully retracted
and locked.
1Installing a LATCH-Compatible Child Seat
For your child's safety, when using a child seat
installed using the LATCH system, make sure that the
seat is properly secured to the vehicle. A child seat
that is not properly secured will not adequately
protect a child in a crash and may cause injury to the
child or other vehicle occupants.
Anchor
Tether Strap
Hook
Table of Contents
Continued
63
uuChild SafetyuSafety of Infants and Small Children
Safe Driving
1. Place the child seat on the vehicle seat.
2. Route the seat belt through the child seat
according to the seat maker's instructions,
and insert the latch plate into the buckle.
u Insert the latch plate fully until it clicks.
3. Slowly pull the shoulder part of the belt all
the way out until it stops. This activates the
lockable retractor.
4. Let the seat belt completely wind up into
the retractor, then try to pull it out to make
sure the retractor is locked.
u If you are able to pull the shoulder belt
out, the lockable retractor is not
activated. Pull the seat belt all the way
out, and repeat steps 2 – 4.
5. Grab the shoulder part of the seat belt near
the buckle, and pull up to remove any slack
from the lap part of the belt.
u When doing this, place your weight on
the child seat and push it into the vehicle
seat.
Installing a Child Seat with a Lap/Shoulder Seat Belt
1Installing a Child Seat with a Lap/Shoulder Seat Belt
A child seat that is not properly secured will not
adequately protect a child in a crash and may cause
injury to the child or other vehicle occupants.
Table of Contents
uuChild SafetyuSafety of Infants and Small Children
64
Safe Driving
6. Make sure the child seat is firmly secured by
rocking it forward and back and side to
side; little movement should be felt.
7. Make sure any unused seat belt that a child
can reach is buckled, the lockable retractor
is activated, and the belt is fully retracted
and locked.
1Installing a Child Seat with a Lap/Shoulder Seat Belt
To deactivate a lockable retractor, release the buckle
and allow the seat belt to wind up all the way.
Table of Contents
65
uuChild SafetyuSafety of Infants and Small Children
Safe Driving
A tether anchorage point is provided behind
each rear seating position. A child seat that is
installed with a seat belt and comes with a
tether can use the tether for additional
security.
1. Locate the appropriate tether anchorage
point and lift the cover.
2. Raise the head restraint to its highest
position, then route the tether strap
through the head restraint legs. Make sure
the strap is not twisted.
3. Secure the tether strap hook onto the
anchor.
4. Tighten the tether strap as instructed by the
child seat manufacturer.
Adding Security with a Tether
1Adding Security with a Tether
Since a tether can provide additional security to the
lap/shoulder seat belt installation, we recommend
using a tether whenever one is available.
Tether Anchorage Points
Cover
Anchor
Outer Position
Tether Strap
Hook
Anchor
Center Position
Tether Strap
Hook
Anchor
Table of Contents
66
uuChild SafetyuSafety of Larger Children
Safe Driving
Safety of Larger Children
The following pages give instructions on how to check proper seat belt fit, what kind
of booster seat to use if one is needed, and important precautions for a child who
must sit in front.
When a child is too big for a child seat, secure the child in a rear seat using the lap/
shoulder seat belt. Have the child sit upright and all the way back, then answer the
following questions.
Checklist
Do the child's knees bend comfortably over
the edge of the seat?
Does the shoulder belt cross between the
child's neck and arm?
Is the lap part of the seat belt as low as
possible, touching the child's thighs?
Will the child be able to stay seated like this
for the whole trip?
If you answer yes to all these questions, the child is ready to wear the lap/shoulder
seat belt correctly. If you answer no to any question, the child needs to ride on a
booster seat until the seat belt fits properly without a booster seat.
Protecting Larger Children
Checking Seat Belt Fit
1Safety of Larger Children
3
WARNING
Allowing a child age 12 or under to sit in
front can result in injury or death if the
passenger's front airbag inflates.
If a larger child must ride in front, move the
vehicle seat as far to the rear as possible,
have the child sit up properly and wear the
seat belt properly, using a booster seat if
needed.
Table of Contents
67
uuChild SafetyuSafety of Larger Children
Safe Driving
If a lap/shoulder seat belt cannot be used
properly, position the child in a booster seat in
a rear seating position. For the child's safety,
check that the child meets the booster seat
manufacturer's recommendations.
Your vehicle has a rear seat where children can be properly restrained. If you ever
have to carry a group of children, and a child must ride in front:
Make sure you read and fully understand the instructions and safety information
in this manual.
Move the front passenger seat as far back as possible.
Have the child sit upright and well back in the seat.
Check that the seat belt is properly positioned so that the child is secure in the
seat.
Monitoring child passengers
We strongly recommend that you keep an eye on child passengers. Even older, more
mature children sometimes need to be reminded to fasten their seat belts and sit up
properly.
Booster Seats
1Booster Seats
When installing a booster seat, make sure to read the
instructions that came with it, and install the seat
accordingly.
There are high- and low-type booster seats. Choose a
booster seat that allows the child to wear the seat
belt correctly.
Some U.S. states and Canadian provinces and
territories require children to use a booster seat until
they reach a given age or weight (e.g. 6 years or 60
lbs). Be sure to check current laws in the state or
province, or territory where you intend to drive.
Protecting Larger Children-Final Checks
Table of Contents
68
Safe Driving
Exhaust Gas Hazard
Carbon Monoxide Gas
The engine exhaust from this vehicle contains carbon monoxide, a colorless,
odorless, and highly toxic gas. As long as you properly maintain your vehicle, carbon
monoxide gas will not get into the interior.
Have the exhaust system inspected for leaks whenever
The exhaust system is making an unusual noise.
The exhaust system may have been damaged.
The vehicle is raised for an oil change.
When you operate a vehicle with the trunk open, airflow can pull exhaust gas into
the interior and create a hazardous condition. If you must drive with the trunk open,
open all the windows and set the climate control system as shown below.
1. Select the fresh air mode.
2. Select the mode.
3. Set the fan speed to high.
4. Set the temperature control to a comfortable setting.
Adjust the climate control system in the same manner if you sit in your parked
vehicle with the engine running.
1Carbon Monoxide Gas
An enclosed area such as a garage can quickly fill up
with carbon monoxide gas.
Do not turn the power system on with the garage
door closed. Even when the garage door is open,
drive out of the garage immediately after turning the
power system on.
3
WARNING
Carbon monoxide gas is toxic.
Breathing it can cause unconsciousness and
even kill you.
Avoid any enclosed areas or activities that
expose you to carbon monoxide.
Table of Contents
69
Safe Driving
Safety Labels
Label Locations
These labels are in the locations shown. They warn you of potential hazards that can cause serious injury or death. Read these labels
carefully.
If a label comes off or becomes hard to read (except for the U.S. dashboard label which may be removed by the owner), contact a dealer
for a replacement.
Sun Visor
U.S. models Canadian models
Radiator
Cap
Doorjambs
U.S. models
U.S. models only
Dashboard
Canadian models
High Voltage System Components
U.S. models Canadian models
Table of Contents
70
Table of Contents
71
Instrument Panel
This chapter describes the buttons, indicators, and gauges that are used while driving.
Indicators ............................................ 72
Multi-Information Display Warning and
Information Messages...................... 84
Gauges and Multi-Information Display
Gauges.............................................. 92
Multi-Information Display .................. 94
Main Menu
72
Instrument Panel
Indicators
Indicator Name On/Blinking Explanation Message
Parking Brake
and Brake
System Indicator
(Red)
Comes on for a few seconds when
you set the power mode to ON,
then goes off if the parking brake
has been released.
Comes on when the parking brake
is applied, and goes off when it is
released.
Comes on when the brake fluid
level is low.
Comes on if there is a problem
with the brake system.
The beeper sounds and the
indicator comes on if you drive
with the parking brake not fully
released.
Comes on while driving - Make sure
the parking brake is released. Check the
brake fluid level.
2 What to do when the indicator
comes on while driving P. 530
Comes on along with the brake
system indicator (amber) - Immediately
stop in a safe place. Contact a dealer for
repair. The brake pedal becomes harder
to operate. Depress the pedal further
than you normally do.
Comes on along with the ABS
indicator - Have your vehicle checked by
a dealer.
2 If the Brake System Indicator (Red)
Comes On P. 530
Brake System
Indicator
(Amber)
Comes on for a few seconds when
you set the power mode to ON,
then goes off.
Comes on if there is a problem
with the cooperative control with
regenerative braking, the electric
servo brake system, or the hill start
assist system.
Stays on constantly - Avoid high speeds
and sudden braking. Take the vehicle to a
dealer immediately.
U.S.
Canada
(Red)
U.S.
Canada
(Amber)
Table of Contents
73
uuIndicatorsu
Continued
Instrument Panel
Indicator Name On/Blinking Explanation Message
POWER
SYSTEM
Indicator
Comes on for a few seconds when
you set the power mode to ON,
then goes off.
Comes on if there is a problem
with the electric vehicle system.
Comes on when the High Voltage
battery temperature becomes high
while the battery is being charged.
Have your vehicle checked by a dealer.
READY Indicator
Comes on for a few seconds when
you set the power mode to ON,
then goes off.
Comes on when the vehicle is
ready to drive.
2 Turning on the Power P. 416
EV Indicator
Comes on for a few seconds when
you set the power mode to ON,
then goes off.
Comes on when the vehicle is
moved by the motor, and the
engine is not operating.
EV Mode
Indicator
Comes on for a few seconds when
you set the power mode to ON,
then goes off.
Comes on when the vehicle is in EV
mode.
2 SPORT HYBRID i-MMD
(intelligent Multi Mode
Drive) P. 7
Table of Contents
74
uuIndicatorsu
Instrument Panel
Indicator Name On/Blinking Explanation Message
Low Oil Pressure
Indicator
Comes on for a few seconds when
you set the power mode to ON,
then goes off.
Comes on when the engine oil
pressure is low.
Comes on while driving - Immediately
stop in a safe place.
2 If the Low Oil Pressure Indicator
Comes On P. 528
Malfunction
Indicator Lamp
Comes on when you set the power
mode to ON, and goes off either
when the power system is on or
after several seconds if the vehicle
did not start. If “readiness codes”
have not been set, it blinks five
times before it goes off.
Comes on if there is a problem
with the emissions control system.
Blinks when a misfire in the
engine's cylinders is detected.
Readiness codes are part of the on board
diagnostics for the emissions control
systems.
2 Testing of Readiness Codes P. 543
Comes on while driving - Have your
vehicle checked by a dealer.
Blinks while driving - Stop in a safe
place where there are no flammable
objects. Stop the power system for 10
minutes or more, and wait for the engine
to cool down. Then, take the vehicle to a
dealer.
2 If the Malfunction Indicator Lamp
Comes On or Blinks P. 529
12-Volt Battery
Charging System
Indicator
Comes on when you set the power
mode to ON, and goes off when
the power system is on.
Comes on when the 12-volt
battery is not charging.
Comes on while driving - Turn off the
climate control system and rear defogger
in order to reduce electricity
consumption.
2 If the 12-Volt Battery Charging
System Indicator Comes On P. 528
Table of Contents
75
uuIndicatorsu
Continued
Instrument Panel
Indicator Name On/Blinking Explanation Message
Shift Lever
Position Indicator
Indicates the current shift lever
position.
2 Shifting P. 420
Transmission
Indicator
Blinks if the transmission system
has a problem.
Blinks while driving - Avoid sudden
starts and acceleration and have your
vehicle checked by a dealer immediately.
Seat Belt
Reminder
Indicator
Comes on and the beeper sounds
if you are not wearing a seat belt
when you set the power mode to
ON.
If the front passenger is not
wearing a seat belt, the indicator
comes on a few seconds later.
Blinks while driving if either you or
the front passenger has not
fastened a seat belt. The beeper
sounds and the indicator blinks at
regular intervals.
The beeper stops and the indicator goes
off when you and the front passenger
fasten their seat belts.
Stays on after you or the front
passenger has fastened the seat belt
- A detection error may have occurred in
the sensor. Have your vehicle checked by
a dealer.
2 Seat Belt Reminder P. 37
Table of Contents
76
uuIndicatorsu
Instrument Panel
Indicator Name On/Blinking Explanation Message
Low Fuel
Indicator
Comes on when the fuel reserve is
running low (approximately 2.3 U.S.
gal./8.8 Liter left).
Blinks if there is a problem with the
fuel gauge.
Comes on - Refuel your vehicle as soon
as possible.
Blinks - Have your vehicle checked by a
dealer.
Anti-lock Brake
System (ABS)
Indicator
Comes on for a few seconds when
you set the power mode to ON, then
goes off.
If it comes on at any other time,
there is a problem with the ABS.
Stays on constantly - Have your
vehicle checked by a dealer. With this
indicator on, your vehicle still has
normal braking ability but no anti-lock
function.
2 Anti-lock Brake System (ABS)
P. 454
Supplemental
Restraint System
Indicator
Comes on for a few seconds when
you set the power mode to ON, then
goes off.
Comes on if a problem with any of
the following is detected:
- Supplemental restraint system
- Side airbag system
- Side curtain airbag system
- Seat belt tensioner
Stays on constantly or does not
come on at all - Have your vehicle
checked by a dealer.
Table of Contents
77
uuIndicatorsu
Continued
Instrument Panel
Indicator Name On/Blinking Explanation Message
Vehicle Stability
Assist (VSA®)
System Indicator
Comes on for a few seconds when
you set the power mode to ON, then
goes off.
Blinks when VSA® is active.
Comes on if there is a problem with
the VSA® system.
Stays on constantly - Have your
vehicle checked by a dealer.
2 Vehicle Stability Assist (VSA®), aka
Electronic Stability Control (ESC),
System P. 443
Vehicle Stability
Assist (VSA®) OFF
Indicator
Comes on for a few seconds when
you set the power mode to ON, then
goes off.
Comes on when you deactivate
VSA®.
2 VSA® OFF Button P. 444
Table of Contents
78
uuIndicatorsu
Instrument Panel
Indicator Name On/Blinking Explanation Message
Electric Power
Steering (EPS)
System Indicator
Comes on when you set the power
mode to ON, and goes off when the
power system is on.
Comes on if there is a problem with
the EPS system.
Stays on constantly or does not
come on at all - Have your vehicle
checked by a dealer.
2 If the Electric Power Steering (EPS)
System Indicator Comes On P. 530
Low Tire Pressure/
TPMS Indicator
Comes on for a few seconds when
you set the power mode to ON, then
goes off.
May come on briefly if the power
mode is set to ON and the vehicle is
not moved within 45 seconds, to
indicate the calibration process is
not yet complete.
Comes on when:
- One or more tires’ pressures are
determined to be significantly low.
- The system has not been
calibrated.
Comes on while driving - Stop in a
safe place, check tire pressures, and
inflate the tire(s) if necessary.
Stays on after the tires are inflated
to the recommended pressures - The
system needs to be calibrated.
2 TPMS Calibration P. 447
Blinks for about one minute, and
then stays on if there is a problem
with the TPMS.
Blinks and remains on - Have your
vehicle checked by a dealer.
Table of Contents
79
uuIndicatorsu
Continued
Instrument Panel
Indicator Name On/Blinking Explanation Message
System
Message
Indicator
Comes on for a few seconds when you set
the power mode to ON, then goes off.
Comes on along with a beep when a
problem is detected. A system message on
the multi-information display appears at
the same time.
While the indicator is on, press the
(information) button to see the
message again.
Refer to the Indicators information in
this chapter when a system message
appears on the multi-information
display. Take the appropriate action for
the message.
The multi-information display does not return
to the normal screen unless the warning is
canceled, or the button is pressed.
Turn Signal
and Hazard
Warning
Indicators
The turn signal indicators blink when you
operate the turn signal lever.
If you press the hazard warning button,
both indicators and all turn signals blink at
the same time.
Does not blink or blinks rapidly - A
turn signal light bulb has blown.
Change the bulb immediately.
2 Replacing Light Bulbs P. 487, 488
High Beam
Indicator
Comes on when the high beam headlights
are on.
Lights On
Indicator
Comes on whenever the light switch is on,
or in AUTO when the exterior lights are
on.
If you set the power mode to VEHICLE
OFF (LOCK) while the exterior lights are
on, a chime sounds when the driver's
door is opened.
Table of Contents
80
uuIndicatorsu
Instrument Panel
Indicator Name On/Blinking Explanation Message
Immobilizer
System Indicator
Comes on briefly when you set the
power mode to ON, then goes off.
Comes on if the immobilizer system
cannot recognize the key
information.
Blinks - You cannot start the power
system. Set the power mode to VEHICLE
OFF (LOCK), then select ON again.
Repeatedly blinks - The system may
be malfunctioning. Have your vehicle
checked by a dealer.
Do not attempt to alter this system or
add other devices to it. Electrical
problems can occur.
Security System
Alarm Indicator
Blinks when the security system
alarm has been set.
2 Security System Alarm P. 126
Indicator
Table of Contents
81
uuIndicatorsu
Continued
Instrument Panel
*1:On the left: Models without adaptive cruise control
On the right: Models with adaptive cruise control
Indicator Name On/Blinking Explanation Message
*1
Forward
Collision
Warning
(FCW)
Indicator
*
Comes on for a few seconds
when you set the power mode
to ON, then goes off.
Comes on when you have
customized FCW to turn off.
Comes on if there is a problem
with the FCW system.
Stays on constantly without FCW off - Have your
vehicle checked by a dealer.
Comes on when the FCW
system shuts itself off.
Stays on - The temperature inside the FCW system is
too high. The system activates when the temperature
inside the system cools down.
2 Automatic shutoff P. 437
Stays on - The radar sensor or the area around the
camera is blocked by dirt, mud, etc. Stop your vehicle
in a safe place, and wipe it off with a soft cloth.
Have your vehicle checked by a dealer if:
The indicator and message stay on after you cleaned
the radar sensor cover.
The indicator and message come back on after you
cleaned the area around the camera.
2 Automatic shutoff P. 437
2 Automatic shutoff P. 437
Models without adaptive cruise control
Models with adaptive cruise control
Models without adaptive cruise control
* Not available on all models
Table of Contents
82
uuIndicatorsu
Instrument Panel
*1:On the left: Models without adaptive cruise control
On the right: Models with adaptive cruise control
Indicator Name On/Blinking Explanation Message
*1
Lane Departure
Warning (LDW)
Indicator
*
Comes on for a few seconds when
you set the power mode to ON, then
goes off.
Comes on if there is a problem with
the LDW system.
Stays on constantly - Have your
vehicle checked by a dealer.
Comes on when the LDW system
shuts itself off.
Stays on - The temperature inside the
LDW camera is too high.
The system activates when the
temperature inside the camera cools
down.
2 Lane Departure Warning Camera
(LDW Camera) P. 440
Stays on - The area around the camera
is blocked by dirt, mud, etc. Stop your
vehicle in a safe place, and wipe it off
with a soft cloth.
Have your vehicle checked by a dealer if
the indicator and message come back
on after you cleaned the area around
the camera.
2 Lane Departure Warning Camera
(LDW Camera) P. 440
* Not available on all models
Table of Contents
83
uuIndicatorsu
Instrument Panel
Indicator Name On/Blinking Explanation Message
ECON Mode
Indicator
Comes on for a few seconds when
you set the power mode to ON, then
goes off.
Comes on when you press the
ECON button.
2 ECON Button P. 422
Smart Entry
System Indicator
Comes on for a few seconds when
you set the power mode to ON, then
goes off.
Comes on as soon as a problem is
detected in the smart entry system
or push button starting system.
Stays on constantly or does not
come on at all - Have your vehicle
checked by a dealer.
Table of Contents
84
uuIndicatorsuMulti-Information Display Warning and Information Messages
Instrument Panel
Multi-Information Display Warning and Information Messages
The following messages appear only on the multi-information display. Press the (information) button to see the message again
with the system message indicator on.
Message Condition Explanation
Appears when the fuel fill cap is loose or is not
installed.
2 Tighten Fuel Cap Message P. 529
Appears when the scheduled maintenance is due
soon.
u Consequently, Maintenance Due Now and
Maintenance Past Due follow.
2 Maintenance Minder Messages on the Multi-
Information Display P. 468
Appears when the engine coolant temperature gets
abnormally high.
2 Overheating P. 525
Appears when the engine coolant temperature is
near its upper limit.
Drive slowly to prevent overheating.
Appears if any door or the trunk is not completely
closed.
The beeper sounds and the message comes on if any
door or the trunk is opened while driving.
Goes off when all doors and the trunk are closed.
Table of Contents
85
uuIndicatorsuMulti-Information Display Warning and Information Messages
Continued
Instrument Panel
Message Condition Explanation
Appears if there is a problem with the automatic
lighting control system.
Appears while driving - Manually turn the lights on,
and have your vehicle checked by a dealer.
Appears if there is a problem with the low beam
headlights.
Have your vehicle checked by a dealer.
Appears if there is a problem with the acoustic
vehicle alerting system.
Have your vehicle checked by a dealer.
Appears while you are customizing the settings and
the shift lever is moved out of
(P .
2 Customized Features P. 101
Appears if you try to go to Vehicle Settings from
the multi-information display while the audio/
information screen shows the same menu.
Select either display to customize a setting. You cannot
have Vehicle Settings displayed on the multi-
information display and audio/information screen
simultaneously.
2 Customized Features P. 101, 293
Models with LED
low beam
headlights
Table of Contents
86
uuIndicatorsuMulti-Information Display Warning and Information Messages
Instrument Panel
Message Condition Explanation
Appears when you set the power mode to
ACCESSORY or ON.
2 Turning on the Power P. 416
Appears when the steering wheel is locked.
Move the steering wheel left and right after pressing
the POWER button.
Appears if you push the POWER button to turn the
power system off without the shift lever in
(P .
Push the POWER button twice after moving the shift
lever to
(P .
Appears when the power mode is in ACCESSORY.
Appears after the driver’s door is opened when the
power mode is in ACCESSORY.
Press the POWER button twice with your foot off the
brake pedal to change the power mode to VEHICLE OFF
(LOCK).
Table of Contents
87
uuIndicatorsuMulti-Information Display Warning and Information Messages
Continued
Instrument Panel
Message Condition Explanation
Appears when you close the door with the power
mode in ON without the smart entry remote inside
the vehicle.
Disappears when you bring the smart entry remote
back inside the vehicle and close the door.
2 Smart Entry Remote Reminder P. 135
Appears when the smart entry remote battery
becomes weak.
Replace the battery as soon as possible.
2 Replacing the Button Battery P. 503
Appears if the smart entry remote battery is too
weak to turn on the power system or the key is not
within operating range to turn on the power system.
A beeper sounds six times.
2 If the Smart Entry Remote Battery is Weak P. 520
Appears three seconds after you bring the smart
entry remote in front of the POWER button when
To Start, Hold Remote Near Start Button
appears. To Start Vehicle: Brake + Push appears
sequentially.
2 Changing the Power Mode P. 133
Appears when there is a problem with the sensor on
the 12-volt battery.
Appears when the 12-volt battery is not charging.
Have your vehicle checked by a dealer.
2 Checking the 12-Volt Battery P. 502
Appears along with the 12-volt battery charging
system indicator - Turn off the climate control system
and rear defogger to reduce electricity consumption.
2 If the 12-Volt Battery Charging System Indicator
Comes On P. 528
Table of Contents
88
uuIndicatorsuMulti-Information Display Warning and Information Messages
Instrument Panel
Message Condition Explanation
Appears for about three seconds when ACC has
been automatically canceled.
You can resume the set speed after the condition that
caused ACC to cancel improves. Press the RES/+
button.
2 Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC)
*
P. 427
Appears when you press the MAIN button on the
steering wheel.
2 Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC)
*
P. 427
Appears for a few seconds when you set the power
mode to ON.
Appears if there is a problem with ACC.
Have your vehicle checked by a dealer.
Models with adaptive cruise control
(Green)
(Amber)
* Not available on all models
Table of Contents
89
uuIndicatorsuMulti-Information Display Warning and Information Messages
Continued
Instrument Panel
Message Condition Explanation
Appears when you press the CRUISE button on the
steering wheel.
2 Cruise Control
*
P. 424
Appears if you have set a speed for cruise control.
2 Cruise Control
*
P. 424
Message Condition Explanation
Flashes when the system senses a likely collision with
a vehicle in front of you.
Take appropriate action to prevent a collision (apply the
brakes, change lanes, etc.).
2 Forward Collision Warning (FCW)
*
P. 435
2 Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC)
*
P. 427
Appears when your vehicle is too close to the traffic
lane lines. The beeper sounds.
Take appropriate action to keep your vehicle within the
lane lines.
2 Lane Departure Warning (LDW)
*
P. 439
Models without adaptive cruise control
Models with forward collision warning and lane departure warning
* Not available on all models
Table of Contents
90
uuIndicatorsuMulti-Information Display Warning and Information Messages
Instrument Panel
Message Condition Explanation
Appears when the washer fluid gets low.
Refill the washer fluid.
2 Refilling Window Washer Fluid P. 483
Appears when the turn-by-turn direction comes on
the multi-information display.
2 Refer to the Navigation System Manual
Appears when the power system temperature is
high.
Your vehicle has less ability to accelerate and may be
harder to start on an incline.
Park in a safe place, and cool the system down.
2 Overheating P. 525
Appears when the High Voltage battery temperature
is low.
Your vehicle has less ability to accelerate and may be
harder to start on an incline.
Goes off once you start driving as the High Voltage
battery warms up.
Appears after the 12-volt battery charging system
indicator comes on.
Your vehicle has less ability to accelerate and may be
harder to start on an incline.
Contact a dealer immediately.
Canadian models
Table of Contents
91
uuIndicatorsuMulti-Information Display Warning and Information Messages
Instrument Panel
Message Condition Explanation
Appears when the High Voltage battery temperature
is too low to operate (approx. -22°F [-30°C] or
below).
You can start the engine and use the climate control
system to warm up the interior, which will also warm
the High Voltage battery enough for you to drive the
vehicle.
Appears when the High Voltage battery and other
system control temperatures are too low to operate
(approx. -40°F [-40°C] or below).
You must wait for an increase in the ambient
temperature or move the vehicle to a warmer location.
Consult a dealer.
Appears if the power system is in diagnostic mode.
You may notice a decrease in available power. Have your
vehicle checked by a dealer.
As a result of diagnostics, the POWER SYSTEM
indicator may come on.
2 POWER SYSTEM Indicator P. 73
Appears when you failed to select EV mode or EV
mode is automatically canceled.
The cause may be shown with the following
message:
- Ambient Temperature Too Low
- Battery Charge Too Low
- Engine Too Cold
- Cabin Being Heated
- Speed Too High
- Hard Acceleration Requested
EV mode is available once the condition is improved or
the cause that canceled EV mode is cleared.
Table of Contents
92
Instrument Panel
Gauges and Multi-Information Display
Gauges
Gauges include the speedometer, fuel gauge, POWER/CHARGE gauge, High
Voltage battery charge level gauge, and related indicators. They are displayed when
the power mode is in ON.
Displays your driving speed in mph or km/h.
Displays the amount of fuel left in the fuel tank.
Speedometer
Fuel Gauge
1Fuel Gauge
NOTICE
You should refuel when the reading approaches .
Running out of fuel can cause the engine to misfire,
damaging the catalytic converter.
The actual amount of remaining fuel may differ from
the fuel gauge reading.
E
Table of Contents
93
uuGauges and Multi-Information DisplayuGauges
Instrument Panel
Electric motor
The degree to which the electric motor is being powered is displayed by the readings
on the POWER side.
Battery charge in progress
The degree to which the High Voltage battery is being charged is displayed by the
readings on the CHARGE side.
Shows the remaining High Voltage battery charge level.
POWER/CHARGE Gauge
High Voltage Battery Charge Level Gauge
1High Voltage Battery Charge Level Gauge
The High Voltage battery charge level may decrease
under the following conditions:
When the 12-volt battery has been replaced.
When the 12-volt battery has been disconnected.
When the High Voltage battery control system
corrects its reading.
The charge level reading will be corrected
automatically while driving.
Changes in the temperature of the High Voltage
battery can increase or decrease the battery’s
charging capacity. If temperature changes cause the
battery’s capacity to change, the number of
indicators in the battery charge level gauge may also
change, even if the amount of charging remains the
same.
Table of Contents
94
uuGauges and Multi-Information DisplayuMulti-Information Display
Instrument Panel
Multi-Information Display
The multi-information display shows the odometer, trip meter, outside temperature
indicator, and other gauges.
It also displays important messages such as warnings and other helpful information.
Main displays
Press the (information) button to change the display.
Switching the Display
Average Fuel Economy/
Instant Fuel Economy
Range
Elapsed TimeAverage Speed
Blank Screen
Vehicle
Settings
Engine Oil
Life
Button
Average Fuel
Economy Records
Eco Drive Display
Power Flow
Monitor
Table of Contents
95
uuGauges and Multi-Information Display uMulti-Information Display
Continued
Instrument Panel
Lower displays
Press the SEL/RESET button to change the display.
Odometer Trip A Trip B
SEL/RESET
Button
Table of Contents
uuGauges and Multi-Information DisplayuMulti-Information Display
96
Instrument Panel
Shows the total number of miles (U.S.) or kilometers (Canada) that your vehicle has
accumulated.
Shows the total number of miles (U.S.) or kilometers (Canada) driven since the last
reset. Meters A and B can be used to measure two separate trips.
Resetting a trip meter
To reset a trip meter, display it, then press and hold the SEL/RESET button. The trip
meter is reset to 0.0.
Shows the estimated average fuel economy of each trip meter in mpg (U.S.) or l/100
km (Canada). The display is updated at set intervals. When a trip meter is reset, the
average fuel economy is also reset.
Shows the estimated distance you can travel on the remaining power and fuel. This
distance is estimated from the fuel economy of your previous trips.
Shows the time elapsed since Trip A or Trip B was reset.
Odometer
Trip Meter
Average Fuel Economy
Range
Elapsed Time
1Trip Meter
Switch between trip meter A and trip meter B by
pressing the SEL/RESET button.
1Average Fuel Economy
You can change when to reset the average fuel
economy.
2 Customized Features P. 101, 293
1Range
The displayed range may change even when the
vehicle is stationary.
1Elapsed Time
You can change when to reset the elapsed time.
2 Customized Features P. 101, 293
Table of Contents
Continued
97
uuGauges and Multi-Information Display uMulti-Information Display
Instrument Panel
Shows the average speed in mph (U.S.) or km/h (Canada) since Trip A or Trip B was
reset.
Shows the instant fuel economy as a bar graph in mpg (U.S.) or l/100 km (Canada).
Shows the remaining oil life and Maintenance Minder
TM
.
2 Maintenance Minder
TM
P. 467
Shows the outside temperature in Fahrenheit (U.S.) or Celsius (Canada).
Adjusting the outside temperature display
Adjust the temperature reading up to ±5°F or ±3°C if the temperature reading
seems incorrect.
Shows you turn-by-turn driving directions to your destination linked with the
navigation system
*
.
2 Refer to the Navigation System Manual
Average Speed
Instant Fuel Economy
Engine Oil Life
Outside Temperature
Turn-by-Turn Directions
*
1Average Speed
You can change when to reset the average speed.
2 Customized Features P. 101, 293
1Outside Temperature
The temperature sensor is in the front bumper.
Road heat and exhaust from another vehicle can
affect the temperature reading when your vehicle
speed is less than 19 mph (30 km/h).
It may take several minutes for the display to be
updated after the temperature reading has stabilized.
Use the multi-information display's customized
features to correct the temperature.
2 Customized Features P. 101, 293
1Turn-by-Turn Directions
*
You can select whether the turn-by-turn display
comes on during the route guidance.
2 Customized Features P. 101, 293
* Not available on all models
Table of Contents
98
uuGauges and Multi-Information DisplayuMulti-Information Display
Instrument Panel
Shows the average fuel economy for the last
three driving cycles (1-3), and the current
driving cycle (0) in mpg or l/100 km.
Each time you set the power mode to ON, the
display is updated, and the oldest record is
deleted.
Average Fuel Economy Records
Table of Contents
Continued
99
uuGauges and Multi-Information Display uMulti-Information Display
Instrument Panel
The vehicle icon on the display moves forward or backward while driving.
The more aggressive the acceleration is, the further the icon moves forward.
The more aggressive the deceleration is, the further the icon moves backward.
Keep the icon near the center of the circle for better fuel economy while driving.
The fuel economy display color changes while driving. The area around the vehicle
icon becomes blue with aggressive acceleration and deceleration, and blue green as
fuel economy gets better, then green when driving in the most fuel efficient style.
Keep the color green as long as possible.
Eco Drive Display
1Eco Drive Display
The ambient meter color changes corresponding to
the eco drive display.
Aggressive
Deceleration
Vehicle Icon
Aggressive
Acceleration
Blue Green Blue
Moderate
Deceleration
Slow
Acceleration/
Deceleration
Moderate
Acceleration
Blue green Blue green
Table of Contents
uuGauges and Multi-Information DisplayuMulti-Information Display
100
Instrument Panel
Displays the motor and the engine power flow, indicating what supplies power to
the vehicle, or if the battery is being charged.
Power Flow Monitor
1Power Flow Monitor
While the vehicle is stationary with the engine
running, the following may appear on the multi-
information display.
Power is supplied by the
motor and the engine.
Power is only supplied by
the motor.
The motor is charging
the High Voltage battery.
Power is only supplied by
the engine.
Table of Contents
Continued
101
uuGauges and Multi-Information Display uMulti-Information Display
Instrument Panel
Use the multi-information display to customize certain features.
How to customize
Select the Vehicle Settings screen by pressing the button while the power
mode is in ON, and the vehicle is at a complete stop.
Press the SEL/RESET button.
Customized Features
1Customized Features
To customize other features, press the
button.
2 List of customizable options P. 104
2 Example of customization settings P. 107
Customization is possible when you see the driver’s
ID (Driver 1 or Driver 2) on the screen.
The driver’s ID indicates which remote transmitter
you have used to unlock the driver’s door. The
customized settings are recalled every time you
unlock the driver’s door with that remote.
When you customize settings: Shift to
(P
Customizing is also available from the audio/
information screen.
You cannot have Vehicle Settings displayed on the
multi-information display while the audio/
information screen shows the same menu.
2 Customized Features P. 293
Models with driving position memory system
All models
Button:
Changes the customize
menus and items.
Multi-Information Display:
Goes to Vehicle Settings.
SEL/RESET button:
Enters the selected item.
Table of Contents
102
uuGauges and Multi-Information DisplayuMulti-Information Display
Instrument Panel
Customization flow
Press the button.
SEL/RESET
Vehicle Settings
“Trip A” Reset Timing
Language Selection
Adjust Outside Temp. Display
Memory Position Link
Door Unlock Mode
Keyless Access Light Flash
4
4
4
4
TPMS Calibration
Driver Assist System Setup
*
Meter Setup
Driving Position Setup
*
Keyless Access Setup
SEL/RESET
SEL/RESET
SEL/RESET
SEL/RESET
“Trip B” Reset Timing
Fuel Efficiency Backlight
4
Head-up Warning
ACC Pre-Running Car Detect Beep
*
ACC Display Speed Unit
*
4
Turn-by-Turn Display
*
SEL/RESET
Keyless Access Beep
Forward Collision Warning Distance
4
4
4
* Not available on all models
Table of Contents
103
uuGauges and Multi-Information Display uMulti-Information Display
Continued
Instrument Panel
Exit
4
4
4
Door Setup
Maintenance Reset
Default All
SEL/RESET
4
SEL/RESET
4
Lighting Setup
SEL/RESET
4
Key And Remote Unlock Mode
Auto Door Lock
Auto Door Unlock
Keyless Lock Answer Back
Security Relock Timer
Interior Light Dimming Time
Headlight Auto Off Timer
Auto Light Sensitivity
4
4
Table of Contents
104
uuGauges and Multi-Information DisplayuMulti-Information Display
Instrument Panel
List of customizable options
*1:Default Setting
Setup Group Customizable Features Description Selectable Settings
TPMS
Calibration
Calibrates the TPMS. Cancel/Calibrate
Driver Assist
System
Setup
*
Forward Collision
Warning Distance
Changes at which distance FCW alerts, or turns FCW
on and off.
Long/Normal
*1
/Short/Off
Head-up Warning Turns the heads-up warning lights on to flash or off. On
*1
/Off
ACC Pre-Running Car
Detect Beep
*
Causes the system to beep when the system detects
a vehicle, or when the vehicle goes out of ACC
range.
On
*1
/Off
ACC Display Speed Unit
*
Changes the ACC display speed unit.
mph
*1
/km/h (U.S.)
mph/km/h
*1
(Canada)
Meter Setup
Language Selection Changes the displayed language. English
*1
/French/Spanish
Adjust Outside Temp.
Display
Adjusts the temperature reading by a few degrees.
-5°F ~ ±0°F
*1
~ +5°F (U.S.)
-3°C ~ ±0°C
*1
~ +3°C (Canada)
“Trip A” Reset Timing
Changes the setting of how to reset trip meter A,
average fuel economy A, average speed A, and
elapsed time A.
When Refueled/IGN Off/
Manually Reset
*1
“Trip B” Reset Timing
Changes the setting of how to reset trip meter B,
average fuel economy B, average speed B, and
elapsed time B.
When Refueled/IGN Off/
Manually Reset
*1
* Not available on all models
Table of Contents
105
uuGauges and Multi-Information Display uMulti-Information Display
Continued
Instrument Panel
*1: Default Setting
*2: Refer to the navigation system manual for complete details.
Setup Group Customizable Features Description Selectable Settings
Meter Setup
Fuel Efficiency Backlight Turns the ambient meter feature on and off. On
*1
/Off
Turn by Turn Display
*, *2
Selects whether the turn-by-turn display comes on
or not during the route guidance.
On
*1
/Off
Driving
Position
Setup
*
Memory Position Link
Changes the driver's seat position to a stored
setting.
On
*1
/Off
Keyless
Access
Setup
Door Unlock Mode
Changes which doors unlock when you grab the
driver’s door handle.
Driver Door Only
*1
/All Doors
Keyless Access Light
Flash
Causes some exterior lights to blink when you
unlock/lock the doors.
On
*1
/Off
Keyless Access Beep
Sets the beeper sound or not when you grab either
front door handle.
On
*1
/Off
Lighting
Setup
Interior Light Dimming
Time
Changes the length of time the interior lights stay on
after you close the doors.
60sec/30sec
*1
/15sec
Headlight Auto Off
Timer
Changes the length of time the exterior lights stay
on after you close the driver's door.
60sec/30sec/15sec
*1
/0sec
Auto Light Sensitivity Changes the timing for the headlights to come on. Max/High/Mid
*1
/Low/Min
* Not available on all models
Table of Contents
106
uuGauges and Multi-Information DisplayuMulti-Information Display
Instrument Panel
*1: Default Setting
Setup Group Customizable Features Description Selectable Settings
Door Setup
Auto Door Lock
Changes the setting for when the doors
automatically lock.
With Vehicle Speed
*1
/Shift
from P/Off
Auto Door Unlock
Changes the setting for when the doors
automatically unlock.
All Doors When Driver’s
Door Opens
*1
/All Doors
When Shifted To Park/All
Doors When Ignition
Switched Off/Off
Key And Remote Unlock
Mode
Sets up either the driver's door or all doors to unlock
on the first operation of the remote or built-in key.
Driver Door
*1
/ All Doors
Keyless Lock Answer
Back
LOCK/UNLOCK- The exterior lights flash.
LOCK (2nd push)- The beeper sounds.
On
*1
/Off
Security Relock Timer
Changes the time it takes for the doors to relock and
the security system to set after you unlock the
vehicle without opening any door.
90sec/60sec/30sec
*1
Maintenance
Reset
Resets/Cancels the engine oil life display when you
have performed the maintenance service.
Cancel/Reset
Default All
Cancels/Resets all the customized settings as
default.
Cancel/Set
Table of Contents
107
uuGauges and Multi-Information Display uMulti-Information Display
Continued
Instrument Panel
Example of customization settings
The steps for changing the “Trip A” Reset Timing setting to When Refueled are
shown below. The default setting for “Trip A” Reset Timing is Manually Reset.
1. Press the button to select Vehicle
Settings, then press the SEL/RESET
button.
2. Press the button until Meter
Setup appears on the display.
3. Press the SEL/RESET button.
u Language Selection appears first in the
display.
Table of Contents
108
uuGauges and Multi-Information DisplayuMulti-Information Display
Instrument Panel
4. Press the button until “Trip A”
Reset Timing appears on the display, then
press the SEL/RESET button.
u The display switches to the
customization setup screen, where you
can select When Refueled, IGN Off,
Manually Reset, or Exit.
5. Press the button and select When
Refueled, then press the SEL/RESET
button.
u The When Refueled Setup screen
appears, then the display returns to the
customization menu screen.
6. Press the button until Exit appears
on the display, then press the SEL/RESET
button.
7. Repeat Step 6 until you return to the
normal screen.
Table of Contents
109
Controls
This chapter explains how to operate the various controls necessary for driving.
Clock .................................................. 110
Locking and Unlocking the Doors
Key Types and Functions .................. 112
Low Smart Entry Remote Signal
Strength........................................113
Locking/Unlocking the Doors from the
Outside .......................................... 114
Locking/Unlocking the Doors from the
Inside ............................................. 118
Childproof Door Locks ..................... 120
Auto Door Locking/Unlocking .......... 121
Opening and Closing the Trunk.......122
Security System
Immobilizer System .......................... 126
Security System Alarm...................... 126
Opening and Closing the Windows .... 129
Opening and Closing the Moonroof
*
.. 132
Operating the Switches Around the
Steering Wheel
POWER Button................................. 133
Turn Signals..................................... 136
Light Switches.................................. 136
Daytime Running Lights ................... 139
Wipers and Washers ........................ 140
Brightness Control ........................... 141
Rear Defogger/Heated Door Mirror
Button .......................................... 142
Driving Position Memory System
*
.... 143
Adjusting the Steering Wheel........... 145
Adjusting the Mirrors
Interior Rearview Mirror................... 146
Power Door Mirrors ......................... 147
Adjusting the Seats .......................... 148
Interior Lights/Interior Convenience
Items ................................................ 155
Climate Control System
Using Automatic Climate Control .... 165
Synchronized Mode......................... 167
Automatic Climate Control Sensors... 168
* Not available on all models
Main Menu
110
Controls
Clock
Adjusting the Clock
You can adjust the time in the clock display with the power mode is in ON.
Using the Settings menu on the audio/information screen
1. Press the SETTINGS button.
1. Press and hold the DISP button.
2. Rotate to select System Settings, then
press .
u Repeat the procedure to select Clock,
then Clock Adjustment.
3. Rotate to change hour, then press .
4. Rotate to change minute, then press .
Adjusting the Time
1Adjusting the Clock
The clock is automatically updated through the
navigation system, so the time does not need to be
adjusted.
These indications are used to show how to operate
the selector knob.
Rotate to select.
Press to enter.
You can customize the clock display to show the 12
hour clock or 24 hour clock.
2 Customized Features P. 293
You can turn the clock display on and off.
2 Customized Features P. 293
Models with navigation system
Models without navigation system
Models without navigation system
Models with one display
Models with two displays
All models
Table of Contents
111
uuClockuAdjusting the Clock
Controls
Using the SETTINGS button
1. Press and hold the CLOCK (SETTINGS)
button until the clock display blinks.
2. Press Preset
(4 (Hour) or (5 (Minute) to
adjust the time.
3. Press the CLOCK button again to set the
time.
Using the audio with touch screen
1. Select .
2. Select Clock.
3. Adjust the hours and minutes by selecting
/.
4. Select 12H or 24H.
5. Press Set to set the time.
1Using the SETTINGS button
To set the time to the nearest hour: Press and hold
the CLOCK button until the clock display blinks, then
press the
(6 (Reset) button.
Depending on the displayed time, the clock sets
forward or backward.
Example:
1:06 will reset to 1:00
1:53 will reset to 2:00
Models with one display
CLOCK (SETTINGS)
Button
(6 (Reset) Button
(4 (Hour) Button
(5 (Minute) Button
Models with two displays
3
4
Table of Contents
112
Controls
Locking and Unlocking the Doors
Key Types and Functions
This vehicle comes with the following key:
Use the smart entry remote to turn on and off
the power system, to lock and unlock the
doors and to open the trunk. You can also use
the smart entry system to lock and unlock the
doors and to open the trunk.
Smart entry remote
The built-in key can be used to lock/unlock the
doors when the smart entry remote battery
becomes weak and the power door lock/
unlock operation is disabled.
To remove the built-in key, pull it out while
sliding the release knob. To reinstall the built-
in key, push the built-in key into the smart
entry remote until it clicks.
Keys
1Key Types and Functions
All the keys have an immobilizer system. The
immobilizer system helps to protect against vehicle
theft.
2 Immobilizer System P. 126
The keys contain precision electronics.
Adhere to the following advice to prevent damage to
the electronics:
Do not leave the keys in direct sunlight, or in
locations with high temperature or high humidity.
Do not drop the keys or set heavy objects on them.
Keep the keys away from liquids.
Do not take the keys apart except for replacing the
battery.
If the circuits in the keys are damaged, the power
system may not activate, and the remote transmitter
may not work.
If the keys do not work properly, have them
inspected by a dealer.
Built-in Key
Release Knob
Table of Contents
113
uuLocking and Unlocking the DoorsuLow Smart Entry Remote Signal Strength
Controls
Contains a number that you will need if you
purchase a replacement key.
Low Smart Entry Remote Signal Strength
The vehicle transmits radio waves to locate the smart entry remote when locking/
unlocking the doors, opening the trunk, or to activate the power system.
In the following cases, locking/unlocking the doors, opening the trunk, or activating
the power system may be inhibited or operation may be unstable:
Strong radio waves are being transmitted by nearby equipment.
You are carrying the smart entry remote together with telecommunications
equipment, laptop computers, cell phones, or wireless devices.
A metallic object is touching or covering the smart entry remote.
Key Number Tag
1Key Number Tag
Keep the key number tag separate from the key in a
safe place outside of your vehicle.
If you wish to purchase an additional key, contact a
dealer.
If you lose your key and you cannot activate the
power system, contact a dealer.
1Low Smart Entry Remote Signal Strength
Communication between the smart entry remote and
the vehicle consumes the smart entry remote’s
battery.
Battery life is about two years, but this varies
depending on regularity of use.
The battery is consumed whenever the smart entry
remote is receiving strong radio waves. Avoid placing
it near electrical appliances such as televisions and
personal computers.
Table of Contents
114
uuLocking and Unlocking the DoorsuLocking/Unlocking the Doors from the Outside
Controls
Locking/Unlocking the Doors from the Outside
Locking the doors
Press the lock button.
Once:
u Some exterior lights flash, all the doors
lock, and the security system sets.
Twice (within five seconds after the first
push):
u The beeper sounds and verifies the
security system is set.
Unlocking the doors
Press the unlock button.
Once:
u Some exterior lights flash twice, and the
driver's door unlocks.
Twice:
u The remaining doors unlock.
Using the Remote Transmitter
1Using the Remote Transmitter
If you do not open a door within 30 seconds of
unlocking the vehicle with the remote transmitter,
the doors will automatically relock.
You can change the relock timer setting.
2 Customized Features P. 101, 293
If the interior light switch is in the door activated
position, the interior lights come on when you press
the unlock button.
No doors opened: The lights fade out after 30 seconds.
Doors relocked with the remote: The lights go off
immediately.
2 Interior Lights P. 155
The remote transmitter uses low-power signals, so
the operating range may vary depending on the
surroundings.
You can lock or unlock doors using the remote
transmitter or smart entry system only when the
power mode in VEHICLE OFF.
The remote will not lock the vehicle when a door is open.
If the distance at which it works varies, the battery is
probably low.
If the LED does not come on when you press a
button, the battery is dead.
2 Replacing the Button Battery P. 503
You can customize the door unlock mode setting.
2 Customized Features P. 101, 293
LED
Unlock Button
Lock
Button
Table of Contents
Continued
115
uuLocking and Unlocking the DoorsuLocking/Unlocking the Doors from the Outside
Controls
When you carry the smart entry remote, you
can lock/unlock the doors and open the trunk.
You can lock/unlock the doors within a radius
of about 32 inches (80 cm) of the outside door
handle. You can open the trunk within about
32 inches (80 cm) radius from the trunk
release button.
Locking the doors and the trunk
Press the door lock button on the front door.
u Some exterior lights flash; the beeper
sounds; all the doors lock; and the
security system sets.
Using the Smart Entry with Push Button Start System
Door Lock Button
1Using the Smart Entry with Push Button Start System
Do not leave the smart entry remote in the vehicle
when you get out. Carry it with you.
Even if you are not carrying the smart entry remote,
you can lock/unlock the doors while someone else
with the remote is within range.
The door may be unlocked if the door handle is
covered with water in heavy rain or in a car wash if
the smart entry remote is within range.
If you grip a front door handle wearing gloves, the
door sensor may be slow to respond or may not
respond by unlocking the doors.
You cannot unlock the door by gripping the handle
after two seconds of unlocking it.
The door might not open if you pull it immediately
after gripping the door handle. Grip the handle
again and confirm that the door is unlocked before
pulling the handle.
Even within the 32 inches (80 cm) radius, you may not
be able to lock/unlock the doors with the smart entry
remote if it is above or below the outside handle.
The smart entry remote may not operate if it is too
close to the door and door glass.
If the distance at which it works varies, the battery is
probably low.
If the LED does not come on when you press a
button, the battery is dead.
2 Replacing the Button Battery P. 503
You can customize the door lock mode and keyless
lock acknowledgement setting.
2 Customized Features P. 101, 293
Table of Contents
uuLocking and Unlocking the DoorsuLocking/Unlocking the Doors from the Outside
116
Controls
Unlocking the doors and the trunk
Grab the driver’s door handle:
u The driver’s door unlocks.
u Some exterior lights flash twice and the
beeper sounds twice.
Grab the front passenger’s door handle:
u All the doors unlock.
u Some exterior lights flash twice and the
beeper sounds twice.
Press the trunk release button:
u The trunk unlocks and opens.
2 Using the Trunk Release Button P. 123
Trunk Release Button
1Using the Smart Entry with Push Button Start System
If you do not open a door within 30 seconds of
unlocking the vehicle, the doors will automatically
relock.
The light flash, beep and unlock settings can be
customized.
2 Customized Features P. 101, 293
Table of Contents
117
uuLocking and Unlocking the DoorsuLocking/Unlocking the Doors from the Outside
Controls
Fully insert the key and turn it.
Locking the driver's door
Push the lock tab forward
a or push the
master door lock switch in the lock direction
b, and close the door.
Locking the passenger's doors
Push the lock tab forward and close the door.
Lockout prevention system
The doors cannot be locked when the smart entry remote is inside the vehicle.
Locking/Unlocking the Doors Using a Key
1Locking/Unlocking the Doors Using a Key
When you lock the driver's door with a key, all the
other doors lock at the same time. When unlocking,
the driver's door unlocks first. Turn the key a second
time within a few seconds to unlock the remaining
doors.
You can customize the door unlock mode setting.
2 Customized Features P. 101, 293
Lock
Unlock
Locking a Door Without Using a Key
1Locking a Door Without Using a Key
When you lock the driver's door, all the other doors
lock at the same time.
Make sure you have the key in your hand before
locking the door to prevent it from being locked in
the vehicle.
Table of Contents
118
uuLocking and Unlocking the DoorsuLocking/Unlocking the Doors from the Inside
Controls
Locking/Unlocking the Doors from the Inside
Locking a door
Push the lock tab forward.
Unlocking a door
Pull the lock tab rearward.
Using the Lock Tab
1Using the Lock Tab
When you lock the door using the lock tab on the
driver's door, all the other doors lock at the same
time.
When you unlock the door using the lock tab on the
driver's door, only the driver's door will unlock.
To Unlock
Lock Tab
To Lock
Table of Contents
Continued
119
uuLocking and Unlocking the DoorsuLocking/Unlocking the Doors from the Inside
Controls
Pull the front door inner handle.
u The door unlocks and opens in one
motion.
Unlocking and opening the driver’s door from the inner handle unlocks all the other
doors.
To avoid all the doors to be unlocked, use the lock tab on the driver’s door to unlock,
then lock again before opening the door.
u This setting works for one time only. If you do not want all the doors to be
unlocked all the time, customize the Auto Door Unlock setting to Off using
the multi-information display or audio/information screen.
Unlocking Using the Inner Handle of Front Doors
1Unlocking Using the Inner Handle of Front Doors
The inner front door handles are designed to allow
front seat occupants to open the door in one motion.
However this feature requires that front seat
occupants never pull a front door inner handle while
the vehicle is in motion.
Children should always ride in a rear seat where
childproof door locks are provided.
2 Childproof Door Locks P. 120
Inner Handle
Table of Contents
uuLocking and Unlocking the DoorsuChildproof Door Locks
120
Controls
Press the master door lock switch in as shown
to lock or unlock all doors.
Childproof Door Locks
The childproof door locks prevent the rear doors from being opened from the inside
regardless of the position of the lock tab.
Slide the lever in the rear door to the lock
position, and close the door.
When opening the door
Open the door using the outside door handle.
Using the Master Door Lock Switch
1Using the Master Door Lock Switch
When you lock/unlock the driver's door using the
master lock switch, all the other doors lock/unlock at
the same time.
To Unlock
Master Door
Lock Switch
To Lock
Setting the Childproof Door Locks
1Childproof Door Locks
To open the door from the inside when the
childproof door lock is on, put the lock tab in the
unlock position, lower the rear window, put your
hand out of the window, and pull the outside door
handle.
Unlock
Lock
Table of Contents
121
uuLocking and Unlocking the DoorsuAuto Door Locking/Unlocking
Controls
Auto Door Locking/Unlocking
Your vehicle locks and unlocks all doors automatically when a certain condition is
met.
Drive lock mode
All doors lock when the vehicle’s speed reaches about 10 mph (15 km/h).
Driver’s door open mode
All doors unlock when the driver’s door is opened.
Auto Door Locking
Auto Door Unlocking
1Auto Door Locking/Unlocking
You can turn off or change to another auto door
locking/unlocking setting using the audio/
information screen or multi-information display.
2 Customized Features P. 101, 293
Table of Contents
122
Controls
Opening and Closing the Trunk
Precautions for Opening/Closing the Trunk
Opening the trunk
Open the trunk all the way.
u If it is not fully opened, the trunk lid may begin to close under its own weight.
Closing the trunk
Keep the trunk lid closed while driving to:
u Avoid possible damage.
u Prevent exhaust gas from leaking into the vehicle.
2 Exhaust Gas Hazard P. 68
Using the Trunk Opener
Pulling the trunk release to the lower left of
the driver's seat unlocks and opens the trunk.
Trunk
Release
Table of Contents
123
uuOpening and Closing the TrunkuUsing the Trunk Release Button
Controls
Locking the trunk opener
You can lock the trunk release with the built-
in key.
Using the Trunk Release Button
Push up the release button on the trunk lid
after the doors are unlocked.
Even if the trunk is locked, you can open the
trunk if you carry the smart entry remote.
u The beeper will sound.
1Using the Trunk Release Button
Do not leave the smart entry remote in the vehicle
when you get out. Carry it with you.
A person who is not carrying the smart entry
remote can unlock the trunk if a person who is
carrying it is within range.
Do not leave the smart entry remote inside the
trunk and close the lid. The beeper sounds and the
trunk cannot be closed.
Do not carry the smart entry remote near the trunk
lid when closing it.
Do not place the smart entry remote around the
rear seat when closing the trunk.
Trunk Release Button
Table of Contents
124
uuOpening and Closing the TrunkuUsing the Remote Transmitter
Controls
Using the Remote Transmitter
Press the trunk release button for
approximately one second to unlock and open
the trunk.
Trunk Main Switch
The trunk main switch disables the trunk
release button on the remote transmitter and
the trunk release button on the trunk lid to
protect luggage in the trunk.
1. Turn off the trunk main switch in the glove
box.
2. Lock the glove box.
3. Lock the trunk release.
2 Using the Trunk Opener P. 122
Trunk Button
1Trunk Main Switch
If you need to give the key to someone else, remove
the built-in key from the smart entry remote by
sliding the release knob, and give the remote as a
valet key.
ON
OFF
Main Switch
Table of Contents
125
uuOpening and Closing the TrunkuEmergency Trunk Opener
Controls
Emergency Trunk Opener
The trunk release lever allows you to open the
trunk from inside for your safety.
Slide the release lever in the direction of the
arrow.
1Emergency Trunk Opener
Parents should decide if their children should be
shown how to use this feature.
Lever
Table of Contents
126
Controls
Security System
Immobilizer System
The immobilizer system prevents a key that has not been pre-registered from
starting the motor. Each key contains electronic transmitters that use electronic
signals to verify the key.
Pay attention to the following when selecting the ACCESSORY mode with the
POWER button:
Do not allow objects that emit strong radio waves near the POWER button.
Make sure the key is not covered by or touching a metal object.
Do not bring a key from another vehicle's immobilizer system near the smart entry
remote.
Security System Alarm
The security system alarm activates when the doors, trunk, or hood are opened
without the key, remote transmitter, or smart entry system.
When the security system alarm activates
The horn sounds intermittently and all of the exterior lights flash.
To deactivate the security system alarm
Unlock the vehicle using the key, remote transmitter, or smart entry system. The
system, along with the horn and flashing lights, is deactivated.
1Immobilizer System
NOTICE
Leaving the ignition key in the vehicle can result in
theft or accidental movement of the vehicle.
Always take the ignition key with you whenever you
leave the vehicle unattended.
Do not alter the system or add other devices to it.
Doing so may damage the system and make your
vehicle inoperable.
1Security System Alarm
The security alarm continues for a maximum of two
minutes until the security system deactivates.
Table of Contents
Continued
127
uuSecurity SystemuSecurity System Alarm
Controls
Setting the security system alarm
The security system alarm automatically sets when the following conditions have
been met:
The power mode is in VEHICLE OFF (LOCK).
The hood and trunk are closed.
All doors are locked from outside with the key, the remote transmitter, or smart
entry system.
When the security system alarm sets
The security system alarm indicator in the instrument panel blinks. When the
blinking interval changes after about 15 seconds, the security system is set.
To cancel the security system alarm
The security system alarm is canceled when the vehicle is unlocked using the key,
remote transmitter, or smart entry system. The security system indicator goes off at
the same time.
1Security System Alarm
Do not set the security system alarm when someone
is in the vehicle or a window is open. The system can
accidentally activate when:
Unlocking the door with the lock tab.
Opening the trunk with the trunk release or the
emergency trunk opener.
If the 12-volt battery goes dead after you have set the
security system alarm, the security alarm may go off
once the 12-volt battery is recharged or replaced.
If this occurs, deactivate the security system alarm by
unlocking a door using the key or remote transmitter.
Do not attempt to alter this system or add another
device to it.
Table of Contents
128
uuSecurity SystemuSecurity System Alarm
Controls
The panic button on the remote
transmitter
If you press the panic button for
approximately one second, the following will
occur for about 30 seconds:
The horn sounds.
Some exterior lights flash.
Canceling panic mode
Press any button on the remote transmitter, or set the power mode to ON.
Panic Mode
Panic Button
Table of Contents
129
Continued
Controls
Opening and Closing the Windows
Opening/Closing the Power Windows
The power windows can be opened and closed when the power mode is in ON,
using the switches on the doors. The driver's side switches can be used to open and
close all of the windows.
The power window lock button on the driver's side must be switched off (not
pushed in, indicator off) to open and close the windows from anywhere other than
the driver's seat.
When the power window lock button is pushed in, the indicator comes on and you
can only operate the driver's window. Turn the power window lock button on when
children are in the vehicle.
Automatic operation
To open: Push the switch down firmly.
To close: Pull the switch up firmly.
The window opens or closes completely. To
stop the window at any time, push or pull the
switch briefly.
Manual operation
To open: Push the switch down lightly, and
hold it until the desired position is reached.
To close: Pull the switch up lightly, and hold it
until the desired position is reached.
Opening/Closing Windows with Auto-Open/Close Function
1Opening/Closing the Power Windows
The power windows can be operated for up to 10
minutes after you set the power mode to VEHICLE
OFF (LOCK).
Opening either front door cancels this function.
Auto Reverse
If a power window senses resistance when closing
automatically, it will stop closing and reverse
direction.
The driver’s window auto reverse function is disabled
when you continuously pull up the switch.
The auto reverse function stops sensing when the
window is almost closed to ensure that it fully closes.
3
WARNING
Closing a power window on someone's
hands or fingers can cause serious injury.
Make sure your passengers are away from
the windows before closing them.
On
Off
Power Window
Lock Button
Indicator
Driver’s
Window
Switch
Front Passenger’s
Window Switch
Table of Contents
130
uuOpening and Closing the WindowsuOpening/Closing the Power Windows
Controls
To open: Push the switch down.
To close: Pull the switch up.
Release the switch when the window reaches
the desired position.
To open: Press the unlock button twice
within 10 seconds and hold it down for the
second time. If the windows stop midway,
repeat the procedure.
Opening/Closing Windows without Auto-Open/Close Function
Close
Open
Opening Windows and Moonroof with the Remote
Unlock
Button
Table of Contents
131
uuOpening and Closing the WindowsuOpening/Closing the Power Windows
Controls
To open: Unlock the driver’s door with the
key. Within 10 seconds of returning the key to
the central position, turn the key in the unlock
direction and hold it there.
To close: Lock the driver’s door with the key.
Within 10 seconds of returning the key to the
central position, turn the key in the lock
direction and hold it there.
Release the key to stop the windows/
moonroof at the desired position. If you want
further adjustment, repeat the same
operation.
Opening/Closing the Windows and Moonroof with the Key
Close
Open
Table of Contents
132
Controls
Opening and Closing the Moonroof
*
You can only operate the moonroof when the power mode is in ON. Use the switch
in the front of the ceiling to open and close the moonroof.
Automatic operation
To open: Pull the switch back firmly.
To close: Push the switch forward firmly.
The moonroof will automatically open or close
all the way. To stop the moonroof midway,
touch the switch briefly.
Manual operation
To open: Pull the switch back lightly, and
hold it until the desired position is reached.
To close: Push the switch forward lightly, and
hold it until the desired position is reached.
Tilting the moonroof up
To tilt: Push on the center of the moonroof
switch.
To close: Push the switch forward firmly, then
release.
Opening/Closing the Moonroof
1Opening/Closing the Moonroof
NOTICE
Opening the moonroof in below freezing
temperature or when it is covered with snow or ice
can damage the moonroof panel or motor.
The power moonroof can be operated for up to 10
minutes after you set the power mode to VEHICLE
OFF (LOCK).
Opening either front door cancels this function.
When resistance is detected, the auto reverse
function causes the moonroof to change directions,
then stop. Auto reverse stops sensing when the
moonroof is almost closed to ensure that it fully
closes. Make sure that all objects, including fingers,
are clear of the moonroof.
3
WARNING
Opening or closing the moonroof on
someone's hands or fingers can cause
serious injury.
Make sure all hands and fingers are clear of
the moonroof before opening or closing it.
Open
Close
Tilt
* Not available on all models
Table of Contents
133
Continued
Controls
Operating the Switches Around the Steering Wheel
POWER Button
Changing the Power Mode
1POWER Button
POWER Button Operating Range
You can start the power system when the smart entry
remote is inside the vehicle.
The power system may also start if the smart entry
remote is close to the door or window, even if it is
outside the vehicle.
ON mode:
Indicator in the button is off, if the engine is running.
If the smart entry remote battery is weak, beeper
sounds and the To Start, Hold Remote Near Start
Button message appears on the multi-information
display.
2 If the Smart Entry Remote Battery is Weak
P. 520
Do not leave the power mode in ACCESSORY or ON
when you get out.
Operating Range
VEHICLE OFF (LOCK)
Indicator in the button is off.
The steering wheel is locked. The power to all
electrical components is turned off.
Press the button without the shift lever in
(P .
Shift to
(P then press the button.
Press the button.
Without pressing
the brake pedal
ACCESSORY
Indicator in the button is on.
Indicator in the button blinks (from ON to
ACCESSORY). Operate the audio system and
other accessories in this position.
ON
Indicator in the button is on.
All electrical components can be used.
Indicator
Table of Contents
134
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluPOWER Button
Controls
If you leave the vehicle for 30 to 60 minutes with the shift lever in (P and the power
mode in ACCESSORY, the vehicle automatically goes into the mode similar to
VEHICLE OFF (LOCK) to avoid the 12-volt battery drain.
When in this mode:
The steering wheel does not lock.
You cannot lock or unlock doors with the remote transmitter or the smart entry
system.
Press the POWER button twice to switch the mode to VEHICLE OFF (LOCK).
Automatic Power Off
Table of Contents
135
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluPOWER Button
Controls
If you open the driver’s door when the power mode is set to ACCESSORY, a warning
buzzer sounds.
Warning buzzers may sound from inside or/
and outside the vehicle to remind you that the
smart entry remote is out of the vehicle. If the
buzzer continues even after the remote is put
back inside, place it to be within its
operational range.
When the power mode is in ON
If the smart entry remote is taken out of the
vehicle, and the driver’s door is closed,
warning buzzers sound from both inside and
outside the vehicle. A warning message on
the multi-information display notifies the
driver inside that the remote is out.
When the power mode is in
ACCESSORY
If the smart entry remote is taken out of the
vehicle, and all the doors are closed, a
warning buzzer sounds from outside the
vehicle.
Power Mode Reminder
Smart Entry Remote Reminder
1Smart Entry Remote Reminder
When the smart entry remote is within the system’s
operational range, and the driver’s door is closed, the
warning function cancels.
If the smart entry remote is taken out of the vehicle
after the power system has been turned on, you can
no longer change the POWER button mode or
restart the power system. Always make sure if the
remote is in your vehicle when you operate the
POWER button.
Removing the smart entry remote from the vehicle
through a window does not activate the warning
buzzer.
Do not put the smart entry remote on the dashboard
or in the glove box. It may cause the warning buzzer
to go off. Under some other conditions that can
prevent the vehicle from locating the remote, the
warning buzzer may also go off even if the remote is
within the system’s operational range.
Table of Contents
136
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluTurn Signals
Controls
Turn Signals
The turn signals can be used when the power
mode is in ON.
One-touch turn signal
When you lightly push up or down and release
the turn signal lever, the exterior turn signals
and turn signal indicator blink three times.
This feature can be used when signaling for a
lane change.
Light Switches
Rotating the light switch turns the lights on
and off, regardless of the power mode
setting.
High beams
Push the lever forward until you hear a click.
Low beams
When in high beams, pull the lever back to
return to low beams.
Flashing the high beams
Pull the lever back, and release it.
Right Turn
Left Turn
Manual Operation
1Light Switches
If you leave the power mode in VEHICLE OFF (LOCK)
while the lights are on, a chime sounds when the
driver’s door is opened.
When the lights are on, the lights on indicator in the
instrument panel will be on.
2 Lights On Indicator P. 79
If you sense that the level of the headlights is
abnormal, have your vehicle inspected by a dealer.
Do not leave the lights on when the power system is
off because it will cause the 12-volt battery to
discharge.
High Beams
Flashing the high beams
Low Beams
Turns on parking, side marker,
tail, and rear license plate lights
Turns on headlights, parking, side
marker, tail, and rear license plate
lights
Table of Contents
Continued
137
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluLight Switches
Controls
Automatic lighting control can be used when
the power mode is in ON.
When you turn the light switch to AUTO, the
headlights and other exterior lights will switch
on and off automatically depending on the
ambient brightness.
u You can change the auto light sensitivity
setting.
2 Customized Features P. 101, 293
Automatic Lighting Control
1Automatic Lighting Control
We recommend that you turn on the lights manually
when driving at night, in a dense fog, or in dark areas
such as long tunnels or parking facilities.
The light sensor is in the location shown below.
Do not cover this light sensor with anything;
otherwise, the automatic lighting system may not
work properly.
Adjust the auto light sensitivity as follows:
Setting
The exterior lights come on
when the ambient light is at
MAX
HIGH
MID
LOW
MIN
Light Sensor
Bright
Dark
Table of Contents
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluLight Switches
138
Controls
The headlights automatically come on when the wipers are used several times within
a certain number of intervals with the headlight switch in AUTO.
The headlights automatically go off a few minutes later if the wipers are stopped.
The headlights, all other exterior lights, and the instrument panel lights turn off 15
seconds after you set the power mode to VEHICLE OFF (LOCK), take the remote with
you, and close the driver’s door.
u You can change the headlight auto off timer setting.
2 Customized Features P. 101, 293
If you set the power mode to VEHICLE OFF (LOCK) with the headlight switch on, but
do not open the door, the lights turn off after 10 minutes (three minutes, if the
switch is in the AUTO position).
The lights turn on again when you unlock or open the driver's door. If you unlock
the door, but do not open it within 15 seconds, the lights go off. If you open the
driver's door, you will hear a lights on reminder chime.
Headlight Integration with Wipers
*
Automatic Lighting Off Feature
1Headlight Integration with Wipers
*
This feature activates while the headlights are off in
AUTO.
The instrument panel brightness does not change
when the headlights come on.
At dark ambient light levels, the automatic lighting
control feature turns on the headlights, regardless of
the number of wiper sweeps.
* Not available on all models
Table of Contents
139
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluDaytime Running Lights
Controls
Daytime Running Lights
The parking/daytime running lights come on when the following conditions have
been met:
The power mode is ON.
The headlight switch is off, or in .
The parking brake is released.
The lights remain on even if you set the parking brake. Setting the power mode to
VEHICLE OFF will turn off the daytime running lights.
Table of Contents
140
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluWipers and Washers
Controls
Wipers and Washers
The windshield wipers and washers can be
used when the power mode is in ON.
MIST
The wipers run at high speed until you release
the lever.
Wiper switch (OFF, INT, LO, HI)
Change the wiper switch setting according to
the amount of rain.
Adjusting the delay
Turn the adjustment ring to adjust the wiper
delay.
Washer
Sprays while you pull the lever toward you.
When you release the lever, the wipers make
two or three more sweeps before stopping.
1Wipers and Washers
NOTICE
Do not use the wipers when the windshield is dry.
The windshield will get scratched, or the rubber
blades will get damaged.
NOTICE
In cold weather, the blades may freeze to the
windshield, becoming stuck.
Operating the wipers in this condition may damage
the wipers. Use the defroster to warm the
windshield, then turn the wipers on.
If the vehicle speeds up while the wipers are
operating intermittently, the length of the wipe
interval shortens. When the vehicle starts moving, the
wipers make a single sweep.
When the vehicle speeds up, the wiper operation’s shortest
delay setting ( ) and the
LO
setting become the same.
Turn the washers off if no washer fluid comes out.
The pump may get damaged.
The wiper motor is equipped with a breaker that may
stop motor operation temporarily to prevent an
overload. Wiper operation will return to normal within a
few minutes, once the circuit has returned to normal.
If the wipers stop operating due to any obstacle such as
the build-up of snow, park the vehicle in a safe place.
Rotate the wiper switch to
OFF
, and set the power
mode to ACCESSORY or VEHICLE OFF (LOCK), then
remove the obstacle.
Intermittent Time
Adjustment Ring
MIST
INT: Low speed with
intermittent
OFF
LO: Low speed wipe
HI: High speed wipe
Pull to
use
washer.
Long delay
Short delay
Table of Contents
141
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluBrightness Control
Controls
Brightness Control
When the parking lights are turned on and the
power mode is in ON, you can use the
brightness control knob to adjust instrument
panel brightness.
Brighten: Turn the knob to the right.
Dim: Turn the knob to the left.
You will hear a beep when the brightness
reaches minimum or maximum. The multi-
information display will return to its original
state several seconds after you adjust the
brightness.
Brightness level indicator
The brightness level is shown on the multi-
information display while you are adjusting it.
1Brightness Control
Instrument panel brightness varies, depending on
whether the exterior lights are on or off. The
instrument panel dims to reduce glare when they are
on.
Pressing the (Select/Reset) knob switches the
display.
If you turn the knob to the right until the brightness
display is up to max, the beeper sounds. This cancels
the reduced instrument panel brightness when the
parking lights are on.
The brightness can be set differently for when the
exterior lights are on, and when they are off.
Control Knob
Table of Contents
142
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluRear Defogger/Heated Door Mirror Button
Controls
Rear Defogger/Heated Door Mirror Button
Press the rear defogger and heated door mirror button to defog the rear window
and mirrors when the power mode is in ON.
The rear defogger and heated door mirrors
automatically switch off after 10-30 minutes
depending on the outside temperature.
However, if the outside temperature is 32°F
(0°C) or below, they do not automatically
switch off.
1Rear Defogger/Heated Door Mirror Button
NOTICE
When cleaning the inside of the rear window, be
careful not to damage the heating wires.
It is critical to wipe the window from side to side
along the defogger heating wires.
This system consumes a lot of power, so turn it off
when the window has been defogged.
Also, do not use the system for a long period when
the power system is off. This may weaken the 12-volt
battery, making it difficult to turn the power system
on.
Table of Contents
143
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluDriving Position Memory System
*
Continued
Controls
Driving Position Memory System
*
You can store two driver’s seat positions with the driving position memory system.
When you unlock and open the driver’s door with a remote, the seat adjusts
automatically to one of the two preset positions.
The multi-information display shows you which remote you used to unlock the
vehicle when you enter.
DRIVER 1 transmitter is linked to memory button 1.
DRIVER 2 transmitter is linked to memory button 2.
1Driving Position Memory System
*
Using the audio/information screen or multi-
information display, you can disable the automatic
seat adjustment function.
2 Customized Features P. 101, 293
DRIVER 1
DRIVER 2
* Not available on all models
Table of Contents
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluDriving Position Memory System
*
144
Controls
1. Set the power mode to ON. Adjust the
driver’s seat to the desired position.
2. Press the SET button.
u You will hear a beep, and the memory
button indicator light will blink.
3. Press and hold memory button
(1 or (2
within five seconds of pressing the SET
button.
u Once the seat position has been
memorized, the indicator light on the
button you pressed stays on.
1. Move the shift lever to
(P .
2. Apply the parking brake.
3. Press a memory button (
(1 or (2).
u You will hear a beep, and the indicator
light will blink.
The seat will automatically move to the
memorized position. When it has finished
moving, you will hear a beep, and the
indicator light stays on.
Storing a Position in Memory
1Storing a Position in Memory
After you press the SET button, the storing operation
will be canceled when:
You do not press the memory button within five
seconds.
You readjust the seat position before the double-
beep.
You set the power mode to any position except
ON.
Memory
Button 1
Memory
Button 2
SET Button
Recalling the Stored Position
1Recalling the Stored Position
The seat will stop moving if you:
Press the SET button, or a memory button (
(1 or
(2 ).
Adjust the seat position.
Shift into any position except
(P .
Memory
Button 1
Memory
Button 2
Table of Contents
145
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluAdjusting the Steering Wheel
Controls
Adjusting the Steering Wheel
The steering wheel height and distance from your body can be adjusted so that you
can comfortably grip the steering wheel in an appropriate driving posture.
1. Pull the steering wheel adjustment lever up.
u The steering wheel adjustment lever is
under the steering column.
2. Move the steering wheel up or down, and
in or out.
u Make sure you can see the instrument
panel gauges and indicators.
3. Push the steering wheel adjustment lever
down to lock the steering wheel in position.
u After adjusting the position, make sure
you have securely locked the steering
wheel in place by trying to move it up,
down, in, and out.
1Adjusting the Steering Wheel
Make any steering wheel adjustments before you
start driving.
3
WARNING
Adjusting the steering wheel position while
driving may cause you to lose control of the
vehicle and be seriously injured in a crash.
Adjust the steering wheel only when the
vehicle is stopped.
To adjust
To lock
Lever
Table of Contents
146
Controls
Adjusting the Mirrors
Interior Rearview Mirror
Adjust the angle of the rearview mirror when you are sitting in the correct driving
position.
Flip the tab to switch the position.
The night position will help to reduce the glare
from headlights behind you when driving
after dark.
When driving after dark, the automatic
dimming rearview mirror reduces the glare
from headlights behind you. Press the auto
button to turn this function on and off. When
activated, the auto indicator comes on.
Rearview Mirror with Day and Night Positions
*
1Adjusting the Mirrors
Keep the inside and outside mirrors clean and
adjusted for best visibility.
Adjust the mirrors before you start driving.
2 Adjusting the Seat Positions P. 148
Tab
Daytime
Position
Night Position
Up
Down
Automatic Dimming Rearview Mirror
*
1Automatic Dimming Rearview Mirror
*
The auto dimming function cancels when the shift
position is in
(R .
Sensor
Auto Button
Indicator
* Not available on all models
Table of Contents
147
uuAdjusting the MirrorsuPower Door Mirrors
Controls
Power Door Mirrors
You can adjust the door mirrors when the
power mode is in ON.
Mirror position adjustment
L/R selector switch: Select the left or right
mirror. After adjusting the mirror, return the
switch to the center position.
Mirror position adjustment switch: Press
the switch left, right, up, or down to move the
mirror.
The driver side door mirror has outer and inner
segments.
The outer segment is slightly curved to provide
a wider angle view than a standard flat mirror.
This wider view may help you check areas that
are not visible using a standard door mirror.
Selector Switch
Adjustment Switch
Expanded View Driver's Mirror
1Expanded View Driver's Mirror
Objects visible in the outer segment of the driver side
door mirror appear smaller than objects in the rest of
the mirror. But in fact, they are closer than they
appear.
Do not rely on your mirrors. Always look to the side
and behind your vehicle before changing lanes.
Inner Segment
Outer Segment
Table of Contents
148
Controls
Adjusting the Seats
Adjusting the Seat Positions
Adjust the driver's seat as far back as possible
while allowing you to maintain full control of
the vehicle. You should be able to sit upright,
well back in the seat and be able to
adequately press the pedals without leaning
forward, and grip the steering wheel
comfortably. The passenger's seat should be
adjusted in a similar manner, so that it is as far
back from the front airbag in the dashboard
as possible.
Adjusting the front power seat(s)
*
1Adjusting the Seats
The National Highway Traffic Safety Administration
and Transport Canada recommend that drivers allow
at least 10 inches (25 cm) between the center of the
steering wheel and the chest.
Always make seat adjustments before driving.
3
WARNING
Sitting too close to a front airbag can result
in serious injury or death if the front
airbags inflate.
Always sit as far back from the front
airbags as possible while maintaining
control of the vehicle.
Move back.
Allow sufficient
space.
Horizontal Position
Adjustment
Height Adjustment
(Driver’s seat only)
Seat-back Angle
Adjustment
Lumbar Support
Adjustment
(Driver’s seat only)
* Not available on all models
Table of Contents
Continued
149
uuAdjusting the SeatsuAdjusting the Seat Positions
Controls
Adjusting the front passenger’s manual seat
*
1Adjusting the front passenger’s manual seat
*
Once a seat is adjusted correctly, rock it back and
forth to make sure it is locked in position.
Horizontal Position
Adjustment
Pull up on the bar to
move the seat, then
release the bar.
Seat-back Angle
Adjustment
Pull up the lever to
change the angle.
* Not available on all models
Table of Contents
uuAdjusting the SeatsuAdjusting the Seat Positions
150
Controls
Adjust the driver's seat-back to a comfortable,
upright position, leaving ample space
between your chest and the airbag cover in
the center of the steering wheel.
The front seat passenger should also adjust
their seat-back to a comfortable, upright
position.
Reclining a seat-back so that the shoulder part of the belt no longer rests against the
occupant's chest reduces the protective capability of the belt. It also increases the
chance of sliding under the belt in a crash and being seriously injured. The farther a
seat-back is reclined, the greater the risk of injury.
Adjusting the Seat-Backs
1Adjusting the Seat-Backs
Do not put a cushion, or other object, between the
seat-back and your back.
Doing so may interfere with proper seat belt or airbag
operation.
If you cannot get far enough away from the steering
wheel and still reach the controls, we recommend
that you investigate whether some type of adaptive
equipment may help.
3
WARNING
Reclining the seat-back too far can result in
serious injury or death in a crash.
Adjust the seat-back to an upright position,
and sit well back in the seat.
Table of Contents
Continued
151
uuAdjusting the SeatsuAdjusting the Seat Positions
Controls
Your vehicle is equipped with head restraints
in all seating positions.
Head restraints are most effective for
protection against whiplash and other rear-
impact crash injuries when the center of the
back of the occupant's head rests against the
center of the restraint. The tops of the
occupant's ears should be level with the
center height of the restraint.
Adjusting the front head restraint positions
To raise the head restraint: Pull it upward.
To lower the head restraint: Push it down
while pressing the release button.
Adjusting the Head Restraints
1Adjusting the Head Restraints
For a head restraint system to work properly:
Do not hang any items on the head restraints, or
from the restraint legs.
Do not place any object between an occupant and
the seat-back.
Install each restraint in its proper location.
3
WARNING
Improperly positioning head restraints
reduces their effectiveness and increases
the likelihood of serious injury in a crash.
Make sure head restraints are in place and
positioned properly before driving.
Position head in the center
of the head restraint.
Table of Contents
uuAdjusting the SeatsuAdjusting the Seat Positions
152
Controls
A passenger sitting in the center back seating
position should adjust the height of their head
restraint to an appropriate position before the
vehicle begins moving.
To raise the head restraint:
Pull it upward.
To lower the head restraint:
Push it down while pressing the release
button.
Head restraints can be removed for cleaning or repair.
To remove a head restraint:
Pull the restraint up as far as it will go. Then push the release button, and pull the
restraint up and out.
To reinstall a head restraint:
Insert the legs back in place, then adjust the head restraint to an appropriate height
while pressing the release button. Pull up on the restraint to make sure it is locked
in position.
Changing the Rear Center Seat Head Restraint Positions
Removing and Reinstalling the Head Restraints
1Removing and Reinstalling the Head Restraints
3
WARNING
Failure to reinstall, or correctly reinstall, the
head restraints can result in severe injury
during a crash.
Always replace the head restraints before
driving.
Table of Contents
153
uuAdjusting the SeatsuAdjusting the Seat Positions
Controls
After all occupants have adjusted their seats and head restraints, and put on their
seat belts, it is very important that they continue to sit upright, well back in their
seats, with their feet on the floor, until the vehicle is safely parked and the power
system is off.
Sitting improperly can increase the chance of injury during a crash. For example, if
an occupant slouches, lies down, turns sideways, sits forward, leans forward or
sideways, or puts one or both feet up, the chance of injury during a crash is greatly
increased.
In addition, an occupant who is out of position in the front seat can be seriously or
fatally injured in a crash by striking interior parts of the vehicle or being struck by an
inflating front airbag.
Maintain a Proper Sitting Position
1Maintain a Proper Sitting Position
3
WARNING
Sitting improperly or out of position can
result in serious injury or death in a crash.
Always sit upright, well back in the seat,
with your feet on the floor.
Table of Contents
154
uuAdjusting the SeatsuArmrest
Controls
Armrest
Pull down the armrest in the center seat-back.
Using the Rear Seat Armrest
Table of Contents
155
Continued
Controls
Interior Lights/Interior Convenience Items
Interior Lights
ON
The interior lights come on regardless of
whether the doors are open or closed.
Door activated
The interior lights come on in the following
situations:
When any of the doors are opened.
You unlock the driver's door.
When the power mode is set to VEHICLE
OFF (LOCK).
OFF
The interior lights remain off regardless of
whether the doors are open or closed.
Interior Light Switches
1Interior Light Switches
In the door activated position, the interior lights fade out
and go off about 30 seconds after the doors are closed.
The lights go off after 30 seconds in the following
situations:
When you unlock the driver's door but do not open it.
When you set the power mode to VEHICLE OFF
(LOCK) but do not open a door.
You can change the interior lights dimming time.
2 Customized Features P. 101, 293
The interior lights go off immediately in the following
situations:
When you lock the driver's door.
When you turn the set the power mode to ON.
When you close the driver's door in ACCESSORY
mode.
If you leave any of the doors open in VEHICLE OFF
(LOCK) mode, the interior lights go off after about 15
minutes.
Door Activated Position
Off
Door Activated
Position
On
Off
Table of Contents
uuInterior Lights/Interior Convenience ItemsuInterior Lights
156
Controls
The map lights can be turned on and off by
pressing the lenses.
Map Lights
1Map Lights
When the ceiling light switch is in the door activated
position and any door is open, the map light will not
go off when you press the lens.
Table of Contents
157
uuInterior Lights/Interior Convenience ItemsuInterior Convenience Items
Continued
Controls
Interior Convenience Items
Pull the handle to open the glove box.
You can lock the glove box with the built-in
key.
Pull the handle to open the console
compartment.
Glove Box
1Glove Box
3
WARNING
An open glove box can cause serious injury
to your passenger in a crash, even if the
passenger is wearing the seat belt.
Always keep the glove box closed while
driving.
Glove Box
Handle
To Lock
Console Compartment
Table of Contents
158
uuInterior Lights/Interior Convenience ItemsuInterior Convenience Items
Controls
Pull the handle to open the pocket.
Center Pocket
*
Handle
* Not available on all models
Table of Contents
Continued
159
uuInterior Lights/Interior Convenience ItemsuInterior Convenience Items
Controls
Front seat beverage holders
Are located in the console between the front
seats.
Rear seat beverage holders
Fold the armrest down to use the rear seat
beverage holders.
Beverage Holders
1Beverage Holders
NOTICE
Spilled liquids damage the upholstery, carpeting, and
electrical components in the interior.
Be careful when you are using the beverage holders.
Hot liquid can scald you.
Table of Contents
uuInterior Lights/Interior Convenience ItemsuInterior Convenience Items
160
Controls
The accessory power sockets can be used when the power mode is in ACCESSORY
or ON.
Accessory power socket (console panel)
Open the cover to use it.
Accessory power socket (console
compartment)
Open the console lid and the cover to use it.
Accessory Power Sockets
1Accessory Power Sockets
NOTICE
Do not insert an automotive type cigarette lighter
element.
This can overheat the power socket.
The accessory power socket is designed to supply
power for 12-volt DC accessories that are rated 180
watts (15 amps) or less.
To prevent battery drain, only use the power socket
with the power system on.
When both sockets are being used, the combined
power rating of the accessories should not exceed
180 watts (15 amps).
Table of Contents
Continued
161
uuInterior Lights/Interior Convenience ItemsuInterior Convenience Items
Controls
There is a coat hook on the rear left grab
handle. Pull it down to use it.
The cargo hook in the trunk can be used to
install a net for securing items.
Coat Hook
1Coat Hook
The coat hook is not designed for large or heavy
items.
Cargo Hook
1Cargo Hook
Heavy objects may damage the hook.
Make sure any items put on this hook weigh less than
6.6 lbs (3 kg).
Distribute cargo evenly on the floor of the trunk,
placing the heaviest items on the bottom and as far
forward as possible.
2 Maximum Load Limit P. 413
Table of Contents
uuInterior Lights/Interior Convenience ItemsuInterior Convenience Items
162
Controls
In addition to the larger cargo area, the trunk
incorporates a small shelf above the High
Voltage (HV) battery module that can carry up
to 15.4 lbs (7kg). Do not exceed this capacity.
Be aware that this vehicle was not designed to
carry a spare tire. This is because the spare
could be forced into the HV battery and cause
leakage of flammable electrolyte in the event
your vehicle were to be severely impacted
from the rear.
In the event a flat tire, a tire repair kit is
provided beneath the trunk floor.
2 Temporarily Repairing a Flat Tire P. 510
To open the sunglasses holder, push and
release the indent. To close, push it again until
it latches.
You can store eyeglasses and other small
items in this holder.
Cargo Area
1Cargo Area
NOTICE
Heavy objects may damage the trunk shelf.
Make sure any items put on the shelf weigh less than
15.4 lbs (7kg).
3
WARNING
Carrying a spare tire in the trunk can result
in damage to the High Voltage battery and
leakage of flammable electrolyte if your
vehicle were to get severely impacted from
the rear.
Do not attempt to carry a spare tire in the
trunk.
Trunk Shelf
Sunglasses Holder
1Sunglasses Holder
Keep the holder closed while driving except when
accessing stored items.
Push
Table of Contents
Continued
163
uuInterior Lights/Interior Convenience ItemsuInterior Convenience Items
Controls
The power mode must be in ON to use the
seat heaters. The HI setting heats the seats
faster than the LO setting.
While in HI, the heater cycles on and off.
u The appropriate indicator will be on
while the seat heater is on. Briefly press
the switch on the opposite side to turn
the heater off. The indicator will be off.
When a comfortable temperature is
reached, select LO to keep the seat
warm.
Front Seat Heaters
*
1Front Seat Heaters
*
Do not use the seat heaters even in LO when the
power system is off. Under such conditions, the 12-
volt battery may be weakened, making the power
system difficult to start.
In the LO setting, the heater runs continuously and
does not automatically turn off.
3
WARNING
Heat induced burns are possible when
using seat heaters.
Persons with a diminished ability to sense
temperature (e.g., persons with diabetes,
lower-limb nerve damage, or paralysis) or
with sensitive skin should not use seat
heaters.
* Not available on all models
Table of Contents
uuInterior Lights/Interior Convenience ItemsuInterior Convenience Items
164
Controls
The power mode must be in ON to use the
seat heaters. The HI setting heats the seats
faster than the LO setting.
There is no heater in the rear center seating
position.
While in HI, the heater cycles on and off.
u The appropriate indicator will be on
while the seat heater is on. When a
comfortable temperature is reached,
select LO to keep the seat warm.
Rear Seat Heaters
*
1Rear Seat Heaters
*
Do not use the seat heaters even in LO when the
power system is off. Under such conditions, the 12-
volt battery may be weakened, making the power
system difficult to start.
In the LO setting, the heater runs continuously and
does not automatically turn off.
3
WARNING
Heat induced burns are possible when
using seat heaters.
Persons with a diminished ability to sense
temperature (e.g., persons with diabetes,
lower-limb nerve damage, or paralysis) or
with sensitive skin should not use seat
heaters.
* Not available on all models
Table of Contents
165
Continued
Controls
Climate Control System
Using Automatic Climate Control
The automatic climate control system maintains the interior temperature you select.
The system also selects the proper mix of heated or cooled air that raises or lowers
the interior temperature to your preference as quickly as possible.
Use the system when the power system is ON.
1. Press the AUTO button.
2. Adjust the interior temperature using the driver’s side or passenger’s side control
buttons.
3. Press the (on/off) button to cancel.
Switching between the recirculation and fresh air modes
Press the (recirculation) button and switch the mode depending on
environmental conditions.
Recirculation mode (indicator on): Recirculates air from the vehicle’s interior through
the system.
Fresh air mode (indicator off): Maintains outside ventilation. Keep the system in
fresh air mode in normal situations.
1Using Automatic Climate Control
If any buttons are pressed while using the climate
control system in auto, the function of the button
that was pressed will take priority.
The AUTO indicator will go off, but functions
unrelated to the button that was pressed will be
controlled automatically.
To prevent cold air from blowing in from outside, the
fan may not start immediately when the AUTO
button is pressed.
If the interior is very warm, you can cool it down
more rapidly by partially opening the windows,
turning the system on auto, and setting the
temperature to low. Change the fresh mode to
recirculation mode until the temperature cools down.
When you set the temperature to the lower or upper
limit, Lo or Hi is displayed.
Pressing the button switches the climate
control system between on and off. When turned on,
the system returns to your last selection.
Floor and
defroster
vents
Floor ventsDashboard and floor
vents, and back of
the center console
Dashboard vents
and back of the
center console
AUTO Button
Driver’s Side
Temperature
Control Buttons
(Recirculation) Button
/ (Fan Control) Buttons
A/C (Air Conditioning)
Button
Passenger’s Side
Temperature
Control Buttons
Table of Contents
uuClimate Control SystemuUsing Automatic Climate Control
166
Controls
Pressing the button turns the air
conditioning system on and automatically
switches the system to fresh air mode.
Press the button again to turn off, the
system returns to the previous settings.
To rapidly defrost the windows
1. Press the button.
2. Press the button.
Defrosting the Windshield and Windows
1Defrosting the Windshield and Windows
For your safety, make sure you have a clear view
through all the windows before driving.
Do not set the temperature near the upper or lower
limit.
When cold air hits the windshield, the outside of the
windshield may fog up.
If the side windows fog up, adjust the vents so that
the air hits the side windows.
1To rapidly defrost the windows
After defrosting the windows, switch over to fresh air
mode. If you keep the system in recirculation mode,
the windows may fog up from humidity. This
impedes visibility.
Table of Contents
167
uuClimate Control SystemuSynchronized Mode
Controls
Synchronized Mode
You can set the temperature synchronously for the driver side and the passenger
side in synchronized mode.
1. Press the SYNC button.
u The system will switch to the synchronized mode.
2. Adjust the temperature using driver’s side temperature control buttons.
Press the SYNC button to return to dual mode.
1Synchronized Mode
When you press the button, the system changes
to synchronized mode.
When the system is in dual mode, the driver side
temperature and the passenger side temperature can
be set separately.
The system adjusts each temperature based on the
information of the sunlight sensor and the sun
position updated by the navigation system’s GPS.
Models with navigation system
Table of Contents
168
uuClimate Control SystemuAutomatic Climate Control Sensors
Controls
Automatic Climate Control Sensors
The automatic climate control system is
equipped with sensors. Do not cover or spill
any liquid on them.
Sensor
Sensor
Table of Contents
169
Features
This chapter describes how to operate technology features.
Audio System
USB Port .......................................... 171
Auxiliary Input Jack .......................... 172
Audio System Theft Protection
*
....... 173
Audio Remote Controls.................... 174
Audio System Basic Operation ...... 175
Audio/Information Screen ................ 176
Display Setup ................................... 181
Playing AM/FM Radio....................... 182
Playing a CD ....................................184
Playing an iPod ................................ 187
Playing Internet Radio ......................190
Playing a USB Flash Drive .................192
Playing Bluetooth® Audio.................195
Models with one display
Audio System Basic Operation ...... 197
Audio with Touch Screen ................. 198
Audio/Information Screen ................ 201
Display Setup................................... 207
Playing AM/FM Radio....................... 208
Playing XM® Radio
*
......................... 212
Playing a CD .................................... 215
Playing an iPod ................................ 218
Playing Internet Radio ...................... 222
Playing a USB Flash Drive ................. 225
Playing Bluetooth® Audio................. 228
Audio System Basic Operation ...... 230
Audio with Touch Screen ................. 231
Audio/Information Screen ................ 233
Models with two displays
Models with navigation system
Display Setup................................... 238
Voice Control Operation .................. 239
Playing AM/FM Radio....................... 247
Playing XM® Radio........................... 251
Playing a CD .................................... 254
Playing Hard Disc Drive (HDD) Audio.....257
Playing an iPod ................................ 267
Playing Internet Radio ...................... 275
Playing a USB Flash Drive ................. 278
Playing Bluetooth® Audio ................ 281
Audio Error Messages...................... 283
General Information on the Audio System
.....289
Customized Features........................ 293
HomeLink® Universal Transceiver
*
.. 331
Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink®..... 333, 370
* Not available on all models
Main Menu
170
Features
Audio System
About Your Audio System
See the Navigation System Manual for information on the navigation system.
The audio system features AM/FM radio and XM® Radio service
*
. It can also play
audio CDs, WMA/MP3/AAC files, Hard Disc Drive (HDD) audio
*
, USB flash drives,
and iPod, iPhone® and Bluetooth® devices.
You can operate the audio system from the buttons and switches on the panel or
the icons on the touchscreen interface
*
.
1About Your Audio System
XM® Radio is available on a subscription basis only.
For more information on XM® Radio, contact a
dealer.
2 General Information on the Audio System
P. 289
XM® Radio is available in the United States and
Canada, except Hawaii, Alaska, and Puerto Rico.
XM® is a registered trademark of Sirius XM Radio, Inc.
Video CDs, DVDs, and 3-inch (8-cm) mini CDs are not
supported.
iPod and iPhone® are trademarks of Apple Inc.
State or local laws may prohibit the operation of
handheld electronic devices while operating a
vehicle.
Models with navigation system
Remote Controls
iPod
USB Flash
Drive
* Not available on all models
Table of Contents
171
uuAudio SystemuUSB Port
Features
USB Port
Install the iPod dock connector or the USB
flash drive to the USB port.
1USB Port
Do not leave the iPod or USB flash drive in the
vehicle. Direct sunlight and high temperatures may
damage it.
We recommend using an extension cable with the
USB port.
Do not connect the iPod or USB flash drive using a
hub.
Do not use a device such as a card reader or hard
disk drive, as the device or your files may be
damaged.
We recommend backing up your data before using
the device in your vehicle.
Displayed messages may vary depending on the
device model and software version.
If the audio system does not recognize the iPod, try
reconnecting it a few times or reboot the device. To
reboot, follow the manufacturer's instructions
provided with the iPod or visit www.apple.com/ipod.
Table of Contents
172
uuAudio SystemuAuxiliary Input Jack
Features
Auxiliary Input Jack
Use the jack to connect standard audio devices.
1. Open the AUX cover.
2. Connect a standard audio device to the
input jack using a 1/8 inch (3.5 mm) stereo
miniplug.
u The audio system automatically switches
to the AUX mode.
1Auxiliary Input Jack
You can return to AUX mode by pressing the AUX
button.
You can return to AUX mode by selecting Change
Source on the Audio menu screen or Source on the
touchscreen.
Replacement of the audio system with other than a
genuine Honda system may make the auxiliary jack
inoperable.
Models with one display
Models with two displays
Models with navigation system
Models with one display
Models with two
displays
Models with
navigation system
Table of Contents
173
uuAudio System uAudio System Theft Protection
*
Features
Audio System Theft Protection
*
The audio system is disabled when it is disconnected from the power source, such as
when the 12-volt battery is disconnected or goes dead.
Reactivating the audio system
1. Set the power mode to ON, and turn on the audio system.
u If you set the power mode to ACCESSORY, you will be requested to enter the
audio security code. See step 3.
2. Press and hold the power button again for more than two seconds.
u The audio system is reactivated when the system’s control unit recognizes that
the system is in your vehicle.
If the control unit fails to recognize, Enter PIN Code appears on the audio/
information screen.
3. If the two steps do not work, you can enter the audio security code using the
touch screen. If you enter an incorrect digit, continue to the last digit, then try
again. If you do not enter code correctly after 10 tries, leave the system for one
hour before trying again, or visit a dealer to have the system reset.
1Audio System Theft Protection
*
Find the audio system's security code and serial
number label in your owner’s manual kit.
We recommend that you write down the serial
number in this owner’s manual.
Do not store the label in your vehicle. If you lose the
label, you must first retrieve the serial number, and
then obtain the code.
You can find out about your serial number and
security code from a dealer.
You can register the security code at Honda Owners
(owners.honda.com.), and find information on how
to retrieve the serial number and obtain the code at
radio-navicode.honda.com.
U.S. models
* Not available on all models
Table of Contents
174
uuAudio SystemuAudio Remote Controls
Features
Audio Remote Controls
Allow you to operate the audio system while driving.
SOURCE Button
Cycles through the audio modes as follows:
FM AM XM
*
CD HDD
*
USB iPod
Bluetooth® Audio Pandora®
*
Aha
TM*
AUX
(+ (- (Volume) Buttons
Press
(+ : To increase the volume.
Press
(- : To decrease the volume.
Buttons
When listening to the radio
Press : To select the next preset radio station.
Press : To select the previous preset radio station.
Press and hold : To select the next strong station.
Press and hold : To select the previous strong station.
When listening to a CD, HDD
*
, iPod, USB flash drive, or Bluetooth® Audio
Press : To skip to the next song.
Press : To go back to the beginning of the current or previous song.
When listening to a CD, HDD
*
or USB flash drive
Press and hold : To skip to the next folder.
Press and hold : To go back to the previous folder.
When listening to Pandora®
*
or Aha
TM*
Press : To skip to the next song.
Press and hold : To select the next station.
Press and hold : To select the previous station.
1Audio Remote Controls
The CD mode appears only when a CD is loaded.
Pandora®, Bluetooth® Audio, and Aha
TM
appear
when a connection (Bluetooth® or USB) is established
with a device.
Button
SOURCE Button
Button
(+ Button
(- Button
* Not available on all models
Table of Contents
175
Features
Audio System Basic Operation
To use the audio system function, the power mode must be in ACCESSORY or ON.
Use the selector knob or MENU button to
access some audio functions.
Press to switch between the normal and
extended display for some functions.
Selector knob: Rotate left or right to scroll
through the available choices. Press to set
your selection.
MENU button: Press to select any mode.
The available mode includes Change Source,
Station List, Save Preset, Radio Text,
Music Search, and play modes. Play modes
can be also selected from Scan, Random/
Repeat, and so on.
BACK button: Press to go back to the
previous display.
button: Press to change the audio/
information screen brightness.
Press once and make an adjustment.
u Each time you press , the mode
switches between the daytime mode,
nighttime mode and OFF mode.
Models with one display
1Audio System Basic Operation
These indications are used to show how to operate
the selector knob.
Rotate to select.
Press to enter.
Audio Menu Items
2 Station List P. 183
2 Radio text P. 183
2 Music Search P. 185, 188, 193
2 Scan P. 186, 194
2 Random/Repeat P. 186, 189, 194
Button
Selector Knob
MENU ButtonBACK Button
Table of Contents
176
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAudio/Information Screen
Features
Audio/Information Screen
Displays the audio status and wallpaper. From this screen, you can go to various
setup options.
Press the (display) button to change the display.
Switching the Display
(Display) Button
Audio
Trip Computer
(Current Drive)
Clock/Wallpaper
Trip Computer
(History of Trip A)
Audio/Information Screen
Table of Contents
177
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAudio/Information Screen
Continued
Features
Audio
Shows the current audio information.
Trip computer (Current Drive)
Shows the range, and instant and average fuel economy of the current trip, as well
as the average fuel economy from your last trip.
Trip computer (History of Trip A)
Shows the range, average fuel economy and distance traveled for the current trip,
as well as the average fuel economy and distances traveled during the last three
driving cycles.
Each time you reset the trip meter A, the information on the display updates. The
history of the previous three driving cycles is kept.
Clock/Wallpaper
Shows a clock screen or an image you import.
Table of Contents
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAudio/Information Screen
178
Features
You can change, store, and delete the wallpaper on the audio/information screen.
Import wallpaper
You can import up to three images, one at a time, for wallpaper from a USB flash
drive.
1. Connect the USB flash drive to the USB
port.
2 USB Port P. 171
2. Press the SETTINGS button.
3. Rotate to select System Settings, then
press .
u Repeat the procedure to select Clock,
Clock/Wallpaper Type, then
Wallpaper.
4. Rotate to select Add New Wallpaper,
then press .
u The preview of the imported data is
displayed.
5. Rotate to select a desired picture.
u The preview is displayed on the left side
on the screen.
6. Press to save the data.
u The confirmation message will appear.
Then the display will return to the
wallpaper list.
Wallpaper Setup
1Wallpaper Setup
When importing wallpaper files, the image must be
in the USB flash drive’s root directory.
Images in a folder cannot be imported.
The file name must be fewer than 64 characters.
The file format of the image that can be imported
is BMP (bmp) or JPEG (jpg).
The individual file size limit is 2 MB.
The maximum image size is 1,680 x 936 pixels. If
the image size is less than 420 × 234 pixels, the
image is displayed in the middle of the screen with
the extra area appearing in black.
Up to 255 files can be selected.
If the USB flash drive does not have any pictures,
the No files detected message appears.
Table of Contents
179
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAudio/Information Screen
Features
Select wallpaper
1. Press the SETTINGS button.
2. Rotate to select System Settings, then press .
u Repeat the procedure to select Clock, Clock/Wallpaper Type, then
Wallpaper.
u The screen changes to the wallpaper list.
3. Rotate to select a desired wallpaper, then press .
u The pop-up menu appears on the screen.
4. Rotate to select Set, then press .
Delete wallpaper
1. Press the SETTINGS button.
2. Rotate to select System Settings, then press .
u Repeat the procedure to select Clock, Clock/Wallpaper Type, then
Wallpaper.
u The screen changes to the wallpaper list.
3. Rotate to select a wallpaper that you want to delete, then press .
u The pop-up menu appears on the screen.
4. Rotate to select Delete, then press .
u The confirmation message will appear.
5. Rotate to select OK, then press to delete completely.
1Wallpaper Setup
From the pop-up menu, rotate to select Preview
and press to see a preview at full-size screen.
To go back to the previous screen, press to select
OK, or press the BACK button.
When the file size is large, it takes a while to be
previewed.
Table of Contents
180
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAdjusting the Sound
Features
Adjusting the Sound
1. Press the SETTINGS button.
2. Rotate to select Audio Settings, then
press .
3. Rotate to select Sound, then press .
Rotate to scroll through the following
choices:
1Adjusting the Sound
The SVC has four modes: Off, Low, Mid, and High.
SVC adjusts the volume level based on the vehicle
speed. As you go faster, audio volume increases. As
you slow down, audio volume decreases.
Selector Knob
SETTINGS Button
Speed-sensitive
Volume
Compensation
Bass
Treble
Fader
Balance
SVC
Table of Contents
181
uuAudio System Basic OperationuDisplay Setup
Features
Display Setup
You can change the brightness or color theme of the audio/information screen.
1. Press the SETTINGS button.
2. Rotate to select System Settings, then
press .
u Repeat the procedure to select Display.
3. Rotate to select Brightness, then press
.
4. Rotate to adjust the setting, then press
.
1. Press the SETTINGS button.
2. Rotate to select System Settings, then
press .
u Repeat the procedure to select Other.
3. Rotate to select Background Color,
then press .
4. Rotate to select the setting you want,
then press .
Changing the Screen Brightness
1Changing the Screen Brightness
You can change the Contrast and Black level
settings in the same manner.
Changing the Screen’s Color Theme
Table of Contents
182
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying AM/FM Radio
Features
Playing AM/FM Radio
Audio/Information Screen
FM/AM Button
Press to select a band.
Preset Buttons (1-6)
To store a station:
Tune to the selected station.
Pick a preset button and hold it until you hear a beep.
To listen to a stored station, select a band, then press the preset button.
Seek/Skip Buttons
Press and to search up and
down the selected band for a
station with a strong signal.
MENU Button
Press to display the menu items.
Selector Knob
Turn to tune the radio frequency.
Press and turn to select an item,
then press to set your selection.
VOL/ (Power/volume)
Knob
Press to turn the audio system
on and off.
Turn to adjust the volume.
BACK Button
Press to go back to the
previous display or cancel a
setting.
Table of Contents
183
uuAudio System Basic Operationu Playing AM/FM Radio
Features
Provides text data information related to your selected RDS-capable FM station.
To find an RDS station from Station List
1. Press while listening to an FM station.
2. Rotate to select the station, then press .
Manual update
Updates your available station list at any time.
1. Press while listening to an FM station.
2. Rotate to select Refresh, then press .
Radio text
Displays the radio text information of the selected RDS station.
1. Press the MENU button.
2. Rotate to select Radio Text, then press .
Scan
Samples each of the strongest stations on the selected band for 10 seconds.
1. Press the MENU button.
2. Rotate to select Scan, then press .
To turn off scan, press to select Stop, or press the BACK button.
Radio Data System (RDS)
1Playing AM/FM Radio
The ST indicator appears on the display indicating
stereo FM broadcasts.
Stereo reproduction in AM is not available.
Switching the Audio Mode
Press the SOURCE button on the steering wheel.
2 Audio Remote Controls P. 174
You can also switch the mode by pressing the MENU
button and selecting Change Source on the MENU
screen.
You can store 6 AM stations and 12 FM stations into
the preset memory.
1Radio Data System (RDS)
When you select an RDS-capable FM station, the RDS
automatically turns on, and the frequency display
changes to the station name. However, when the
signals of that station become weak, the display
changes from the station name to the frequency.
Table of Contents
184
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying a CD
Features
Playing a CD
Your audio system supports audio CDs, CD-Rs and CD-RWs in either MP3, WMA, or
AAC
*1
format. With the CD loaded, press the CD button.
*1:Only AAC format files recorded with iTunes® are playable on this unit.
Audio/Information Screen
CD Button
Press to play a CD.
Seek/Skip Buttons
Press or to change tracks
(files in MP3, WMA, or AAC).
Press and hold to move rapidly
within a track/file.
MENU Button
Press to display the menu items.
Selector Knob
Turn to change tracks/folders.
Press and turn to select an item,
then press to set your selection.
VOL/ (Power/volume)
Knob
Press to turn the audio system
on and off.
Turn to adjust the volume.
BACK Button
Press to go back to the
previous display or cancel a
setting.
CD Slot
Insert a CD about halfway into the
CD slot.
(CD Eject) Button
Press to eject a CD.
Table of Contents
Continued
185
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying a CD
Features
1. Press the MENU button.
2. Rotate to select Music Search, then
press .
3. Rotate to select a folder.
4. Press to change the display to a list of
files in that folder.
5. Rotate to select a file, then press .
How to Select a File from the Music Search List
(MP3/WMA/AAC)
1Playing a CD
NOTICE
Do not use CDs with adhesive labels. The label can
cause the CD to jam in the unit.
WMA files protected by digital rights management
(DRM) cannot be played.
The audio system displays Unplayable File, then
skips to the next file.
Text data appears on the display under the following
circumstances:
When you select a new folder, file, or track.
When you change the audio mode to CD.
When you insert a CD.
If you eject the CD but do not remove it from the slot,
the system reloads the CD automatically after several
seconds.
File Selection
Folder Selection
Table of Contents
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying a CD
186
Features
You can select scan, repeat, and random modes when playing a track or file.
1. Press the MENU button.
2. Rotate to select Scan or Random/
Repeat, then press .
3. Rotate to select a mode, then press .
To turn off a play mode
1. Press the MENU button.
2. Rotate to select the mode you want to turn off, then press .
How to Select a Play Mode
1How to Select a Play Mode
Play Mode Menu Items
Scan
Scan Folders (MP3/WMA/AAC): Provides 10-second
sampling of the first file in each of the main folders.
Scan Tracks: Provides 10-second sampling of all
tracks on the CD (all files in the current folder in MP3,
WMA, or AAC).
Random/Repeat
Repeat Folder (MP3/WMA/AAC): Repeats all files in
the current folder.
Repeat Track: Repeats the current track/file.
Random in Folder (MP3/WMA/AAC): Plays all files
in the current folder in random order.
Random All Tracks: Plays all tracks/files in random
order.
Random/Repeat
is selected.
Table of Contents
187
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying an iPod
Continued
Features
Playing an iPod
Connect the iPod using your dock connector to the USB Port, then press the AUX
button.
2 USB Port P. 171
Audio/Information Screen
AUX Button
Press to select iPod (if connected).
Seek/Skip Buttons
Press or to change songs.
Press and hold to move rapidly
within a song.
MENU Button
Press to display the menu items.
Selector Knob
Turn to change songs.
Press and turn to select an item,
then press to set your selection.
VOL/ (Power/volume)
Knob
Press to turn the audio system
on and off.
Turn to adjust the volume.
BACK Button
Press to go back to the
previous display or cancel a
setting.
Album Art
USB Indicator
Appears when an iPod is connected.
Table of Contents
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying an iPod
188
Features
1. Press the MENU button.
2. Rotate to select Music Search, then
press .
3. Rotate to select a menu.
4. Press to display the items on that menu.
5. Rotate to select an item, then press .
How to Select a Song from the Music Search List
1Playing an iPod
Available operating functions vary on models or
versions. Some functions may not be available on the
vehicle's audio system.
If there is a problem, you may see an error message
on the audio/information screen.
2 iPod/USB Flash Drive P. 285
Table of Contents
189
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying an iPod
Features
You can select repeat and shuffle modes when playing a file.
1. Press the MENU button.
2. Rotate to select Shuffle/Repeat, then
press .
3. Rotate to select a mode, then press .
To turn off a play mode
1. Press the MENU button.
2. Rotate to select the mode you want to turn off, then press .
How to Select a Play Mode
1How to Select a Play Mode
Play Mode Menu Items
Repeat Song: Repeats the current file.
Shuffle Album: Plays all available albums in a
selected list (playlists, artists, albums, songs, genres,
or composers) in random order.
Shuffle All Songs: Plays all available files in a
selected list (playlists, artists, albums, songs, genres,
or composers) in random order.
Table of Contents
190
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying Internet Radio
Features
Playing Internet Radio
Connect a compatible phone through Bluetooth®.
You can also connect the phone using your dock connector to the USB port.
Press the AUX button to select Pandora mode.
Compatible phones only
1Playing Internet Radio
Pandora®, the Pandora logo, and the Pandora trade
dress are trademarks or registered trademarks of
Pandora Media, Inc., used with permission. Pandora
is currently available exclusively in the United States.
To find out if your phone is compatible with this
feature, visit www.handsfreelink.honda.com, or call
1-888-528-7876.
To use this service in your vehicle, the Pandora® app
must first be installed on your phone. Visit
www.pandora.com. for more information.
iPhone
Audio/Information Screen
AUX Button
Press to select Pandora®.
Skip Button
Press to skip a song.
MENU Button
Press to display the menu items.
Selector Knob
Turn to switch to another station.
VOL/ (Volume/Power) Knob
Press to turn the audio system on
and off.
Turn to adjust the volume.
BACK Button
Press to go back to the previous display.
USB Indicator
Appears when a phone is
connected.
Rating Icon
Preset Button (1)
Press to switch the mode between
pause and resume.
Preset Button (2)
Press to select Dislike.
Preset Button (3)
Press to select Like.
Preset Button (4)
Press to select Bookmark Track.
Preset Button (5)
Press to select Bookmark Artist.
Table of Contents
191
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying Internet Radio
Features
You can operate some of the Pandora® menu items from your vehicle’s audio
system. The available items are:
Like (Thumbs-up)
Dislike (Thumbs-down)
Station List
Change Source
Bookmark Track
Bookmark Artist
Play/Pause
Operating a menu item
1. Press the MENU button.
2. Rotate to select an item, then press .
Pandora® Menu
1Playing Internet Radio
Pandora® is free, personalized radio that plays music
and comedy you'll love. Just start with the name of
one of your favorite artists, songs, comedians or
composers and Pandora® will create a custom station
that plays similar tracks. Pandora® also features
hundreds of genre stations ranging from Dubstep to
Smooth Jazz to Power Workout.
If you cannot operate Pandora® through the audio
system, it may be streaming through Bluetooth®
Audio. Make sure Pandora® mode on your audio
system is selected.
Changing Stations
To change stations, activate the Pandora® menu,
select Station List, and then select a new station.
1Pandora® Menu
Available operating functions vary on software
versions. Some functions may not be available on the
vehicle's audio system.
If there is a problem, you may see an error message
on the audio/information screen.
2 Pandora® P. 286
Pandora® may limit the total number of skips allowed
on the service. If you dislike a track after the skip limit
has been reached, your feedback will be saved but
the current track will continue to play.
Table of Contents
192
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying a USB Flash Drive
Features
Playing a USB Flash Drive
Your audio system reads and plays sound files on a USB flash drive in either MP3,
WMA or AAC
*1
format.
Connect your USB flash drive to the USB port, then press the AUX button.
2 USB Port P. 171
*1:Only AAC format files recorded with iTunes® are playable on this unit.
Audio/Information Screen
AUX Button
Press to select USB flash drive
(if connected).
Seek/Skip Buttons
Press or to change files.
Press and hold to move rapidly
within a file.
MENU Button
Press to display the menu items.
Selector Knob
Turn to change folders.
Press and turn to select an item,
then press to set your selection.
VOL/ (Power/volume)
Knob
Press to turn the audio system
on and off.
Turn to adjust the volume.
BACK Button
Press to go back to the
previous display.
USB Indicator
Appears when a USB flash drive is
connected.
Table of Contents
Continued
193
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying a USB Flash Drive
Features
1. Press the MENU button.
2. Rotate to select Music Search, then
press .
3. Rotate to select a folder.
4. Press to change the display to a list of
files in that folder.
5. Rotate to select a file, then press .
How to Select a File from the Music Search List
1Playing a USB Flash Drive
Use the recommended USB flash drives.
2 General Information on the Audio System
P. 289
Files in WMA format protected by digital rights
management (DRM) cannot be played.
The audio system displays Unplayable File, and then
skips to the next file.
If there is a problem, you may see an error message
on the audio/information screen.
2 iPod/USB Flash Drive P. 285
File Selection
Folder Selection
Table of Contents
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying a USB Flash Drive
194
Features
You can select scan, repeat, and random modes when playing a file.
1. Press the MENU button.
2. Rotate to select Scan or Random/
Repeat, then press .
3. Rotate to select a mode, then press .
To turn off a play mode
1. Press the MENU button.
2. Rotate to select the mode you want to turn off, then press .
How to Select a Play Mode
1How to Select a Play Mode
Play Mode Menu Items
Scan
Scan Folders: Provides 10-second sampling of the
first file in each of the main folders.
Scan Tracks: Provides 10-second sampling of all files
in the current folder.
Random/Repeat
Repeat Folder: Repeats all files in the current folder.
Repeat Track: Repeats the current file.
Random in Folder: Plays all files in the current folder
in random order.
Random All Tracks: Plays all files in random order.
Random/Repeat
is selected.
Table of Contents
195
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying Bluetooth® Audio
Continued
Features
Playing Bluetooth® Audio
Your audio system allows you to listen to music from your Bluetooth®-compatible
phone.
This function is available when the phone is paired and connected to the vehicle's
Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink® (HFL) system.
2 Phone Setup P. 341
1Playing Bluetooth® Audio
Not all Bluetooth-enabled phones with streaming
audio capabilities are compatible with the system.
For a list of compatible phones:
U.S.: Visit www.handsfreelink.honda.com, or call
1-888-528-7876.
Canada: Visit www.handsfreelink.ca, or call 1-888-
528-7876.
In some states, it may be illegal to perform some data
device functions while driving.
If more than one phone is paired to the HFL system,
there will be a delay before the system begins to play.
MENU Button
Press to display
the menu items.
AUX Button
Press to select
Bluetooth® Audio.
Skip Buttons
Press or
to change files.
Bluetooth Indicator
Appears when your
phone is connected
to HFL.
VOL/
(Power/volume)
Knob
Press to turn the
audio system on
and off.
Turn to adjust the
volume.
Audio/
Information
Screen
Preset Button (1)
Press to resume
playing a file.
Preset Button (2)
Press to pause a
playing file.
Table of Contents
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying Bluetooth® Audio
196
Features
1. Make sure that your phone is paired and
connected to HFL.
2. Press the AUX button.
If the phone is not recognized, another HFL-
compatible phone, which is not compatible
for Bluetooth® Audio, may already be
connected.
To pause or resume a file
1. Press the MENU button.
2. Rotate to select Play or Pause, then press .
To Play Bluetooth® Audio Files
1To Play Bluetooth® Audio Files
To play the audio files, you may need to operate your
phone. If so, follow the phone maker's operating
instructions.
The pause function may not be available on some
phones.
If any audio device is connected to the auxiliary input
jack, you may need to press the AUX button
repeatedly to select the Bluetooth® Audio system.
Switching to another mode pauses the music playing
from your phone.
Table of Contents
197
Features
Audio System Basic Operation
To use the audio system function, the power mode must be in ACCESSORY or ON.
Use the selector knob, DISP and BACK
buttons to access some audio functions.
Press to switch between the normal and
extended display for some functions.
Selector knob: Rotate left or right to scroll
through the available choices. Press to set
your selection.
Also press to select any mode. The available
mode includes Change Source, Station List,
Save Preset, Radio Text, Music Search, and
play modes. Play modes can be also selected
from Scan, Random/Repeat, and so on.
BACK button: Press to go back to the
previous display.
button: Press to change the audio/
information screen brightness.
Press once and make an adjustment.
u Each time you press , the mode
switches between the daytime mode,
nighttime mode and OFF mode.
Models with two displays
1Audio System Basic Operation
These indications are used to show how to operate
the selector knob.
Rotate to select.
Press to enter.
Audio Menu Items
2 Station List P. 210
2 Save Preset P. 209, 214
2 Radio text P. 211
2 Music Search P. 216, 220, 226
2 Scan P. 217, 227
2 Random/Repeat P. 217, 221, 227
Button
Selector Knob
DISP (SETTINGS) Button
BACK Button
Table of Contents
198
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAudio with Touch Screen
Features
Audio with Touch Screen
Use the touch screen to operate the audio system.
Select Source, then select an icon on the source list to switch the audio source.
Select More to display the menu items.
Selecting an Audio Source
1Audio with Touch Screen
Icons that appear on the screen vary by the source
selected.
Select to go back to the previous screen.
Use the / / / icons to turn the page.
X
Displaying the Menu Items
Select Source.
Source List Icons
Select More.
Menu Items
Table of Contents
Continued
199
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAudio with Touch Screen
Features
Select to adjust the clock and screen settings.
Changing the Clock settings
2 Clock P. 110
Changing the Screen settings
1. Select Screen Settings.
2. Use
(+ , (- or others to adjust the setting.
Changing the Clock/Screen Settings
1Changing the Clock/Screen Settings
The followings are adjustable screen settings:
Brightness
Contrast
Black Level
Display
Changes between the daytime or nighttime
modes.
Beep
Mutes a beep that sounds every time you touch the
screen.
Keyboard
Changes the on-screen keyboard from the
alphabetical order to the qwerty type.
Fade Timer
Sets the screen black out timing.
Select .
Table of Contents
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAudio with Touch Screen
200
Features
1. Select More, then Sound Settings.
2. Use
(+ , (- or others to adjust the setting.
Select to switch to the phone operation screen.
2 Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink® P. 333
Adjusting the Sound
1Adjusting the Sound
Select Off, Low, Mid or High for the SVC setting.
2 Adjusting the Sound P. 206
Displaying the Phone Operation Screen
1Displaying the Phone Operation Screen
The phone operation screen is available when a
phone is paired to HFL.
Select .
Table of Contents
201
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAudio/Information Screen
Continued
Features
Audio/Information Screen
Displays the audio status and wallpaper. From this screen, you can go to various
setup options.
Press the (display) button to change the display.
Switching the Display
Using the button
(Display) Button
Audio
Trip Computer
(Current Drive)
Clock/Wallpaper
Trip Computer
(History of Trip A)
Audio/Information Screen
Table of Contents
202
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAudio/Information Screen
Features
Press the DISP button to go to the Function Change screen.
Rotate to select Audio, Phone, Info or Settings and press .
Audio
Shows the current audio information.
Phone
Shows the HFL information. 2Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink® P. 333
Settings
Enters the customizing menu screen. 2Customized Features P. 293
Using the DISP button
Function Change Screen
DISP Button
Selector Knob
Table of Contents
203
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAudio/Information Screen
Continued
Features
Info
Shows the Trip Computer or Clock/Wallpaper information.
Press , rotate to select an item, then press .
Trip computer (Current Drive)
Shows the range, and instant and average fuel economy of the current trip, as well
as the average fuel economy from your last trip.
Trip computer (History of Trip A)
Shows the range, average fuel economy and distance traveled for the current trip,
as well as the average fuel economy and distances traveled during the last three
driving cycles.
Each time you reset the trip meter A, the information on the display updates. The
history of the previous three driving cycles is kept.
Deleting the history manually
1. Press on the History of Trip A screen.
2. Rotate to select Delete History, then press .
3. You will receive a confirmation message on the screen. Rotate to select Yes,
then press .
Clock/Wallpaper
Shows a clock screen or an image you import.
Table of Contents
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAudio/Information Screen
204
Features
You can change, store, and delete the wallpaper on the audio/information screen.
Import wallpaper
You can import up to three images, one at a time, for wallpaper from a USB flash
drive.
1. Connect the USB flash drive to the USB
port.
2 USB Port P. 171
2. Press and hold the DISP button to go to the
Settings screen.
3. Rotate to select System Settings, then
press .
u Repeat the procedure to select Clock,
Clock/Wallpaper Type, then
Wallpaper.
4. Rotate to select Add New, then press .
u The picture name is displayed on the list.
5. Rotate to select a desired picture.
u The preview is displayed on the left side
on the screen.
6. Press to save the data.
u The confirmation message will appear.
Then the display will return to the
wallpaper list.
Wallpaper Setup
1Wallpaper Setup
When importing wallpaper files, the image must be
in the USB flash drive’s root directory.
Images in a folder cannot be imported.
The file name must be fewer than 64 characters.
The file format of the image that can be imported
is BMP (bmp) or JPEG (jpg).
The individual file size limit is 2 MB.
The maximum image size is 1,680 x 936 pixels. If
the image size is less than 420 × 234 pixels, the
image is displayed in the middle of the screen with
the extra area appearing in black.
Up to 255 files can be selected.
If the USB flash drive does not have any pictures,
the No files detected message appears.
Table of Contents
205
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAudio/Information Screen
Features
Select wallpaper
1. Press and hold the DISP button to go to the Settings screen.
2. Rotate to select System Settings, then press .
u Repeat the procedure to select Clock/Wallpaper Type, then Wallpaper.
u The screen changes to the wallpaper list.
3. Rotate to select a desired wallpaper.
u The preview is displayed on the left side on the screen.
4. Press .
u The pop-up menu appears on the screen.
5. Rotate to select Set, then press .
u The display will return to the wallpaper list.
Delete wallpaper
1. Press and hold the DISP button to go to the Settings screen.
2. Rotate to select System Settings, then press .
u Repeat the procedure to select Clock/Wallpaper Type, then Wallpaper.
u The screen changes to the wallpaper list.
3. Rotate to select a wallpaper that you want to delete.
u The preview is displayed on the left side on the screen.
4. Press .
u The pop-up menu appears on the screen.
5. Rotate to select Delete, then press .
u The confirmation message will appear.
6. Rotate to select OK, then press to delete completely.
u The display will return to the wallpaper list.
1Wallpaper Setup
From the pop-up menu, rotate to select Preview
and press to see a preview at full-size screen.
To go back to the previous screen, press to select
OK, or press the BACK button.
When the file size is large, it takes a while to be
previewed.
Table of Contents
206
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAdjusting the Sound
Features
Adjusting the Sound
1. Press and hold the DISP button.
2. Rotate to select Audio Settings, then
press .
3. Rotate to select Sound, then press .
Rotate to scroll through the following
choices:
1Adjusting the Sound
The SVC has four modes: Off, Low, Mid, and High.
SVC adjusts the volume level based on the vehicle
speed. As you go faster, audio volume increases. As
you slow down, audio volume decreases.
Selector Knob
DISP (SETTINGS) Button
BACK Button
Speed-sensitive
Volume
Compensation
Subwoofer
*
Bass
Treble
Fader
Balance
SUBW
*
SVC
* Not available on all models
Table of Contents
207
uuAudio System Basic OperationuDisplay Setup
Features
Display Setup
You can change the brightness or color theme of the audio/information screen.
1. Press and hold the DISP button to go to the
Settings screen.
2. Rotate to select System Settings, then
press .
u Repeat the procedure to select Display.
3. Rotate to select Brightness, then press
.
4. Rotate to adjust the setting, then press
.
1. Press and hold the DISP button to go to the
Settings screen.
2. Rotate to select System Settings, then
press .
u Repeat the procedure to select Other.
3. Rotate to select Background Color,
then press .
4. Rotate to select the setting you want,
then press .
Changing the Screen Brightness
1Changing the Screen Brightness
You can change the Contrast and Black Level
settings in the same manner.
Changing the Screen’s Color Theme
Table of Contents
208
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying AM/FM Radio
Features
Playing AM/FM Radio
Audio/Information Screen
Audio with Touch Screen
Tune Up/Down Icons
Select or to tune the radio
frequency.
BACK Button
Press to go back to the previous
display.
Selector Knob
Press and turn to select an item,
then press to set your selection.
VOL/ (Volume/Power) Knob
Press to turn the audio system on
and off.
Turn to adjust the volume.
Source
Select to change a band or change
an audio source.
To listen to a stored channel,
select 1-6 (AM) or 1-12 (FM).
Presets
Select to store a station.
Skip/Seek Icons
Select or to search up and
down the selected band for a
station with a strong signal.
More
Select to display the menu items.
Table of Contents
Continued
209
uuAudio System Basic Operationu Playing AM/FM Radio
Features
To store a station:
1. Tune to the selected station.
2. Press to switch to the Audio menu screen.
3. Rotate to select Save Preset, then press .
4. Rotate to select the preset number you want to store that station, then press
.
2. Select More.
3. Select Save Preset.
4. Select the preset number you want to store that station.
Preset Memory
1Playing AM/FM Radio
The ST indicator appears on the display indicating
stereo FM broadcasts.
Stereo reproduction in AM is not available.
Switching the Audio Mode
Press the SOURCE button on the steering wheel.
2 Audio Remote Controls P. 174
You can also switch the mode by pressing and
selecting Change Source on the Audio menu
screen.
You can store 6 AM stations and 12 FM stations into
the preset memory.
Selector Knob
Audio with Touch Screen
Table of Contents
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying AM/FM Radio
210
Features
Provides text data information related to your selected RDS-capable FM station.
To find an RDS station from Station List
1. Press to switch to the Audio menu screen while listening to an FM station.
2. Rotate to select Station List, then press .
3. Rotate to select the station, then press .
Manual update
Updates your available station list at any time.
1. Press to switch to the Audio menu screen while listening to an FM station.
2. Rotate to select Station List, then press .
3. Rotate to select UPDATE LIST, then press .
Radio Data System (RDS)
1Radio Data System (RDS)
When you select an RDS-capable FM station, the RDS
automatically turns on, and the frequency display
changes to the station name. However, when the
signals of that station become weak, the display
changes from the station name to the frequency.
Table of Contents
211
uuAudio System Basic Operationu Playing AM/FM Radio
Features
Radio text
Displays the radio text information of the selected RDS station.
1. Press to switch to the Audio menu screen.
2. Rotate to select Radio Text, then press .
Scan
Samples each of the strongest stations on the selected band for 10 seconds.
1. Press to switch to the Audio menu screen.
2. Rotate to select Scan, then press .
To turn off scan, press to select Cancel Scan, or press the BACK button.
1. Select More.
2. Select Scan.
To turn off scan, select Cancel Scan.
Selector Knob
Audio with Touch Screen
Table of Contents
212
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying XM® Radio
*
Features
Playing XM® Radio
*
Audio/Information Screen
Audio with Touch Screen
Category Up/Down Icons
Select or to display and select
an XM® Radio category.
BACK Button
Press to go back to the previous
display.
Selector Knob
Press and turn to select an item,
then press to set your selection.
VOL/ (Volume/Power) Knob
Press to turn the audio system on
and off.
Turn to adjust the volume.
Source
Select to change an audio source.
To listen to a stored channel,
select 1-12.
Presets
Select to store a station.
Skip/Seek Icons
Select or to the previous
or next channel.
In channel mode, select and hold to
change the channel rapidly.
More
Select to display the menu items.
* Not available on all models
Table of Contents
Continued
213
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying XM® Radio
*
Features
1. Select the XM® mode.
2 Audio Remote Controls P. 174
2 Audio with Touch Screen P. 198
2. Press to switch to the Audio menu screen.
3. Rotate to select XM Tune Mode, then press .
4. Rotate to select Channel Mode or Category Mode, then press .
5. Rotate to select Channel List, then press .
6. Rotate to select a channel from a list, then press .
2. Select More.
3. Select Tune Mode.
4. Select CH Channel Mode or CAT Category Mode.
5. Select a channel using the , , , icons on the tune mode screen or the
preset numbers (1-12) on the preset mode screen.
To Play the XM® Radio
1Playing XM® Radio
*
In the channel mode, all available channels are
selectable. In the category mode, you can select a
channel within a category (Jazz, Rock, Classical, etc.).
There may be instances when XM® Radio does not
broadcast all the data fields (artist name, title). This
does not indicate a problem with your audio system.
Selector Knob
Audio with Touch Screen
* Not available on all models
Table of Contents
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying XM® Radio
*
214
Features
To store a station:
1. Tune to the selected station.
2. Press to switch to the Audio menu screen.
3. Rotate to select Save Preset, then press .
4. Rotate to select the preset number you want to store that station, then press
.
2. Select More.
3. Select Save Preset.
4. Select the preset number you want to store that station.
Preset Memory
1Playing XM® Radio
*
You can store 12 XM® stations into the preset
memory.
Selector Knob
Audio with Touch Screen
* Not available on all models
Table of Contents
215
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying a CD
Continued
Features
Playing a CD
Your audio system supports audio CDs, CD-Rs and CD-RWs in either MP3, WMA, or
AAC
*1
format. With the CD loaded, select the CD mode.
*1:Only AAC format files recorded with iTunes® are playable on this unit.
Audio/Information Screen
Audio with Touch Screen
BACK Button
Press to go back to the previous
display.
Selector Knob
Press and turn to select an item,
then press to set your selection.
VOL/ (Volume/Power) Knob
Press to turn the audio system on
and off.
Turn to adjust the volume.
Skip/Seek Icons
Select or to change tracks
(files in MP3, WMA, or AAC).
Select and hold to move rapidly
within a track/file.
More
Select to display the menu items.
Folder Up/Down Icons
Select to skip to the next folder,
and to skip to the beginning of
the previous folder in MP3, WMA,
or AAC.
Source
Select to change an audio source.
CD Slot
Insert a CD about halfway into the
CD slot.
(CD Eject) Button
Press to eject a CD.
Table of Contents
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying a CD
216
Features
1. Press . Rotate to select Music
Search, then press .
2. Rotate to select a folder.
3. Press to change the display to a list of
files in that folder.
4. Rotate to select a file, then press .
How to Select a File from the Music Search List
(MP3/WMA/AAC)
1Playing a CD
NOTICE
Do not use CDs with adhesive labels. The label can
cause the CD to jam in the unit.
WMA files protected by digital rights management
(DRM) cannot be played.
The audio system displays Unplayable File, then
skips to the next file.
Text data appears on the display under the following
circumstances:
When you select a new folder, file, or track.
When you change the audio mode to CD.
When you insert a CD.
If you eject the CD but do not remove it from the slot,
the system reloads the CD automatically after several
seconds.
Folder Selection
File Selection
Table of Contents
217
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying a CD
Features
You can select scan, repeat, and random modes when playing a track or file.
1. Press to switch to the Audio menu
screen.
2. Rotate to select Scan or Random/
Repeat, then press .
3. Rotate to select a mode, then press .
1. Select More.
2. Select Scan or Random/Repeat.
3. Select a mode.
To turn off a play mode
1. Press to switch to the Audio menu screen.
2. Rotate to select the mode you want to turn off, then press .
1. Select More.
2. Select the mode you want to turn off.
How to Select a Play Mode
1How to Select a Play Mode
Play Mode Menu Items
Scan
Scan Folders (MP3/WMA/AAC): Provides 10-second
sampling of the first file in each of the main folders.
Scan Tracks: Provides 10-second sampling of all
tracks on the CD (all files in the current folder in MP3,
WMA, or AAC).
Random/Repeat
Repeat Folder (MP3/WMA/AAC): Repeats all files in
the current folder.
Repeat Track: Repeats the current track/file.
Random in Folder (MP3/WMA/AAC): Plays all files
in the current folder in random order.
Random All Tracks: Plays all tracks/files in random
order.
Random/Repeat is selected.
Selector Knob
Random/Repeat is selected.
Audio with Touch Screen
Selector Knob
Audio with Touch Screen
Table of Contents
218
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying an iPod
Features
Playing an iPod
Connect the iPod using your dock connector to the USB port, then select the iPod
mode.
2 USB Port P. 171
Audio/Information Screen
Audio with Touch Screen
BACK Button
Press to go back to the previous
display.
Selector Knob
Press and turn to select an item,
then press to set your selection.
VOL/ (Volume/Power) Knob
Press to turn the audio system on
and off.
Turn to adjust the volume.
Skip/Seek Icons
Select or to change songs.
Select and hold to move rapidly
within a song.
More
Select to display the menu items.
Album Art Icon
Source
Select to change an audio source.
Album Bar
Select to search for an album.
Album Art
Table of Contents
Continued
219
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying an iPod
Features
1. Select the album bar.
u The image of the current album is displayed.
2. Select or icon to search for an album.
u When the album image you are looking for appears, select it to play.
How to Select an Album
1How to Select an Album
You cannot select an album while the vehicle is
moving.
Select to go back to the previous screen.
X
Album AAA
Artist AAA
Select an album
image.
Select the
album bar.
Album Bar
Album Image
Table of Contents
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying an iPod
220
Features
1. Press . Rotate to select Music
Search, then press .
2. Rotate to select a menu.
3. Press to display the items on that menu.
4. Rotate to select an item, then press .
How to Select a Song from the Music Search List
1How to Select a Song from the Music Search List
Available operating functions vary on models or
versions. Some functions may not be available on the
vehicle's audio system.
If there is a problem, you may see an error message
on the audio/information screen.
2 iPod/USB Flash Drive P. 285
Folder Selection
File Selection
Table of Contents
221
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying an iPod
Features
You can select repeat and shuffle modes when playing a file.
1. Press to switch to the Audio menu
screen.
2. Rotate to select Shuffle/Repeat, then
press .
3. Rotate to select a mode, then press .
1. Select More.
2. Select Shuffle/Repeat.
3. Select a mode.
To turn off a play mode
1. Press to switch to the Audio menu screen.
2. Rotate to select the mode you want to turn off, then press .
1. Select More.
2. Select the mode you want to turn off.
How to Select a Play Mode
1How to Select a Play Mode
Play Mode Menu Items
Repeat Song: Repeats the current track.
Shuffle Albums: Plays all available albums in a
selected list (playlists, artists, albums, songs, genres,
or composers) in random order.
Shuffle All Songs: Plays all available files in a
selected list (playlists, artists, albums, songs, genres,
or composers) in random order.
Selector Knob
Audio with Touch Screen
Selector Knob
Audio with Touch Screen
Table of Contents
222
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying Internet Radio
Features
Playing Internet Radio
Connect a compatible phone through Bluetooth®.
You can also connect the phone using your dock connector to the USB port.
Select Source to select Pandora or Aha mode.
Compatible phones only
1Playing Internet Radio
Pandora®, the Pandora logo, and the Pandora trade
dress are trademarks or registered trademarks of
Pandora Media, Inc., used with permission. Pandora
is currently available exclusively in the United States.
To find out if your phone is compatible with this
feature, visit www.handsfreelink.honda.com, or call
1-888-528-7876.
To use this service in your vehicle, the Pandora® app
must first be installed on your phone. Visit
www.pandora.com. for more information.
iPhone
Audio/Information Screen
Album Art
USB Indicator
Appears when a phone is
connected.
Rating Icon
Audio with Touch Screen
BACK Button
Press to go back to the previous
display.
Selector Knob
Press and turn to select an item,
then press to set your selection.
VOL/ (Volume/Power) Knob
Press to turn the audio system on
and off.
Turn to adjust the volume.
Skip Icon
Select to skip a song.
More
Select to display the menu items.
Station Up/Down Icons
Select to change a station.
Source
Select Pandora® or Aha
TM
.
Like/Dislike Icons
Select to evaluate a song.
Play/Pause Icon
Select to resume or play a song.
Table of Contents
Continued
223
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying Internet Radio
Features
You can operate some of the Pandora® menu items from your vehicle’s audio
system. The available items are:
Like (Thumbs-up)
Dislike (Thumbs-down)
Station List
Change Source
Bookmark Track
Bookmark Artist
Play/Pause
Operating a menu item
1. Press to switch to the Audio menu
screen.
2. Rotate to select an item and press .
Pandora® Menu
*
1Playing Internet Radio
Pandora® is free, personalized radio that plays music
and comedy you'll love. Just start with the name of
one of your favorite artists, songs, comedians or
composers and Pandora® will create a custom station
that plays similar tracks. Pandora® also features
hundreds of genre stations ranging from Dubstep to
Smooth Jazz to Power Workout.
If you cannot operate Pandora® through the audio
system, it may be streaming through Bluetooth®
Audio. Make sure Pandora® mode on your audio
system is selected.
Changing Stations
To change stations, activate the Pandora® menu,
select Station List, and then select a new station.
1Pandora® Menu
*
Available operating functions vary on software
versions. Some functions may not be available on the
vehicle's audio system.
If there is a problem, you may see an error message
on the audio/information screen.
2 Pandora® P. 286
Pandora® may limit the total number of skips allowed
on the service. If you dislike a track after the skip limit
has been reached, your feedback will be saved but
the current track will continue to play.
* Not available on all models
Table of Contents
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying Internet Radio
224
Features
You can operate some of the Aha
TM
menu items from your vehicle’s audio system.
The available items are:
Operating a menu item
1. Press to switch to the Audio menu
screen.
2. Rotate to select an item and press .
Aha
TM
Radio Menu
Like 15sec Back
Play/Pause 30sec Skip
Stations View text
Change Source View list
Dislike
1Aha
TM
Radio Menu
Aha
TM
by Harman is a cloud-based service that
organizes your favorite web content into live radio
stations. You can access podcasts, internet radio,
location-based services, and audio updates from
social media sites.
Available operating functions vary on software
versions. Some functions may not be available on the
vehicle's audio system.
If there is a problem, you may see an error message
on the audio/information screen.
2 Aha
TM
Radio
*
P. 288
The menu items vary depending on the station you
selected.
To use this service in your vehicle, the HondaLink app
must be installed on your phone. Visit
owners.honda.com/apps for more information.
You must have a previously set up Aha account prior
to using the service in your vehicle. Visit
www.aharadio.com for more information.
* Not available on all models
Table of Contents
225
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying a USB Flash Drive
Continued
Features
Playing a USB Flash Drive
Your audio system reads and plays sound files on a USB flash drive in either MP3,
WMA or AAC
*1
format.
Connect your USB flash drive to the USB port, then select the USB mode.
2 USB Port P. 171
*1:Only AAC format files recorded with iTunes® are playable on this unit.
Audio/Information Screen
Audio with Touch Screen
BACK Button
Press to go back to the previous display.
Selector Knob
Press and turn to select an item,
then press to set your selection.
VOL/ (Volume/Power) Knob
Press to turn the audio system on
and off.
Turn to adjust the volume.
Skip/Seek Icons
Select or to change files.
Select and hold to move rapidly
within a file.
More
Select to display the menu items.
Source
Select to change an audio source.
USB Indicator
Appears when a USB flash drive
is connected.
Folder Up/Down Icons
Select to skip to the next folder,
and to skip to the beginning of
the previous folder.
Table of Contents
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying a USB Flash Drive
226
Features
1. Press . Rotate to select Music
Search, then press .
2. Rotate to select a folder.
3. Press to change the display to a list of
files in that folder.
4. Rotate to select a file, then press .
How to Select a File from the Music Search List
1Playing a USB Flash Drive
Use the recommended USB flash drives.
2 General Information on the Audio System
P. 289
Files in WMA format protected by digital rights
management (DRM) cannot be played.
The audio system displays Unplayable File, and then
skips to the next file.
If there is a problem, you may see an error message
on the audio/information screen.
2 iPod/USB Flash Drive P. 285
Folder Selection
File Selection
Table of Contents
227
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying a USB Flash Drive
Features
You can select scan, repeat, and random modes when playing a file.
1. Press to switch to the Audio menu
screen.
2. Rotate to select Scan or Random/
Repeat, then press .
3. Rotate to select a mode, then press .
1. Select More.
2. Select Scan or Random/Repeat.
3. Select a mode.
To turn off a play mode
1. Press to switch to the Audio menu screen.
2. Rotate to select the mode you want to turn off, then press .
1. Select More.
2. Select the mode you want to turn off.
How to Select a Play Mode
1How to Select a Play Mode
Play Mode Menu Items
Scan
Scan Folders: Provides 10-second sampling of the
first file in each of the main folders.
Scan Tracks: Provides 10-second sampling of all files
in the current folder.
Random/Repeat
Repeat Folder: Repeats all files in the current folder.
Repeat Track: Repeats the current file.
Random in Folder: Plays all files in the current folder
in random order.
Random All Tracks: Plays all files in random order.
Random/Repeat is selected.
Selector Knob
Random/Repeat is selected.
Audio with Touch Screen
Selector Knob
Audio with Touch Screen
Table of Contents
228
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying Bluetooth® Audio
Features
Playing Bluetooth® Audio
Your audio system allows you to listen to music from your Bluetooth®-compatible
phone.
This function is available when the phone is paired and connected to the vehicle's
Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink® (HFL) system.
2 Phone Setup P. 341
1Playing Bluetooth® Audio
Not all Bluetooth-enabled phones with streaming
audio capabilities are compatible with the system.
For a list of compatible phones:
U.S.: Visit www.handsfreelink.honda.com, or call
1-888-528-7876.
Canada: Visit www.handsfreelink.ca, or call 1-888-
528-7876.
In some states, it may be illegal to perform some data
device functions while driving.
If more than one phone is paired to the HFL system,
there will be a delay before the system begins to play.
Skip/Seek Icons
Select or to
change files.
Bluetooth Indicator
Appears when your
phone is connected
to HFL.
VOL/
(Volume/Power)
Knob
Press to turn the
audio system on
and off.
Turn to adjust the
volume.
Audio/
Information
Screen
Audio with Touch Screen
Play Icon
Pause Icon
BACK Button
Press to go back to
the previous display.
More
Select to display
the menu items.
Selector Knob
Press and turn to
select an item,
then press to set
your selection.
Source
Select to change an audio source.
Folder Up/Down
Icons
Select or to
change folder.
Table of Contents
229
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying Bluetooth® Audio
Features
1. Make sure that your phone is paired and
connected to HFL.
2. Select the Bluetooth® Audio mode.
If the phone is not recognized, another HFL-
compatible phone, which is not compatible
for Bluetooth® Audio, may already be
connected.
To pause or resume a file
1. Press to switch to the Audio menu screen.
2. Rotate to select Play or Pause, then press .
Select the play icon or pause icon.
To Play Bluetooth® Audio Files
1To Play Bluetooth® Audio Files
To play the audio files, you may need to operate your
phone. If so, follow the phone maker's operating
instructions.
The pause function may not be available on some
phones.
Switching to another mode pauses the music playing
from your phone.
Selector knob
Audio with Touch Screen
Table of Contents
230
Features
Audio System Basic Operation
To use the audio system function, the power mode must be in ACCESSORY or ON.
Use the interface dial or MENU button to
access some audio functions.
Press to switch between the normal and
extended display for some functions.
Interface dial: Rotate left or right to scroll
through the available choices. Press to set
your selection. Move right, left, up or down to
select secondary menu.
MENU button: Press to select any mode. The
available mode includes Change Source,
Station List, Save Preset, Radio Text,
Music Search, and play modes. Play modes
can be also selected from Scan, Random/
Repeat, and so on.
BACK button: Press to go back to the
previous display.
button: Press to change the audio/
information screen brightness.
Press once and make an adjustment.
u Each time you press , the mode
switches between the daytime mode,
nighttime mode and off mode.
Models with navigation system
1Audio System Basic Operation
Voice Control System
The audio system is voice operable. See the
navigation system manual for details.
These indications are used to show how to operate
the interface dial.
Rotate to select.
Press to enter.
Move , , or to select secondary menu.
Audio Menu Items
2 Station List P. 249
2 Save Preset P. 248, 253
2 Radio text P. 250
2 Music Search P. 255, 259, 269, 279
2 Scan P. 256, 260, 280
2 Random/Repeat P. 256, 260, 270, 280
Interface Dial
MENU ButtonBACK Button
Button
Table of Contents
231
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAudio with Touch Screen
Continued
Features
Audio with Touch Screen
Use the touch screen to operate the audio system.
Select Source, then select an icon on the source list to switch the audio source.
Select More to display the menu items.
Selecting an Audio Source
1Audio with Touch Screen
Icons that appear on the screen vary by the source
selected.
Select to go back to the previous screen.
Use the / / / icons to turn the page.
X
Displaying the Menu Items
Select Source.
Source List Icons
Select More.
Menu Items
Table of Contents
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAudio with Touch Screen
232
Features
1. Select More, then Sound Settings.
2. Use
(+ , (- or others to adjust the setting.
1. Select More, then Screen Settings.
2. Use
(+ , (- or others to adjust the setting.
Adjusting the Sound
1Adjusting the Sound
Select Off, Low, Mid or High for the SVC setting.
2 Adjusting the Sound P. 237
Changing the Screen Settings
1Changing the Screen Settings
The followings are adjustable screen settings:
Brightness
Contrast
Black Level
Display
Changes between the daytime or nighttime
modes.
Beep
Mutes a beep that sounds every time you touch the
screen.
Keyboard
Changes the on-screen keyboard from the
alphabetical order to the qwerty type.
Fade Timer
Sets the screen black out timing.
Table of Contents
233
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAudio/Information Screen
Continued
Features
Audio/Information Screen
Displays the audio status and wallpaper. From this screen, you can go to various
setup options.
Press the (display) button to change the display.
Switching the Display
1Switching the Display
You can also use the AUDIO, NAV, PHONE and
INFO buttons to go to the corresponding display.
(Display) Button
Audio
Info
Audio/Information Screen
Navigation
Phone
AUDIO ButtonNAV Button
PHONE Button INFO Button
Table of Contents
234
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAudio/Information Screen
Features
Audio
Shows the current audio information.
Navigation
Shows the navigation screen. 2Refer to the Navigation System Manual
Phone
Shows the HFL information. 2Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink® P. 370
Info
Shows the Trip Computer or Clock/Wallpaper and other information. Rotate
to select an item, then press .
Trip computer (Current Drive)
Shows the range, and instant and average fuel economy of the current trip, as well
as the average fuel economy from your last trip.
Trip computer (History of Trip A)
Shows the range, average fuel economy and distances traveled for the current trip, as well
as the average fuel economy and distances traveled during the last three driving cycles.
Each time you reset the trip meter A, the information on the display updates. The
history of the previous three driving cycles is kept.
Deleting the history manually
1. Move on the History of Trip A screen to select Delete History, then press .
2. You will receive a confirmation message on the screen. Rotate to select Yes,
then press .
Clock/Wallpaper
Shows a clock screen or an image you import.
Table of Contents
Continued
235
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAudio/Information Screen
Features
You can change, store, and delete the wallpaper on the audio/information screen.
Import wallpaper
You can import up to three images, one at a time, for wallpaper from a USB flash
drive.
1. Connect the USB flash drive to the USB
port.
2 USB Port P. 171
2. Press the SETTINGS button.
3. Rotate to select System Settings, then
press .
u Repeat the procedure to select Clock,
Clock/Wallpaper Type.
4. Move to select Wallpaper.
u The screen will change to the wallpaper
list.
5. Move to select Add New, then press .
6. Rotate to select a desired picture.
u The preview is displayed on the left side
on the screen.
7. Press , then move to select Start
Import.
u The confirmation message will appear.
Then the display will return to the
wallpaper list.
Wallpaper Setup
1Wallpaper Setup
When importing wallpaper files, the image must be
in the USB flash drive’s root directory.
Images in a folder cannot be imported.
The file name must be fewer than 64 characters.
The file format of the image that can be imported
is BMP (bmp) or JPEG (jpg).
The individual file size limit is 6 MB.
The maximum image size is 1,680 x 936 pixels. If
the image size is less than 420 × 234 pixels, the
image is displayed in the middle of the screen with
the extra area appearing in black.
Up to 255 files can be selected.
If the USB flash drive does not have any pictures,
the No files detected message appears.
Table of Contents
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAudio/Information Screen
236
Features
Select wallpaper
1. Press the SETTINGS button.
2. Rotate to select System Settings, then press .
u Repeat the procedure to select Clock/Wallpaper Type.
3. Move to select Wallpaper.
u The screen changes to the wallpaper list.
4. Rotate to select a desired wallpaper.
u The preview is displayed on the left side on the screen.
5. Press .
u The pop-up menu appears on the screen.
6. Rotate to select Set, then press .
u The display will return to the wallpaper list.
Delete wallpaper
1. Press the SETTINGS button.
2. Rotate to select System Settings, then press .
u Repeat the procedure to select Clock/Wallpaper Type.
3. Move to select Wallpaper.
u The screen changes to the wallpaper list.
4. Rotate to select a wallpaper that you want to delete, then press .
u The preview is displayed on the left side on the screen.
5. Press .
u The pop-up menu appears on the screen.
6. Rotate to select Delete, then press .
u The confirmation message will appear.
7. Rotate to select Yes, then press to delete completely.
u The display will return to the wallpaper list.
1Wallpaper Setup
From the pop-up menu, rotate to select Preview
and press to see a preview at full-size screen.
To go back to the previous screen, press to select
OK, or press the BACK button.
When the file size is large, it takes a while to be
previewed.
Table of Contents
237
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAdjusting the Sound
Features
Adjusting the Sound
1. Press the SETTINGS button.
2. Rotate to select Audio Settings, then
press .
3. Rotate to select Sound, then press .
Rotate to scroll through the following
choices:
1Adjusting the Sound
The SVC has four modes: Off, Low, Mid, and High.
SVC adjusts the volume level based on the vehicle
speed. As you go faster, audio volume increases. As
you slow down, audio volume decreases.
SETTINGS Button
Speed-sensitive
Volume
Compensation
Subwoofer
Bass
Treble
Fader
Balance
SUBW
SVC
Table of Contents
238
uuAudio System Basic OperationuDisplay Setup
Features
Display Setup
You can change the brightness or color theme of the audio/information screen.
1. Press the SETTINGS button.
2. Rotate to select System Settings, then
press .
3. Rotate to select Brightness, then press
.
4. Rotate to adjust the setting, then press
.
1. Press the SETTINGS button.
2. Rotate to select System Settings, then
press .
3. Rotate to select Background Color,
then press .
4. Rotate to select the setting you want,
then press .
Changing the Screen Brightness
1Changing the Screen Brightness
You can change the Contrast and Black Level
settings in the same manner.
Changing the Screen’s Color Theme
Table of Contents
239
uuAudio System Basic Operationu Voice Control Operation
Continued
Features
Voice Control Operation
Your vehicle has a voice control system that allows hands-free operation of most of
the navigation system functions.
The voice control system uses the (Talk) and (hang-up/back) buttons on the
steering wheel and a microphone near the map lights on the ceiling.
To achieve optimum voice recognition when using the navigation voice control
system:
Make sure the correct screen is displayed for the voice command that you are
using.
Close the windows and moonroof.
Adjust the dashboard and side vents so air does not blow onto the microphone
on the ceiling.
Speak clearly in a clear, natural speaking voice without pausing between words.
Reduce any background noise if possible. The system may misinterpret your
command if more than one person is speaking at the same time.
Refer to the Voice Help feature.
2 Refer to the Navigation System Manual
Voice Recognition
1Voice Control Operation
When you press the button, a helpful prompt asks
what you would like to do. Press and release the
button again to bypass this prompt and give a
command.
1Voice Recognition
The voice control system can only be used from the
driver’s seat because the microphone unit removes
noises from the front passenger’s side.
Table of Contents
240
uuAudio System Basic OperationuVoice Control Operation
Features
The system accepts these commands on the
Voice Portal screen.
Call Your contact name
Call Phone Number
Find nearest POI category name
Go home
Route menu
Cancel route
The system accepts these commands on any
screen.
Call by number
Call by name
Call Phone Number
Call your contact name
Contacts that are imported from your
phone to the vehicle are all made available
by voice. Voice Tags can also be recorded
for each of your Speed Dial entries.
Voice Portal Commands
Phone Commands
2 Refer to the Navigation System Manual
The system accepts these commands on any
screen.
Trip computer
Traffic information
Display clock
Display wallpaper
Navigation Commands
Info Commands
When the (Talk) button is pressed,
available voice commands appear on the
screen.
For a complete list of commands, say “Voice
Help” after the beep.
On Screen Commands
Table of Contents
241
uuAudio System Basic Operationu Voice Control Operation
Continued
Features
The system accepts these commands on
most screens.
Climate control automatic
*1
Climate control off
*1
Air conditioner on
*1
Air conditioner off
*1
Climate control defrost on
*1
Climate control defrost off
*1
Rear defrost on
*1
Rear defrost off
*1
Climate control fresh air
Climate control recirculate
Climate control vent
Climate control bi-level
Climate control floor
Climate control floor and defrost
Fan speed up
Fan speed down
Fan speed # (#: 1 to 7)
Temperature # degrees (#: 57 to 87°F, 15
to 29°C)
Driver temperature # degrees (#: 57 to
87°F, 15 to 29°C)
Passenger temperature # degrees (#: 57
to 87°F, 15 to 29°C)
Temperature up
Temperature down
Climate Control Commands
Driver temperature up
Driver temperature down
Passenger temperature up
Passenger temperature down
Temperature max heat
Temperature max cool
Driver temperature max heat
Driver temperature max cool
Passenger temperature max heat
Passenger temperature max cool
Climate control sync on
*1
Climate control sync off
*1
*1: These commands toggle the function
on and off, so the command may not match
your intended action.
The system accepts these commands on
most screens.
Using Song By Voice
TM
Song By Voice
TM
is a feature that allows you
to select music from your Hard Disc Drive or
iPod device using your voice.
To activate this mode, you must press the
(Talk) button on the Voice Portal screen
and say:“Music search.”
Audio Commands
Song By Voice
TM
commands
Music search
List album (specify album)
List artist (specify artist)
List composer (specify composer)
List genre (specify genre)
List playlist (specify playlist)
Play album (specify album)
Play artist (specify artist)
Play composer (specify composer)
Play genre (specify genre)
Play playlist (specify playlist)
Play song (specify song)
What am I listening to?
Who am I listening to?
Who is this?
What’s playing?
Who’s playing?
What album is this?
Table of Contents
242
uuAudio System Basic OperationuVoice Control Operation
Features
HDD commands
Hard Disc Drive play
Hard Disc Drive play track # (#: 1 to 30)
Hard Disc Drive skip forward
Hard Disc Drive skip back
Hard Disc Drive album up
*2
Hard Disc Drive album down
*2
Hard Disc Drive track up
Hard Disc Drive track down
Hard Disc Drive playlist up
*2
Hard Disc Drive playlist down
*2
Hard Disc Drive track random
*1
Hard Disc Drive track repeat
*1
Hard Disc Drive track scan
*1
Hard Disc Drive normal play
What am I listening to?
Who am I listening to?
Who is this?
What’s playing?
Who’s playing?
What album is this?
*1: These commands toggle the function
on and off, so the command may not match
your intended action.
*2: These commands are available only in
the corresponding playback mode.
For example, “Artist” commands are
available only in “Artist” mode.
Radio commands
Audio on
*1
Audio off
*1
Radio on
*1
Radio off
*1
Radio select FM
Radio select AM
Radio tune to # FM
(#: frequency from 87.7 to 107.9)
Radio tune to # AM
(#: frequency from 530 [five thirty] to
1710 [seventeen ten])
Radio seek up
Radio seek down
Radio next station
Radio preset # (#: 1 to 12)
Radio FM preset # (#: 1 to 12)
Radio AM preset # (#: 1 to 6)
Radio scan
*1
Radio select XM
XM channel #
(#: 0 to 255 [two fifty five])
XM channel down
XM category up
XM category down
XM preset # (#: 1 to 12)
XM scan
*1
XM category mode
XM channel mode
*1: These commands toggle the function
on and off, so the command may not match
your intended action.
NOTE:
Radio volume levels cannot be controlled
using voice control.
Disc commands
Disc play
Disc play track # (#: 1 to 30)
Disc skip forward
Disc skip back
Disc track random
*1
Disc track repeat
*1
Disc track scan
*1
Disc folder up
Disc folder down
Disc folder random
*1
Disc folder repeat
*1
Disc folder scan
*1
Disc normal play
*1: These commands toggle the function
on and off, so the command may not match
your intended action.
Table of Contents
243
uuAudio System Basic Operationu Voice Control Operation
Continued
Features
iPod commands
iPod play
iPod play track # (#: 1 to 30)
iPod skip forward
iPod skip back
iPod track shuffle
*1
iPod album shuffle
*1
iPod track repeat
*1
iPod normal play
What am I listening to?
Who am I listening to?
Who is this?
What’s playing?
Who’s playing?
What album is this?
*1: These commands toggle the function
on and off, so the command may not match
your intended action.
USB commands
USB play
USB play track # (#: 1 to 30)
USB skip forward
USB skip back
USB track random
*1
USB track repeat
*1
USB track scan
*1
USB folder up
USB folder down
USB folder random
*1
USB folder repeat
*1
USB folder scan
*1
USB normal play
*1: These commands toggle the function
on and off, so the command may not match
your intended action.
Bluetooth® Audio commands
Bluetooth Audio play
Bluetooth Audio skip forward
Bluetooth Audio skip back
Bluetooth Audio group up
Bluetooth Audio group down
Bluetooth Audio pause
Bluetooth Audio resume
Bluetooth Audio track random
Bluetooth Audio track repeat
NOTE:
Bluetooth® Audio commands may not work
on some phones or Bluetooth® Audio
devices.
AUX commands
Auxiliary play
Table of Contents
244
uuAudio System Basic OperationuVoice Control Operation
Features
Pandora® commands
*
The system accepts these commands while
the Pandora® is playing.
Pandora play
Pandora skip forward
Pandora station up
Pandora station down
Pandora pause
Pandora resume
Pandora thumbs up
Pandora thumbs down
Aha
TM
Radio commands
The system accepts these commands while
the Aha
TM
is playing.
Aha radio play
Aha radio skip forward
Aha radio skip back
Aha radio station up
Aha radio station down
Aha radio resume
Aha radio pause
Aha radio like
Aha radio dislike
Internet service commands
Internet service play
Internet service skip forward
*1
Internet service skip back
*1
Internet service station up
*1
Internet service station down
*1
Internet service resume
*1
Internet service pause
*1
Internet service like
*1
Internet service dislike
*1
*1: The system accepts these commands
while the Internet service is playing.
* Not available on all models
Table of Contents
245
uuAudio System Basic Operationu Voice Control Operation
Continued
Features
In keyboard screen, letters can be selected
by saying each individual letter or by saying
a keyword phrase. These keyword phrases
are:
Keyboard Entry Commands
Letters
Say . . . Or say . . .
A Apple/Alpha
B Boy/Bravo
C Charlie
D Dog/Delta
E Edward/Echo
F Frank/Foxtrot
G George/Golf
H Henry/Hotel
I Igloo/India
J John/Juliet
K King/Kilo
L Larry/Lima
M Mary/Mike
N Nancy/November
O Oscar
P Paul/Papa
Q Queen/Quebec
R Robert/Romeo
S Sam/Sierra
T Tom/Tango
U Uncle/Uniform
V Victor
W William/Whiskey
X X-ray
Y Yellow/Yankee
Z Zebra/Zulu
Numbers
Number . . . Or say . . .
0 Zero
1 One
2 Two
3 Three
4 Four
5 Five
6 Six
7 Seven
8 Eight
9 Nine
Table of Contents
246
uuAudio System Basic OperationuVoice Control Operation
Features
Symbols
Symbol . . . Or say . . .
- Hyphen
! Exclamation point
Double Quote
# Pound
$ Dollar
% Percent
& Ampersand
Apostrophe
( Open Parenthesis
) Close Parenthesis
~ Tilde
/ Slash
< Less than
> Greater than
{ Open Brace
} Close Brace
Accented letters
Symbol . . . Or say . . .
À A grave
 A circumflex
Ä A umlaut
Ç C cedilla
È E grave
É E acute
Ê E circumflex
Ë E umlaut
Ì I grave
Î I circumflex
Ï I umlaut
Ô O circumflex
Ù U grave
Û U circumflex
Ü U umlaut
Punctuation marks
Symbol . . . Or say . . .
@ At Sign
^ Caret
* Asterisk
_ Underscore
` Back Quote
, Comma
. Dot
? Question mark
: Colon
; Semicolon
+ Plus
Table of Contents
247
uuAudio System Basic Operationu Playing AM/FM Radio
Continued
Features
Playing AM/FM Radio
Audio/Information Screen
Audio with Touch Screen
Tune Up/Down Icons
Select or to tune the radio
frequency.
MENU Button
Press to display the menu items.
(Power) Button
Press to turn the audio system on
and off.
Source
Select to change a band or change
an audio source.
To listen to a stored channel,
select 1-6 (AM) or 1-12 (FM).
Presets
Select to store a station.
Skip/Seek Icons
Select or to search up and
down the selected band for a
station with a strong signal.
More
Select to display the menu items.
BACK Button
Press to go back to the previous
display.
VOL (Volume) Knob
Turn to adjust the volume.
Interface Dial/ENTER Button
Press and turn to tune the radio
frequency.
Move up, down, right and left to
select secondary menu.
Table of Contents
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying AM/FM Radio
248
Features
To store a station:
1. Tune to the selected station.
2. Press the MENU button.
3. Rotate to select Save Preset, then press .
4. Rotate to select the preset number you want to store that station, then press
and hold .
2. Select More.
3. Select Save Preset.
4. Select the preset number you want to store that station.
Preset Memory
1Playing AM/FM Radio
You can control the AM/FM radio using voice
commands.
2 Voice Control Operation P. 239
The ST indicator appears on the display indicating
stereo FM broadcasts.
Stereo reproduction in AM is not available.
Switching the Audio Mode
Press the SOURCE button on the steering wheel.
2 Audio Remote Controls P. 174
You can also switch the mode by pressing the MENU
button and selecting Change Source on the Audio
menu screen.
You can store 6 AM stations and 12 FM stations into
the preset memory.
Interface Dial
Audio with Touch Screen
Table of Contents
Continued
249
uuAudio System Basic Operationu Playing AM/FM Radio
Features
Provides text data information related to your selected RDS-capable FM station.
To find an RDS station from Station List
1. Press the MENU button while listening to an FM station.
2. Rotate to select Station List, then press .
3. Rotate to select the station, then press .
Manual update
Updates your available station list at any time.
1. Press the MENU button while listening to an FM station.
2. Rotate to select Station List, then press .
3. Rotate to select Refresh, then press .
Radio Data System (RDS)
1Radio Data System (RDS)
When you select an RDS-capable FM station, the RDS
automatically turns on, and the frequency display
changes to the station name. However, when the
signals of that station become weak, the display
changes from the station name to the frequency.
Table of Contents
250
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying AM/FM Radio
Features
Radio text
Display the radio text information of the selected RDS station.
1. Press the MENU button.
2. Rotate to select Radio Text, then press .
Scan
Samples each of the strongest stations on the selected band for 10 seconds.
1. Press the MENU button.
2. Rotate to select Scan, then press .
To turn off scan, press to select Cancel Scan, or press the BACK button.
1. Select More.
2. Select Scan.
To turn off scan, select Cancel Scan.
Interface Dial
Audio with Touch Screen
Table of Contents
251
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying XM® Radio
Continued
Features
Playing XM® Radio
Audio/Information Screen
Audio with Touch Screen
Category Up/Down Icons
Select or to display and select
an XM® Radio category.
MENU Button
Press to display the menu items.
(Power) Button
Press to turn the audio system on
and off.
Source
Select to change an audio source.
To listen to a stored channel,
select 1-12.
Presets
Select to store a station.
Skip/Seek Icons
Select or to the previous
or next channel.
In channel mode, select and hold to
change the channel rapidly.
More
Select to display the menu items.
BACK Button
Press to go back to the previous
display.
VOL (Volume) Knob
Turn to adjust the volume.
Interface Dial/ENTER Button
Press and turn to tune the radio
frequency.
Move up, down, right and left to
select secondary menu.
Table of Contents
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying XM® Radio
252
Features
1. Select the XM® mode.
2 Audio Remote Controls P. 174
2 Audio with Touch Screen P. 231
2. Press the MENU button.
3. Rotate to select XM Tune Mode, then press .
4. Rotate to select Channel Mode or Category Mode, then press .
5. Rotate to select Channel List, then press .
6. Rotate to select a channel from a list, then press .
2. Select More.
3. Select Tune Mode.
4. Select CH Channel Mode or CAT Category Mode.
5. Select a channel using the , , , icons on the tune mode screen or
the preset numbers (1-12) on the preset mode screen.
To Play the XM® Radio
1Playing XM® Radio
You can control the XM® radio using voice
commands.
2 Voice Control Operation P. 239
In the channel mode, all available channels are
selectable. In the category mode, you can select a
channel within a category (Jazz, Rock, Classical, etc.).
There may be instances when XM® Radio does not
broadcast all the data fields (artist name, title). This
does not indicate a problem with your audio system.
Interface Dial
Audio with Touch Screen
Table of Contents
253
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying XM® Radio
Features
To store a station:
1. Tune to the selected station.
2. Press the MENU button.
3. Rotate to select Save Preset, then press .
4. Rotate to select the preset number you want to store that station, then press
and hold .
2. Select More.
3. Select Save Preset.
4. Select the preset number you want to store that station.
Preset Memory
1Playing XM® Radio
You can store 12 XM® stations into the preset
memory.
Interface Dial
Audio with Touch Screen
Table of Contents
254
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying a CD
Features
Playing a CD
Your audio system supports audio CDs, CD-Rs and CD-RWs in either MP3, WMA, or
AAC
*1
format. With the CD loaded, select the CD mode.
*1:Only AAC format files recorded with iTunes® are playable on this unit.
Audio/Information Screen
Audio with Touch Screen
MENU Button
Press to display the menu items.
CD Slot
Insert a CD about halfway into the
CD slot.
(CD Eject) Button
Press to eject a CD.
Folder Up/Down Icons
Select to skip to the next folder,
and to skip to the beginning of
the previous folder in MP3, WMA,
or AAC.
Source
Select to change an audio source.
Skip/Seek Icons
Select or to change tracks
(files in MP3, WMA, or AAC).
Select and hold to move rapidly
within a track/file.
More
Select to display the menu items.
(Power) Button
Press to turn the audio system on
and off.
BACK Button
Press to go back to the previous
display.
VOL (Volume) Knob
Turn to adjust the volume.
Interface Dial/ENTER Button
Press and turn to select an item,
then press to set your selection.
Move up, down, right and left to
select secondary menu.
Table of Contents
Continued
255
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying a CD
Features
1. Press the MENU button.
2. Rotate to select Music Search, then
press .
3. Rotate , move or , then press to
select a file from the Music Search list.
How to Select a File from the Music Search List
(MP3/WMA/AAC)
1Playing a CD
NOTICE
Do not use CDs with adhesive labels. The label can
cause the CD to jam in the unit.
WMA files protected by digital rights management
(DRM) cannot be played.
The audio system displays Unplayable File, then
skips to the next file.
Text data appears on the display under the following
circumstances:
When you select a new folder, file, or track.
When you change the audio mode to CD.
When you insert a CD.
If you eject the CD but do not remove it from the slot,
the system reloads the CD automatically after several
seconds.
You can control a CD audio using voice commands.
2 Voice Control Operation P. 239
Folder Selection
File Selection
Table of Contents
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying a CD
256
Features
You can select scan, repeat, and random modes when playing a track or file.
1. Press the MENU button.
2. Rotate to select Scan or Random/
Repeat, then press .
3. Rotate to select a mode, then press .
1. Select More.
2. Select Scan or Random/Repeat.
3. Select a mode.
To turn off a play mode
1. Press the MENU button.
2. Rotate to select the mode you want to turn off, then press .
1. Select More.
2. Select the mode you want to turn off.
How to Select a Play Mode
1How to Select a Play Mode
Play Mode Menu Items
Scan
Scan Folders (MP3/WMA/AAC): Provides 10-second
sampling of the first file in each of the main folders.
Scan Tracks: Provides 10-second sampling of all
tracks on the CD (all files in the current folder in MP3,
WMA, or AAC).
Random/Repeat
Repeat Folder (MP3/WMA/AAC): Repeats all files in
the current folder.
Repeat Track: Repeats the current track/file.
Random in Folder (MP3/WMA/AAC): Plays all files
in the current folder in random order.
Random All Tracks: Plays all tracks/files in random
order.
Random/Repeat is selected.
Interface Dial
Random/Repeat is selected.
Audio with Touch Screen
Interface Dial
Audio with Touch Screen
Table of Contents
257
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying Hard Disc Drive (HDD) Audio
Continued
Features
Playing Hard Disc Drive (HDD) Audio
The Hard Disc Drive (HDD) Audio function plays tracks from music CDs that have
been recorded onto the built-in HDD. You can arrange the tracks in playlists or play
the tracks using various search methods.
Audio/Information Screen
Audio with Touch Screen
MENU Button
Press to display the menu items.
CD Slot
Insert a CD about halfway into the
CD slot.
(CD Eject) Button
Press to eject a CD.
Playlist/Album Up/Down Icons
Select to skip to the next playlist/
album, and to skip to the
beginning of the previous playlist/
album.
Source
Select to change an audio source.
Skip/Seek Icons
Select or to change tracks.
Select and hold to move rapidly
within a track.
More
Select to display the menu items.
(Power) Button
Press to turn the audio system on
and off.
BACK Button
Press to go back to the previous
display or cancel a setting.
VOL (Volume) Knob
Turn to adjust the volume.
Interface Dial/ENTER Button
Press and turn to select an item,
then press to set your selection.
Move up, down, right and left to
select secondary menu.
SETTINGS Button
Press to go the Settings menu screen.
Table of Contents
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying Hard Disc Drive (HDD) Audio
258
Features
When Recording from CD is set to Auto, the songs on music CDs are automatically
recorded to the HDD the first time you play each disc. You can then play the songs
directly from the HDD.
2 Customized Features P. 293
1. Press the MENU button.
2. Rotate to select Cancel Record to HDD, then press .
When Recording from CD is set to Manual, the songs on music CDs can be
manually recorded to the HDD.
1. Press the MENU button.
2. Rotate to select Rec to HDD, then press .
Recording a Music CD to HDD
1Recording a Music CD to HDD
You can add tracks to user playlists, where you can
mix and match tracks from other CDs recorded on
the HDD.
2 Editing an Album or Playlist P. 261
2 Editing Track Information P. 264
If you stop the engine or the power system is turned
off while recording a CD, there may be pauses
between songs when you play back from the HDD.
Repeat, random, and scan functions are not available
during recording.
You can play music from other sources (e.g., XM,
HDD, etc.) while recording.
Please note that there is no compensation offered in
the case of unsuccessful recording of audio data or
the loss of audio data due to any cause whatsoever.
Clearing the HDD
Any music tracks stored on the HDD can be deleted.
2 Deleting all HDD Data P. 330
Stop Recording
Recording a CD Manually
Recording Indicator
Recording
Ready to record
Table of Contents
Continued
259
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying Hard Disc Drive (HDD) Audio
Features
1. Press the MENU button.
2. Rotate to select Music Search, then
press .
3. Rotate , move or , then press to
select a track from the Music Search list.
u Title information is displayed if found in
the Gracenote® Album Info (Gracenote®
Media Database) stored on the HDD.
u The HDD has two types of playlists:
original playlists and user playlists. An
original playlist is automatically created
for each album when a music CD is
recorded. You can customize up to six
user playlists provided on the HDD by
adding tracks from your original playlists.
How to Select a Track from the Music Search List
1How to Select a Track from the Music Search List
You can control the HDD audio using voice
commands.
2 Voice Control Operation P. 239
2 Song By Voice
TM
(SBV) P. 271
Music tracks recorded on HDD cannot be recorded
onto CDs or other devices.
Tracks are recorded at four times the playback speed
using ultra-efficient compression technology;
therefore, sound quality may vary slightly from the
original.
If the HDD is ever replaced, all music data is lost and
cannot be recovered.
If there is a problem, you may see an error message
on the display.
2 Hard Disc Drive (HDD) Audio P. 284
Table of Contents
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying Hard Disc Drive (HDD) Audio
260
Features
You can select scan, repeat, and random modes when playing a track.
1. Press the MENU button.
2. Rotate to select Scan or Random/
Repeat, then press .
3. Rotate to select a mode, then press .
1. Select More.
2. Select Scan or Random/Repeat.
3. Select a mode.
To turn off a play mode
1. Press the MENU button.
2. Rotate to select the mode you want to turn off, then press .
1. Select More.
2. Select the mode you want to turn off.
How to Select a Play Mode
1How to Select a Play Mode
Play Mode Menu Items
Scan
Scan Albums: Provides 10-second sampling of the
first track in each album.
Scan Tracks: Provides 10-second sampling of all
tracks on HDD.
Random/Repeat
Repeat Album: Repeats all tracks in the current
album.
Repeat Track: Repeats the current track.
Random in Album: Plays all tracks in the current
album in random order.
Random All Tracks: Plays all tracks in random order.
Random/Repeat is selected.
Interface Dial
Random/Repeat is selected.
Audio with Touch Screen
Interface Dial
Audio with Touch Screen
Table of Contents
Continued
261
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying Hard Disc Drive (HDD) Audio
Features
Change the playlist name, album name, genre, and track order of the current
playlist. You can also delete tracks, playlists, and albums.
Editing an album
1. Press the MENU button.
2. Rotate to select Edit/Delete, then press
.
3. Rotate to select Albums, then press .
u The pop-up menu appears on the screen.
4. To edit an album name:
Rotate to select Edit name, then press
.
u Enter the name using the interface dial or
the audio with touch screen.
To delete an album:
Rotate to select Delete, then press .
To edit track information or delete a track:
Rotate to select List Tracks, then press
.
2 Editing Track Information P. 264
Editing an Album or Playlist
1Editing an Album or Playlist
The maximum number of songs in each of the six
user playlists is 999. Adding new songs overwrites
the oldest songs.
The maximum number of original playlists is 999 with
a maximum of 99 songs in each playlist.
Each album CD counts as an original playlist. Adding
a track from a user playlist into the same user playlist
will cause the track to appear twice in the playlist.
Deleting an album (original playlist) also deletes the
album tracks you have stored in any user playlists.
Deleting a user playlist or deleting all tracks from a
user playlist does not remove the playlist folder.
The folder retains the playlist name and artist
information.
Table of Contents
262
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying Hard Disc Drive (HDD) Audio
Features
Editing a playlist
1. Press the MENU button.
2. Rotate to select Edit/Delete, then press
.
3. Rotate to select Playlists, then press
.
u The pop-up menu appears on the screen.
4. To edit a playlist name:
Rotate to select Edit name, then press
.
u Enter the name using the interface dial or
the audio with touch screen.
To delete a playlist:
Rotate to select Delete, then press .
To edit track information or delete a track:
Rotate to select List Tracks, then press
.
2 Editing Track Information P. 264
Table of Contents
263
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying Hard Disc Drive (HDD) Audio
Continued
Features
Creating a new playlist
1. Press the MENU button.
2. Rotate to select Edit/Delete, then press
.
3. Rotate to select Playlists, then press
.
4. Rotate to select Create New Playlist,
then press .
u Enter the name using the interface dial or
the audio with touch screen, then select
tracks from the Music Search list.
Table of Contents
264
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying Hard Disc Drive (HDD) Audio
Features
Change the track title, artist name, genre and composer. You can also delete tracks.
1. Press the MENU button.
2. Rotate to select Edit/Delete, then press
.
3. Rotate to select Tracks, then press .
4. Rotate to select a track you want to edit
or delete, then press .
u The pop-up menu appears on the screen.
5. To edit track information:
Rotate to select Edit name, then press
.
u Enter the track name, track artist, etc.
using the interface dial or the audio with
touch screen. Move , rotate to
select OK, then press .
To delete a track:
Rotate to select Delete, then press .
Editing Track Information
Table of Contents
265
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying Hard Disc Drive (HDD) Audio
Continued
Features
Music information (album name, artist name, genre) can be acquired by accessing
the Gracenote® Album Info.
1. Press the MENU button.
2. Rotate to select Edit/Delete, then press
.
3. Rotate to select Albums, then press .
4. Rotate to select an album you want to
edit, then press .
u The pop-up menu appears on the screen.
5. Rotate to select Edit name, then press
.
6. Move to select Get Music Info, then
press .
u The system starts to access the
Gracenote® Album Info.
Displaying Music Information
Table of Contents
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying Hard Disc Drive (HDD) Audio
266
Features
Update the Gracenote® Album Info (Gracenote® Media Database) that is included
with the navigation system.
1. Insert the update disc into the disc slot or
connect the USB flash drive that includes
the update.
2. Press the SETTINGS button in the HDD
mode.
3. Rotate to select Audio Settings, then
press .
u Repeat the procedure to select Update
Gracenote Album Info.
4. Rotate to select Update by USB or
Update by CD, then press .
u The system starts updating and the
confirmation message appears on the
screen. Press to finish.
Updating Gracenote® Album Info
1Updating Gracenote® Album Info
To acquire updated files:
Consult a dealer.
U.S.: Visit automobiles.honda.com.
Canada: Visit www.hondanavi.ca.
Once you perform an update, any information you
edited before will be overwritten or erased.
Table of Contents
267
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying an iPod
Continued
Features
Playing an iPod
Connect the iPod using your dock connector to the USB port, then select the iPod
mode.
2 USB Port P. 171
Audio/Information Screen
Audio with Touch Screen
MENU Button
Press to display the menu items.
Album Bar
Select to search for an album.
Source
Select to change an audio source.
Skip/Seek Icons
Select or to change songs.
Select and hold to move rapidly
within a song.
More
Select to display the menu items.
(Power) Button
Press to turn the audio system on
and off.
BACK Button
Press to go back to the previous
display.
VOL (Volume) Knob
Turn to adjust the volume.
Interface Dial/ENTER Button
Press and turn to select an item,
then press to set your selection.
Move up, down, right and left to
select secondary menu.
USB Indicator
Appears when an iPod is connected.
Album Art
Album Art Icon
Table of Contents
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying an iPod
268
Features
1. Select the album bar.
u The image of the current album is displayed.
2. Select or icon to search for an album.
u When the album image you are looking for appears, select it to play.
How to Select an Album
1How to Select an Album
You cannot select an album while the vehicle is
moving.
Select to go back to the previous screen.
X
Select an album
image.
Select the
album bar.
Album Bar
Album Image
Table of Contents
Continued
269
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying an iPod
Features
1. Press the MENU button.
2. Rotate to select Music Search, then
press .
3. Rotate , move or , then press
to select a song from the Music Search list.
How to Select a Song from the Music Search List
1How to Select a Song from the Music Search List
You can control an iPod using voice commands.
2 Voice Control Operation P. 239
2 Song By Voice
TM
(SBV) P. 271
Available operating functions vary on models or
versions. Some functions may not be available on the
vehicle's audio system.
If there is a problem, you may see an error message
on the audio/information screen.
2 iPod/USB Flash Drive P. 285
Table of Contents
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying an iPod
270
Features
You can select repeat and shuffle modes when playing a file.
1. Press the MENU button.
2. Rotate to select Shuffle/Repeat, then
press .
3. Rotate to select a mode, then press .
1. Select More.
2. Select Shuffle/Repeat.
3. Select a mode.
To turn off a play mode
1. Press the MENU button.
2. Rotate to select the mode you want to turn off, then press .
1. Select More.
2. Select the mode you want to turn off.
How to Select a Play Mode
1How to Select a Play Mode
Play Mode Menu Items
Repeat Song: Repeats the current track.
Shuffle Albums: Plays all available albums in a
selected list (playlists, artists, albums, songs, genres,
or composers) in random order.
Shuffle All Songs: Plays all available files in a
selected list (playlists, artists, albums, songs, genres,
or composers) in random order.
Interface Dial
Audio with Touch Screen
Interface Dial
Audio with Touch Screen
Table of Contents
271
uuAudio System Basic OperationuSong By Voice
TM
(SBV)
Continued
Features
Song By Voice
TM
(SBV)
Use SBV to search for and play music from your HDD or iPod using voice commands.
To enable SBV
1. Press the SETTINGS button.
2. Rotate to select System Settings, then
press .
3. Rotate to select Song by Voice, then
press .
4. Rotate to select On or Off, then press
.
1Song By Voice
TM
(SBV)
Setting options:
On (factory default): Song By Voice commands are
available.
Off: Disable the feature.
Table of Contents
uuAudio System Basic OperationuSong By Voice
TM
(SBV)
272
Features
Searching for music using SBV
1. Press the (Talk) button and say “Music
Search” to activate the SBV feature for the
HDD and iPod.
2. Press the button and say a command.
u Example 1: Say “(List) ‘Artist A’“ to view a
list of songs by that artist. Select the
desired song to start playing.
u Example 2: Say “Play ‘Artist A’“ to start
playing songs by that artist.
3. To cancel SBV, press the (hang-up/back)
button on the steering wheel. The selected
song continues playing.
Once you have canceled this mode, you need
to press the button and say “Music Search”
again to re-activate this mode.
1Searching for music using SBV
Song By Voice
TM
Commands List
2 Song By Voice
TM
commands P. 241
NOTE:
Song By Voice
TM
commands are available for tracks
stored on the HDD or iPod.
You can add phonetic modifications of difficult
words so that it is easier for SBV to recognize artists,
songs, albums, and composers in voice commands.
2 Phonetic Modification P. 273
Table of Contents
Continued
273
uuAudio System Basic OperationuSong By Voice
TM
(SBV)
Features
Add phonetic modifications of difficult or foreign words so that it is easier for SBV
to recognize artists, songs, albums, and composers in voice commands when
searching for music on the HDD or iPod.
1. Press the SETTINGS button.
2. Rotate to select System Settings,
then press .
3. Rotate to select Song by Voice
Phonetic Modification, then press .
4. Move and rotate to select New
Modification, then press .
5. Rotate to select HDD or iPod, then
press .
Phonetic Modification
1Phonetic Modification
Phonetic Modification is grayed out when Song By
Voice is set to Off.
You can store up to 2,000 phonetic modification
items.
Table of Contents
274
uuAudio System Basic OperationuSong By Voice
TM
(SBV)
Features
6. Rotate to select the item to modify
(e.g., Artist), then press .
u The list of the selected item appears on
the screen.
7. Rotate to select an entry (e.g., No
Name), then press .
u The pop-up menu appears on the
screen.
u To listen to the current phonetic
modification, rotate to select Play,
then press .
u To delete the current phonetic
modification, rotate to select
Delete, then press .
8. Rotate to select Modify, then press
.
9. Enter the phonetic spelling you wish to
use (e.g., “Artist A”) when prompted.
10. Move to select OK to exit.
u The artist “No Name” is phonetically
modified to “Artist A.” When in the SBV
mode, you can press the (Talk)
button and use the voice command
“Play ‘Artist A’” to play songs by the
artist “No Name.”
Table of Contents
275
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying Internet Radio
Continued
Features
Playing Internet Radio
Connect a compatible phone through Bluetooth®.
You can also connect the phone using your dock connector to the USB port.
Select Source to select Pandora or Aha mode.
Compatible phones only
1Playing Internet Radio
Pandora®, the Pandora logo, and the Pandora trade
dress are trademarks or registered trademarks of
Pandora Media, Inc., used with permission. Pandora
is currently available exclusively in the United States.
To find out if your phone is compatible with this
feature, visit www.handsfreelink.honda.com, or call
1-888-528-7876.
To use this service in your vehicle, the Pandora® app
must first be installed on your phone. Visit
www.pandora.com. for more information.
iPhone
Audio/Information Screen
Album Art
USB Indicator
Appears when a phone is connected.
Rating Icon
Audio with Touch Screen
BACK Button
Press to go back to the previous display.
Skip Icon
Select to skip a song.
More
Select to display the menu items.
Station Up/Down Icons
Select to change a station.
Source
Select Pandora® or Aha
TM
.
Play/Pause Icon
Select to resume or play a song.
Like/Dislike Icons
Select to evaluate a song.
(Power) Button
Press to turn the audio system on and off.
VOL (Volume) Knob
Turn to adjust the volume.
Interface Dial/ENTER Button
Press and turn to select an item, then press to set
your selection. Move up, down, right and left to
select secondary menu.
Table of Contents
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying Internet Radio
276
Features
You can operate some of the Pandora® menu items from your vehicle’s audio
system. The available items are:
Operating a menu item
The menu items are shown in the lower half of
the audio/information screen.
Rotate to select an item and press .
To select Change Source, press the MENU
button, then press .
Pandora® Menu
*
Skip Forward Dislike (Thumbs-down)
Play/Pause Bookmark This Song
Station List Bookmark This Artist
Like (Thumbs-up) Change Source
1Playing Internet Radio
Pandora® is free, personalized radio that plays music
and comedy you'll love. Just start with the name of
one of your favorite artists, songs, comedians or
composers and Pandora® will create a custom station
that plays similar tracks. Pandora® also features
hundreds of genre stations ranging from Dubstep to
Smooth Jazz to Power Workout.
If you cannot operate Pandora® through the audio
system, it may be streaming through Bluetooth®
Audio. Make sure Pandora® mode on your audio
system is selected.
Changing Stations
To change stations, activate the Pandora® menu,
select Station List, and then select a new station.
1Pandora® Menu
*
You can control Pandora® using voice commands.
2 Voice Control Operation P. 239
Available operating functions vary on software
versions. Some functions may not be available on the
vehicle's audio system.
If there is a problem, you may see an error message
on the audio/information screen.
2 Pandora® P. 286
Pandora® may limit the total number of skips allowed
on the service. If you dislike a track after the skip limit
has been reached, your feedback will be saved but
the current track will continue to play.
* Not available on all models
Table of Contents
277
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying Internet Radio
Features
You can operate some of the Aha
TM
menu items from your vehicle’s audio system.
The available items are:
Operating a menu item
The menu items are shown in the lower half of
the audio/information screen.
Rotate to select an item and press .
To select Change Source or Stations, press
the MENU button, then press .
Aha
TM
Radio Menu
Like View text
Dislike View list
Play/Pause Reply
15sec Back Change Source
30sec Skip Stations
1Aha
TM
Radio Menu
Aha
TM
by Harman is a cloud-based service that
organizes your favorite web content into live radio
stations. You can access podcasts, internet radio,
location-based services, and audio updates from
social media sites.
You can control Aha
TM
Radio using voice commands.
2 Voice Control Operation P. 239
Available operating functions vary on software
versions. Some functions may not be available on the
vehicle's audio system.
If there is a problem, you may see an error message
on the audio/information screen.
2 Aha
TM
Radio
*
P. 288
The menu items vary depending on the station you
selected.
To use this service in your vehicle, the HondaLink app
must be installed on your phone. Visit
owners.honda.com/apps for more information.
You must have a previously set up Aha account prior
to using the service in your vehicle. Visit
www.aharadio.com for more information.
* Not available on all models
Table of Contents
278
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying a USB Flash Drive
Features
Playing a USB Flash Drive
Your audio system reads and plays sound files on a USB flash drive in either MP3,
WMA, or AAC
*1
format.
Connect your USB flash drive to the USB port, then select the USB mode.
2 USB Port P. 171
*1:Only AAC format files recorded with iTunes® are playable on this unit.
Audio/Information Screen
BACK Button
Press to go back to the previous display.
More
Select to display the menu items.
Source
Select to change an audio source.
USB Indicator
Appears when a USB flash drive
is connected.
Folder Up/Down Icons
Select to skip to the next folder,
and to skip to the beginning of
the previous folder.
Skip/Seek Icons
Select or to change files.
Select and hold to move rapidly
within a file.
(Power) Button
Press to turn the audio system on
and off.
VOL (Volume) Knob
Turn to adjust the volume.
Interface Dial/ENTER Button
Press and turn to select an item, then press
to set your selection. Move up, down, right
and left to select secondary menu.
Audio with Touch Screen
MENU Button
Press to display the menu items.
Table of Contents
Continued
279
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying a USB Flash Drive
Features
1. Press the MENU button.
2. Rotate to select Music Search, then
press .
3. Rotate , move or , then press to
select a file from the Music Search list.
How to Select a File from the Music Search List
1Playing a USB Flash Drive
You can control a USB flash drive using voice
commands.
2 Voice Control Operation P. 239
Use the recommended USB flash drives.
2 General Information on the Audio System
P. 289
Files in WMA format protected by digital rights
management (DRM) cannot be played.
The audio system displays Unplayable File, and then
skips to the next file.
If there is a problem, you may see an error message
on the audio/information screen.
2 iPod/USB Flash Drive P. 285
Folder Selection
File Selection
Table of Contents
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying a USB Flash Drive
280
Features
You can select scan, repeat, and random modes when playing a file.
1. Press the MENU button.
2. Rotate to select Scan or Random/
Repeat, then press .
3. Rotate to select a mode, then press .
1. Select More.
2. Select Random/Repeat.
3. Select a mode.
To turn off a play mode
1. Press the MENU button.
2. Rotate to select the mode you want to turn off, then press .
1. Select More.
2. Select the mode you want to turn off.
How to Select a Play Mode
1How to Select a Play Mode
Play Mode Menu Items
Scan
Scan Folders: Provides 10-second sampling of the
first file in each of the main folders.
Scan Tracks: Provides 10-second sampling of all files
in the current folder.
Random/Repeat
Repeat Folder: Repeats all files in the current folder.
Repeat Track: Repeats the current file.
Random in Folder: Plays all files in the current folder
in random order.
Random All Tracks: Plays all files in random order.
Random/Repeat is selected.
Interface Dial
Random/Repeat is selected.
Audio with Touch Screen
Interface Dial
Audio with Touch Screen
Table of Contents
281
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying Bluetooth® Audio
Continued
Features
Playing Bluetooth® Audio
Your audio system allows you to listen to music from your Bluetooth®-compatible
phone.
This function is available when the phone is paired and connected to the vehicle's
Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink® (HFL) system.
2 Phone Setup P. 376
1Playing Bluetooth® Audio
Not all Bluetooth-enabled phones with streaming
audio capabilities are compatible with the system.
For a list of compatible phones:
U.S.: Visit www.handsfreelink.honda.com, or call
1-888-528-7876.
Canada: Visit www.handsfreelink.ca, or call 1-888-
528-7876.
In some states, it may be illegal to perform some data
device functions while driving.
If more than one phone is paired to the HFL system,
there will be a delay before the system begins to play.
You can control Bluetooth® Audio using voice
commands.
2 Voice Control Operation P. 239
Bluetooth Indicator
Appears when your
phone is connected
to HFL.
Audio/
Information
Screen
Audio with Touch
Screen
Play IconPause Icon
More
Select to display
the menu items.
Source
Select to change
an audio source.
(Power) Button
Press to turn the
audio system on and
off.
VOL (Volume)
Knob
Turn to adjust the
volume.
Interface Dial/
ENTER Button
Press and turn to
select an item,
then press to set
your selection.
Move up, down,
right and left to
select secondary
menu.
Skip/Seek Icons
Select or
to change files.
MENU Button
Press to display
the menu items.
Folder Up/Down
Icons
Select or to
change folders.
Table of Contents
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying Bluetooth® Audio
282
Features
1. Make sure that your phone is paired and
connected to HFL.
2. Select the Bluetooth® Audio mode.
If the phone is not recognized, another HFL-
compatible phone, which is not compatible
for Bluetooth® Audio, may already be
connected.
To pause or resume a file
1. Press the MENU button.
2. Rotate to select Play or Pause, then press .
Select the play icon or pause icon.
To Play Bluetooth® Audio Files
1To Play Bluetooth® Audio Files
To play the audio files, you may need to operate your
phone. If so, follow the phone maker's operating
instructions.
The pause function may not be available on some
phones.
Switching to another mode pauses the music playing
from your phone.
Interface Dial
Audio with Touch Screen
Table of Contents
283
Features
Audio Error Messages
CD Player
If a disc error occurs, you may see the following error messages.
Error Message Cause Solution
Unplayable File Track/file format not supported
Current track/file will be skipped. The next supported track/file
plays automatically.
Bad Disc
Please Check Owner’s
Manual
Push Eject
Mechanical error
Press the (eject) button and remove the disc, and check that the
error message is cleared.
Check that the disc is not damaged or deformed, and insert the
disc again.
2 Protecting CDs P. 291
If the error message reappears, press the button, and pull out
the disc.
Insert a different disc.
If the new disc plays, there is a problem with the first disc.
If the error message repeats, or the disc cannot be removed,
contact a dealer.
Do not try to force the disc out of the player.
Mecha Error
Bad Disc
Please Check Owner’s
Manual
Servo error
Check Disc Disc error
Check that the disc is not damaged or deformed.
2 Protecting CDs P. 291
Heat Error High temperature
Turn the audio system off and allow the player to cool down until
the error message is cleared.
Table of Contents
284
uuAudio Error MessagesuHard Disc Drive (HDD) Audio
Features
Hard Disc Drive (HDD) Audio
If an error occurs while playing the Hard Disc Drive (HDD) Audio, you may see the
following error messages. If you cannot clear the error message, contact a dealer.
Error Message Solution
HDD access error.
Please consult your dealer.
The navigation system temperature is too high. For
protection, the system will shut off until it cools down.
Turn the audio system off and allow the player to cool down until
the error message is cleared.
The navigation system temperature is too low. For
protection, the system will shut off until it warms up.
The navigation system has difficulty reading the HDD when the
temperature is below approximately -22°F (-30°C). The navigation
system starts up automatically when the display warms up.
Unplayable File
Appears when a file format not supported. Current track will be
skipped. The next supported track plays automatically.
Models with navigation system
Table of Contents
285
uuAudio Error MessagesuiPod/USB Flash Drive
Features
iPod/USB Flash Drive
If an error occurs while playing an iPod or USB flash drive, you may see the following
error messages. If you cannot clear the error message, contact a dealer.
Error Message Solution
USB Error
Appears when there is a problem with the USB adapter unit. Check if the device is compatible with the
USB adapter unit.
Incompatible USB Device
Please Check Owner’s
Manual
Appears when an incompatible device is connected. Disconnect the device. Then turn the audio system
off, and turn it on again. Do not reconnect the device that caused the error.
Unsupported Version
Appears when an unsupported iPod is connected. If it appears when a supported iPod is connected,
update the iPod software to the newer version.
Connect Retry Appears when the system does not acknowledge the iPod. Reconnect the iPod.
Unplayable File
Appears when the files in the USB flash drive are DRM or an unsupported format. This error message
appears for about 3 seconds, then plays the next song.
No Data
Appears when the iPod is empty.
Appears when the USB flash drive is empty or there are no MP3, WMA, or AAC files in the USB flash
drive.
Check that compatible files are stored on the device.
Unsupported
Appears when an unsupported device is connected. If it appears when a supported device is
connected, reconnect the device.
iPod
USB flash drive
iPod and USB flash drive
Table of Contents
286
uuAudio Error MessagesuPandora®
Features
Pandora®
If an error occurs while playing Pandora®, you may see the following error messages.
If you cannot clear the error message, contact a dealer.
Error Message Solution
Incompatible USB Device
Please Check Owner’s Manual
Appears when an incompatible device is connected. Disconnect
the device. Then turn the audio system off, and turn it again. Do
not reconnect the device that caused the error.
There is no station list in the device.
Please add the station list to your device.
No stations have been created.
Please create a station on the device.
Appears when there is no station list on the device. Use the device
to create a station.
Music licenses force us to limit the number of tracks you may
skip each hour.
Appears when you try to skip a song or select Dislike over the
predetermined number of times in an hour.
U.S. models
Audio/Information Screen
Audio with Touch Screen
Table of Contents
287
uuAudio Error MessagesuPandora®
Features
Error Message Solution
Unable to save rating.
Unable to save bookmark
or
Unable to skip
Appears when the commanded operation is failed. Try again later.
No data
Appears when no data is available with Pandora® activated.
Reboot the app and reconnect the device.
PANDORA ver unsupport
Appears when Pandora® version is not supported. Update
Pandora® to the latest version.
PANDORA system maintenance
Appears when the Pandora® server is in maintenance. Try again
later.
Cannot connect to PANDORA when stopped. Check your
mobile phone
Appears when Pandora® is unable to play music. Check your
device.
Table of Contents
288
uuAudio Error MessagesuAha
TM
Radio
*
Features
Aha
TM
Radio
*
If an error occurs while playing Aha
TM
Radio, you may see the following error
messages.
If you cannot clear the error message, contact a dealer.
Error Message Solution
Cannot connect to HondaLink. When stopped, check your
mobile device.
Appears when the Aha
TM
app is not activated. Check your device.
Incompatible USB Device
Please Check Owner’s Manual
Appears when an incompatible device is connected. Disconnect
the device. Then turn the audio system off, and turn it on again.
Do not reconnect the device that caused the error.
* Not available on all models
Table of Contents
289
Features
General Information on the Audio System
XM® Radio Service
*
1. You need your radio ID ready before registering for subscription. To see the ID in
the display: Turn the selector knob or the interface dial until 0 appears.
2. Have your radio ID and credit card number ready, and either call or visit the XM®
website to subscribe.
Switch to the XM® mode by using the SOURCE button, or through the audio with
touch screen, and stay in this mode for about 30 minutes until the service is
activated. Make sure your vehicle is in an open area with good reception.
Loading:
XM® is loading the audio or program information.
Ch off air:
The channel is not currently broadcasting.
Ch unauthorized:
XM® radio is receiving information update from the network.
No signal:
The signal is too weak in the current location.
Ch unavailable:
No such channel exists, the channel is not part of your subscription, or the artist or
title information is unavailable.
Check antenna:
There is a problem with the XM® antenna. Contact a dealer.
Subscribing to XM® Radio
Receiving XM® Radio
XM® Radio Display Messages
1Subscribing to XM® Radio
Contact Information for XM® Radio:
US: XM® Radio at www.siriusxm.com or (800) 852-
9696
Canada: XM® Canada at www.xmradio.ca, or (877)
209-0079
1Receiving XM® Radio
The XM® satellites are in orbit over the equator;
therefore, objects south of the vehicle may cause
satellite reception interruptions. Satellite signals are
more likely to be blocked by tall buildings and
mountains the farther north you travel from the
equator.
You may experience reception problems under the
following circumstances:
In a location with an obstruction to the south of
your vehicle.
In tunnels
On the lower level of a multi-tiered road
Large items carried on the roof rack
* Not available on all models
Table of Contents
290
uuGeneral Information on the Audio SystemuRecommended CDs
Features
Recommended CDs
Use only high-quality CD-R or CD-RW discs labeled for audio use.
Use only CD-R or CD-RW discs on which the recordings are closed.
Play only standard round-shaped CDs.
Some software files may not allow for audio play or text data display.
Some versions of MP3, WMA, or AAC formats may be unsupported.
1Recommended CDs
A Dual-disc cannot play on this audio unit. If recorded
under certain conditions, a CD-R or CD-RW may not
play either.
Manufactured under license under U.S. Patent Nos:
5,956,674; 5,974,380; 6,487,535 & other U.S. and
worldwide patents issued & pending. DTS, the
Symbol, & DTS and the Symbol together are
registered trademarks & DTS 2.0 Channel is a
trademark of DTS, Inc. Product includes software.
©DTS, Inc. All Rights Reserved.
CDs with MP3, WMA, or AAC files
The CD packages or jackets should have one of these marks.
Also includes:
Table of Contents
291
uuGeneral Information on the Audio SystemuRecommended CDs
Features
Protecting CDs
Follow these precautions when handling or storing CDs:
Store a CD in its case when it is not being played.
When wiping a CD, use a soft clean cloth from the center to the outside edge.
Handle a CD by its edge. Never touch either surface.
Never insert foreign objects into the CD player.
Keep CDs out of direct sunlight and extreme heat.
Do not place stabilizer rings or labels on the CD.
Avoid fingerprints, liquids, and felt-tip pens on the CD.
1Protecting CDs
NOTICE
Do not insert a damaged CD. It may be stuck inside
and damage the audio unit.
Examples:
Damaged CDs
Bubbled/
Wrinkled
With Label/
Sticker
Using
Printer Label
Kit
Sealed With Plastic Ring
Poor quality
CDs
Chipped/
Cracked
Warped Burrs
Small CDs
3-inch
(8-cm)
CD
Bubbled, wrinkled, labeled, and
excessively thick CDs
Table of Contents
292
uuGeneral Information on the Audio SystemuCompatible iPod, iPhone®, and USB Flash Drives
Features
Compatible iPod, iPhone®, and USB Flash Drives
*1:Models with one display
*2:Models with two displays or the navigation system
Use a recommended USB flash drive of 256 MB or higher.
Some digital audio players may not be compatible.
Some USB flash drives (e.g., a device with security lockout) may not work.
Some software files may not allow for audio play or text data display.
Some versions of MP3, WMA, or AAC formats may be unsupported.
iPod and iPhone® Model Compatibility
Model
iPod (5th generation)
iPod classic 80GB/160GB (launch in 2007)
iPod classic 120GB (launch in 2008)
iPod classic 160GB (launch in 2009)
iPod nano (1st to 7th generation) launch in 2012
*1
iPod nano (1st to 6th generation) launch in 2010
*2
iPod touch (1st to 5th generation) launch in 2012
*1
iPod touch (1st to 4th generation) launch in 2010
*2
iPhone® 3G/iPhone® 3GS/iPhone® 4/iPhone® 4S/iPhone® 5
*1
iPhone® 3G/iPhone® 3GS/iPhone® 4/iPhone® 4S
*2
USB Flash Drives
1iPod and iPhone® Model Compatibility
This system may not work with all software versions
of these devices.
1USB Flash Drives
Files on the USB flash drive are played in their stored
order. This order may be different from the order
displayed on your PC or device.
Table of Contents
293
Continued
Features
Customized Features
Use the audio/information screen to customize certain features.
How to customize
While the vehicle is at a complete stop with the power mode in ON, press the
SETTINGS button, rotate to select a setting item, and press .
1Customized Features
When you customize settings:
Make sure that the vehicle is at a complete stop.
Shift to
(P .
1How to customize
To customize other features, rotate , and press .
2 List of customizable options P. 300
Models without navigation system
Models with one display
SETTINGS Button
Audio/Information Screen
Table of Contents
294
uuCustomized Featuresu
Features
While the vehicle is at a complete stop with the power mode in ON, press and hold
the DISP button, rotate to select a setting item, and press .
Models with two displays
DISP Button
Audio/Information Screen
Table of Contents
295
uuCustomized Features u
Continued
Features
Customization flow
Models without navigation system
Clock Format
Background Color
Header Clock Display
Factory Data Reset
Clock Adjustment
Press the SETTINGS button.
Press and hold the DISP button.
Models with one display
Models with two displays
Language
Default
Edit Pairing Code
Bluetooth On/Off
Bluetooth Device List
Voice Prompt
Brightness
Contrast
Black Level
Beep
Clock/
Wallpaper
Type
Clock Type
Wallpaper
System
Settings
Voice
Recog
Bluetooth
Display
Clock
Other
Table of Contents
296
uuCustomized Featuresu
Features
“Trip B” Reset Timing
Adjust Outside Temp. Display
“Trip A” Reset Timing
Keyless Access Light Flash
Auto Light Sensitivity
Auto Door Lock
Auto Door Unlock
Fuel Efficiency Backlight
Forward Collision Warning Distance
Door Unlock Mode
Interior Light Dimming Time
Headlight Auto Off Timer
Memory Position Link
Language Selection
Key And Remote Unlock Mode
Keyless Lock Answer Back
Security Relock Timer
Maintenance Reset
Default
Vehicle
Settings
Driver
Assist
System
Setup
*
Meter
Setup
TPMS Calibration
Driving Position Setup
*
Keyless
Access
Setup
Lighting
Setup
Door
Setup
Maintenance Info.
Keyless Access Beep
Head-up Warning
* Not available on all models
Table of Contents
297
uuCustomized Features u
Continued
Features
Wallpaper
Source Select Popup
Clock Type
Sound
Default
Cover Art
*1
Connect Bluetooth Audio Device
*1
Bluetooth Device List
*1
Default
Clock Adjustment
Clock Format
Audio
Settings
Clock/
Wallpaper
Type
Info
Settings
*1: May change depending on your currently selected source.
Table of Contents
298
uuCustomized Featuresu
Features
Add Bluetooth Device
Disconnect
Edit Speed Dial
Auto Transfer
Auto Answer
Ring Tone
Automatic Phone Sync
Default
Use Contact Photo
*2
Enable Text Message
*1
,
Enable Text/Email
*2
Select Account
*
Message Auto Reading
New Text Message Alert
*1
,
New Text/Email Alert
*2
*1: Models with one display
*2: Models with two displays
Phone
Settings
Connect
Phone
Text
Message
*1
,
Text/Email
*2
Bluetooth
Device
List
Phone
* Not available on all models
Table of Contents
299
uuCustomized Features u
Continued
Features
Display
Show with Turn Signal
Reference Lines
Default
*1
Default
Default
Fixed Guideline
Dynamic Guideline
Camera
Settings
LaneWatch
Rear
Camera
Brightness
Contrast
Black Level
Color
Tint
*1: Models with two displays
Table of Contents
300
uuCustomized Featuresu
Features
List of customizable options
*1:Default Setting
Setup
Group
Customizable Features Description Selectable Settings
System
Settings
Display
Brightness
Changes the brightness of the audio/information
screen.
Contrast
Changes the contrast of the audio/information
screen.
Black Level
Changes the black level of the audio/information
screen.
Beep
Selects whether a beeper sounds or not when
you operate the selector knob.
On
*1
/Off
Blue-
tooth
Bluetooth On/Off Turns the Bluetooth® on and off. On
*1
/Off
Bluetooth Device List
Pairs a new phone to HFL, edits and deletes a
paired phone, and create a security PIN.
2 Phone Setup P. 341
Edit Pairing Code
Changes a pairing code.
2 To change the pairing code setting P. 343
Random/Fixed
*1
Voice
Recog
Voice Prompt Turns the voice prompt on and off. Beginner
*1
/Expert
Models without navigation system
Table of Contents
301
uuCustomized Features u
Continued
Features
*1:Default Setting
Setup
Group
Customizable Features Description Selectable Settings
System
Settings
Clock
Clock/
Wallpaper
Type
Clock Type Changes the clock display type.
Analog/Digital
*1
/
Small Digital/Off
Wallpaper
Changes the wallpaper type.
Imports an image file for a new wallpaper.
Deletes an image file for a wallpaper.
2 Wallpaper Setup P. 178, 204
Blank/Galaxy
*1
/
Metallic/Add New
Clock Adjustment
Adjusts Clock.
2 Clock P. 110
Clock Format Selects the digital clock display from 12H to 24H. 12H
*1
/24H
Other
Language Changes the display language.
English
*1
/French/
Spanish
Background Color
Changes the background color of the audio/
information screen and the audio with touch
screen
*
.
Blue
*1
/Amber/Red/
Green
Header Clock Display Selects whether the clock display comes on. On
*1
/Off
Factory Data Reset
Resets all the settings to their factory default.
2 Defaulting All the Settings P. 328
Yes/No
Default
Cancels/Resets all customized items in the
System Settings group as default.
Yes/No
* Not available on all models
Table of Contents
302
uuCustomized Featuresu
Features
*1:Default Setting
Setup
Group
Customizable Features Description Selectable Settings
Vehicle
Settings
TPMS Calibration Cancels/Calibrates the TPMS. Cancel
*1
/Calibrate
Driver
Assist
System
Setup
*
Forward Collision Warning
Distance
Changes at which distance FCW alerts, or turns
FCW on and off.
Long/Normal
*1
/
Short/Off
Head-up Warning Turns the heads-up warning lights on to flash or off. On
*1
/Off
Meter
Setup
Language Selection
Changes the displayed language on the multi-
information display.
English
*1
/French/
Spanish
Adjust Outside Temp.
Display
Adjusts the temperature reading by a few
degrees.
-5°F ~ ±0°F
*1
~ +5°F
(U.S.)
-3°C ~ ±0°C
*1
~ +3°C
(Canada)
“Trip A” Reset Timing
Changes the setting of how to reset trip meter A,
average fuel economy A, average speed A, and
elapsed time A.
With Refuel/IGN Off/
Manually Reset
*1
“Trip B” Reset Timing
Changes the setting of how to reset trip meter B,
average fuel economy B, average speed B, and
elapsed time B.
With Refuel/IGN Off/
Manually Reset
*1
Fuel Efficiency Backlight Turns the ambient meter feature on and off. On
*1
/Off
Driving
Position
Setup
*
Memory Position Link
Changes the driver’s seat position to a stored
setting.
On
*1
/Off
* Not available on all models
Table of Contents
303
uuCustomized Features u
Continued
Features
*1:Default Setting
Setup
Group
Customizable Features Description Selectable Settings
Vehicle
Settings
Keyless
Access
Setup
Door Unlock Mode
Changes which doors unlock when you grab the
driver’s door handle.
Driver Door Only
*1
/
All Doors
Keyless Access Light Flash
Causes some exterior lights to blink when you
unlock/lock the doors.
On
*1
/Off
Keyless Access Beep
Sets the beeper sound or not when you grab
either front door handle.
On
*1
/Off
Lighting
Setup
Interior Light Dimming
Time
Changes the length of time the interior lights stay
on after you close the doors.
60seconds/
30seconds
*1
/
15seconds
Headlight Auto Off Timer
Changes the length of time the exterior lights
stay on after you close the driver's door.
60seconds/
30seconds/
15seconds
*1
/
0seconds
Auto Light Sensitivity
Changes the timing for the headlights to come
on.
Max/High/Mid
*1
/
Low/Min
Table of Contents
304
uuCustomized Featuresu
Features
*1:Default Setting
Setup
Group
Customizable Features Description Selectable Settings
Vehicle
Settings
Door
Setup
Auto Door Lock
Changes the setting for when the doors
automatically lock.
With Vehicle Speed
*1
/
Shift from P/Off
Auto Door Unlock
Changes the setting for when the doors
automatically unlock.
All Doors When
Driver’s Door Opens
*1
/
All Doors When
Shifted to Park/All
Doors When Ignition
Switched Off/Off
Key And Remote Unlock
Mode
Sets up either the driver's door or all doors to
unlock on the first push of the remote.
Driver Door
*1
/All
Doors
Keyless Lock Answer Back
LOCK/UNLOCK- The exterior lights flash.
LOCK (2nd push)- The beeper sounds.
On
*1
/Off
Security Relock Timer
Changes the time it takes for the doors to relock
and the security system to set after you unlock
the vehicle without opening any door.
90seconds/
60seconds/
30seconds
*1
Mainte-
nance
Info.
Maintenance Reset
Resets the engine oil life display when you have
performed the maintenance service.
Default
Cancels/Resets all customized items in the
Vehicle Settings group as default.
Yes/No
Table of Contents
305
uuCustomized Features u
Continued
Features
*1:Default Setting
Setup
Group
Customizable Features Description Selectable Settings
Audio
Settings
Sound
Adjusts the settings of the audio speaker’s sound.
2 Adjusting the Sound P. 180, 206
-6 ~ C
*1
~ +6 (Bass,
Treble and SUBW
*
), -9
~ C
*1
~ +9 (Fader and
Balance),Off/Low/
Mid
*1
/High (SVC)
Source Select Popup
Selects whether the list of selectable audio sources
comes on when the AUDIO button is pressed.
Selects whether the list of selectable audio
sources comes on when Audio is selected on the
Function Change screen.
On/Off
*1
Cover Art
Turns on and off the cover art display. On
*1
/Off
Connect Bluetooth Audio Device
Connects, disconnects or pairs a Bluetooth®
Audio device to HFL.
Bluetooth Device List
Edits or deletes a Bluetooth® Audio device paired
to HFL.
Default
Cancels/Resets all customized items in the Audio
Settings group as default.
Yes/No
Models with one display
Models with two displays
iPod, USB, Pandora®
*
or Aha
TM*
mode
Bluetooth® Audio, Pandora®
*
or Aha
TM*
mode
Bluetooth® Audio, Pandora®
*
or Aha
TM*
mode
* Not available on all models
Table of Contents
306
uuCustomized Featuresu
Features
Setup
Group
Customizable Features Description Selectable Settings
Info
Settings
Clock/
Wall-
paper
type
Clock Type
See System Settings on P. 300 to P. 301
Wallpaper
Clock Adjustment
Clock Format
Default
Cancels/Resets all customized items in the Info
Settings group as default.
Yes/No
Table of Contents
307
uuCustomized Features u
Continued
Features
*1:Default Setting
*2:Models with two displays
Setup
Group
Customizable Features Description Selectable Settings
Phone
Settings
Connect Phone
Pairs a new phone to HFL, connects or
disconnects a paired phone.
2 Phone Setup P. 341
Bluetooth Device List
Pairs a new phone to HFL, edits or deletes a
paired phone, or creates a security PIN.
2 Phone Setup P. 341
Phone
Edit Speed Dial
Edits, adds or deletes a speed dial entry.
2 Speed Dial P. 352
Auto Transfer
Sets calls to automatically transfer from your
phone to HFL when you enter the vehicle.
On
*1
/Off
Auto Answer
Sets whether to automatically answer an
incoming call after about four seconds.
On/Off
*1
Ring Tone Selects the ring tone.
Fixed/Mobile
Phone
*1
/Off
Automatic Phone Sync
Sets a phonebook data to be automatically
imported when a phone is paired to HFL.
On
*1
/Off
Use Contact Photo
*2
Displays a caller’s picture on an incoming call
screen.
On
*1
/Off
Table of Contents
308
uuCustomized Featuresu
Features
*1:Default Setting
*2:Models with one display
*3:Models with two displays
Setup
Group
Customizable Features Description Selectable Settings
Phone
Settings
Text/
Message
*2
,
Text/
Email
*3
Enable Text Message
*2
,
Enable Text/Email
*3
Turns the text message/e-mail function on and
off.
On
*1
/Off
Select Account
*
Selects a mail or text message account.
New Text Message Alert
*2
,
New Text/Email Alert
*3
Selects whether a pop-up alert comes on the
screen when HFL receives a new text message/e-
mail.
On/Off
*1
Message Auto Reading
Sets the system to automatically read an
incoming text message/e-mail.
On- A text message/e-mail is always read
aloud.
Off- A text message/e-mail is not read aloud.
Auto- A text message/e-mail is read aloud only
when driving.
On/Off/Auto
*1
Default
Cancels/Resets all customized items in the Phone
Settings group as default.
Yes/No
* Not available on all models
Table of Contents
309
uuCustomized Features u
Continued
Features
*1:Default Setting
*2:Models with two displays
Setup
Group
Customizable Features Description Selectable Settings
Camera
Settings
Lane-
Watch
Show with Turn Signal
Select whether the LaneWatch display comes on
when you move the turn signal lever to the
passenger side.
On
*1
/Off
Reference Lines
Selects whether the reference lines come on the
LaneWatch monitor.
On
*1
/Off
Display
Brightness
Adjusts the LaneWatch display settings.
Contrast
Black Level
Color
Tint
Default
*2
Cancels/Resets all customized items in the
LaneWatch group as default.
Yes/No
Rear
Camera
Fixed Guideline
Selects whether the fixed guidelines come on the
rear camera monitor.
On
*1
/Off
Dynamic Guideline
Selects whether the dynamic guidelines come on
the rear camera monitor.
On
*1
/Off
Default
Cancels/Resets all customized items in the Rear
Camera group as default.
Yes/No
Default
Cancels/Resets all customized items in the
Camera Settings group as default.
Yes/No
Table of Contents
uuCustomized Featuresu
310
Features
How to customize
While the vehicle is at a complete stop with the power mode in ON, press the
SETTINGS button, rotate to select a setting item, and press .
1How to customize
To customize other features, rotate , move , ,
or , and press .
2 List of customizable options P. 317
Models with navigation system
SETTINGS Button
Audio/Information Screen
Table of Contents
311
uuCustomized Features u
Continued
Features
Customization flow
Models with navigation system
Song by Voice
Song by Voice Phonetic Modification
Phonebook Phonetic Modification
Press the SETTINGS button.
Volume
Voice Prompt
Message Auto Reading
Volume
Interface Dial Feedback
Verbal Reminder
Brightness
Contrast
Black Level
Bluetooth Status
Bluetooth Device List
Edit Pairing Code
Default
Sound/
Beep
Display
System
Settings
Bluetooth
Voice Rec
Table of Contents
312
uuCustomized Featuresu
Features
System Device Information
Factory Data Reset
Background Color
Header Clock Display
Clock Reset
Auto Time Zone
*
Auto Daylight
*
Clock
Clock Adjustment
Clock Format
Clock
Units
Language
Voice Command Tips
Others
Wallpaper
Clock/Wallpaper
Type
* Not available on all models
Table of Contents
313
uuCustomized Features u
Continued
Features
“Trip A” Reset Timing
“Trip B” Reset Timing
Fuel Efficiency Backlight
Language Selection
Adjust Outside Temp. Display
Forward Collision Warning Distance
ACC Pre-Running Car Detect Beep
*
ACC Display Speed Unit
*
Turn by Turn Display
Default
Memory Position Link
Door Unlock Mode
Keyless Access Light Flash
Interior Light Dimming Time
Headlight Auto Off Timer
Auto light Sensitivity
Key And Remote Unlock Mode
Keyless Lock Answer Back
Security Relock Timer
Auto Door Lock
Auto Door Unlock
Maintenance Reset
TPMS Calibration
Vehicle
Settings
Meter
Setup
Driver
Assist
System
Setup
Driving Position Setup
*
Keyless
Access
Setup
Lighting
Setup
Door
Setup
Maintenance Info.
Keyless Access Beep
Head-up Warning
* Not available on all models
Table of Contents
314
uuCustomized Featuresu
Features
Show with Turn Signal
Reference Lines
Next Maneuver Pop up
Default
Fixed Guideline
Dynamic Guideline
Default
Default
Sound
Source Select Popup
Cover Art
*1
Connect Bluetooth Audio Device
*1
Bluetooth Device List
*1
Recording from CD
*1
Recording Quality
*1
HDD Info
*1
Update Gracenote Album Info
*1
Delete all HDD Data
*1
Camera
Settings
Rear
Camera
LaneWatch
Audio
Settings
Display
Brightness
Contrast
Black Level
Color
Tint
*1: May change depending on your currently selected source.
Table of Contents
315
uuCustomized Features u
Continued
Features
Add Bluetooth
Device
Disconnect
Default
Phone
Connect phone
Edit Bluetooth
Device
Add Bluetooth
Device
Bluetooth Device
List
Edit Speed Dial
Auto Transfer
Auto Answer
Ring Tone
Automatic Phone Sync
Use Contact Photo
Default
Default
Enable Text/Email
Select Account
New Text/Email Alert
Text/Email
Phone
Settings
Table of Contents
316
uuCustomized Featuresu
Features
Auto Daylight
*
Clock Reset
Info Screen Preference
Clock Format
Auto Time Zone
*
Clock/Wallpaper Type
Clock Adjustment
Clock
Default
Others
Info
Settings
Navi
Settings
See Navigation System Manual.
* Not available on all models
Table of Contents
317
uuCustomized Features u
Continued
Features
List of customizable options
*1:Default Setting
Setup
Group
Customizable Features Description Selectable Settings
System
Settings
Display
Brightness
Changes the brightness of the audio/information
screen.
Contrast
Changes the contrast of the audio/information
screen.
Black Level
Changes the black level of the audio/information
screen.
Sound/
Beep
Volume Changes the volume of the audio speakers.
Interface Dial Feedback
Sets if and when the system reads aloud a
selection made using the Interface Dial.
On/Off/Auto
*1
Message Auto Reading
Selects whether the system automatically read
out message, does not read, or read out only
when driving.
On/Off/Auto
*1
Verbal Reminder Turns the verbal reminders on and off. On
*1
/Off
Blue-
tooth
Bluetooth Status Turns the Bluetooth® on and off. On
*1
/Off
Bluetooth Device List
Pairs a new phone to HFL, edits and deletes a
paired phone, and create a security PIN.
2 Phone Setup P. 376
Edit Pairing Code
Changes a pairing code.
2 To change the pairing code setting P. 378
Random/Fixed
*1
Models with navigation system
Table of Contents
318
uuCustomized Featuresu
Features
*1:Default Setting
Setup
Group
Customizable Features Description Selectable Settings
System
Settings
Voice
Rec
Volume Changes the volume of the voice prompt.
Voice Prompt Turns the voice prompt on and off. On
*1
/Off
Song by Voice
Turns the Song By Voice
TM
on and off.
2 Song By Voice
TM
(SBV) P. 271
On
*1
/Off
Song by Voice Phonetic
Modification
Modifies a voice command for music stored in
the HDD or an iPod.
2 Phonetic Modification P. 273
Phonebook Phonetic
Modification
Modifies a voice command for the phonebook.
2 Phonebook Phonetic Modification P. 391
Clock
Clock/
Wallpaper
Type
Clock Changes the clock display type.
Analog/Digital
*1
/
Small Digital/Off
Wallpaper
Changes the wallpaper type.
Imports an image file for a new wallpaper.
Deletes an image file for a wallpaper.
2 Wallpaper Setup P. 235
Blank/Galaxy
*1
/
Metallic
Clock Adjustment
Adjusts Clock.
2 Clock P. 110
Clock Format Selects the digital clock display from 12H to 24H. 12H
*1
/24H
Auto Time Zone
*
Sets the navigation system to automatically
adjust the clock when driving through different
time zones.
On
*1
/Off
* Not available on all models
Table of Contents
319
uuCustomized Features u
Continued
Features
*1:Default Setting
Setup
Group
Customizable Features Description Selectable Settings
System
Settings
Clock
Auto Daylight
*
Sets the navigation system to automatically adjust
the clock (“spring ahead” or “fall back” by one
hour) when a daylight saving time change occurs.
On
*1
/Off
Clock Reset Resets the settings of all items in the Clock group.
Others
Units
Changes the distance unit on the navigation map
screen.
mile
*1
/km (U.S.)
mile/km
*1
(Canada)
Language Changes the display language.
English
*1
/French/
Spanish
Voice Command Tips
Alerts you when manual control of the system is
disabled to prevent distraction while driving. Only
voice commands are available.
On
*1
/Off
Background Color
Changes the background color of the audio/
information screen and the audio with touch screen.
Blue
*1
/Amber/Red/
Green
Header Clock Display Selects whether the clock display comes on. On
*1
/Off
System Device Information Displays the system/Device information.
Factory Data Reset
Resets all the settings to their factory default.
2 Defaulting All the Settings P. 329
Default
Cancels /Resets all customized items in the
System Settings group as default.
Default/OK
* Not available on all models
Table of Contents
320
uuCustomized Featuresu
Features
*1:Default Setting
*2:Refer to the Navigation System Manual for complete details.
Setup
Group
Customizable Features Description Selectable Settings
Vehicle
Settings
TPMS Calibration Cancels/Calibrates the TPMS. Cancel
*1
/Calibrate
Driver
Assist
System
Setup
*
Forward Collision Warning
Distance
Changes at which distance FCW alerts, or turns
FCW on and off.
Long/Normal
*1
/
Short/Off
Head-up Warning Turns the heads-up warning lights on to flash or off. On
*1
/Off
ACC Pre-Running Car
Detect Beep
*
Causes the system to beep when the system detects a
vehicle, or when the vehicle goes out of ACC range.
On
*1
/Off
ACC Display Speed Unit
*
Changes the speed unit for ACC on the multi-
information display.
mph
*1
/km/h (U.S.)
miles/km
*1
(Canada)
Meter
Setup
Language Selection
Changes the displayed language on the multi-
information display.
English
*1
/French/
Spanish
Adjust Outside Temp.
Display
Adjusts the temperature reading by a few
degrees.
-5°F ~ ±0°F
*1
~ +5°F (U.S.)
-3°C ~ ±0°C
*1
~ +3°C
(Canada)
“Trip A” Reset Timing
Changes the setting of how to reset trip meter A, average
fuel economy A, average speed A, and elapsed time A.
With Refuel/IGN Off/
Manually Reset
*1
“Trip B” Reset Timing
Changes the setting of how to reset trip meter B, average
fuel economy B, average speed B, and elapsed time B.
With Refuel/IGN Off/
Manually Reset
*1
Fuel Efficiency Backlight Turns the ambient meter feature on and off. On
*1
/Off
Turn by Turn Display
*2
Selects whether the turn-by-turn display comes
on during the route guidance.
On
*1
/Off
* Not available on all models
Table of Contents
321
uuCustomized Features u
Continued
Features
*1:Default Setting
Setup
Group
Customizable Features Description Selectable Settings
Vehicle
Settings
Driving
Position
Setup
*
Memory Position Link
Changes the driver’s seat position to a stored
setting.
On
*1
/Off
Keyless
Access
Setup
Door Unlock Mode
Changes which doors unlock when you grab the
driver’s door handle.
Drivers Door Only
*1
/
All Doors
Keyless Access Light Flash
Causes some exterior lights to blink when you
unlock/lock the doors.
On
*1
/Off
Keyless Access Beep
Causes the beeper to sound when you unlock/
lock the doors.
On
*1
/Off
Lighting
Setup
Interior Light Dimming
Time
Changes the length of time the interior lights stay
on after you close the doors.
60seconds/
30seconds
*1
/
15seconds
Headlight Auto Off Timer
Changes the length of time the exterior lights
stay on after you close the driver's door.
60seconds/
30seconds/
15seconds
*1
/
0seconds
Auto Light Sensitivity
Changes the timing for the headlights to come
on.
Max/High/Mid
*1
/
Low/Min
* Not available on all models
Table of Contents
322
uuCustomized Featuresu
Features
*1:Default Setting
Setup
Group
Customizable Features Description Selectable Settings
Vehicle
Settings
Door
Setup
Auto Door Lock
Changes the setting for when the doors
automatically lock.
With Vehicle Speed
*1
/
Shift from P/Off
Auto Door Unlock
Changes the setting for when the doors
automatically unlock.
All Doors When
Driver’s Door Opens
*1
/
All Doors When
Shifted to Park/All
Doors When Ignition
Switched Off/Off
Key And Remote Unlock
Mode
Sets up either the driver's door or all doors to
unlock on the first push of the remote.
Driver Door
*1
/All
Doors
Keyless Lock Answer Back
LOCK/UNLOCK- The exterior lights flash.
LOCK (2nd push)- The beeper sounds.
On
*1
/Off
Security Relock Timer
Changes the time it takes for the doors to relock
and the security system to set after you unlock
the vehicle without opening any door.
90seconds/
60seconds/
30seconds
*1
Mainte-
nance
Info.
Maintenance Reset
Resets the engine oil life display when you have
performed the maintenance service.
Default
Cancels/Resets all customized items in the
Vehicle Settings group as default.
Default/OK
Table of Contents
323
uuCustomized Features u
Continued
Features
*1:Default Setting
Setup
Group
Customizable Features Description Selectable Settings
Camera
Settings
Lane-
Watch
Show with Turn Signal
Selects whether the LaneWatch display comes on
when you move the turn signal lever to the
passenger side.
On
*1
/Off
Reference Lines
Selects whether the reference lines come on the
LaneWatch monitor.
On
*1
/Off
Next Maneuver Pop up
Selects whether a turn direction screen of the
navigation system interrupts on the LaneWatch
display.
On
*1
/Off
Display
Brightness
Adjusts the LaneWatch display settings.
Contrast
Black Level
Color
Tint
Default
Cancels/Resets all customized items in the
LaneWatch group as default.
Default/OK
Rear
Camera
Fixed Guideline
Selects whether the fixed guidelines come on the
rear camera monitor.
On
*1
/Off
Dynamic Guideline
Selects whether the dynamic guidelines come on
the rear camera monitor.
On
*1
/Off
Default
Cancels/Resets all customized items in the Rear
Camera group as default.
Default/OK
Table of Contents
324
uuCustomized Featuresu
Features
*1:Default Setting
Setup
Group
Customizable Features Description Selectable Settings
Audio
Settings
Sound
Adjusts the settings of the audio speaker’s sound.
2 Adjusting the Sound P. 237
-6 ~ C
*1
~ +6 (Bass,
Treble and SUBW), -9
~ C
*1
~ +9 (Fader and
Balance), Off/Low/
Mid
*1
/High (SVC)
Source Select Popup
Selects whether the list of selectable audio sources
comes on when the AUDIO button is pressed.
On/Off
*1
Cover Art
Turns on and off the cover art display. On
*1
/Off
Connect Bluetooth Audio Device
Connects, disconnects or pairs a Bluetooth®
Audio device to HFL.
Bluetooth Device List
Edits or deletes a Bluetooth® Audio device paired
to HFL.
Recording from CD
Selects whether the songs on music CDs are
automatically recorded to the HDD.
Auto/Manual
*1
Recording Quality
Selects the quality of the music files recorded to
the HDD.
Standard
*1
/High
CD (MP3/WMA/AAC), iPod, USB, Pandora®
*
or Aha
TM
mode
Bluetooth® Audio, Pandora®
*
or Aha
TM
mode
Bluetooth® Audio, Pandora®
*
or Aha
TM
mode
CD mode
CD mode
* Not available on all models
Table of Contents
325
uuCustomized Features u
Continued
Features
*1:Default Setting
Setup
Group
Customizable Features Description Selectable Settings
Audio
Settings
HDD Info
Displays the HDD capacity.
Update Gracenote Album Info
Updates the Gracenote® Album Info (Gracenote®
Media Database).
Update by USB
*1
/
Update by CD
Delete all HDD Data
2 Deleting all HDD Data P. 330
Default
Cancels/Resets all customized items in the Audio
Settings group as default.
Default/OK
Phone
Settings
Phone
Connect phone
Pairs a new phone to HFL, connects or
disconnects a paired phone.
2 Phone Setup P. 376
Bluetooth Device List
Pairs a new phone to HFL, edits or deletes a
paired phone, or creates a security PIN.
2 Phone Setup P. 376
Edit Speed Dial
Edits, adds or deletes a speed dial entry.
2 Phone Setup P. 376
HDD mode
CD or HDD mode
HDD mode
Table of Contents
326
uuCustomized Featuresu
Features
*1:Default Setting
Setup
Group
Customizable Features Description Selectable Settings
Phone
Settings
Phone
Auto Transfer
Sets calls to automatically transfer from your
phone to HFL when you enter the vehicle.
On
*1
/Off
Auto Answer
Sets whether to automatically answer an
incoming call after about four seconds.
On/Off
*1
Ring Tone Selects the ring tone.
Fixed/Mobile
Phone
*1
/Off
Automatic Phone Sync
Sets a phonebook data to be automatically
imported when a phone is paired to HFL.
On
*1
/Off
Use Contact Photo
Displays a caller’s picture on an incoming call
screen.
On
*1
/Off
Text/
Email
Enable Text/Email
Turns the text message/e-mail function on and
off.
On
*1
/Off
Select Account Selects a mail or text message account.
New Text/Email Alert
Selects whether a pop-up alert comes on the
screen when HFL receives a new text message/e-
mail.
On/Off
*1
Default
Cancels/Resets all customized items in the Phone
Settings group as default.
Default/OK
Table of Contents
327
uuCustomized Features u
Features
*1:Default Setting
Setup
Group
Customizable Features Description Selectable Settings
Info
Settings
Clock
Clock/
Wallpaper
type
Clock
See System Settings on P. 317 to P. 319.
Wallpaper
Clock Adjustment
Clock Format
Auto Time Zone
*
Auto Daylight
*
Clock Reset
Others Info Screen Preference
Selects any of the following to be displayed when
you press the INFO button.
Info Top: Some of the available menu items
pop up.
Info Menu: All available menu items pop up.
Off: The menu item you selected last time is
displayed.
Info Top/Info
Menu
*1
/Off
Default
Cancels/Resets all customized items in the Info
Settings group as default.
Default/OK
* Not available on all models
Table of Contents
328
uuCustomized FeaturesuDefaulting All the Settings
Features
Defaulting All the Settings
Reset all the menu and customized settings as the factory defaults.
1. Press the SETTINGS button.
1. Press and hold the DISP button.
2. Rotate to select System Settings, then
press .
u Repeat the procedure to select Other,
then Factory Data Reset.
u The confirmation message will appear.
3. Rotate to select Yes, then press to
reset the settings.
4. Rotate to select Yes, then press
again to reset the settings.
u The confirmation message will appear.
Press to select OK.
Models without navigation system
1Defaulting All the Settings
When you transfer the vehicle to a third party, reset
all settings to default and delete all personal data.
The following settings will be reset:
Audio preset settings
Phonebook entries
Other display and each item settings.
Models with one display
Models with two displays
All models
Table of Contents
329
uuCustomized FeaturesuDefaulting All the Settings
Features
Defaulting All the Settings
Reset all the menu and customized settings as the factory defaults.
1. Press the SETTINGS button.
2. Rotate to select System Settings, then
press .
3. Move or to select Others.
4. Rotate to select Factory Data Reset,
then press .
u The pop-up menu appears on the screen.
5. Rotate to select Yes, then press .
u The confirmation message will appear.
6. Rotate to select Yes, then press
again to reset the settings.
u The confirmation message will appear.
Press to select OK.
Models with navigation system
1Defaulting All the Settings
When you transfer the vehicle to a third party, reset
all settings to default and delete all personal data.
The following settings will be reset:
Routing & Guidance: Rerouting, Unverified Area
Routing, Traffic Rerouting, Edit Waypoint Search
Area, Guidance Mode, Street Name Guidance
Route Preference
Audio preset settings
Phonebook entries
Other display and each item settings.
Table of Contents
330
uuCustomized FeaturesuDeleting all HDD Data
Features
Deleting all HDD Data
Reset all the menu and customized settings, and delete all music data on the HDD.
1. Turn on the audio system and select the
HDD mode.
2. Press the SETTINGS button.
3. Rotate to select Audio Settings, then
press .
4. Rotate to select Delete all HDD Data,
then press .
u The confirmation message will appear.
5. Rotate to select Yes, then press .
Models with navigation system
Table of Contents
331
Continued
Features
HomeLink® Universal Transceiver
*
The HomeLink® Universal Transceiver can be programmed to operate up to three
remote controlled devices around your home, such as garage doors, lighting, or
home security systems.
Refer to the safety information that comes with your garage door opener to test that
the safety features are functioning properly. If you do not have the safety
information, contact the manufacturer.
Before programming HomeLink, make sure that people and objects are out of the
way of the garage or gate to prevent potential injury or damage.
When programming a garage door opener, park just outside the garage door’s
path.
Training HomeLink
If you have not trained any of the buttons in
HomeLink before, you should erase any
previously learned codes. To do this:
Press and hold the two outside buttons for
about 20 seconds, until the red indicator
blinks. Release the buttons, and proceed to
step 1.
If you are training the second or third
button, go directly to step 1.
Important Safety Precautions
1HomeLink® Universal Transceiver
*
HomeLink® is a registered trademark of Johnson
Controls., Inc.
Before programming HomeLink to operate a garage
door opener, confirm that the opener has an external
entrapment protection system, such as an “electronic
eye,” or other safety and reverse stop features. If it
does not, HomeLink may not be able to operate it.
Red Indicator
* Not available on all models
Table of Contents
uuHomeLink® Universal Transceiver
*
uTraining HomeLink
332
Features
Training a Button
1Training HomeLink
Retraining a Button
If you want to retrain a programmed button for a
new device, you do not have to erase all button
memory. You can replace the existing memory code
using this procedure:
1.
Press and hold the desired HomeLink button
until the HomeLink indicator begins to blink.
2.
Continue to hold the HomeLink button and
follow steps 1 - 3 under “Training a Button.”
Indicator remains on
for about 25 secs.
Standard transmitter
Indicator blinks rapidly for
2 secs, then remains on for
about 23 secs.
Rolling code transmitter
Erasing Codes
To erase all the codes, press and hold the two outside
buttons until the HomeLink indicator begins to blink
(about 10 to 20 secs). You should erase all codes
before selling the vehicle.
If you have any problems, see the device’s
instructions, visit www.homelink.com, or call
HomeLink at (800) 355-3515.
4.
a.
3.
2.
5.
a.
b.
1.
Position the remote transmitter you wish to link 1 to 3 inches (3 - 8 cm) from the
HomeLink button you want to program.
Press and hold the desired HomeLink button and the button on
the remote transmitter. Does the HomeLink indicator (LED)
blink after 10 secs?
Press and hold the
programmed HomeLink
button for about a sec.
Does the device (garage
door opener) work?
Press and hold the remote and the HomeLink
button at the same time. Then, while
continuing to hold the HomeLink button,
press and release the button on the remote
every 2 secs.
Does the LED blink within 20 secs?
Training
Complete
Press and hold the HomeLink button again.
Press and hold the HomeLink
button again.
The remote-controlled device
should operate.
Training Complete
The remote has a rolling code. Press the
“learn” button on the remote-controlled
device (e.g. garage door opener).
Within 30 secs, press and hold the
programmed HomeLink button for 2 secs.
HomeLink indicator blinks for 2 secs,
then remains on.
HomeLink LED
is on.
YES
NO
YES
YES
NO
NO
Table of Contents
333
Continued
Features
Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink®
Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink® (HFL) allows you to place and receive phone calls using
your vehicle’s audio system, without handling your cell phone.
Using HFL
(Pick-up) button: Press to answer an incoming call.
(Hang-up/back) button: Press to end a call or to cancel a command.
(Talk) button: Press to call a number with a stored voice tag, a phonebook
name, or a number.
PHONE button: Press to go directly to the Phone screen.
Selector knob: Rotate to select an item on the screen, then press .
HFL Buttons
1Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink®
To use HFL, you need a Bluetooth-compatible cell
phone. For a list of compatible phones, pairing
procedures, and special feature capabilities:
U.S.: Visit www.handsfreelink.honda.com, or call
1-888-528-7876.
Canada: Visit www.handsfreelink.ca, or call 1-888-
528 -7876.
To use HFL, the Bluetooth On/Off setting must be On.
2 Customized Features P. 293
Voice control tips
Aim the vents away from the ceiling and close the
windows, as noise coming from them may interfere
with the microphone.
Press and release the button when you want to
call a number using a stored voice tag, a
phonebook name, or a number. Speak clearly and
naturally after a beep.
If the microphone picks up voices other than yours,
the command may be misinterpreted.
To change the volume level, use the audio system's
volume knob or the remote audio controls on the
steering wheel.
State or local laws may prohibit the operation of
handheld electronic devices while operating a vehicle.
If you receive a call while using the audio system, the
system resumes its operation after ending the call.
Models without navigation system
Models with one display
Talk Button
Volume up
Microphone
Hang-up/Back Button
Pick-up
Button
Volume down
Selector
Knob
PHONE
Button
Table of Contents
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® uUsing HFL
334
Features
(Pick-up) button: Press to display the phone menu on half of the screen, or to
answer an incoming call.
(Hang-up/back) button: Press to end a call or to cancel a command.
(Talk) button: Press to call a number with a stored voice tag, a phonebook
name, or a number.
Selector knob: Rotate to select an item on the screen, then press .
To go to the Phone screen:
1. Press the DISP button to switch the display to the Function Change screen.
2. Rotate to select Phone, then press .
1Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink®
Bluetooth® Wireless Technology
The Bluetooth® word mark and logos are registered
trademarks owned by Bluetooth SIG, Inc., and any
use of such marks by Honda Motors Co., Ltd., is
under license. Other trademarks and trade names are
those of their respective owners.
HFL Limitations
An incoming call on HFL will interrupt the audio
system when it is playing. It will resume when the call
is ended.
Models with two displays
Talk Button
Volume up
Microphone
Hang-up/Back Button
Pick-up
Button
Volume down
Selector
Knob
DISP
Button
Table of Contents
335
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® uUsing HFL
Features
The audio/information screen notifies you when there is an incoming call.
Certain manual functions are disabled or
inoperable while the vehicle is in motion.
You cannot select a grayed-out option until
the vehicle is stopped.
Only previously stored speed dial entries with
voice tags, phonebook names, or numbers
can be called using voice commands while the
vehicle is in motion.
2 Speed Dial P. 352
HFL Status Display
1HFL Status Display
The information that appears on the audio/
information screen varies between phone models.
You can change the system language to English,
French, or Spanish.
2 Customized Features P. 293
Limitations for Manual Operation
Bluetooth Indicator
Comes on when your
phone is connected to HFL.
Signal Strength
HFL Mode
Battery Level
Status
Roam Status
Caller’s Name
Caller’s Number
Disabled Options
Table of Contents
336
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® uHFL Menus
Features
HFL Menus
The power mode must be in ACCESSORY or ON to use HFL.
Phone Settings screen
1. Press the SETTINGS button.
1. Press and hold the DISP button.
2. Rotate to select Phone Settings, then
press .
1HFL Menus
To use HFL, you must first pair your Bluetooth-
compatible cell phone to the system while the vehicle
is parked.
Some functions are limited while driving. A message
appears on the screen when the vehicle is moving
and the operation is canceled.
Models with one display
Models with two displays
All models
Pair a phone to the system.
Replace a previously paired phone with a
new phone.
Connect
Phone
*1
Bluetooth
Device List
Add Bluetooth Device
Edit PIN
(Existing entry list)
Disconnect
Connect a phone to the system.
Disconnect a paired phone from the system.
*1:
(Existing
entry list)
*1
Replace This
Device
Delete This
Device
Delete a previously paired phone.
Create a security PIN for a paired phone.
Add
Bluetooth
Device
Appears only when a phone is connected to HFL.
Pair a phone to the system.
Table of Contents
337
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® uHFL Menus
Continued
Features
Select a phone number from the call
history to store as a speed dial number.
Manual Input
New Entry
Import from
Call History
Import from
Phonebook
Enter a phone number to store as a
speed dial number.
Delete all of the previously stored speed dial number.
*2: Models with two displays
Select a phone number from the
phonebook to store as a speed dial number.
Edit
Edit a previously stored speed dial number.
Change a number.
Create or delete a voice tag.
Delete
Delete a previously stored speed dial
number.
(Existing
entry list)
Delete All
Edit Speed
Dial
*1
Set calls to automatically transfer from your phone to HFL when you enter the
vehicle.
Auto Transfer
Auto Answer
Ring Tone
Set whether to automatically answer an incoming call after about four
seconds.
Select the ring tone.
Automatic Phone Sync
*1
Use Contact Photo
*2
Set phonebook data to be automatically imported when a phone is paired to
HFL.
Display a caller’s picture on an incoming call screen.
Phone
*1: Appears only when a phone is connected to HFL.
Table of Contents
338
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® uHFL Menus
Features
*1: Appears only when a phone is connected to HFL.
Turn the text message/e-mail function on and off.
Select Account
*
Select a mail or text message account.
New Text Message Alert
*2
New Text/Email Alert
*3
Message Auto Reading
Select whether a pop-up alert comes on the screen when HFL
receives a new text message/e-mail.
Sets the system to automatically read an incoming text
message/e-mail.
Text Message
*1, *2
Text/Email
*1, *3
Default
Enable Text Message
*2
Enable Text/Email
*3
Cancel/Reset all customized items in the Phone Settings group as default.
*2: Models with one display
*3: Models with two displays
* Not available on all models
Table of Contents
339
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® uHFL Menus
Continued
Features
Phone screen
1. Press the PHONE button.
2. Press the MENU button to display the
menu items.
1. Press the DISP button.
2. Rotate to select Phone, then press .
Models with one display
Models with two displays
Display the last 20 outgoing, incoming and missed calls.
Select a phone number from the call history to store as a
speed dial number.
Call
History
*1
Speed Dial
*1
All
Manual Input
Dialed
Received
Display the last 20 outgoing calls.
Display the last 20 incoming calls.
New Entry
Import from
Call History
Import from
Phonebook
Select a phone number from the phonebook to store as a
speed dial number.
Enter a phone number to store as a speed dial number.
More Speed Dials
Display another paired phone’s speed dial list.
*1: Appears only when a phone is connected to HFL.
Missed
Display the last 20 missed calls.
Dial
*1
Redial
*1
Enter a phone number to dial.
Redial the last number dialed in the phone’s history.
(Existing entry list)
Dial the selected number in the speed dial list.
Table of Contents
340
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® uHFL Menus
Features
See the previous message.
Text Message
*1, *2
Text/Email
*1, *3
Read/Stop
Select Account
*
Previous Message
Next Message
See the next message.
System reads received message aloud, or
stop message from being read.
Phonebook
*1
Display the paired phone’s phonebook.
Message is read
aloud.
Reply
Call
Reply to a received message using one of
six fixed phrases.
Make a call to the sender.
Select a message
and press .
Select a mail or text message account.
*1: Appears only when a phone is connected to HFL.
*2: Models with one display
*3: Models with two displays
* Not available on all models
Table of Contents
Continued
341
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® uHFL Menus
Features
To pair a cell phone (when there is no
phone paired to the system)
1. Go to the Phone screen.
2 Phone screen P. 339
2. Rotate to select Yes, then press .
3. Make sure your phone is search or
discoverable mode, then press .
u HFL automatically searches for a
Bluetooth device.
4. When your phone appears on the list, select
it by pressing .
u If your phone does not appear, you can
select Refresh to search again.
u If your phone still does not appear, select
Phone Not Found and search for
Bluetooth devices using your phone.
From your phone, select
HandsFreeLink.
5. HFL gives you a pairing code on the audio/
information screen.
u Confirm if the pairing code on the screen
and your phone match.
This may vary by phone.
6. You will receive a notification on the screen
if pairing is successful.
Phone Setup
1Phone Setup
Your Bluetooth-compatible phone must be paired to
HFL before you can make and receive hands-free
calls.
Phone Pairing Tips:
You cannot pair your phone while the vehicle is
moving.
Up to six phones can be paired.
Your phone's battery may drain faster when it is
paired to HFL.
If your phone is not ready for pairing or not found
by the system within three minutes, the system will
time out and returns to idle.
Once you have paired a phone, you can see it
displayed on the screen with one or two icons on the
right side.
These icons indicate the following:
: The phone can be used with HFL.
: The phone is compatible with Bluetooth® Audio.
When pairing is completed, an Automatic Phone
Sync prompt appears. Select On if you want your call
history and phonebook automatically imported to
HFL.
2 Changing the Automatic Phone Sync
setting P. 351
Table of Contents
342
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® uHFL Menus
Features
To pair a cell phone (when a phone has
already been paired to the system)
1. Go to the Phone Settings screen.
2 Phone Settings screen P. 336
2. Rotate to select Connect Phone, then
press .
u Repeat the procedure to select Add
Bluetooth Device.
3. Make sure your phone is in search or
discoverable mode, then press .
u HFL automatically searches for a
Bluetooth device.
4. When your phone appears on the list, select
it by pressing .
u If your phone does not appear, you can
select Refresh to search again.
u If your phone still does not appear, select
Phone Not Found and search for
Bluetooth devices using your phone.
From your phone, select
HandsFreeLink.
5. HFL gives you a pairing code on the audio/
information screen.
u Confirm if the pairing code on the screen
and your phone match.
This may vary by phone.
6. You will receive a notification on the screen
if pairing is successful.
Table of Contents
Continued
343
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® uHFL Menus
Features
To change the pairing code setting
1. Press the SETTINGS button.
1. Press and hold the DISP button.
2. Rotate to select System Settings, then
press .
u Repeat the procedure to select
Bluetooth, then Edit Pairing Code.
3. Rotate to select Fixed or Random,
then press .
1To change the pairing code setting
The pairing code may be six or four digits depending
on your phone.
The default pairing code is 0000 until you change the
setting.
To create your own, select Fixed, and delete the
current code, then enter a new one.
For a randomly generated pairing code each time you
pair a phone, select Random.
Edit Pairing Code
Models with one display
Models with two displays
All models
Table of Contents
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® uHFL Menus
344
Features
To replace an already-paired phone
with a new phone
1. Go to the Phone Settings screen.
2 Phone Settings screen P. 336
2. Rotate to select Bluetooth Device List,
then press .
3. Rotate to select a paired phone you
want to replace, then press .
4. Rotate to select Replace This Device,
then press .
5. HFL enters the pairing process and searches
a new phone.
u Follow the prompts to pair a new phone.
6. You will receive a notification on the screen
if pairing is successful.
1To replace an already-paired phone with a new phone
The replaced phone will keep the same speed dial
entries, call history, and security PIN information from
the previously paired phone.
Table of Contents
345
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® uHFL Menus
Continued
Features
To delete a paired phone
1. Go to the Phone Settings screen.
2 Phone Settings screen P. 336
2. Rotate to select Bluetooth Device List,
then press .
3. Rotate to select a phone you want to
delete, then press .
4. Rotate to select Delete This Device,
then press .
5. You will receive a confirmation message on
the screen. Rotate to select Yes, then
press .
6. You will receive a notification on the screen
if it is successful.
Table of Contents
346
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® uHFL Menus
Features
To turn on or off the text/e-mail
function
1. Go to the Phone Settings screen.
2 Phone Settings screen P. 336
2. Rotate to select Text Message, then
press .
u Repeat the procedure to select Enable
Text Message.
u A pop-up menu appears on the screen.
2. Rotate to select Text/Email, then press
.
u Repeat the procedure to select Enable
Text/Email.
u A pop-up menu appears on the screen.
3. Rotate to select On or Off, then press
.
To Set Up a Text Message/E-mail Options
Models with one display
Models with two displays
All models
Table of Contents
Continued
347
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® uHFL Menus
Features
To turn on or off the text/e-mail notice
1. On the Text Message screen, rotate to
select New Text Message Alert, then
press .
1. On the Text/Email screen, rotate to
select New Text/Email Alert, then press
.
u A pop-up menu appears on the screen.
2. Rotate to select On or Off, then press
.
To set up the auto reading option
1. On the Text Message or the Text/Email
screen, rotate to select Message Auto
Reading, then press .
u A pop-up menu appears on the screen.
2. Rotate to select On, Off or Auto then
press .
1To turn on or off the text/e-mail notice
On: A pop-up notification comes on every time you
receive a new message.
Off: The message you receive is stored in the system
without notification.
Models with one display
Models with two displays
All models
1To set up the auto reading option
On: A text message/e-mail is always read aloud.
Off: A text message/e-mail is not read aloud.
Auto: A text message/e-mail is read aloud only when
driving.
Table of Contents
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® uHFL Menus
348
Features
You can protect each of the six cell phones with a security PIN.
1. Go to the Phone Settings screen.
2 Phone Settings screen P. 336
2. Rotate to select Bluetooth Device List,
then press .
3. Rotate to select a phone you want to
add a security PIN to, then press .
4. Rotate to select Edit PIN, then press .
5. Enter a new four-digit number.
u
Rotate to select, then press .
Press to delete. Press OK to enter the
security PIN.
u
You can also enter a number using the
icons.
6. Re-enter the four-digit number.
u The screen returns to the screen in step
4.
To Create a Security PIN
1To Create a Security PIN
If the phone is already security PIN protected, you
need to enter the current security PIN before clearing
the PIN or creating a new one.
Audio/information screen
Audio with touch screen
*
Audio/information screen
Audio with touch screen
*
* Not available on all models
Table of Contents
349
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® uHFL Menus
Continued
Features
If you get into the vehicle while you are on the phone, the call can be automatically
transferred to HFL.
1. Go to the Phone Settings screen.
2 Phone Settings screen P. 336
2. Rotate to select Phone, then press .
u Repeat the procedure to select Auto
Transfer.
3. Rotate to select On, then press .
You can set HFL to automatically answer an incoming call in four seconds.
1. Go to the Phone Settings screen.
2 Phone Settings screen P. 336
2. Rotate to select Phone, then press .
u Repeat the procedure to select Auto
Answer.
3. Rotate to select On, then press .
Automatic Transferring
Auto Answer
Table of Contents
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® uHFL Menus
350
Features
You can change the ring tone setting.
1. Go to the Phone Settings screen.
2 Phone Settings screen P. 336
2. Rotate to select Phone, then press .
u Repeat the procedure to select Ring
Tone.
3. Rotate to select Fixed, Mobile Phone
or Off, then press .
You can display a caller’s picture on an incoming call screen.
1. Go to the Phone Settings screen.
2 Phone Settings screen P. 336
2. Rotate to select Phone, then press .
u Repeat the procedure to select Use
Contact Photo.
3. Rotate to select On or Off, then press
.
Ring Tone
1Ring Tone
Fixed: The fixed ring tone sounds from the speaker.
Mobile Phone: The ring tone stored in the
connected cell phone sounds from the speaker.
Off: No ring tones sound from the speaker.
Use Contact Photo
Models with two displays
Table of Contents
Continued
351
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® uHFL Menus
Features
When Automatic Phone Sync is set to
On:
When your phone is paired, the contents of its
phonebook and call history are automatically
imported to HFL.
Changing the Automatic Phone Sync
setting
1. Go to the Phone Settings screen.
2 Phone Settings screen P. 336
2. Rotate to select Phone, then press .
u Repeat the procedure to select
Automatic Phone Sync.
3. Rotate to select On or Off, then press
.
Automatic Import of Cellular Phonebook and Call History
1Automatic Import of Cellular Phonebook and Call History
When you select a person from the list in the cellular
phonebook, you can see up to three category icons.
The icons indicate what types of numbers are stored
for that name.
On some phones, it may not be possible to import the
category icons to HFL.
The phonebook is updated after every connection.
Call history is updated after every connection or call.
Pref
Home
Mobile
Work Pager
Fax
Car
Other
Voice
Table of Contents
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® uHFL Menus
352
Features
Up to 20 speed dial numbers can be stored per phone.
To store a speed dial number:
1. Go to the Phone screen.
2 Phone screen P. 339
Press the MENU button to display the
menu items.
2. Rotate to select Speed Dial, then press
.
u Repeat the procedure to select New
Entry.
3. Rotate to select a place to choose a
number from, then press .
From Import from Call History:
u Select a number from the call history.
From Manual Input:
u Input the number manually.
From Import from Phonebook:
u Select a number from the linked cell
phone’s imported phonebook.
4. When the speed dial is successfully stored
from Import from Call History or Import
from Phonebook, you are asked to create
a voice tag for the number. Rotate to
select Yes or No, then press .
5. Using the button, follow the prompts to
store a voice tag for the speed dial entry.
Speed Dial
1Speed Dial
When a voice tag is stored, press the button to
call the number using the voice tag. Say “Call” and
the voice tag name.
Mr.AAA
111AAA####
555EEE####
444DDD####
333CCC####
222BBB####
Mr.EEE
Mr.DDD
Mr.CCC
Mr.BBB
Select a method to store
Models with one display
Table of Contents
Continued
353
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® uHFL Menus
Features
To add a voice tag to a stored speed
dial number
1. Go to the Phone Settings screen.
2 Phone Settings screen P. 336
2. Rotate to select Phone, then press .
u Repeat the procedure to select Edit
Speed Dial.
3. Select an existing speed dial entry.
u From the pop-up menu, rotate to
select Edit, then press .
4. Rotate to select Voice Tag, then press
.
u From the pop-up menu, rotate to
select Record, then press .
5. Using the button, follow the prompts to
complete the voice tag.
1Speed Dial
Avoid using duplicate voice tags.
Avoid using “home” as a voice tag.
It is easier for HFL to recognize a longer name. For
example, use “John Smith” instead of “John.”
Table of Contents
354
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® uHFL Menus
Features
To delete a voice tag
1. Go to the Phone Settings screen.
2 Phone Settings screen P. 336
2. Rotate to select Phone, then press .
u Repeat the procedure to select Edit
Speed Dial.
3. Select an existing speed dial entry.
u From the pop-up menu, rotate to
select Edit, then press .
4. Rotate to select Voice Tag, then press
.
u From the pop-up menu, rotate to
select Clear, then press .
5. You will receive a confirmation message on
the screen. Rotate to select Yes, then
press .
To delete a speed dial
1. Go to the Phone Settings screen.
2 Phone Settings screen P. 336
2. Rotate to select Phone, then press .
u Repeat the procedure to select Edit
Speed Dial.
3. Select an existing speed dial entry.
u From the pop-up menu, rotate to
select Delete, then press .
4. You will receive a confirmation message on
the screen. Rotate to select Yes, then
press .
Table of Contents
Continued
355
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® uHFL Menus
Features
You can make calls by inputting any phone
number, or by using the imported
phonebook, call history, speed dial entries, or
redial.
Making a Call
1Making a Call
Any voice-tagged speed dial entry, phonebook name,
or number can be dialed by voice from most screens.
Press the button and say “Call” and the
phonebook name, phone number, or stored voice
tag.
The maximum range between your phone and
vehicles is 30 feet (10 meters).
Once a call is connected, you can hear the voice of
the person you are calling through the audio
speakers.
Table of Contents
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® uHFL Menus
356
Features
To make a call using the imported
phonebook
1. Go to the Phone screen.
2 Phone screen P. 339
Press the MENU button to display the
menu items.
2. Rotate to select Phonebook, then
press .
3. Rotate to select a name, then press .
u You can also search by letter. Rotate
to select Alphabet Search, then press
.
u Use the keyboard on the touch screen for
entering letters.
4. Rotate to select a number, then press
.
u Dialing starts automatically.
1To make a call using the imported phonebook
This function is disabled while the vehicle is moving.
However, you can call a stored voice-tagged speed
dial number, phonebook name, or number using
voice commands.
2 Limitations for Manual Operation P. 335
2 Speed Dial P. 352
You can use the keyboard on the audio with touch
screen for an alphabetical search.
Models with two displays
Models with one display
Models with two displays
Table of Contents
Continued
357
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® uHFL Menus
Features
To make a call using a phone number
1. Go to the Phone screen.
2 Phone screen P. 339
Press the MENU button to display the
menu items.
2. Rotate to select Dial, then press .
3. Rotate to select a number, then press
.
4. Rotate to select , then press .
u Dialing starts automatically.
To make a call using redial
1. Go to the Phone screen.
2 Phone screen P. 339
Press the MENU button to display the
menu items.
2. Rotate to select Redial, then press .
u Dialing starts automatically.
1To make a call using a phone number
This function is disabled while the vehicle is moving.
However, you can call a stored voice-tagged speed
dial number, phonebook name, or number using
voice commands.
2 Limitations for Manual Operation P. 335
2 Speed Dial P. 352
You can use the keyboard on the audio with touch
screen to input numbers.
Select numbers, then to start dialing.
Models with two displays
Models with one display
Models with one display
Table of Contents
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® uHFL Menus
358
Features
To make a call using the call history
Call history is stored by All, Dialed,
Received, and Missed.
1. Go to the Phone screen.
2 Phone screen P. 339
Press the MENU button to display the
menu items.
2. Rotate to select Call History, then
press .
3. Rotate to select All, Dialed, Received,
or Missed, then press .
4. Rotate to select a number, then press
.
u Dialing starts automatically.
1To make a call using the call history
The call history displays the last 20 dialed, received, or
missed calls.
(Appears only when a phone is connected to HFL.)
Audio/information screen
Models with one display
Table of Contents
359
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® uHFL Menus
Continued
Features
You can dial to the last six numbers in the call
history.
1. Select .
2. Select Call History.
3. Select 1-6.
u Dialing starts automatically.
Audio with touch screen
*
* Not available on all models
Table of Contents
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® uHFL Menus
360
Features
To make a call using a speed dial entry
1. Go to the Phone screen.
2 Phone screen P. 339
Press the MENU button to display the
menu items.
2. Rotate to select Speed Dial, then press
.
3. Rotate to select a number, then press .
u Dialing starts automatically.
You can dial to the first six numbers in the
speed dial entries ( - ).
1. Select .
2. Select Speed Dial.
3. Select 1-6.
u Dialing starts automatically.
1To make a call using a speed dial entry
Select More Speed Dials to view another paired
phone’s speed dial list. You can make a call from that
list using the currently connected phone.
When a voice tag is stored, press the button to
call the number using the voice tag.
2 Speed Dial P. 352
Any voice-tagged speed dial entry, phonebook name,
or number can be dialed by voice from any screen.
Press the button and follow the prompts.
To call stored speed dial entries 1-6, press the
corresponding preset buttons from the Phone
screen.
Models with one display
Audio/information screen
Models with one display
Audio with touch screen
*
* Not available on all models
Table of Contents
Continued
361
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® uHFL Menus
Features
When there is an incoming call, an audible
notification sounds (if activated) and the
Incoming Call screen appears.
Press the button to answer the call.
Press the button to decline or end the call.
Receiving a Call
1Receiving a Call
Call Waiting
Press the button to put the current call on hold to
answer the incoming call.
Press the button again to return to the current
call.
Ignore the incoming call if you do not want to answer
it.
Press the button if you want to hang up the
current call.
You can select the icons on the audio with touch
screen instead of the and buttons.
Models with two displays
Table of Contents
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® uHFL Menus
362
Features
The following options are available during a call.
Mute: Mute your voice.
Transfer: Transfer a call from HFL to your phone.
Touch Tones: Send numbers during a call. This is useful when you call a menu-
driven phone system.
Pres the MENU button to display the options.
The available options are shown on the lower
half of the screen.
Rotate to select the mute option, then
press .
u The mute icon appears when Mute is
selected. Select Mute again to turn it off.
Options During a Call
1Options During a Call
Touch Tones: Available on some phones.
You can select the icons on the audio with touch
screen.
Models with two displays
Mute Icon
Models with one display
Models with two displays
All models
Table of Contents
Continued
363
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® uHFL Menus
Features
HFL can display newly received text messages as well as 20 of the most recently
received messages on a linked cell phone. Each received message can be read aloud
and replied to using a fixed common phrase.
HFL can also display e-mails.
1. A pop-up appears and notifies you of a new
text message or e-mail.
2. Rotate to select Read to listen to the
message, then press .
u The text message or e-mail is displayed.
The system automatically starts reading
out the message.
3. To discontinue the message read-out, press
.
Receiving a Text Message/E-mail
1Receiving a Text Message/E-mail
The system does not display any received messages
while you are driving. You can only hear them read
aloud.
With some phones, you may be able to display up to
20 most recent text messages and e-mails.
State or local laws may limit your use of the HFL text
message/e-mail feature. Only use the text message/
e-mail feature when conditions allow you to do so
safely.
When you receive a text message or e-mail for the
first time after the phone is paired to HFL, you are
asked to turn the New Text Message Alert or the
New Text/Email Alert setting to On.
2 To turn on or off the text/e-mail notice
P. 347
Models with two displays
Table of Contents
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® uHFL Menus
364
Features
If a paired phone has text message or mail accounts, you can select one of them to
be active and receive notifications.
1. Go to the Phone Settings screen.
2 Phone Settings screen P. 336
2. Rotate to select Text/Email, then press
.
u Repeat the procedure to select Select
Account.
3. Rotate to select Text message or an
e-mail account you want, then press .
Selecting a Mail Account
Models with two displays
1Selecting a Mail Account
You can also select a mail account from the folder list
screen or the message list screen.
Rotate to select Select Account on the top of the
list, then press .
You can only receive notifications from one text
message or mail account at a time.
Message List
Table of Contents
Continued
365
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® uHFL Menus
Features
Displaying text messages
1. Go to the Phone screen.
2 Phone screen P. 339
Press the MENU button to display the
menu items.
2. Rotate to select Text Message, then
press .
2. Rotate to select Text/Email, then press
.
u Select account if necessary.
3. Rotate to select a message, then press
.
u The text message is displayed. The
system automatically starts reading the
message aloud.
Displaying Messages
1Displaying Messages
The icon appears next to an unread message.
If you delete a message on the phone, the message is
also deleted in the system. If you send a message
from the system, the message goes to your phone’s
outbox.
To see the previous or next message, press on the
text message screen. From the pop-up menu, rotate
to select Previous Message or Next Message,
then press .
Message List
Text Message
Models with one display
Models with one display
Models with two displays
All models
Table of Contents
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® uHFL Menus
366
Features
Displaying e-mails
1. Go to the Phone screen.
2 Phone screen P. 339
2. Rotate to select Text/Email, then press
.
u Select account if necessary.
3. Rotate to select a folder, then press .
4. Rotate to select a message, then press
.
u The e-mail is displayed. The system
automatically starts reading the message
aloud.
1Displaying e-mails
Received text messages and e-mails may appear in
the message list screen at the same time. In this case,
text messages are titled No Subject.
Message List
E-mail
Folder List
Models with two displays
Table of Contents
Continued
367
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® uHFL Menus
Features
Using the Stop or Read option
1. Go to the text message or e-mail screen.
u The system automatically starts reading
the message aloud.
2 Displaying Messages P. 365
2. Press to have the pop-up menu appear
on the screen.
3. Rotate to select Stop or Read, then
press .
1Using the Stop or Read option
This option changes to:
Stop while the text message/e-mail is read out.
Select this option to discontinue the message read
out.
Read when the system has finished reading out the
text message/e-mail, or after you selected Stop.
Select this option to hear the system read out the
selected message.
Table of Contents
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® uHFL Menus
368
Features
Reply to a message
1. Go to the text message or e-mail screen.
u The system automatically starts reading
the message aloud.
2 Displaying Messages P. 365
2. Press to have the pop-up menu appear
on the screen.
3. Rotate to select Reply, then press .
4. Rotate to select the reply message, then
press .
u The pop-up menu appears on the screen.
5. Select Send to send the message.
u Complete appears on the screen when
the reply message was successfully sent.
1Reply to a message
The available fixed reply messages are as follows:
Talk to you later, I’m driving.
I’m on my way.
I’m running late.
OK
Yes
No
You cannot add, edit, or delete reply messages.
Table of Contents
369
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® uHFL Menus
Features
Making a call to a sender
1. Go to the text message screen.
u The system automatically starts reading
the message aloud.
2 Displaying text messages P. 365
2. Press to have the pop-up menu appear
on the screen.
3. Rotate to select Call, then press .
Table of Contents
370
Features
Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink®
Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink® (HFL) allows you to place and receive phone calls using
your vehicle’s navigation system, without handling your cell phone.
Using HFL
(Pick-up) button: Press to go to the Phone Call screen or to answer an
incoming call.
(Hang-up/back) button: Press to end a call or to cancel a command.
(Talk) button: Press to give HFL voice commands.
PHONE button: Press to go directly to the Phone screen.
Interface dial: Rotate to select an item on the screen, then press . Move ,
, or to select secondary menu.
HFL Buttons
1Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink®
To use HFL, you need a Bluetooth-compatible cell
phone. For a list of compatible phones, pairing
procedures, and special feature capabilities:
U.S.: Visit www.handsfreelink.honda.com, or call
1-888-528-7876.
Canada: Visit www.handsfreelink.ca, or call 1-888-
528 -7876.
To use HFL, the Bluetooth Status setting must be On.
2 Customized Features P. 293
Voice control tips
Aim the vents away from the ceiling and close the
windows, as noise coming from them may interfere
with the microphone.
Press and release the button when you want to
call a number using a stored voice tag, a
phonebook name, or a number. Speak clearly and
naturally after a beep.
If the microphone picks up voices other than yours,
the command may be misinterpreted.
To change the volume level, use the audio system's
volume knob or the remote audio controls on the
steering wheel.
State or local laws may prohibit the operation of
handheld electronic devices while operating a vehicle.
If you receive a call while using the audio system, the
system resumes its operation after ending the call.
Models with navigation system
Talk Button
Volume up
Hang-up/Back Button
Pick-up
Button
Volume down
Interface
Dial
PHONE
Button
Microphone
Table of Contents
371
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® uUsing HFL
Features
The audio/information screen notifies you when there is an incoming call.
Certain manual functions are disabled or
inoperable while the vehicle is in motion.
You cannot select a grayed-out option until
the vehicle is stopped.
Only previously stored speed dial entries with
voice tags, phonebook names, or numbers
can be called using voice commands while the
vehicle is in motion.
2 Speed Dial P. 388
HFL Status Display
1Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink®
Bluetooth® Wireless Technology
The Bluetooth® word mark and logos are registered
trademarks owned by Bluetooth SIG, Inc., and any
use of such marks by Honda Motors Co., Ltd., is
under license. Other trademarks and trade names are
those of their respective owners.
HFL Limitations
An incoming call on HFL will interrupt the audio
system when it is playing. It will resume when the call
is ended.
1HFL Status Display
The information that appears on the audio/
information screen varies between phone models.
You can change the system language to English,
French, or Spanish.
2 Customized Features P. 293
Limitations for Manual Operation
Bluetooth Indicator
Comes on when your
phone is connected to HFL.
Signal Strength
HFL Mode
Battery Level
Status
Roam Status
Caller’s Name
Caller’s Number
Disabled Option
Table of Contents
372
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® uHFL Menus
Features
HFL Menus
The power mode must be in ACCESSORY or ON to use HFL.
Phone Settings screen
1. Press the SETTINGS button.
2. Rotate to select Phone Settings, then
press .
1HFL Menus
To use HFL, you must first pair your Bluetooth-
compatible cell phone to the system while the vehicle
is parked.
Some functions are limited while driving. A message
appears on the screen when the vehicle is moving
and the operation is canceled.
Edit the user name of a paired phone.
Phone
Edit Device
Name
Connect
phone
Bluetooth
Device List
(Existing
entry list)
Replace This
Device
Add Bluetooth
Device
Disconnect a paired phone from the system.
Connect a phone to the system.
*1: Appears only when a phone is connected to HFL.
Disconnect
(Existing entry list)
Pair a phone to the system.
Edit PIN
Create a security PIN for a paired phone.
Replace a previously paired phone with a
new phone.
Delete This
Device
Delete a previously paired phone.
Add Bluetooth
Device
Pair a phone to the system.
Table of Contents
373
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® uHFL Menus
Continued
Features
Text/Email
*1
Manual Input
Edit Speed
Dial
New Entry
Import from
Call History
*1: Appears only when a phone is connected to HFL.
Import from
Phonebook
Delete All
Delete all the previously stored speed dial numbers.
Select a phone number from the call
history to store as a speed dial number.
Select a phone number from the
phonebook to store as a speed dial number.
Enter a phone number to store as a speed
dial number.
Edit
Delete
(Existing
entry list)
Edit a previously stored speed dial number.
Change a number.
Create or delete a voice tag.
Delete a previously stored speed dial number.
Set calls to automatically transfer from your phone to HFL when you enter the
vehicle.
Auto Transfer
Auto Answer
Ring Tone
Set whether to automatically answer an incoming call after about four
seconds.
Select the ring tone.
Use Contact Photo
Set phonebook data to be automatically imported when a phone is paired to
HFL.
Display a caller’s picture on an incoming call screen.
Automatic Phone Sync
Select Account
Select a mail or text message account.
Enable Text/Email
Turn the text message/e-mail function on and off.
New Text/Email Alert
Select whether a pop-up alert comes on the screen when HFL receives a new
text message/e-mail.
Cancel/Reset all customized items in the Phone Settings group as default.
Default
Table of Contents
374
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® uHFL Menus
Features
Phone screen
1. Press the PHONE button.
2. Press the MENU button to display the
menu items.
Select a phone number from the call history to store as a
speed dial number.
Speed Dial
*1
Manual Input
New Entry
Import from
Call History
Import from
Phonebook
Select a phone number from the phonebook to store as a
speed dial number.
Enter a phone number to store as a speed dial number.
More Speed Dials
Display another paired phone’s speed dial list.
*1: Appears only when a phone is connected to HFL.
(Existing entry list)
Dial the selected number in the speed dial list.
Phonebook
*1
Dial
*1
Display the paired phone’s phonebook.
Enter a phone number to dial.
Table of Contents
375
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® uHFL Menus
Continued
Features
Text/Email
*1
Message is
read aloud.
*1: Appears only when a phone is connected to HFL.
See the previous message.
(Read/Stop)
Previous
Next
See the next message.
System reads received message aloud, or stop message
from being read.
Reply
Call
Reply to a received message using one of six fixed phrases.
Make a call to the sender.
Select Account
Select a message
and press .
Select a mail or text message account.
Redial
*1
Redial the last number dialed in the phone’s history.
Display the last 20 outgoing, incoming and missed calls.
Call History
*1
All
Dialed
Received
Display the last 20 outgoing calls.
Display the last 20 incoming calls.
Missed
Display the last 20 missed calls.
Table of Contents
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® uHFL Menus
376
Features
To pair a cell phone (when there is no
phone paired to the system)
1. Press the PHONE button.
2. Rotate to select Yes, then press .
3. Make sure your phone is search or
discoverable mode, then press .
u HFL automatically searches for a
Bluetooth device.
4. When your phone appears on the list, select
it by pressing .
u If your phone does not appear, you can
select Refresh to search again.
u If your phone still does not appear, move
to select Phone Not Found? and
search for Bluetooth devices using your
phone. From your phone, select
HandsFreeLink.
5. HFL gives you a pairing code on the audio/
information screen.
u Confirm if the pairing code on the screen
and your phone match.
This may vary by phone.
6. You will receive a notification on the screen
if pairing is successful.
Phone Setup
1Phone Setup
Your Bluetooth-compatible phone must be paired to
HFL before you can make and receive hands-free
calls.
Phone Pairing Tips:
You cannot pair your phone while the vehicle is
moving.
Up to six phones can be paired.
Your phone's battery may drain faster when it is
paired to HFL.
If your phone is not ready for pairing or not found
by the system within three minutes, the system will
time out and returns to idle.
Once you have paired a phone, you can see it
displayed on the screen with one or two icons on the
right side.
These icons indicate the following:
: The phone can be used with HFL.
: The phone is compatible with Bluetooth® Audio.
When pairing is completed, an Automatic Phone
Sync prompt appears. Select On if you want your call
history and phonebook automatically imported to
HFL.
2 Changing the Automatic Phone Sync
setting P. 387
Table of Contents
377
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® uHFL Menus
Continued
Features
To pair a cell phone (when a phone has
already been paired to the system)
1. Press the SETTINGS button.
2. Rotate to select Phone Settings, then
press .
u Repeat the procedure to select Connect
Phone, then Add Bluetooth Device.
3. Make sure your phone is in search or
discoverable mode, then press .
u HFL automatically searches for a
Bluetooth device.
4. When your phone appears on the list, select
it by pressing .
u If your phone does not appear, you can
select Refresh to search again.
u If your phone still does not appear, move
to select Phone Not Found? and
search for Bluetooth devices using your
phone. From your phone, select
HandsFreeLink.
5. HFL gives you a pairing code on the audio/
information screen.
u Confirm if the pairing code on the screen
and your phone match.
This may vary by phone.
6. You will receive a notification on the screen
if pairing is successful.
Table of Contents
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® uHFL Menus
378
Features
To change the pairing code setting
1. Press the SETTINGS button.
2. Rotate to select System Settings, then
press .
u Repeat the procedure to select Edit
Pairing Code.
3. Rotate to select Fixed or Random,
then press .
1To change the pairing code setting
The pairing code may be six or four digits depending
on your phone.
The default pairing code is 0000 until you change the
setting.
To create your own, select Fixed, and delete the
current code, then enter a new one.
For a randomly generated pairing code each time you
pair a phone, select Random.
Table of Contents
Continued
379
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® uHFL Menus
Features
To replace an already-paired phone
with a new phone
1. Press the SETTINGS button.
2. Rotate to select Phone Settings, then
press .
u Repeat the procedure to select
Bluetooth Device List.
3. Rotate to select a paired phone you
want to replace, then press .
4. Rotate to select Replace This Device,
then press .
5. HFL enters the pairing process and searches
a new phone.
u Follow the prompts to pair a new phone.
6. You will receive a notification on the screen
if pairing is successful.
1To replace an already-paired phone with a new phone
The replaced phone will keep the same speed dial
entries, call history, and security PIN information from
the previously paired phone.
Table of Contents
380
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® uHFL Menus
Features
To delete a paired phone
1. Press the SETTINGS button.
2. Rotate to select Phone Settings, then
press .
u Repeat the procedure to select
Bluetooth Device List.
3. Rotate to select a phone you want to
delete, then press .
4. Rotate to select Delete This Device,
then press .
5. You will receive a confirmation message on
the screen. Rotate to select Yes, then
press .
6. You will receive a notification on the screen
if it is successful.
Table of Contents
Continued
381
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® uHFL Menus
Features
To turn on or off the text/e-mail
function
1. Press the SETTINGS button.
2. Rotate to select Phone Settings, then
press .
u Repeat the procedure to select Enable
Text/Email.
u A pop-up menu appears on the screen.
3. Rotate to select On or Off, then press
.
To turn on or off the text/e-mail notice
1. Press the SETTINGS button.
2. Rotate to select Phone Settings, then
press .
u Repeat the procedure to select New
Text/Email Alert.
u A pop-up menu appears on the screen.
3. Rotate to select On or Off, then press
.
To Set Up a Text Message/E-mail Options
1To turn on or off the text/e-mail notice
On: A pop-up notification comes on every time you
receive a new message.
Off: The message you receive is stored in the system
without notification.
Table of Contents
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® uHFL Menus
382
Features
To set up the auto reading option
1. Press the SETTINGS button.
2. Rotate to select System Settings, then
press .
u Repeat the procedure to select Message
Auto Reading.
u A pop-up menu appears on the screen.
3. Rotate to select On, Off or Auto, then
press .
1To set up the auto reading option
On: A text message/e-mail is always read aloud.
Off: A text message/e-mail is not read aloud.
Auto: A text message/e-mail is read aloud only when
driving.
Table of Contents
Continued
383
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® uHFL Menus
Features
You can protect each of the six cell phones with a security PIN.
1. Press the SETTINGS button.
2. Rotate to select Phone Settings, then
press .
u Repeat the procedure to select
Bluetooth Device List.
3. Rotate to select a phone you want to
add a security PIN to, then press .
4. Rotate to select Edit PIN, then press .
5. Enter a new four-digit number.
u
Rotate to select, then press .
Move to delete. Rotate to select
OK to enter the security PIN.
u
You can also enter a number using the
icons.
6. Re-enter the four-digit number.
u The screen returns to the screen in step
4.
To Create a Security PIN
1To Create a Security PIN
If the phone is already security PIN protected, you
need to enter the current security PIN before clearing
the PIN or creating a new one.
Audio/information screen
Audio with touch screen
Audio/information screen
Audio with touch screen
Table of Contents
384
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® uHFL Menus
Features
Edit the user name of a paired phone as
follows:
1. Press the SETTINGS button.
2. Rotate to select Phone Settings, then
press .
u Repeat the procedure to select
Bluetooth Device List.
3. Rotate to select a phone you want to
edit, then press .
4. Rotate to select Edit Device Name,
then press .
5. Enter a new name of the phone.
u
Rotate to select, then press .
Move to delete. Rotate or move
to select OK then press to enter the
name.
u
You can also enter a name using the
icons.
Editing User Name
Audio/information screen
Audio with touch screen
Audio/information screen
Audio with touch screen
Table of Contents
385
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® uHFL Menus
Continued
Features
If you get into the vehicle while you are on the phone, the call can be automatically
transferred to HFL.
1. Press the SETTINGS button.
2. Rotate to select Phone Settings, then
press .
u Repeat the procedure to select Auto
Transfer.
3. Rotate to select On, then press .
You can set HFL to automatically answer an incoming call in four seconds.
1. Press the SETTINGS button.
2. Rotate to select Phone Settings, then
press .
u Repeat the procedure to select Auto
Answer.
3. Rotate to select On, then press .
Automatic Transferring
Auto Answer
Table of Contents
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® uHFL Menus
386
Features
You can change the ring tone setting.
1. Press the SETTINGS button.
2. Rotate to select Phone Settings, then
press .
u Repeat the procedure to select Ring
Tone.
3. Rotate to select Fixed, Mobile Phone
or Off, then press .
You can display a caller’s picture on an incoming call screen.
1. Press the SETTINGS button.
2. Rotate to select Phone Settings, then
press .
u Repeat the procedure to select Use
Contact Photo.
3. Rotate to select On or Off, then press
.
Ring Tone
1Ring Tone
Fixed: The fixed ring tone sounds from the speaker.
Mobile Phone: The ring tone stored in the
connected cell phone sounds from the speaker.
Off: No ring tones sound from the speaker.
Use Contact Photo
Table of Contents
Continued
387
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® uHFL Menus
Features
When Automatic Phone Sync is set to
On:
When your phone is paired, the contents of its
phonebook and call history are automatically
imported to HFL.
Changing the Automatic Phone Sync
setting
1. Press the SETTINGS button.
2. Rotate to select Phone Settings, then
press .
u Repeat the procedure to select
Automatic Phone Sync.
3. Rotate to select On or Off, then press
.
Automatic Import of Cellular Phonebook and Call History
1Automatic Import of Cellular Phonebook and Call History
When you select a person from the list in the cellular
phonebook, you can see up to three category icons.
The icons indicate what types of numbers are stored
for that name.
On some phones, it may not be possible to import the
category icons to HFL.
The phonebook is updated after every connection.
Call history is updated after every connection or call.
Pref
Home
Mobile
Work Pager
Fax
Car
Other
Voice
Table of Contents
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® uHFL Menus
388
Features
Up to 20 speed dial numbers can be stored per phone.
To store a speed dial number:
1. Press the PHONE button.
2. Press the MENU button.
3. Rotate to select Speed Dial, then press
.
u Repeat the procedure to select New
Entry.
4. Rotate to select a place to choose a
number from, then press .
From Import from Call History:
u Select a number from the call history.
From Manual Input:
u Input the number manually.
From Import from Phonebook:
u Select a number from the linked cell
phone’s imported phonebook.
5. When the speed dial is successfully stored
from Import from Call History or Import
from Phonebook, you are asked to create
a voice tag for the number. Rotate to
select Yes or No, then press .
6. Using the button, follow the prompts to
store a voice tag for the speed dial entry.
Speed Dial
1Speed Dial
When a voice tag is stored, press the button to
call the number using the voice tag. Say “Call” and
the voice tag name.
Table of Contents
Continued
389
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® uHFL Menus
Features
To add a voice tag to a stored speed
dial number
1. Press the SETTINGS button.
2. Rotate to select Phone Settings, then
press .
u Repeat the procedure to select Edit
Speed Dial.
3. Select an existing speed dial entry.
u From the pop-up menu, rotate to
select Edit, then press .
4. Rotate to select Voice Tag, then press
.
u From the pop-up menu, rotate to
select Record, then press .
5. Using the button, follow the prompts to
complete the voice tag.
1Speed Dial
Avoid using duplicate voice tags.
Avoid using “home” as a voice tag.
It is easier for HFL to recognize a longer name. For
example, use “John Smith” instead of “John.”
Table of Contents
390
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® uHFL Menus
Features
To delete a voice tag
1. Press the SETTINGS button.
2. Rotate to select Phone Settings, then
press .
u Repeat the procedure to select Edit
Speed Dial.
3. Select an existing speed dial entry.
u From the pop-up menu, rotate to
select Edit, then press .
4. Rotate to select Voice Tag, then press
.
u From the pop-up menu, rotate to
select Clear, then press .
5. You will receive a confirmation message on
the screen. Rotate to select Yes, then
press .
To delete a speed dial
1. Press the SETTINGS button.
2. Rotate to select Phone Settings, then
press .
u Repeat the procedure to select Edit
Speed Dial.
3. Select an existing speed dial entry.
u From the pop-up menu, rotate to
select Delete, then press .
4. You will receive a confirmation message on
the screen. Rotate to select Yes, then
press .
Table of Contents
Continued
391
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® uHFL Menus
Features
Add phonetic modifications or a new voice tag to the phone’s contact name so that
it is easier for HFL to recognize voice commands.
To add a new voice tag
1. Press the SETTINGS button.
2. Rotate to select System Settings, then
press .
3. Rotate to select Phonebook Phonetic
Modification, then press .
4. Rotate to select the phone you want to
add phonetic modification to, then press
.
Phonebook Phonetic Modification
1Phonebook Phonetic Modification
Phonetic Modification is grayed out when Song By
Voice is set to Off.
You can store up to 20 phonetic modification items.
Table of Contents
392
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® uHFL Menus
Features
5. Rotate to select New Voice Tag, then
press .
6. Move or and rotate to select a
contact name, then press .
u The pop-up menu appears on the screen.
7. Rotate to select Modify, then press .
8. Using the button, follow the prompts to
complete the voice tag.
9. You will receive a confirmation message on
the screen. Rotate to select OK, then
press .
Table of Contents
Continued
393
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® uHFL Menus
Features
To modify a voice tag
1. Press the SETTINGS button.
2. Rotate to select System Settings, then
press .
3. Rotate to select Phonebook Phonetic
Modification, then press .
4. Rotate to select the phone you want to
add phonetic modification to, then press
.
5. Rotate to select a contact name you
want to modify, then press .
u The pop-up menu appears on the screen.
6. Rotate to select Modify, then press .
7. Using the button, follow the prompts to
complete the voice tag.
8. You will receive a confirmation message on
the screen. Rotate to select OK, then
press .
1Phonebook Phonetic Modification
You can only modify or delete contact names for the
currently connected phone.
Table of Contents
394
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® uHFL Menus
Features
To delete a modified voice tag
1. Press the SETTINGS button.
2. Rotate to select System Settings, then
press .
3. Rotate to select Phonebook Phonetic
Modification, then press .
4. Rotate to select the phone you want to
delete phonetic modification, then press
.
5. Rotate to select a contact name you
want to delete, then press .
u The pop-up menu appears on the screen.
6. Rotate to select Delete, then press .
7. Move and rotate to select OK, then
press .
Table of Contents
395
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® uHFL Menus
Continued
Features
To delete all modified voice tags
1. Press the SETTINGS button.
2. Rotate to select System Settings, then
press .
3. Rotate to select Phonebook Phonetic
Modification, then press .
4. Rotate to select the phone you want to
delete phonetic modification, then press
.
u The contact name list appears.
5. Move and rotate to select Delete All,
then press .
6. You will receive a confirmation message on
the screen. Rotate to select Yes, then
press .
Connect phone
Connect phone
Phone#2
Phone#1
Phone#3
Table of Contents
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® uHFL Menus
396
Features
You can make calls by inputting any phone
number, or by using the imported
phonebook, call history, speed dial entries, or
redial.
Making a Call
1Making a Call
Any voice-tagged speed dial entry, phonebook name,
or number can be dialed by voice from most screens.
Press the button and say “Call” and the
phonebook name, phone number, or stored voice
tag.
The maximum range between your phone and
vehicles is 30 feet (10 meters).
Once a call is connected, you can hear the voice of
the person you are calling through the audio
speakers.
Table of Contents
Continued
397
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® uHFL Menus
Features
To make a call using the imported
phonebook
1. Press the PHONE button.
2. Press the MENU button.
3. Rotate to select Phonebook, then
press .
4. The phonebook is stored alphabetically.
Move to Search.
u You can use the keyboard on the touch
screen for an alphabetical search.
5. Rotate to select a number, then press
.
u Dialing starts automatically.
1To make a call using the imported phonebook
This function is disabled while the vehicle is moving.
However, you can call a stored voice-tagged speed
dial number, phonebook name, or number using
voice commands.
2 Limitations for Manual Operation P. 371
2 Speed Dial P. 388
You can use the keyboard on the audio with touch
screen for an alphabetical search.
Table of Contents
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® uHFL Menus
398
Features
To make a call using a phone number
1. Press the PHONE button.
2. Press the MENU button.
3. Rotate to select Dial, then press .
4. Rotate to select a number, then press
.
5. Rotate to select , then press .
u Dialing starts automatically.
To make a call using redial
1. Press the PHONE button.
2. Press the MENU button.
3. Rotate to select Redial, then press .
u Dialing starts automatically.
1To make a call using a phone number
This function is disabled while the vehicle is moving.
However, you can call a stored voice-tagged speed
dial number, phonebook name, or number using
voice commands.
2 Limitations for Manual Operation P. 371
2 Speed Dial P. 388
You can use the keyboard on the audio with touch
screen to input numbers.
Select numbers, then to start dialing.
Table of Contents
Continued
399
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® uHFL Menus
Features
To make a call using the call history
1. Press the PHONE button.
2. Press the MENU button.
3. Rotate to select Call History, then
press .
4. Move or to select All, Dialed,
Received, and Missed.
5. Rotate to select a number, then press
.
u Dialing starts automatically.
To make a call using a speed dial entry
1. Press the PHONE button.
2. Press the MENU button.
3. Rotate to select Speed Dial, then press
.
4. Rotate to select a number, then press
.
u Dialing starts automatically.
1To make a call using the call history
The call history displays the last 20 dialed, received, or
missed calls.
(Appears only when a phone is connected to HFL.)
These icons next to the number indicate the
following:
: Dialed calls.
: Received calls.
: Missed calls.
1To make a call using a speed dial entry
Move to select More Speed Dials to view another
paired phone’s speed dial list. You can make a call
from that list using the currently connected phone.
When a voice tag is stored, press the button to
call the number using the voice tag.
2 Speed Dial P. 388
Any voice-tagged speed dial entry, phonebook name
or number can be dialed by voice from any screen.
Press the button and follow the prompts.
Table of Contents
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® uHFL Menus
400
Features
When there is an incoming call, an audible
notification sounds (if activated) and the
Incoming call screen appears.
Press the button to answer the call.
Press the button to decline or end the call.
Receiving a Call
1Receiving a Call
Call Waiting
Press the button to put the current call on hold to
answer the incoming call.
Press the button again to return to the current
call.
Ignore the incoming call if you do not want to answer
it.
Press the button if you want to hang up the
current call.
You can select the icons on the audio with touch
screen instead of the and buttons.
Table of Contents
Continued
401
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® uHFL Menus
Features
The following options are available during a call.
Mute: Mute your voice.
Transfer: Transfer a call from HFL to your phone.
Touch Tones: Send numbers during a call. This is useful when you call a menu-
driven phone system.
The available options are shown on the Phone
screen.
Rotate to select the mute option, then
press .
u The mute icon appears when Mute is
selected. Select Mute again to turn it off.
Options During a Call
1Options During a Call
Touch Tones: Available on some phones.
You can select the icons on the audio with touch
screen.
Mute Icon
Table of Contents
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® uHFL Menus
402
Features
HFL can display newly received text messages and e-mails as well as 20 of the most
recently received messages on a linked cell phone. Each received message can be
read aloud and replied to using a fixed common phrase.
1. A pop-up appears and notifies you of a new
text message or e-mail.
2. Rotate to select Read to listen to the
message, then press .
u The text message or e-mail is displayed.
The system automatically starts reading
out the message.
3. To discontinue the message read-out, press
.
Receiving a Text Message/E-mail
1Receiving a Text Message/E-mail
The system does not display any received messages
while you are driving. You can only hear them read
aloud.
With some phones, you may be able to display up to
20 most recent text messages and e-mails.
State or local laws may limit your use of the HFL text
message/e-mail feature. Only use the text message/
e-mail feature when conditions allow you to do so
safely.
When you receive a text message or e-mail for the
first time since the phone is paired to HFL, you are
asked to turn the New Text/Email Alert setting to
On.
2 To turn on or off the text/e-mail notice
P. 381
Table of Contents
Continued
403
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® uHFL Menus
Features
If a paired phone has text message or mail accounts, you can select one of them to
be active and receive notifications.
1. Press the SETTINGS button.
2. Rotate to select Phone Settings, then
press .
u Repeat the procedure to select Select
Account.
3. Rotate to select Text message or an
e-mail account you want, then press .
Selecting a Mail Account
1Selecting a Mail Account
You can also select a mail account from the folder list
screen or the message list screen.
Move to select Select Account, then press .
You can only receive notifications from one text
message or mail account at a time.
Table of Contents
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® uHFL Menus
404
Features
Displaying text messages
1. Press the PHONE button.
2. Press the MENU button.
3. Rotate to select Text/Email, then press
.
u Select account if necessary.
4. Rotate to select a message, then press
.
u The text message is displayed. The
system automatically starts reading the
message aloud.
Displaying Messages
1Displaying Messages
The icon appears next to an unread message.
If you delete a message on the phone, the message is
also deleted in the system. If you send a message
from the system, the message goes to your phone’s
outbox.
To see the previous or next message, move or
on the text message screen.
Message List
Text Message
Table of Contents
Continued
405
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® uHFL Menus
Features
Displaying e-mails
1. Press the PHONE button.
2. Press the MENU button.
3. Rotate to select Text/Email, then press
.
4. Rotate to select a folder, then press .
5. Rotate to select a message, then press
.
u The e-mail is displayed. The system
automatically starts reading the message
aloud.
1Displaying e-mails
Received text messages and e-mails may appear in
the message list screen at the same time. In this case,
text messages are titled No subject.
Folder List
Message List
E-mail
Table of Contents
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® uHFL Menus
406
Features
Read or stop reading a message
1. Go to the text message or e-mail screen.
u The system automatically starts reading
the message aloud.
2 Displaying Messages P. 404
2. Press to stop reading.
Press again to start reading the message
from the beginning.
Reply to a message
1. Go to the text message or e-mail screen.
u The system automatically starts reading
the message aloud.
2 Displaying Messages P. 404
2. Move and rotate to select Reply,
then press .
3. Rotate to select the reply message, then
press .
u The pop-up menu appears on the screen.
4. Select Send to send the message.
u Complete appears on the screen when
the reply message was successfully sent.
1Reply to a message
The available fixed reply messages are as follows:
Talk to you later, I’m driving.
I’m on my way.
I’m running late.
OK
Yes
No
You cannot add, edit, or delete reply messages.
Table of Contents
407
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® uHFL Menus
Features
Making a call to a sender
1. Go to the text message screen.
u The system automatically starts reading
the message aloud.
2 Displaying text messages P. 404
2. Move and rotate to select Call, then
press .
John 0123456789####
Reply Call
Table of Contents
408
Table of Contents
409
Driving
This chapter discusses driving, refueling, and information on items such as accessories.
Before Driving
Driving Preparation .......................... 410
Maximum Load Limit........................413
Towing a Trailer
Towing Your Vehicle........................ 415
When Driving
Turning on the Power ...................... 416
Precautions While Driving.................419
Transmission .................................... 419
Shifting............................................ 420
ECON Button ................................... 422
Acoustic Vehicle Alerting System...... 423
Cruise Control
*
................................ 424
Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC)
*
....... 427
Forward Collision Warning (FCW)
*
.. 435
Lane Departure Warning (LDW)
*
..... 439
Vehicle Stability Assist (VSA
®
), aka Electronic
Stability Control (ESC), System ............... 443
LaneWatch
TM
....................................... 445
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)... 447
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) -
Required Federal Explanation ......... 449
High Voltage Battery........................ 451
Braking
Brake System ................................... 452
Anti-lock Brake System (ABS) ........... 454
Brake Assist System ......................... 455
Parking Your Vehicle
When Stopped ................................ 456
Multi-View Rear Camera.................. 457
Rearview Camera ............................. 458
Refueling
Fuel Information .............................. 459
How to Refuel ................................. 460
Fuel Economy
Improving Fuel Economy.................. 461
Accessories and Modifications ........ 462
* Not available on all models
Main Menu
410
Driving
Before Driving
Driving Preparation
Check the following items before you start driving.
Make sure there are no obstructions on the windows, door mirrors, exterior
lights, or other parts of the vehicle.
u Remove any frost, snow, or ice.
u Remove any snow on the roof, as this can slip down and obstruct your field of
vision while driving. If frozen solid, remove ice once it has softened.
u When removing ice from around the wheels, be sure not to damage the wheel
or wheel components.
Make sure the hood is securely closed.
u If the hood opens while driving, your front view will be blocked.
Make sure the tires are in good condition.
u Check air pressure, check for damage and excessive wear.
2 Checking and Maintaining Tires P. 493
Make sure there are no people or objects behind or around the vehicle.
u There are blind spots from the inside.
Exterior Checks
1Exterior Checks
NOTICE
When doors are frozen shut, use warm water around
the door edges to melt any ice. Do not try to force
them open, as this can damage the rubber trim
around the doors. When done, wipe dry to avoid
further freezing.
Do not pour warm water into the key cylinder.
You will be unable to insert the key if the water
freezes in the hole.
Heat from the engine and exhaust can ignite
flammable materials left under the hood, causing a
fire. If you've parked your vehicle for an extended
period, inspect and remove any debris that may have
collected, such as dried grass and leaves that have
fallen or have been carried in for use as a nest by a
small animal.
Also check under the hood for leftover flammable
materials after you or someone else has performed
maintenance on your vehicle.
Table of Contents
Continued
411
uuBefore DrivinguDriving Preparation
Driving
Store or secure all items on board properly.
u Carrying too much cargo, or improperly storing it, can affect your vehicle's
handling, stability, stopping distance, and tires, and make it unsafe.
2 Maximum Load Limit P. 413
Do not pile items higher than the seat height.
u They can block your view and may be thrown forward in the event of sudden
braking.
Do not place anything in the front seat footwells. Make sure to secure the floor
mat.
u An object or unsecured floor mat can interfere with your brake and accelerator
pedal operation while driving.
If you have any animals on board, do not let them move around in the vehicle.
u They may interfere with driving and a crash could occur.
Securely close and lock all doors and the trunk.
2 Locking/Unlocking the Doors from the Inside P. 118
Adjust your seating position properly.
u Adjust the head restraint, too.
2 Adjusting the Seats P. 148
2 Adjusting the Head Restraints P. 151
Adjust the mirrors and steering wheel properly for your driving.
u Adjust them while sitting in the proper driving position.
2 Adjusting the Mirrors P. 146
2 Adjusting the Steering Wheel P. 145
Interior Checks
1Interior Checks
The headlight aim is set by the factory, and does not
need to be adjusted. However, if you regularly carry
heavy items in the trunk, have the aiming readjusted
at a dealer or by a qualified technician.
Table of Contents
412
uuBefore DrivinguDriving Preparation
Driving
Be sure items placed on the floor behind the front seats cannot roll under the
seats.
u They can interfere with the driver's ability to operate the pedals, the operation
of the seats, or the operation of the sensors under the seats.
Everyone in the vehicle must fasten their seat belt.
2 Fastening a Seat Belt P. 39
Make sure that the indicators in the instrument panel come on when you start the
vehicle, and go off soon after.
u Always have a dealer check the vehicle if a problem is indicated.
2 Indicators P. 72
Table of Contents
413
uuBefore DrivinguMaximum Load Limit
Continued
Driving
Maximum Load Limit
The maximum load for your vehicle is 850 lbs (385 kg).
See Tire and Loading Information label attached to the driver's doorjamb.
This figure includes the total weight of all occupants, cargo, and
accessories, and the tongue load if you are towing a trailer.
Steps for Determining Correct Load Limit -
(1) Locate the statement “The combined weight of occupants and
cargo should never exceed XXX kg or XXX lbs.” on your
vehicle's placard.
(2) Determine the combined weight of the driver and passengers
that will be riding in your vehicle.
(3) Subtract the combined weight of the driver and passengers
from XXX kg or XXX lbs.
(4) The resulting figure equals the available amount of cargo and
luggage load capacity. For example, if the “XXX” amount
equals 1,400 lbs. and there will be five 150 lb. passengers in
your vehicle, the amount of available cargo and luggage load
capacity is 650 lbs.
(1,400 - 750 (5 x 150) = 650 lbs.)
1Maximum Load Limit
Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR):
The maximum allowable weight of the vehicle, all
occupants, all accessories and all cargo.
2 Specifications P. 538
Gross Axle Weight Rating (GAWR):
The maximum allowable weight of the vehicle axle.
2 Specifications P. 538
3
WARNING
Overloading or improper loading
can affect handling and stability
and cause a crash in which you
can be hurt or killed.
Follow all load limits and other
loading guidelines in this manual.
Label Example
Table of Contents
414
uuBefore DrivinguMaximum Load Limit
Driving
(5) Determine the combined weight of luggage and cargo being
loaded on the vehicle. That weight may not safely exceed the
available cargo and luggage load capacity calculated in step 4.
(6) If your vehicle will be towing a trailer, load from your trailer will
be transferred to your vehicle. Consult this manual to
determine how this reduces the available cargo and luggage
load capacity of your vehicle.
In addition, the total weight of the vehicle, all occupants,
accessories, cargo, and trailer tongue load must not exceed the
Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR) or the Gross Axle Weight
Rating (GAWR). Both are on a label on the driver’s doorjamb.
Load Limits Example
Example1
Max Load
850 lbs
(385 kg)
Passenger Weight
150 lbs x 2 = 300 lbs
(68 kg x 2 = 136 kg)
Cargo Weight
550 lbs
(249 kg)
Example2
Max Load
850 lbs
(385 kg)
Passenger Weight
150 lbs x 5 = 750 lbs
(68 kg x 5 = 340 kg)
Cargo Weight
100 lbs
(45 kg)
Table of Contents
415
Driving
Towing a Trailer
Your vehicle is not designed to tow a trailer. Attempting to do so can void your
warranties.
Towing Your Vehicle
Your vehicle is not designed to be towed behind a motor home. If your vehicle needs
to be towed in an emergency, refer to the emergency towing information.
2 Emergency Towing P. 535
Table of Contents
416
Driving
When Driving
Turning on the Power
1. Make sure the parking brake is applied.
2. Check that the shift lever is in
(P , then
depress the brake pedal.
u Although it is possible to start the vehicle
in
(N , it is safer to start it in (P .
1When Driving
When you set the power mode to ON, you may feel
as if the brake pedal is sinking down. This is normal.
1Turning on the Power
Keep your foot firmly on the brake pedal when
starting the power system.
The engine is harder to start in cold weather and in
thinner air found at altitudes above 8,000 feet (2,400
meters).
When turning on the power system in cold weather,
turn off all electrical accessories such as the lights,
climate control system, and rear defogger in order to
reduce the 12-volt battery drain.
If you live in a region where winter is extremely cold,
an engine block heater will improve starting and
warming of the engine. If temperatures consistently
below -22°F (-30°C) are expected, the coolant
mixture should be changed to a higher concentration
to prevent freezing. Consult a dealer for details.
If the exhaust system sounds abnormal or you can
smell exhaust gas inside the vehicle, have your vehicle
checked by a dealer. There may be a problem with
the engine or exhaust system.
Brake Pedal
Table of Contents
Continued
417
uuWhen DrivinguTurning on the Power
Driving
2. Press the POWER button without
depressing the accelerator pedal.
u The Ready To Drive message appears
on the multi-information display and a
buzzer sounds.
1Turning on the Power
The immobilizer system protects your vehicle from
theft.
If an improperly coded device is used, the power
system does not activate.
2 Immobilizer System P. 126
Bring the smart entry remote close to the POWER
button if the battery in the smart entry remote is
weak.
2 If the Smart Entry Remote Battery is Weak
P. 520
The power system may not activate if the smart entry
remote is subjected to strong radio waves.
Table of Contents
uuWhen DrivinguTurning on the Power
418
Driving
You can turn the power system off when the vehicle is completely stopped.
1. Shift to
(P .
2. Press the POWER button.
1. Keeping your right foot on the brake pedal, release the parking brake. Check that
the parking brake indicator has gone off.
2 Parking Brake P. 452
2. Put the shift lever in
(D . Select (R when reversing.
3. Gradually release the brake pedal and gently depress the accelerator pedal to pull
away.
Hill start assist system
Hill start assist keeps the brake engaged briefly to help prevent the vehicle from
rolling on inclines as you move your foot from the brake pedal to the accelerator.
Move the shift lever to
(D or when facing uphill, or (R when facing downhill,
then release the brake pedal.
Stopping the Power System
Starting to Drive
B
1Hill start assist system
Hill start assist may not prevent the vehicle from
rolling downhill on a very steep or slippery slope, and
does not operate on small inclines.
Hill start assist is not a replacement for the parking
brake.
Table of Contents
419
uuWhen DrivinguPrecautions While Driving
Driving
Precautions While Driving
Avoid driving in deep water and on flooded roads. This can damage the power
system or driveline, or cause electrical component failure.
If there is a strong impact with something under the vehicle, stop in a safe location.
Check the underside of the vehicle for damage or any fluid leaks.
Transmission
As with a conventional gasoline-powered vehicle with an automatic transmission,
this vehicle will creep.
Keep the brake pedal firmly depressed when stopped.
Quickly depressing the accelerator pedal while driving uphill may cause the vehicle
to react similar to an automatic transmission vehicle, unexpectedly increasing vehicle
speed. Depress the accelerator pedal carefully, especially on slippery roads and
curves.
In Rain
Other Precautions
Creeping
Kickdown
1Precautions While Driving
NOTICE
Do not operate the shift lever while pressing the
accelerator pedal. You could damage the
transmission.
If the power mode is set to ACCESSORY while
driving, the power system will shut down and all
steering and brake power assist functions will stop,
making it difficult to control the vehicle.
Do not put the shift lever in
(N , as you will lose
regerative braking (and acceleration) performance.
During the first 600 miles (1,000 km) of operation,
avoid sudden acceleration or full throttle operation so
as to not damage the powertrain.
Avoid hard braking for the first 200 miles (300 km).
You should also follow this when the brake pads are
replaced.
NOTICE
If you repeatedly turn the steering wheel at an
extremely low speed, or hold the steering wheel on
the full left or right position for a while, the electric
power steering (EPS) system heats up. The system
goes into a protective mode, and limits its
performance. The steering wheel becomes harder
and harder to operate. Once the system cools down,
the EPS system is restored.
Repeated operation under these conditions can
eventually damage the system.
Table of Contents
420
uuWhen DrivinguShifting
Driving
Shifting
Change the shift position in accordance with your driving needs.
Shift lever positions
1Shifting
While the High Voltage battery level is full, or the
High Voltage battery temperature is low,
regenerative braking may become less effective.
You cannot change the power mode from ON to
VEHICLE OFF (LOCK) unless the shift lever is in P.
When shifting positions in extremely low
temperatures (-22°F/-30°C), there may be a short
delay before the shift position is displayed. Always
confirm you are in the correct shift position before
driving.
Park
Used when parking or turning the
power on or off.
Reverse
Used when reversing.
Neutral
Propulsion power is not transmitted to
wheels.
Drive
Used for normal driving.
Release Button
Drive (B)
Used when driving down a long hill and
to increase regenerative braking.
Table of Contents
421
uuWhen Driving uShifting
Driving
Shift Lever Operation
1Shift Lever Operation
When you change the shift lever from
(D to (R and
vice versa, come to a complete stop and keep the
brake pedal depressed.
Use the shift lever position indicator to check the
lever position before pulling away.
If the transmission indicator blinks when driving, in
any shift position, there is a problem with the
transmission.
Avoid sudden acceleration and have the transmission
checked by a dealer as soon as possible.
It may not be possible to operate the shift lever if the
brake pedal is applied while the shift lever release
button is held down.
Depress the brake pedal first.
Shift Lever Position Indicator
Shift without pressing the shift lever
release button.
Press the shift lever release button
and shift.
Depress the brake pedal and press the
shift lever release button to shift.
Table of Contents
422
uuWhen DrivinguECON Button
Driving
ECON Button
The ECON button turns the ECON mode on and off.
The ECON mode helps you improve your driving range by adjusting the performance
of the climate control system.
Table of Contents
423
uuWhen DrivinguAcoustic Vehicle Alerting System
Driving
Acoustic Vehicle Alerting System
Alerts pedestrians when a vehicle is propelled solely by electricity, approaching at
speeds around 12 mph (20 km/h) or less.
Press the button to turn the system on and
off.
u The indicator in the button comes on
when the system is off.
The system is turned on every time you turn
the power system on, even if you turned it off
the last time you drove the vehicle.
Acoustic Vehicle Alerting System Button
Canadian models
Table of Contents
424
uuWhen DrivinguCruise Control
*
Driving
Cruise Control
*
Maintains a constant vehicle speed without having to keep your foot on the
accelerator. Use cruise control on freeways or open roads where you can travel at a
constant speed with little acceleration or deceleration.
1Cruise Control
*
It may not be possible to maintain a constant speed
when driving uphill or downhill.
When not using cruise control:
Turn off cruise control by pressing the CRUISE
button.
While in the ECON mode, it may take relatively more
time to accelerate to maintain the set speed.
3
WARNING
Improper use of the cruise control can lead
to a crash.
Use the cruise control only when traveling
on open highways in good weather.
When to use
Shift position for cruise control:
In
(D
Always keep sufficient distance
between you and the vehicle in
front of you.
Vehicle speed for cruise control:
Desired speed in a range above
roughly 25 mph (40 km/h) ~
How to use
CRUISE MAIN is on in the
multi-information display.
Cruise control is ready to use.
Press the CRUISE button on
the steering wheel.
* Not available on all models
Table of Contents
425
uuWhen DrivinguCruise Control
*
Continued
Driving
Take your foot off the pedal and press the –/SET button when you reach the desired
speed.
The moment you release the –/SET button, the set speed is fixed, and cruise control
begins. CRUISE CONTROL appears on the multi-information display.
To Set the Vehicle Speed
–/SET Button
On when cruise
control begins
Press and release
OnOn
Table of Contents
uuWhen DrivinguCruise Control
*
426
Driving
Increase or decrease the vehicle speed using the RES/+ or –/SET buttons on the
steering wheel.
Each time you press the button, the vehicle speed is increased or decreased by
about 1 mph (1.6 km/h).
If you keep the button pressed, the vehicle speed increases or decreases until you
release it. This speed is then set.
To cancel cruise control, do any of the
following:
Press the CANCEL button.
Press the CRUISE button.
Depress the brake pedal.
CRUISE CONTROL on the multi-information
display disappears.
To Adjust the Vehicle Speed
1To Adjust the Vehicle Speed
You can set the vehicle speed using the –/SET button
on the steering wheel when adjusting the speed with
the accelerator and brake pedals.
To Cancel
To decrease speed
To increase speed
1To Cancel
Resuming the prior set speed:
After cruise control has been canceled, you can still
resume the prior set speed by pressing the RES/+
button while driving at a speed of at least 25 mph
(40 km/h) or more.
You cannot set or resume in the following situations:
When vehicle speed is less than 25 mph (40 km/h)
When the CRUISE button is turned off
At vehicle speeds of 22 mph (35 km/h) or less, cruise
control is canceled automatically.
CRUISE
Button
CANCEL
Button
Table of Contents
427
uuWhen DrivinguAdaptive Cruise Control (ACC)
*
Continued
Driving
Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC)
*
Helps maintain a constant vehicle speed and a set following distance behind a
vehicle detected ahead of yours, without you having to keep your foot on the brake
or the accelerator.
1Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC)
*
Important Reminder
As with any system, there are limits to ACC. Use the
brake pedal whenever necessary, and always keep a
safe distance between your vehicle and other
vehicles.
The radar sensor for ACC is shared with FCW
(Forward Collision Warning).
2 Forward Collision Warning (FCW)
*
P. 435
3
WARNING
Improper use of ACC can lead to a crash.
Use ACC only when traveling on open
highways in good weather.
3
WARNING
ACC has limited braking capability.
When your vehicle speed drops below
22 mph (35 km/h), ACC will
automatically cancel and no longer will
apply your vehicle’s brakes.
Always be prepared to apply the brake
pedal when conditions require.
When to use
Vehicle speed for adaptive cruise control:
Desired speed in a range above roughly 25
mph (40 km/h) ~
Shift position for adaptive cruise control:
In
(D
The radar sensor is inside the front
grille on the right side.
How to use
Press the MAIN button on
the steering wheel.
ACC (green) is on in the
multi-information
display.
Adaptive cruise control is
ready to use.
* Not available on all models
Table of Contents
uuWhen DrivinguAdaptive Cruise Control (ACC)
*
428
Driving
Take your foot off the pedal and press the –/SET button when you reach the desired
speed.
The moment you release the –/SET button,
the set speed is fixed, and adaptive cruise
control begins.
u A vehicle icon and distance bars appear
on the multi-information display.
To Set the Vehicle Speed
1Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC)
*
Do not use ACC under these conditions:
In poor visibility.
In heavy traffic.
When you must slow down and speed up
repeatedly.
On winding roads.
When you enter a toll gate, interchange, service
area, parking area, etc. In these areas, there is no
vehicle ahead of you, but ACC would still try to
accelerate to your set speed.
In bad weather (rain, fog, snow, etc.).
On a slippery road (for example a road covered
with ice or snow).
When going down a steep hill where the
regenerative braking does not work sufficiently.
When not using adaptive cruise control: Turn off
adaptive cruise by pressing the MAIN button.
1To Set the Vehicle Speed
You can switch the displayed set speed
measurements on the multi-information display
between mph and km/h.
2 Customized Features P. 101, 293
On when adaptive
cruise control
begins
Press and release
–/SET Button
Set Vehicle
Speed
Set Vehicle
Distance
* Not available on all models
Table of Contents
Continued
429
uuWhen DrivinguAdaptive Cruise Control (ACC)
*
Driving
The radar sensor monitors the distance between your vehicle and a vehicle ahead of
you. When the sensor detects a change in distance, the system responds it by
accelerating or braking your vehicle in order to maintain the set speed and following
distance as necessary.
When in Operation
1When in Operation
If the vehicle ahead of you slows down abruptly, or if
another vehicle cuts in front of you, the beeper
sounds and a message appears on the multi-
information display to alert you to brake.
Depress the brake pedal, and keep an appropriate
distance from the vehicle ahead.
Even if the distance between your vehicle and the
vehicle ahead is short, FCW may not alert you or ACC
may start accelerating your vehicle under the
following circumstances:
The vehicle ahead of you is going at almost the
same speed as, or faster than your vehicle.
A vehicle cuts in front of you is going faster than
your vehicle, gradually distancing itself from you.
If you do not want to hear a beep when the system
detects a vehicle, or when the vehicle goes out of
ACC range, you can change the pre-running detect
car beep setting.
2 Customized Features P. 101, 293
Beep
When ACC detects a
vehicle within ACC range:
When the vehicle goes
out of ACC range:
The beeper sounds once and
the vehicle icon appears on the
multi-information display.
The beeper sounds once
and the vehicle icon on the
multi-information display
becomes a dotted-line
contour.
ACC Range: 328 ft. (100 m)
Table of Contents
uuWhen DrivinguAdaptive Cruise Control (ACC)
*
430
Driving
There is no vehicle ahead
Your vehicle cruises at the set speed.
A vehicle ahead is within ACC range and going slower than the set speed
Your vehicle slows down, and maintains the same speed as the speed of the vehicle
ahead to maintain the set following distance.
A vehicle ahead is within ACC range and going at a steady speed
Your vehicle follows the vehicle ahead of it, keeping a constant distance, without
going beyond the set speed.
A vehicle ahead goes out of range
ACC accelerates your vehicle to the set speed, and then maintains it.
When you depress the accelerator pedal
You can temporarily increase the vehicle speed. In this case, there is no audible or
visual alerts even if a vehicle is in ACC range.
ACC stays on unless you cancel it. Once you release the accelerator pedal, the
system resumes the set speed.
1When in Operation
Limitations
Be aware that ACC has limitations. For example, it is
not designed to operate when a vehicle ahead of
yours is going slower than 13 mph (20 km/h) or is
parked. Smaller vehicles, such as motorcycles, may
also be difficult for the system to detect depending
on their size.
You must always be prepared to use the brake pedal
to maintain a safe distance with other vehicles.
ACC may momentarily apply brakes or sound an alert
if there is a vehicle or building adjacent to your
vehicle and:
You make a sudden turn or are driving on a narrow
road.
You abruptly move the steering wheel.
Your vehicle is unusually positioned within your
lane (e.g., at a slight diagonal to the lane direction).
Table of Contents
Continued
431
uuWhen DrivinguAdaptive Cruise Control (ACC)
*
Driving
Increase or decrease the vehicle speed using the RES/+ or –/SET buttons on the
steering wheel.
Each time you press the button, the vehicle speed is increased or decreased by
about 1 mph or 1 km/h accordingly.
If you keep the button pressed, the vehicle speed increases or decreases by about
5 mph or 5 km/h accordingly.
Press the (distance) button to change ACC
range.
Each time you press the button, the following
distance (the distance behind a vehicle
detected ahead of you) setting cycles through
short, middle, long, and extra long following
distances.
To Adjust the Vehicle Speed
1To Adjust the Vehicle Speed
If a vehicle ahead is going at a speed slower than your
increased set speed, ACC may not accelerate your
vehicle. This is to maintain the set following distance
between your vehicle and the vehicle ahead.
You can set the vehicle speed using the –/SET button
on the steering wheel when adjusting the speed with
the accelerator and brake pedals.
To Change Vehicle Distance
To increase speed
To decrease speed
Distance Button
Table of Contents
432
uuWhen DrivinguAdaptive Cruise Control (ACC)
*
Driving
Determine the most appropriate following distance setting based on your specific
driving conditions. Be sure to adhere to any following distance requirements set by
local regulation.
The higher your selected set speed is, the greater the short, middle, long or extra
long following distance becomes. See the following examples for your reference.
Vehicle Distance
When the vehicle speed is:
50 mph (80 km/h) 65 mph (104 km/h)
Short
84 feet
26 meters
1.1 sec
102 feet
31 meters
1.1 sec
Middle
111 feet
34 meters
1.5 sec
139 feet
43 meters
1.5 sec
Long
155 feet
48 meters
2.1 sec
202 feet
62 meters
2.1 sec
Extra
Long
215 feet
66 meters
3.0 sec
285 feet
87 meters
3.0 sec
Table of Contents
Continued
433
uuWhen DrivinguAdaptive Cruise Control (ACC)
*
Driving
To cancel adaptive cruise control, do any of
the following:
Press the CANCEL button.
Press the MAIN button.
u ACC Off appears on the multi-
information display.
Depress the brake pedal.
Automatic cancellation
The beeper sounds and a message appears on the multi-information display when
ACC is automatically canceled. Any of these conditions may cause the ACC
cancellation:
Your vehicle speed slows down to 22 mph (35 km/h) and below.
Bad weather (rain, fog, snow, etc.).
When the radar sensor inside the front grille gets dirty.
The vehicle ahead of you cannot be detected.
An abnormal tire condition is detected, or the tires are skidding.
Driving on a mountainous road, or driving off road for extended periods.
Abrupt steering wheel movement.
When the ABS or VSA is activated.
When the ABS or VSA indicator comes on.
To Cancel
1To Cancel
Resuming the prior set speed: After you have
canceled adaptive cruise control, you can resume the
prior set speed while it is still displayed. Press the
RES/+ button when driving at a speed of at least 25
mph (40 km/h) or more.
You cannot set or resume in the following situations:
When vehicle speed is less than 25 mph (40km/h).
When the MAIN button is turned off.
CANCEL
Button
MAIN
Button
1Automatic cancellation
Even though adaptive cruise control has been
automatically canceled, you can still resume the prior
set speed. Wait until the condition that caused ACC
to cancel improves, then press the RES/+ button.
Table of Contents
uuWhen DrivinguAdaptive Cruise Control (ACC)
*
434
Driving
Press and hold the (distance) button for one second.
Cruise Mode Selected appears on the multi-information display for two seconds,
and then the mode switches to Cruise.
To switch back to ACC, press and hold the button again for one second.
To Switch ACC to Cruise Control
1To Switch ACC to Cruise Control
Always be aware which mode you are in. When you
are driving in Cruise Mode, be more cautious about
keeping a safe distance from a vehicle ahead of you.
ACC ON
Cruise
Control ON
Distance Button
Table of Contents
435
uuWhen DrivinguForward Collision Warning (FCW)
*
Continued
Driving
Forward Collision Warning (FCW)
*
Alerts you when it determines that there is a possibility that your vehicle may collide
with a vehicle detected in front of yours.
If the system determines a collision is possible, it gives both visual and audible alerts,
including a heads-up warning that flashes on the windshield.
u Take appropriate action to prevent a collision (apply the brakes, change lanes,
etc.).
How the system works
The system may give warnings of potential collisions when your vehicle speed is
above 10 mph (15 km/h).
1Forward Collision Warning (FCW)
*
Important Safety Reminder
FCW cannot detect all objects ahead and may not
detect a given object; accuracy of the system will vary
based on weather, speed and other factors. FCW
does not include a braking function. It is always your
responsibility to safely operate the vehicle and avoid
collisions.
You can change the Forward Collision Warning
Distance setting or turn the system on and off.
2 Customized Features P. 101, 293
For the FCW system to work properly:
Always keep the radar sensor cover clean.
Never use chemical solvents or polishing
compounds to clean the sensor cover. Instead,
clean it with water and a mild detergent.
Do not put anything on the radar sensor cover.
See a dealer if the radar sensor gets damaged or
requires repair.
The camera is shared with Lane Departure Warning
(LDW).
2 Lane Departure Warning Camera (LDW
Camera) P. 440
Models with adaptive cruise control
Models without adaptive cruise control
LONG
NORMAL
SHORT
Your Vehicle Vehicle Ahead
You can set Long, Normal or Short for when warnings start:
* Not available on all models
Table of Contents
uuWhen DrivinguForward Collision Warning (FCW)
*
436
Driving
1Forward Collision Warning (FCW)
*
Never apply a film or attach any objects to the
windshield that could obstruct the FCW camera's
field of vision.
Scratches, nicks, and other damage to the windshield
within the FCW camera's field of vision can cause the
system to operate abnormally. If this occurs, we
recommend that you replace the windshield with a
genuine Honda replacement windshield. Making
even minor repairs within the camera's field of vision
or installing an aftermarket replacement windshield
may also cause the system to operate abnormally.
After replacing the windshield, have a dealer
recalibrate the camera. Proper calibration of the FCW
camera is necessary for the system to operate
properly.
Models without adaptive cruise control
1How the system works
The heads-up warning uses a lens located at the front
end of the dashboard.
Do not cover the lens or spill any liquid on it.
Lens
*2
When your setting is:
Long: The heads-up warning
lights flash twice at Long
distance.
When the Short distance is
reached, the lights flash and the
beeper sounds continuously until
a possible collision is avoided.
Beep
Radar-based system
Models with adaptive cruise control
The radar sensor is
at the front right,
inside the grille.
Normal: The heads-up warning
lights flash twice at the Normal
distance.
When the Short distance is
reached, the lights flash and the
beeper sounds continuously
until a possible collision is
avoided.
Short: The heads-up warning
lights flash and the beeper
sounds continuously until a
possible collision is avoided.
When the lights flash at any setting:
The BRAKE message appears until a
possible collision is avoided.
Heads-up
Warning
Lights
* Not available on all models
Table of Contents
Continued
437
uuWhen DrivinguForward Collision Warning (FCW)
*
Driving
Automatic shutoff
FCW may automatically shut itself off and the FCW indicator comes and stays on when:
The temperature inside the system is high.
The windshield is blocked by dirt, mud, leaves, wet snow, etc.
You drive off-road or on a mountain road, or curved and winding road for an
extended period.
You drive in bad weather (rain, fog, snow, etc.).
The radar sensor cover is blocked by dirt, mud, leaves, wet snow, etc.
An abnormal tire condition is detected (wrong tire size, flat tire, etc.).
Once the conditions that caused FCW to shut off improve or are addressed (e.g.,
cleaning), the system comes back on.
1Automatic shutoff
To help reduce the likelihood that high interior
temperatures will cause the camera system to shut
off, when parking, find a shady area or face the front
of the vehicle away from the sun. If you use a
reflective sun shade, do not allow it to cover the
camera housing. Covering the camera can
concentrate heat on the camera.
If the Camera Too Hot message appears:
Use the climate control system to cool down the
interior and, if necessary, the defroster mode when
windows are fogged.
Start driving the vehicle to lower the windshield
temperature, which cools down the area around
the FCW system.
Models without adaptive cruise control
Beep
Camera-based system
Models without adaptive cruise control
The camera is located
behind the rearview mirror.
The beeper sounds and
the BRAKE message
appears until a possible
collision is avoided.
Heads-up
Warning
Lights
Models without adaptive cruise ontrol
Models with adaptive cruise control
All models
Table of Contents
438
uuWhen DrivinguForward Collision Warning (FCW)
*
Driving
FCW may not activate or may not detect a vehicle in front of your vehicle, and may activate even when you are aware of a vehicle ahead
of you, or when there is no vehicle ahead under the following conditions.
FCW Limitations
Condition
Models with
adaptive cruise
control
Models without
adaptive cruise
control
The distance between your vehicle and the vehicle ahead of you is too short.
A vehicle cuts in front of you at a slow speed, and it brakes suddenly.
A vehicle suddenly crosses in front of you.
When either your vehicle or the vehicle ahead of you accelerates rapidly.
The vehicle ahead of you is a motorcycle, a small vehicle, or a unique vehicle such as a tractor.
When you drive off-road or on a mountain road, or curved and winding road for an extended period that
makes it difficult for the sensor/camera to properly detect a vehicle in front of you.
When there are pedestrians or animals in front of your vehicle.
When you drive in bad weather (rain, fog, etc.).
A heavy load in the rear or modifications to the suspension tilts your vehicle.
An abnormal tire condition is detected (wrong tire size, flat tire, etc.).
9 9
When the windshield is blocked by dirt, mud, leaves, wet snow, etc.
When the temperature inside the system is high.
A sudden change between light and dark such as an entrance or exit of a tunnel.
You drive into the sunlight (e.g. at dawn or dusk).
When the windshield is dirty or cloudy.
When streetlights are perceived as the taillight of a vehicle in front of yours.
When driving at night, the vehicle ahead of you is running with either taillight bulb burned out.
When you drive in the shadows of trees, buildings, etc.
9
When the radar sensor cover is blocked by dirt, mud, leaves, wet snow, etc.
You drive under a low or narrow bridge at high speed.
You drive over speed bumps, steel road plates, etc., or your vehicle approaches train tracks or roadside
objects (such as a traffic sign and guard rail) on a curve.
9
Table of Contents
439
uuWhen Driving uLane Departure Warning (LDW)
*
Continued
Driving
Lane Departure Warning (LDW)
*
Alerts you when the system detects a possibility of your vehicle unintentionally
crossing over detected side lane markings.
If your vehicle is getting too close to detected
left or right side lane markings without a turn
signal activated, LDW will give audible and
visual alerts.
The beeper sounds and the Lane Departure
message appears on the multi-information
display, letting you know that you need to
take appropriate action.
How the System Works
1Lane Departure Warning (LDW)
*
Important Safety Reminder
Like all assistance systems, LDW has limitations.
Over-reliance on LDW may result in a collision. It is
always your responsibility to keep the vehicle within
your driving lane.
LDW only alerts you when lane drift is detected
without a turn signal in use. LDW may not detect all
lane markings or lane departures; accuracy will vary
based on weather, speed and lane marker condition.
It is always your responsibility to safely operate the
vehicle and avoid collisions.
* Not available on all models
Table of Contents
uuWhen DrivinguLane Departure Warning (LDW)
*
440
Driving
The system begins to search for lane markings when all the following conditions are
met:
The vehicle is traveling between 40-90 mph (64-145 km/h).
The vehicle is on a straight or slightly curved road.
The turn signals are off.
The brake pedal is not depressed.
The camera is located behind the rearview
mirror.
How the System Activates
Lane Departure Warning Camera (LDW Camera)
1How the System Activates
LDW may automatically shut off and the LDW
indicator comes and stays on.
2 Indicators P. 82
1Lane Departure Warning Camera (LDW Camera)
Never apply a film or attach any objects to the
windshield that could obstruct the LDW camera's
field of vision.
Scratches, nicks, and other damage to the windshield
within the LDW camera's field of vision can cause the
system to operate abnormally. If this occurs, we
recommend that you replace the windshield with a
genuine Honda replacement windshield. Making
even minor repairs within the camera's field of vision
or installing an aftermarket replacement windshield
may also cause the system to operate abnormally.
After replacing the windshield, have a dealer
recalibrate the camera. Proper calibration of the LDW
camera is necessary for the system to operate
properly.
Do not place an object on the top of the instrument
panel. It may reflect onto the windshield and prevent
the system from detecting lane lines properly.
LDW Camera
Table of Contents
Continued
441
uuWhen Driving uLane Departure Warning (LDW)
*
Driving
Press the LDW button to turn the system on
and off.
u The indicator in the button comes on
when the system is on.
LDW On and Off
1Lane Departure Warning Camera (LDW Camera)
To help reduce the likelihood that high interior
temperatures will cause the camera system to shut off,
when parking, find a shady area or face the front of the
vehicle away from the sun. If you use a reflective sun
shade, do not allow it to cover the camera housing.
Covering the camera can concentrate heat on the
camera.
If the Camera Too Hot message appears:
Use the climate control system to cool down the
interior and, if necessary, the defroster mode when
windows are fogged.
Start driving the vehicle to lower the windshield
temperature, which cools down the area around
the LDW camera.
LDW Button
Indicator
Table of Contents
442
uuWhen DrivinguLane Departure Warning (LDW)
*
Driving
LDW may not activate or may not recognize lanes, and may activate even when
keeping in the middle of a lane under the following conditions.
LDW Limitations
Condition
When you drive in bad weather (rain, fog, etc.).
A heavy load in the rear or modifications to the suspension tilts your vehicle.
An abnormal tire condition is detected (wrong tire size, flat tire, etc.).
When the windshield is blocked by dirt, mud, leaves, wet snow, etc.
When the temperature inside the system is high.
A sudden change between light and dark such as an entrance or exit of a tunnel.
You drive into the sunlight (e.g. at dawn or dusk).
When the windshield is dirty or cloudy.
When you drive in the shadows of trees, buildings, etc.
When you drive on a wet road surface following another vehicle.
u The camera may perceive the tire tracks in the water as lane lines.
When there is snow or wheel tracks on the side of the road.
When the road has many repaired areas or erased lines.
When the vehicle is running over painted signs or crosswalk markings.
When you drive in a lane with worn-out lane markings.
Table of Contents
443
uuWhen DrivinguVehicle Stability Assist (VSA®), aka Electronic Stability Control (ESC), System
Continued
Driving
Vehicle Stability Assist (VSA®), aka Electronic
Stability Control (ESC), System
VSA® helps to stabilize the vehicle during cornering if the vehicle turns more or less
than what was intended. It also assists in maintaining traction on slippery surfaces.
It does so by regulating motor output and selectively applying the brakes.
When VSA® activates, you may notice that the
motor does not respond to the accelerator.
You may also notice some noise from the
hydraulic system. You will also see the
indicator blink.
VSA® Operation
1Vehicle Stability Assist (VSA®), aka Electronic Stability Control
(ESC), System
The VSA® may not function properly if tire type and
size are mixed. Make sure to use the same size and
type of tire, and the air pressures as specified.
When the VSA® indicator comes on and stays on
while driving, there may be a problem with the
system. While this may not interfere with normal
driving, have your vehicle checked by a dealer
immediately.
VSA® cannot enhance stability in all driving situations
and does not control the entire braking system. You
still need to drive and corner at speeds appropriate
for the conditions and always leave a sufficient
margin of safety.
The main function of the VSA® system is generally
known as Electronic Stability Control (ESC). The
system also includes a traction control function.
VSA® System
Indicator
Table of Contents
uuWhen DrivinguVehicle Stability Assist (VSA®), aka Electronic Stability Control (ESC), System
444
Driving
This button is on the driver side control panel.
To partially turn the VSA features on and off,
press and hold it until you hear a beep.
The traction control stops fully functioning,
allowing the wheels to spin more freely at low
speed. The VSA® OFF indicator will also come
on.
To turn it on again, press the (VSA® OFF)
button until you hear a beep.
VSA® is turned on every time you turn the
power system on, even if you press the
button the last time you drove the vehicle.
VSA® OFF Button
1Vehicle Stability Assist (VSA®), aka Electronic Stability Control
(ESC), System
With the button pressed, your vehicle will have
normal braking and cornering ability, but VSA®
traction and stability enhancement becomes less
effective.
In certain unusual conditions when your vehicle gets
stuck in shallow mud or fresh snow, it may be easier
to free it with the button pressed.
When the button is pressed, the traction control
function becomes less effective. This allows for the
wheels to spin more freely at low speed. You should
only attempt to free your vehicle with the button
pressed if you are not able to free it without.
Immediately after freeing your vehicle, be sure to
press the button again. We do not recommend
driving your vehicle with the button pressed
(indicator on).
You may hear a motor sound coming from the
engine compartment while system checks are being
performed immediately after turning the power
system on or while driving. This is normal.
VSA® OFF Indicator
Table of Contents
445
uuWhen DrivinguLaneWatch
TM
Continued
Driving
LaneWatch
TM
Is an assistance system that allows you to check the passenger side rear areas
displayed on the audio/information screen when the turn signal is activated to the
passenger’s side. A camera in the passenger side door mirror monitors these areas
and allows you to check for vehicles, in addition to your visual check and use of the
passenger door mirror. You can also keep the system on for your convenience while
driving.
1LaneWatch
TM
Important Safety Reminder
Like all assistance systems, LaneWatch has
limitations. Over reliance on LaneWatch may result in
a collision.
The LaneWatch function can be affected by weather,
lighting (including headlights and low sun angle),
ambient darkness, camera condition, and loading.
The LaneWatch may not provide the intended display
of traffic to the side and rear under the following
conditions:
Your vehicle’s suspension has been altered,
changing the height of the vehicle.
Your tires are over or under inflated.
Your tires or wheels are of varied size or
construction.
3
WARNING
Failure to visually confirm that it is safe to
change lanes before doing so may result in
a crash and serious injury or death.
Do not rely only on LaneWatch while
driving.
Always look in your mirrors, to either side
of your vehicle, and behind you for other
vehicles before changing lanes.
1 2
Camera
Audio/Information Screen
Move the turn signal
lever to the passenger
side.
Press the LaneWatch
button.
Pull the turn signal
lever back.
Press the LaneWatch
button again.
The passenger side view
display appears on the
audio/information screen.
The system activates when you:
The system deactivates when you:
Table of Contents
uuWhen DrivinguLaneWatch
TM
446
Driving
Customizing the LaneWatch settings
You can customize the following items using the audio/information screen.
Show with Turn Signal: Selects whether LaneWatch monitor comes on when
you operate the turn signal light lever.
Reference Lines: Selects whether the reference lines appear on the LaneWatch
monitor.
Next Maneuver Pop up
*
: Selects whether a turn direction screen of the
navigation system interrupts the LaneWatch display.
Display: Adjusts display settings.
2 Customized Features P. 293
Reference Lines
Three lines that appear on the screen can give
an idea of how far the vehicles or objects on
the screen are from your vehicle, respectively.
If an object is near line 1 (in red), it indicates
that it is close to your vehicle whereas an
object near line 3 farther away.
1LaneWatch
TM
The LaneWatch camera view is restricted. Its unique
lens makes objects on the screen look slightly
different from what they are.
LaneWatch display does not come on when the shift
lever is in
(R .
For proper LaneWatch operation:
The camera is located in the passenger side door
mirror. Always keep this area clean. If the camera
lens is covered with dirt or moisture, use a soft,
moist cloth to keep the lens clean and free of debris.
Do not cover the camera lens with labels or stickers
of any kind.
Do not touch the camera lens.
2
3
1
1Reference Lines
The area around the reference line 1 (red) is very close to
your vehicle. As always, make sure to visually confirm
the safety of a lane change before changing lanes.
The distance between your vehicle and lines 1, 2 and
3 on the screen vary depending on road conditions
and vehicle loading. For example, the reference lines
on the screen may seem to appear closer than the
actual distances when the rear of your vehicle is more
heavily loaded.
Consult a dealer if:
The passenger side door mirror, or area around it is
severely impacted, resulting in changing the
camera angle.
The LaneWatch display does not come on at all.
* Not available on all models
Table of Contents
447
uuWhen DrivinguTire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)
Continued
Driving
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)
Instead of directly measuring the pressure in each tire, the TPMS on this vehicle
monitors and compares the rolling radius and rotational characteristics of each
wheel and tire while you are driving to determine if one or more tires are
significantly under-inflated. This will cause the low tire pressure/TPMS indicator to
come on and a message to appear on the multi-information display.
You must start TPMS calibration every time you:
Adjust the pressure in one or more tires.
Rotate the tires.
Replace one or more tires.
Before calibrating the TPMS:
Set the cold tire pressure in all four tires.
2 Checking Tires P. 493
Make sure:
The vehicle is at a complete stop.
The shift lever is in (P.
The power mode is in ON.
TPMS Calibration
1Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)
The system does not monitor the tires when driving
at low speed.
Conditions such as low ambient temperature and
altitude change directly affect tire pressure and can
trigger the low tire pressure/TPMS indicator to come on.
Tire pressure checked and inflated in:
Warm weather can become under-inflated in
colder weather.
Cold weather can become over-inflated in warmer
weather.
The low tire pressure indicator will not come on as a
result of over inflation.
The TPMS may not function properly if tire type and
size are mixed. Make sure to use the same size and
type of tire.
2 Checking and Maintaining Tires P. 493
The low tire pressure/TPMS indicator may come on
with a delay or may not come on at all when:
You rapidly accelerate, decelerate, or turn the
steering wheel.
You drive on snowy or slippery roads.
Snow chains are used.
The low tire pressure/TPMS indicator may come on
under the following conditions:
There is a heavier and uneven load on the tires than
the condition at calibration.
Snow chains are used.
Table of Contents
uuWhen DrivinguTire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)
448
Driving
You can calibrate the system from the
customized features on the multi-information
display.
1. Press the / button to select Vehicle
Settings, then press the SEL/RESET button.
u TPMS Calibration appears on the display.
2. Press the SEL/RESET button.
u The display switches to the
customization setup screen, where you
can select Cancel or Calibrate.
3. Press the / button and select
Calibrate, then press the SEL/RESET button.
u Calibration Started screen appears,
then the display returns to the
customization menu screen.
If the Calibration Failed to Start message
appears, repeat steps 2-3.
The calibration process finishes
automatically.
1TPMS Calibration
The calibration process requires approximately 30
minutes of cumulative driving at speeds between
30-60 mph (48-97 km/h).
During this period, if the power mode is set to ON
and the vehicle is not moved within 45 seconds,
you may notice the low tire pressure indicator
comes on briefly. This is normal and indicates that
the calibration process is not yet complete.
You can calibrate the system using the audio/
information screen.
2 Customized Features P. 293
If the snow chains are installed, remove them before
calibrating the TPMS.
If the low tire pressure/TPMS indicator comes on even
when the properly inflated specified regular tires are
installed, have your vehicle checked by a dealer.
We recommend that the tires be replaced with the
same brand, model, and size as the originals. Ask a
dealer for details.
4
4
Table of Contents
449
uuWhen DrivinguTire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) - Required Federal Explanation
Continued
Driving
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) - Required
Federal Explanation
Each tire, including the spare (if provided), should be checked
monthly when cold and inflated to the inflation pressure
recommended by the vehicle manufacturer on the vehicle placard
or tire inflation pressure label.
(If your vehicle has tires of a different size than the size indicated
on the vehicle placard or tire inflation pressure label, you should
determine the proper tire inflation pressure for those tires.)
As an added safety feature, your vehicle has been equipped with
a tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS) that illuminates a low
tire pressure telltale
when one or more of your tires is significantly under-inflated.
Accordingly, when the low tire pressure telltale illuminates, you
should stop and check your tires as soon as possible, and inflate
them to the proper pressure.
Driving on a significantly under-inflated tire causes the tire to
overheat and can lead to tire failure. Under-inflation also reduces
fuel efficiency and tire tread life, and may affect the vehicle's
handling and stopping ability.
U.S. models
Table of Contents
450
uuWhen DrivinguTire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) - Required Federal Explanation
Driving
Please note that the TPMS is not a substitute for proper tire
maintenance, and it is the driver's responsibility to maintain
correct tire pressure, even if under-inflation has not reached the
level to trigger illumination of the TPMS low tire pressure telltale.
Your vehicle has also been equipped with a TPMS malfunction
indicator to indicate when the system is not operating properly.
The TPMS malfunction indicator is combined with the low tire
pressure telltale. When the system detects a malfunction, the
telltale will flash for approximately one minute and then remain
continuously illuminated. This sequence will continue upon
subsequent vehicle start-ups as long as the malfunction exists.
When the malfunction indicator is illuminated, the system may
not be able to detect or signal low tire pressure as intended.
TPMS malfunctions may occur for a variety of reasons, including
the installation of replacement or alternate tires or wheels on the
vehicle that prevent the TPMS from functioning properly.
Always check the TPMS malfunction telltale after replacing one or
more tires or wheels on your vehicle to ensure that the
replacement or alternate tires and wheels allow the TPMS to
continue to function properly.
Table of Contents
451
uuWhen DrivinguHigh Voltage Battery
Driving
High Voltage Battery
The High Voltage battery gradually discharges even if the vehicle is not in use. As a
result, if your vehicle is parked for an extended period of time, the battery charge
level will become low. Extended periods of time at a low state of charge will shorten
battery life. To maintain the battery state of charge, drive your vehicle for more than
30 minutes at least once every three months.
Extreme high temperatures can affect the battery life. You can minimize the affects
by parking the vehicle in the shade during the summer.
1High Voltage Battery
Be careful not to let the High Voltage battery drain
too much. If the battery level becomes close to zero,
it will make it impossible to start the engine.
Table of Contents
452
Driving
Braking
Brake System
Use the parking brake to keep the vehicle stationary when parking.
To apply:
Pull the lever fully up without pressing the
release button.
To release:
1. Pull the lever slightly, and press and hold
the release button.
2. Lower the lever down all the way, then
release the button.
Parking Brake
1Brake System
When you depress the brake pedal, you may hear a
whirling sound from the motor compartment. This is
because the brake system is in operation, and it is
normal.
1Parking Brake
NOTICE
Release the parking brake fully before driving. The
rear brakes and axle can be damaged if you drive
with the parking brake applied.
If you start driving without fully releasing the parking
brake, a buzzer sounds as a warning, and Release
Parking Brake appears on the multi-information
display.
Always apply the parking brake when parking.
Table of Contents
453
uuBraking uBrake System
Driving
Your vehicle is equipped with disc brakes at all four wheels. The brake assist system
increases the stopping force when you depress the brake pedal hard in an
emergency situation. The anti-lock brake system (ABS) helps you retain steering
control when braking very hard.
2 Brake Assist System P. 455
2 Anti-lock Brake System (ABS) P. 454
Foot Brake
1Foot Brake
Check the brakes after driving through deep water,
or if there is a buildup of road surface water. If
necessary, dry the brakes by lightly depressing the
pedal several times.
If you hear a continuous metallic friction sound when
applying the brakes, the brake pads need to be
replaced. Have your vehicle checked by a dealer.
Constantly using the brake pedal while going down a
long hill builds up heat, which reduces the brake
effectiveness. Apply regenerative braking by taking
your foot off the accelerator pedal and shifting to .
Do not rest your foot on the brake pedal while
driving, as it will lightly apply the brakes and cause
them to lose effectiveness over time and reduce pad
life. It will also confuse drivers behind you.
When you depress the brake pedal, you may hear a
motor sound coming from the engine compartment
while the brake system activates. This is normal.
B
Table of Contents
454
uuBrakinguAnti-lock Brake System (ABS)
Driving
Anti-lock Brake System (ABS)
Helps prevent the wheels from locking up, and helps you retain steering control by
pumping the brakes rapidly, much faster than you.
The electronic brake distribution (EBD) system, which is part of the ABS, also
balances the front-to-rear braking distribution according to vehicle loading.
You should never pump the brake pedal. Let the ABS work for you by always
keeping firm, steady pressure on the brake pedal. This is sometimes referred to as
“stomp and steer.”
ABS operation
The brake pedal may pulsate slightly when the ABS is working. Keep holding the
pedal firmly down. On dry pavement, you will need to press on the brake pedal very
hard before the ABS activates. However, you may feel the ABS activate immediately
if you are trying to stop on snow or ice.
When the vehicle speed goes under 6 mph (10 km/h), the ABS stops.
ABS
1Anti-lock Brake System (ABS)
NOTICE
The ABS may not function correctly if you use an
incorrect tire type and size.
When the ABS indicator comes on while driving,
there may be a problem with the system.
While normal braking is not affected, there is a
possibility of the ABS not operating. Have your
vehicle checked by a dealer immediately.
The ABS does not reduce the time or distance it takes
to stop the vehicle. It only helps with steering control
during hard braking.
In the following cases, your vehicle may need more
stopping distance than a vehicle without the ABS:
When driving on rough road surfaces, including
when driving on uneven surfaces, such as gravel or
snow.
When snow chains are installed.
You may hear a motor sound coming from the
engine compartment while system checks are being
performed immediately after turning the power
system on or while driving. This is normal.
Table of Contents
455
uuBrakinguBrake Assist System
Driving
Brake Assist System
Designed to assist the driver by generating greater braking force when you depress
the brake pedal hard during emergency braking.
Brake assist system operation
Press the brake pedal firmly for more powerful braking.
When brake assist operates, the pedal may wiggle slightly and an operating noise
may be heard. This is normal. Keep holding the brake pedal firmly down.
Brake Assist System
Table of Contents
456
Driving
Parking Your Vehicle
When Stopped
1. Depress the brake pedal firmly.
2. Firmly apply the parking brake.
3. Move the shift lever from
(D to (P.
4. Turn off the power system.
Always set the parking brake firmly, in particular if you are parked on an incline.
1Parking Your Vehicle
Do not park your vehicle near flammable objects,
such as dry grass, oil, or timber.
Heat from the exhaust can cause a fire.
1When Stopped
NOTICE
The following can damage the driveline:
Depressing the accelerator and brake pedals
simultaneously.
Moving the shift lever into
(P before the vehicle
stops completely.
When facing uphill, do not hold the vehicle by
depressing the accelerator pedal.
Doing so may cause the power system to overheat
and fail.
Raise the wiper arms when snow is expected.
Table of Contents
457
Driving
Multi-View Rear Camera
About Your Multi-View Rear Camera
The audio/information screen can display your vehicle’s rear view. The display
automatically changes to the rear view when the shift lever is moved to
(R .
You can view three different camera angles on the rearview display. Press the
selector knob or the interface dial to switch the angle.
If the last used viewing mode is Wide or Normal, the same mode is selected the next
time you shift into
(R . If Top View was last used, Wide mode is selected.
Multi-View Rear Camera Display Area
Models with two displays/Models with navigation system
1About Your Multi-View Rear Camera
The rear camera view is restricted. You cannot see
the corner ends of the bumper or what is underneath
the bumper. Its unique lens also makes objects
appear closer or farther than they actually are.
Visually confirm that it is safe to drive before backing
up. Certain conditions (such as weather, lighting, and
high temperatures) may also restrict the rear view. Do
not rely on the rearview display which does not give
you all information about conditions at the back of
your vehicle.
If the camera lens is covered with dirt or moisture,
use a soft, moist cloth to keep the lens clean and free
of debris.
You can change the Fixed Guideline and Dynamic
Guideline settings.
2 Customized Features P. 293
Fixed Guideline
On: Guidelines appear when you shift into
(R .
Off: Guidelines do not appear.
Dynamic Guideline
On: Guidelines move according to the steering wheel
direction.
Off: Guidelines do not move.
Top Down View Mode
Normal View Mode
Wide View Mode
Guidelines
Bumper
Camera
Approx. 118 inches (3 m)
Approx. 79 inches (2 m)
Approx. 39 inches (1 m)
Approx. 20 inches (50 cm)
Table of Contents
458
Driving
Rearview Camera
About Your Rearview Camera
The audio/information screen can display your vehicle’s rear view.
The display automatically changes to a rear view when the shift lever is moved to
(R .
The rearview camera has a unique lens that makes objects appear closer or further
than they actually are.
Rearview Camera Display Area
Models with one display
1About Your Rearview Camera
The rear camera view is restricted. You cannot see
the corner ends of the bumper or what is underneath
the bumper. Its unique lens also makes objects
appear closer or farther than they actually are.
Visually confirm that it is safe to drive before backing
up. Certain conditions (such as weather, lighting, and
high temperatures) may also restrict the rear view. Do
not rely on the rearview display which does not give
you all information about conditions at the back of
your vehicle.
If the camera lens is covered with dirt or moisture,
use a soft, moist cloth to keep the lens clean and free
of debris.
You can change the Fixed Guideline and Dynamic
Guideline settings.
2 Customized Features P. 293
Fixed Guideline
On: Guidelines appear when you shift into
(R .
Off: Guidelines do not appear.
Dynamic Guideline
On: Guidelines move according to the steering wheel
direction.
Off: Guidelines do not move.
Bumper
Guidelines
Approx. 118 in (3 m)
Approx. 79 in (2 m)
Approx. 39 in (1 m)
Approx. 20 in (0.5 m)
Approx. 118 in (3 m)
Approx. 79 in (2 m)
Approx. 39 in (1 m)
Camera
Table of Contents
459
Driving
Refueling
Fuel Information
Fuel recommendation
Use of a lower octane gasoline can cause a persistent, heavy metallic knocking noise
that can lead to engine damage.
Top tier detergent gasoline
Because the level of detergency and additives in gasoline vary in the market, Honda
endorses the use of “TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline” where available to help
maintain the performance and reliability of your vehicle. TOP TIER Detergent
Gasoline meets a new gasoline standard jointly established by leading automotive
manufacturers to meet the needs of today’s advanced engines.
Qualifying gasoline retailers will, in most cases, identify their gasoline as having met
“TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline” standards at the retail location. This fuel is
guaranteed to contain the proper level of detergent additives and be free of metallic
additives. The proper level of detergent additives, and absence of harmful metallic
additives in gasoline, help avoid build-up of deposits in your engine and emission
control system.
For further important fuel-related information for your vehicle, or on information on
gasoline that does not contain MMT, visit www.hondacars.com. In Canada, visit
www.honda.ca for additional information on gasoline. For more information on top
tier gasoline, visit www.toptiergas.com.
Fuel tank capacity: 15.8 US gal (60 liters)
Unleaded gasoline, pump octane number 87 or higher
1Fuel Information
NOTICE
We recommend quality gasoline containing
detergent additives that help prevent fuel system and
engine deposits. In addition, in order to maintain
good performance, fuel economy, and emissions
control, we strongly recommend the use of gasoline
that does NOT contain harmful manganese-based
fuel additives such as MMT, if such gasoline is
available.
Use of gasoline with these additives may adversely
affect performance, and cause the malfunction
indicator lamp on your instrument panel to come on.
If this happens, contact a dealer for service.
Some gasoline today is blended with oxygenates such
as ethanol. Your vehicle is designed to operate on
oxygenated gasoline containing up to 15% ethanol
by volume. Do not use gasoline containing methanol.
If you notice any undesirable operating symptoms, try
another service station or switch to another brand of
gasoline.
Table of Contents
460
uuRefuelinguHow to Refuel
Driving
How to Refuel
1. Stop your vehicle with the service station
pump on the left side of the vehicle in the
rear.
2. Turn off the power system.
3. Push on the fuel fill door release handle at
the foot of the driver’s seat.
u The fuel fill door opens.
4. Remove the fuel fill cap slowly. If you hear a
release of air, wait until this stops, then turn
the knob slowly to open the fuel fill cap.
5. Place the fuel fill cap in the holder.
6. Insert the filler nozzle fully.
u When the tank is full, the fuel nozzle will
click off automatically. This leaves space
in the fuel tank in case the fuel expands
with a change in the temperature.
7. After filling, replace the fuel fill cap, tightening
it until you hear it click at least once.
u Shut the fuel fill door by hand.
1How to Refuel
The filler nozzle automatically stops to leave space in
the fuel tank so that fuel does not overflow as a result
of changes in air temperature.
If the fuel nozzle keeps turning off when the tank is
not full, there may be a problem with the pump's fuel
vapor recovery system. Try filling at another pump. If
this does not fix the problem, consult a dealer.
Do not continue to add fuel after the nozzle has
automatically stopped. Additional fuel can exceed
the full tank capacity.
3
WARNING
Gasoline is highly flammable and explosive.
You can be burned or seriously injured
when handling fuel.
Turn the power system off, and keep
heat, sparks, and flame away.
Handle fuel only outdoors.
Wipe up spills immediately.
Push
Cap
Cap
Holder
Table of Contents
461
Driving
Fuel Economy
Improving Fuel Economy
Fuel economy depends on several conditions, including driving conditions, your
driving habits, the condition of your vehicle, and loading. Depending on these and
other conditions, you may or may not achieve the rated fuel economy of this vehicle.
You can optimize your fuel economy with proper maintenance of your vehicle.
Always maintain your vehicle in accordance with the messages displayed on the
multi-information display.
Use the recommended viscosity engine oil, displaying the API Certification Seal.
Maintain the specified tire pressure.
Do not load the vehicle with excess cargo.
Keep your vehicle clean. A buildup of snow or mud on your vehicle's underside
adds weight and increases wind resistance.
Maintenance and Fuel Economy
1Improving Fuel Economy
Direct calculation is the recommended method to
determine actual fuel consumed while driving.
In Canada, posted fuel economy numbers are
established following a simulated test. For more
information on how this test is performed, please visit
http://oee.nrcan.gc.ca/
Miles driven
Gallons of
fuel
Miles per
Gallon
100 Liter
Kilometers L per 100 km
Table of Contents
462
Driving
Accessories and Modifications
Accessories
When installing accessories, check the following:
Do not install accessories on the windshield. They can obstruct your view and
delay your reaction to driving conditions.
Do not install accessories over areas marked SRS AIRBAG, on the sides or backs
of the front seats, on front or side pillars, or near the side windows.
Accessories installed in these areas may interfere with proper operation of the
vehicle’s airbags or may be propelled into you or another occupant if the airbags
deploy.
Be sure electronic accessories do not overload electrical circuits or interfere with
proper operation of your vehicle.
2 Fuses P. 532
Before installing any electronic accessory, have the installer contact a dealer for
assistance. If possible, have a dealer inspect the final installation.
Modifications
Do not modify your vehicle or use non-Honda components that can affect its
handling, stability, and reliability.
Overall vehicle performance can be affected. Always make sure all equipment is
properly installed and maintained, and that it meets federal, state, province,
territory, and local regulations.
1Accessories and Modifications
Honda Genuine accessories are recommended to
ensure proper operation on your vehicle.
3
WARNING
Improper accessories or modifications can
affect your vehicle's handling, stability, and
performance, and cause a crash in which
you can be seriously hurt or killed.
Follow all instructions in this owner's
manual regarding accessories and
modifications.
Table of Contents
463
Maintenance
This chapter discusses basic maintenance.
Before Performing Maintenance
Inspection and Maintenance ............464
Safety When Performing Maintenance..... 465
Parts and Fluids Used in Maintenance
Service ........................................... 466
Maintenance Minder
TM
.....................467
Maintenance Under the Hood
Maintenance Items Under the Hood..... 471
Opening the Hood ........................... 472
Recommended Engine Oil ................ 473
Oil Check.........................................474
Adding Engine Oil............................475
Changing the Engine Oil and Oil Filter ..... 476
Coolant System................................ 478
Inverter Coolant............................... 480
Transmission Fluid............................ 481
Brake Fluid....................................... 482
Refilling Window Washer Fluid......... 483
Replacing Light Bulbs ....................... 484
Checking and Maintaining Wiper
Blades .......................................... 491
Checking and Maintaining Tires
Checking Tires ................................. 493
Tire and Loading Information Label...... 494
Tire Labeling .................................... 494
DOT Tire Quality Grading (U.S. Vehicles).......496
Wear Indicators ............................... 498
Tire Service Life................................ 498
Tire and Wheel Replacement ........... 499
Tire Rotation.................................... 500
Winter Tires ..................................... 501
12-Volt Battery ................................. 502
Remote Transmitter Care
Replacing the Button Battery ........... 503
Climate Control System Maintenance... 504
Cleaning
Interior Care .................................... 505
Exterior Care.................................... 507
Main Menu
464
Maintenance
Before Performing Maintenance
Inspection and Maintenance
For your safety, perform all listed inspections and maintenance to keep your vehicle
in good condition. If you become aware of any abnormality (noise, smell, insufficient
brake fluid, oil residue on the ground, etc.), have your vehicle inspected by a dealer.
(Note, however, that service at a dealer is not mandatory to keep your warranties in
effect.) Refer to the separate maintenance booklet for detailed maintenance and
inspection information.
Daily inspections
Perform inspections before long distance trips, when washing the vehicle, or when
refueling.
Periodic inspections
Check the brake fluid level monthly.
2 Brake Fluid P. 482
Check the tire pressure monthly. Examine the tread for wear and foreign objects.
2 Checking and Maintaining Tires P. 493
Check the operation of the exterior lights monthly.
2 Replacing Light Bulbs P. 484
Check the condition of the wiper blades at least every six months.
2 Checking and Maintaining Wiper Blades P. 491
Types of Inspection and Maintenance
1Inspection and Maintenance
Maintenance, replacement, or repair of
emissions control devices and systems may be
done by any automotive repair establishment or
individuals using parts that are “certified” to
EPA standards.
According to state and federal regulations, failure to
perform maintenance on the maintenance main
items marked with # will not void your emissions
warranties. However, all maintenance services should
be performed in accordance with the intervals
indicated by the multi-information display.
2 Maintenance Service Items P. 469
If you want to perform complex maintenance tasks
that require more skills and tools, you can purchase a
subscription to the Service Express website at
www.techinfo.honda.com.
2 Authorized Manuals P. 547
If you want to perform maintenance yourself, make
sure that you have the necessary tools and skills first.
After performing maintenance, update the records in
the separate maintenance booklet.
U.S. models
Table of Contents
465
uuBefore Performing MaintenanceuSafety When Performing Maintenance
Maintenance
Safety When Performing Maintenance
Some of the most important safety precautions are given here.
However, we cannot warn you of every conceivable hazard that can arise in
performing maintenance. Only you can decide whether or not you should perform
a given task.
To reduce the possibility of fire or explosion, keep cigarettes, sparks, and flames
away from the 12-volt battery and all fuel related parts.
Never leave rags, towels, or other flammable objects under the hood.
u Heat from the engine and exhaust can ignite them causing a fire.
To clean parts, use a commercially available degreaser or parts cleaner, not
gasoline.
Wear eye protection and protective clothing when working with the 12-volt
battery or compressed air.
Engine exhaust contains carbon monoxide, which is poisonous and can kill you.
u Only operate the engine if there is sufficient ventilation.
The vehicle must be in a stationary condition.
u Make sure your vehicle is parked on level ground, the parking brake is set, and
the power system is turned off.
Be aware that hot parts can burn you.
u Make sure to let the power system including the engine and exhaust system
cool thoroughly before touching vehicle parts.
Be aware that moving parts can injure you.
u Do not activate the power system unless instructed, and keep your hands and
limbs away from moving parts. When the power mode is on, the engine can
automatically start, or the radiator fan may start operating without the engine
running.
Maintenance Safety
Vehicle Safety
1Safety When Performing Maintenance
3
WARNING
Improperly maintaining this vehicle or
failing to correct a problem before driving
can cause a crash in which you can be
seriously hurt or killed.
Always follow the inspection and
maintenance recommendations according
to the schedules in this owner's manual.
3
WARNING
Failure to properly follow maintenance
instructions and precautions can cause you
to be seriously hurt or killed.
Always follow the procedures and
precautions in this owner's manual.
Table of Contents
466
uuBefore Performing MaintenanceuParts and Fluids Used in Maintenance Service
Maintenance
Parts and Fluids Used in Maintenance Service
The use of Honda genuine parts and fluids is recommended when maintaining and
servicing your vehicle. Honda genuine parts are manufactured according to the
same high quality standards used in Honda vehicles.
Table of Contents
467
Continued
Maintenance
Maintenance Minder
TM
If the engine oil life is less than 15%, you will see the Maintenance Minder messages
appear on the multi-information display every time you set the power mode to ON.
The messages notify you when to change the engine oil, or when to bring your
vehicle to a dealer for indicated maintenance services.
To Use Maintenance Minder
TM
1. Set the power mode to ON.
2. Press the (Information) button repeatedly until the engine oil life appears
on the multi-information display.
Displaying the Engine Oil Life
1Displaying the Engine Oil Life
Based on the engine operating conditions, the
remaining engine oil life is calculated and displayed
as a percentage.
Displayed Engine Oil
Life (%)
Calculated Engine Oil
Life (%)
100 100 to 91
90 90 to 81
80 80 to 71
70 70 to 61
60 60 to 51
50 50 to 41
40 40 to 31
30 30 to 21
20 20 to 16
15 15 to 11
10 10 to 6
5 5 to 1
0 0
Button
Maintenance
Item Codes
Remaining
Engine Oil
Life
Table of Contents
468
uuMaintenance Minder
TM
uTo Use Maintenance Minder
TM
Maintenance
The system message indicator ( ) comes on along with the Maintenance Minder message.
Maintenance Minder Messages on the Multi-Information
Display
Maintenance Message Oil Life Display Explanation Information
Maintenance Due Soon 15 % The remaining engine oil life is 15 to
6 percent. Once you switch the
display by pressing the
(Information) button, this message
will go off.
The engine oil is approaching the end
of its service life, and the maintenance
items should be inspected and serviced
soon.
Maintenance Due Now 5 % The remaining engine oil life is 5 to 1
percent. Press the button to
switch to another display.
The engine oil has almost reached the
end of its service life, and the
maintenance items should be inspected
and serviced as soon as possible.
Maintenance Past Due Negative Distance The remaining engine oil life has
passed its service life, and a negative
distance appears after driving over
10 miles (U.S. models) or 10 km
(Canadian models). Press the
button to switch to another
display.
The engine oil life has passed.
The maintenance items must be
inspected and serviced immediately.
Table of Contents
469
uuMaintenance Minder
TM
uTo Use Maintenance Minder
TM
Continued
Maintenance
Maintenance Service Items
1Maintenance Service Items
Independent of the Maintenance Minder
information, replace the brake fluid every 3 years.
Inspect idle speed every 160,000 miles (256,000
km).
Adjust the valves during services A, B, 1, 2, or 3 if
they are noisy.
Maintenance Minder
Message
System Message
Indicator
Sub ItemsMain Item
*1: If a message Service does not appear more than 12 months after the display is reset, change the
engine oil every year.
# : See information on maintenance and emissions warranty.
CODE Maintenance Main Items
A
Replace engine oil
*1
B
Replace engine oil
*1
and oil filter
Inspect front and rear brakes/service as necessary
Check parking brake adjustment
Inspect tie rod ends, steering gearbox, and boots
Inspect suspension components
Inspect driveshaft boots
Inspect brake hoses and lines (Including ABS/VSA)
Inspect all fluid levels and condition of fluids
Inspect exhaust system
#
Inspect fuel lines and connections
#
Check expiration date for TRK bottle
*2: If you drive in dusty conditions, replace the air cleaner element every 15,000 miles (24,000 km).
*3: If you drive primarily in urban areas that have high concentrations of soot in the air from industry and
from diesel-powered vehicles, replace the dust and pollen filter every 15,000 miles (24,000 km).
*4: Driving in mountainous areas at very low vehicle speeds results in higher transmission temperatures.
This requires transmission fluid changes more frequently than recommended by the Maintenance
Minder. If you regularly drive your vehicle under these conditions, have the transmission fluid changed
every 47,500 miles (75,000 km) or 3 years.
CODE Maintenance Sub Items
1
Rotate tires
2
Replace air cleaner element
*2
Replace dust and pollen filter
*3
3
Replace transmission fluid
*4
4
Replace spark plugs
Inspect valve clearance
5
Replace engine coolant
Table of Contents
uuMaintenance Minder
TM
uTo Use Maintenance Minder
TM
470
Maintenance
Reset the engine oil life display if you have performed the maintenance service.
1. Set the power mode to ON.
2. Press the button to select Vehicle Settings, then press the SEL/RESET
button.
3. Press the button until Maintenance Reset appears on the display.
4. Press the SEL/RESET button.
u The oil life reset mode is displayed on the multi-information display.
5. Select Reset with the button, then press the SEL/RESET button.
u The displayed maintenance items disappear, and the engine oil life display
returns to 100%.
To cancel the oil life reset mode, select Cancel, then press the SEL/RESET button.
Resetting the Display
1Resetting the Display
NOTICE
Failure to reset the engine oil life after a maintenance
service results in the system showing incorrect
maintenance intervals, which can lead to serious
mechanical problems.
The dealer will reset the engine oil life display after
completing the required maintenance service. If
someone other than a dealer performs maintenance
service, reset the engine oil life display yourself.
You can reset the engine oil life display using the
audio/information screen.
2 Customized Features P. 293
Engine Oil Life
SEL/RESET
Button
Maintenance Item Codes
(Information)
Button
Table of Contents
471
Maintenance
Maintenance Under the Hood
Maintenance Items Under the Hood
Brake Fluid
(Black Cap)
Engine Coolant
Reservoir
Radiator Cap
Washer Fluid
(Blue Cap)
Engine Oil Dipstick
(Orange Handle)
Engine Oil Fill Cap
12-Volt Battery
Inverter Coolant
Filler Tank
Table of Contents
472
uuMaintenance Under the HooduOpening the Hood
Maintenance
Opening the Hood
1. Park the vehicle on a level surface, and set
the parking brake.
2. Pull the hood release handle under the
lower left corner of the dashboard.
u The hood will pop up slightly.
3. Push up the hood latch lever in the center
of the hood to release the lock mechanism,
and open the hood.
4. Remove the support rod from the clamp
using the grip. Mount the support rod in
the hood.
When closing, remove the support rod, and
stow it in the clamp, then gently lower the
hood. Remove your hand at a height of
approximately 12 inches (30 cm) and let the
hood close.
1Opening the Hood
NOTICE
Do not open the hood when the wiper arms are
raised.
The hood will strike the wipers, and may damage
either the hood or the wipers.
When closing the hood, check that the hood is
securely latched.
If the hood latch lever moves stiffly, or if you can
open the hood without lifting the lever, the latch
mechanism should be cleaned and lubricated.
Hood Release Handle
Pull
Lever
Support Rod
Grip
Clamp
Table of Contents
473
uuMaintenance Under the HooduRecommended Engine Oil
Maintenance
Recommended Engine Oil
Oil is a major contributor to your engine's
performance and longevity. If you drive the
vehicle with insufficient or deteriorated oil,
the engine may fail or be damaged.
This seal indicates the oil is energy conserving
and that it meets the American Petroleum
Institute’s latest requirements.
Use a Genuine Honda Motor Oil or another
commercial engine oil of suitable viscosity for
the ambient temperature as shown.
Synthetic oil
You may also use synthetic motor oil if it is labeled with the API Certification Seal
and is the specified viscosity grade.
Genuine Honda Motor Oil
Premium-grade 0W-20 detergent oil with an API Certification Seal on the
container.
1Recommended Engine Oil
Engine Oil Additives
Your vehicle does not require oil additives. In fact,
they may adversely affect the engine performance
and durability.
Ambient Temperature
Table of Contents
474
uuMaintenance Under the HooduOil Check
Maintenance
Oil Check
We recommend that you check the engine oil level every time you refuel.
Park the vehicle on level ground.
Turn off the power system. You can check the oil level without the engine having
run beforehand. If the engine has been running, wait approximately three minutes
before you check the oil.
1. Remove the dipstick (orange handle).
2. Wipe the dipstick with a clean cloth or
paper towel.
3. Insert the dipstick back all the way into its
hole.
4. Remove the dipstick again, and check the
level. It should be between the upper and
lower marks. Add oil if necessary.
1Oil Check
If the oil level is near or below the lower mark, slowly
add oil being careful not to overfill.
Upper Mark
Lower Mark
Table of Contents
475
uuMaintenance Under the HooduAdding Engine Oil
Maintenance
Adding Engine Oil
1. Unscrew and remove the engine oil fill cap.
2. Add oil slowly.
3. Reinstall the engine oil fill cap, and tighten
it securely.
4. Wait for three minutes and recheck the
engine oil dipstick.
1Adding Engine Oil
If any oil spills, wipe it up immediately. Spilled oil may
damage the engine compartment components.
NOTICE
Do not fill the engine oil above the upper mark.
Overfilling the engine oil can result in leaks and
engine damage.
Engine Oil Fill Cap
Table of Contents
476
uuMaintenance Under the HooduChanging the Engine Oil and Oil Filter
Maintenance
Changing the Engine Oil and Oil Filter
You must change the engine oil and oil filter regularly in order to maintain the
engine's lubrication. The engine may be damaged if they are not changed regularly.
Turning the power system on automatically starts the engine if the High Voltage
battery charge level gauge shows two segments or less.
2 High Voltage Battery Charge Level Gauge P. 93
Change the oil and filter in accordance with the maintenance message on the multi-
information display.
1. Remove the engine under cover.
2. Run the engine until it reaches normal
operating temperature, and then turn the
engine off.
3. Open the hood and remove the engine oil
fill cap.
4. Remove the drain bolt and washer from the
bottom of the engine, and drain the oil into
a suitable container.
1Changing the Engine Oil and Oil Filter
NOTICE
You may damage the environment if you do not
dispose of the oil in a suitable way. If you are
changing the oil by yourself, appropriately dispose of
the used oil. Put the oil in a sealed container and take
it to a recycling center. Do not throw the oil away
into a garbage can or onto the ground.
Drain Bolt
Washer
Table of Contents
477
uuMaintenance Under the HooduChanging the Engine Oil and Oil Filter
Maintenance
5. Remove the oil filter and dispose of the
remaining oil.
6. Check that the filter gasket is not stuck to
the engine contact surface.
u If it is stuck, you must detach it.
7. Wipe away dirt and dust adhering to the
contact surface of the engine block, and
install a new oil filter.
u Apply a light coat of new engine oil to
the oil gasket.
8. Put a new washer on the drain bolt, then
reinstall the drain bolt.
u Tightening torque:
30 lbf∙ft (40 N∙m, 4.0 kgf∙m)
9. Pour the recommended engine oil into the
engine.
u Engine oil change capacity (including
filter):
3.9 US qt (3.7 L)
10. Reinstall the engine oil fill cap securely and
start the engine.
11. Run the engine for a few minutes, and
then check that there is no leak from the
drain bolt or oil filter.
12. Stop the engine, wait for three minutes,
and then check the oil level on the
dipstick.
u If necessary, add more engine oil.
1Changing the Engine Oil and Oil Filter
You will need a special wrench to replace the oil
filter. You can buy this wrench from a dealer.
When installing the new oil filter, follow the
instructions supplied with the oil filter.
Reinstall the engine oil fill cap. Start the engine. The
low oil pressure indicator should go off within five
seconds. If it does not, turn off the engine, and check
your work.
Oil Filter
Table of Contents
478
uuMaintenance Under the HooduCoolant System
Maintenance
Coolant System
This coolant is premixed with 50% antifreeze and 50% water. Do not add any
straight antifreeze or water.
We recommend you check the engine coolant level every time you refuel. Check the
engine coolant reservoir first. If it is completely empty, also check the coolant level
in the radiator. Add the engine coolant accordingly.
1. Check the amount of coolant in the engine
coolant reservoir.
2. If the coolant level is below the MIN mark,
add the specified coolant until it reaches
the MAX mark.
3. Inspect the cooling system for leaks.
Specified coolant: Honda Long Life Antifreeze/Coolant Type 2
Engine Coolant Reservoir
1Coolant System
NOTICE
If temperatures consistently below −22°F (−30°C) are
expected, the coolant mixture should be changed to
a higher concentration. Consult a dealer for more
information.
If Honda antifreeze/coolant is not available, you may
use another major brand non-silicate coolant as a
temporary replacement. Check that it is a high quality
coolant recommended for aluminum engines.
Continued use of any non-Honda coolant can result
in corrosion, causing the cooling system to
malfunction or fail. Have the cooling system flushed
and refilled with Honda antifreeze/coolant as soon as
possible.
Do not add rust inhibitors or other additives to your
vehicle's coolant system. They may not be compatible
with the coolant or with the engine components.
Engine
Coolant
Reservoir
MAX
MIN
Table of Contents
479
uuMaintenance Under the HooduCoolant System
Maintenance
1. Make sure the engine and radiator are
cool.
2. Turn the radiator cap counterclockwise and
relieve any pressure in the coolant system.
Do not push the cap down when turning.
3. Push down and turn the radiator cap
counterclockwise to remove it.
4. The coolant level should be up to the base
of the filler neck. Add coolant if it is low.
5. Put the radiator cap back on, and tighten it
fully.
6. Pour coolant into the engine coolant
reservoir until it reaches the MAX mark. Put
the cap back on the engine coolant
reservoir.
Radiator
1Radiator
NOTICE
Pour the fluid slowly and carefully so you do not spill
any. Clean up any spills immediately; they can
damage components in the engine compartment.
3
WARNING
Removing the radiator cap while the
engine is hot can cause the coolant to spray
out, seriously scalding you.
Always let the engine and radiator cool
down before removing the radiator cap.
Radiator Cap
Table of Contents
480
uuMaintenance Under the HooduInverter Coolant
Maintenance
Inverter Coolant
This coolant is premixed with 50% antifreeze and 50% water. Do not add any
straight antifreeze or water.
We recommend you check the inverter coolant level every time you refuel. Check
the filler tank. Add the inverter coolant accordingly.
Have a dealer replace the inverter coolant.
1. Check the amount of coolant in the filler
tank.
2. If the coolant level is below the MIN mark,
add the specified coolant until it reaches
the MAX mark.
3. Inspect the cooling system for leaks.
Specified coolant: Honda Long Life Antifreeze/Coolant Type 2
Checking the Coolant
1Inverter Coolant
NOTICE
If temperatures consistently below −22°F (−30°C) are
expected, the coolant mixture should be changed to
a higher concentration. Consult a dealer for more
information.
If Honda antifreeze/coolant is not available, you may
use another major brand non-silicate coolant as a
temporary replacement. Check that it is a high quality
coolant recommended for aluminum engines.
Continued use of any non-Honda coolant can result
in corrosion, causing the cooling system to
malfunction or fail. Have the cooling system flushed
and refilled with Honda antifreeze/coolant as soon as
possible.
Do not add rust inhibitors or other additives to your
vehicle's coolant system. They may not be compatible
with the coolant or with the motor components.
MAX
MIN
Filler
Tank
Table of Contents
481
uuMaintenance Under the HooduTransmission Fluid
Maintenance
Transmission Fluid
Have a dealer check the fluid level and replace if necessary.
Specified fluid: Honda ATF DW-1 (automatic transmission fluid)
1Transmission Fluid
NOTICE
Do not mix Honda ATF DW-1 with other
transmission fluids.
Using a transmission fluid other than Honda ATF
DW-1 may adversely affect the operation and
durability of your vehicle's transmission, and damage
the transmission.
Any damage caused by using a transmission fluid that
is not equivalent to Honda ATF DW-1 is not covered
by Honda's new vehicle warranty.
Table of Contents
482
uuMaintenance Under the HooduBrake Fluid
Maintenance
Brake Fluid
The fluid level should be between the MIN
and MAX marks on the side of the reservoir.
Specified fluid: Honda Heavy Duty Brake Fluid DOT 3
Checking the Brake Fluid
1Brake Fluid
NOTICE
Brake fluid marked DOT 5 is not compatible with your
vehicle's braking system and can cause extensive
damage.
If the specified brake fluid is not available, you should
use only DOT 3 or DOT 4 fluid from a sealed
container as a temporary replacement.
Using any non-Honda brake fluid can cause corrosion
and decrease the longevity of the system. Have the
brake system flushed and refilled with Honda Heavy
Duty Brake Fluid DOT 3 as soon as possible.
If the brake fluid level is at or below the MIN mark,
have a dealer inspect for leaks or worn brake pads as
soon as possible.
Brake Reservoir
MIN
MAX
Table of Contents
483
uuMaintenance Under the HooduRefilling Window Washer Fluid
Maintenance
Refilling Window Washer Fluid
Check the amount of window washer fluid by looking at the reservoir.
If the level is low, fill the washer reservoir.
If the washer fluid is low, a message appears
on the multi-information display.
Pour the washer fluid carefully. Do not overflow the reservoir.
1Refilling Window Washer Fluid
NOTICE
Do not use engine antifreeze or a vinegar/water
solution in the windshield washer reservoir.
Antifreeze can damage your vehicle's paint. A
vinegar/water solution can damage the windshield
washer pump.
Canadian models
Table of Contents
484
Maintenance
Replacing Light Bulbs
Headlight Bulbs
When replacing, use the following bulbs.
1. Unlock the holding clips, then remove the
upper part of the air intake duct.
2. Remove the engine coolant reservoir.
High beam headlight: 60 W (HB3 for halogen bulb type)
Low beam headlight: LED type
*
Low beam headlight: 55 W (H11 for halogen bulb type)
*
High Beam Headlight
1Headlight Bulbs
NOTICE
Halogen bulbs get very hot when lit.
Oil, perspiration, or a scratch on the glass can cause
the bulb to overheat and shatter.
The headlight aim is set by the factory, and does not
need to be adjusted. However, if you regularly carry
heavy items in the trunk, have the aiming readjusted
at a dealer or by a qualified technician.
When replacing a halogen bulb, handle it by its base,
and protect the glass from contact with your skin or
hard objects. If you touch the glass, clean it with
denatured alcohol and a clean cloth.
The exterior lights' inside lenses (headlights, brake
lamps, etc.) may fog temporarily after a car wash or
while driving in the rain. This does not impact the
exterior light function.
However, if you see a large amount of water or ice
accumulated inside the lenses, have your vehicle
inspected by a dealer.
Holding
Clips
Passenger side
* Not available on all models
Table of Contents
Continued
485
uuReplacing Light BulbsuHeadlight Bulbs
Maintenance
3. Push the tab to remove the coupler.
4. Rotate the old bulb to the left to remove.
5. Insert a new bulb into the headlight
assembly and turn it to the right.
6. Insert the coupler into the connector of the
bulb.
1High Beam Headlight
Insert a flat-tip screwdriver, lift and remove the
central pin to remove the clip.
Insert the clip with the central pin raised, and push
until it is flat.
Holding clip
Central pin
Push until the
pin is flat.
Tab
Coupler
Bulb
Both sides
Table of Contents
uuReplacing Light BulbsuHeadlight Bulbs
486
Maintenance
1. Turn the steering wheel all the way to the
opposite side from the light being replaced.
Passenger side: Turn the steering wheel
to the left.
Driver side: Turn the steering wheel to the
right.
2. Remove the holding clip and screw, and
pull the inner fender back.
3. Push the tab to remove the coupler.
4. Rotate the old bulb to the left to remove.
5. Insert a new bulb into the headlight
assembly and turn it to the right.
6. Insert the coupler into the connector of the
bulb.
Low Beam Headlights
1Low Beam Headlights
Low beam headlight bulbs are LED type. Have an
authorized Honda dealer inspect and replace the light
assembly.
Insert a flat-tip screwdriver, lift and remove the
central pin to remove the clip.
Insert the clip with the central pin raised, and push
until it is flat.
Models with LED low beam headlights
Models with halogen low beam headlights
Central pin
Push until the
pin is flat.
Models with halogen low beam headlights
Screw
Holding Clip
Bulb
Coupler
Tab
Table of Contents
487
uuReplacing Light BulbsuFront Turn Signal/Side Marker Light Bulbs
Maintenance
Front Turn Signal/Side Marker Light Bulbs
When replacing, use the following bulbs.
Turn the steering wheel and pull the inner fender back in the same way as when
replacing the halogen low beam headlight bulbs
*
.
2 Low Beam Headlights P. 486
1. Turn the socket to the left and remove it.
2. Push in the old bulb, rotate to the left until
it unlocks, and remove.
3. Insert a new bulb.
Side Turn Signal/Emergency Indicator Light Bulbs
Door mirrors have the side turn lights. Have an authorized Honda dealer inspect and
replace the light assembly.
Parking/Daytime Running Light Bulbs
Parking/daytime running light bulbs are LED type. Have an authorized Honda dealer
inspect and replace the light assembly.
Front Turn Signal/Side Marker Light: 24/2.2 CP (Amber)
Bulb
Socket
* Not available on all models
Table of Contents
488
uuReplacing Light BulbsuBrake/Taillight, Rear Turn Signal Light, and Rear Side Marker Light Bulbs
Maintenance
Brake/Taillight, Rear Turn Signal Light, and Rear Side
Marker Light Bulbs
When replacing, use the following bulbs.
1. Remove the holding clips using a flat-tip
screwdriver, then pull the lining back.
2. Turn the socket to the left and remove it.
3. Remove the old bulb and insert a new bulb.
Brake/Taillight: LED
Rear Turn Signal Light: 21 W (Amber)
Rear Side Marker Light: LED
1Brake/Taillight, Rear Turn Signal Light, and Rear Side Marker
Light Bulbs
Brake/taillight and rear side marker light bulbs are
LED type. Have an authorized Honda dealer inspect
and replace the light assembly.
When removing the clip, insert a flat-tip screwdriver,
then lift and remove the clip.
Insert the clip with the pin raised, and push until it is
flat.
Clip
Push until the
pin is flat.
Holding Clip
Bulb Socket
Table of Contents
489
uuReplacing Light BulbsuTaillight and Back-Up Light Bulbs
Maintenance
Taillight and Back-Up Light Bulbs
When replacing, use the following bulbs.
1. Remove the holding clips using a flat-tip
screwdriver, then pull the lining back.
2 Brake/Taillight, Rear Turn Signal Light,
and Rear Side Marker Light Bulbs
P. 488
2. Turn the socket to the left and remove it.
3. Remove the old bulb and insert a new bulb.
Back-Up Light: 16 W
Taillight: LED
1Taillight and Back-Up Light Bulbs
Taillight bulbs are LED type. Have an authorized
Honda dealer inspect and replace the light assembly.
Holding Clip
Bulb
Socket
Table of Contents
490
uuReplacing Light BulbsuRear License Plate Light Bulbs
Maintenance
Rear License Plate Light Bulbs
When replacing, use the following bulbs.
1. Remove the license plate light assembly by
pushing the left edge of the lens toward the
right and pulling the assembly out.
2. Remove the lens by pushing the tabs.
3. Remove the old bulb and insert a new bulb.
High-Mount Brake Light Bulbs
High-mount brake light bulbs are the LED type. Have an authorized Honda dealer
inspect and replace the light assembly.
Rear License Plate Light: 5 W
Bulb
Tab
Lens
Table of Contents
491
Continued
Maintenance
Checking and Maintaining Wiper Blades
Checking Wiper Blades
If the wiper blade rubber has deteriorated, it will leave streaks and the metal wiper
arm may scratch the window glass.
Changing the Wiper Blade Rubber
1. Lift the driver side wiper arm first, then the
passenger side.
2. Press and hold the tab, then slide the blade
from the wiper arm.
1Changing the Wiper Blade Rubber
NOTICE
Avoid dropping the wiper arm; it may damage the
windshield.
Tab
Table of Contents
492
uuChecking and Maintaining Wiper BladesuChanging the Wiper Blade Rubber
Maintenance
3. Slide the wiper blade out from its holder by
pulling the tabbed end out.
4. Remove the retainers from the rubber blade
that has been removed, and mount to a
new rubber blade.
u Correctly align the rubber protrusion and
the retainer grooves.
5. Slide the new wiper blade onto the holder
from the bottom end.
u The tab on the holder should fit in the
indent of the wiper blade.
6. Slide the wiper blade onto the wiper arm,
then push down the lock tab.
7. Lower the passenger side wiper arm first,
then the driver side.
Blade
Top
Retainer
Blade
Tab
Indent
Table of Contents
493
Maintenance
Checking and Maintaining Tires
Checking Tires
To safely operate your vehicle, your tires must be of the proper type and size, in
good condition with adequate tread, and properly inflated.
Inflation guidelines
Properly inflated tires provide the best combination of handling, tread life, and comfort.
Refer to the driver’s doorjamb label or specification’s page for the specified pressure.
Underinflated tires wear unevenly, adversely affect handling and fuel economy, and
are more likely to fail from overheating.
Overinflated tires make your vehicle ride harshly, are more prone to road hazards,
and wear unevenly.
Every day before you drive, look at each of the tires. If one looks lower than the
others, check the pressure with a tire gauge.
At least once a month or before long trips, use a gauge to measure the pressure in
all tires. Even tires in good condition can lose 1 to 2 psi (10 to 20 kPa, 0.1 to 0.2
kgf/cm
2
) per month.
Inspection guidelines
Every time you check inflation, also examine the tires and valve stems.
Look for:
Bumps or bulges on the side or in the tread. Replace the tire if you find any cuts,
splits, or cracks in the side of the tire. Replace it if you see fabric or cord.
Remove any foreign objects and inspect for air leaks.
Uneven tread wear. Have a dealer check the wheel alignment.
Excessive tread wear.
2 Wear Indicators P. 498
Cracks or other damage around valve stem.
1Checking Tires
Measure the air pressure when tires are cold. This
means the vehicle has been parked for at least three
hours, or driven less than 1 mile (1.6 km). If
necessary, add or release air until the specified
pressure is reached.
If checked when hot, tire pressure can be as much as
4–6 psi (30–40 kPa, 0.3–0.4 kgf/cm
2
) higher than if
checked when cold.
Whenever tire pressure is adjusted, you must
calibrate the TPMS.
2 TPMS Calibration P. 447
Have a dealer check the tires if you feel a consistent
vibration while driving. New tires and any that have
been removed and reinstalled should be properly
balanced.
3
WARNING
Using tires that are excessively worn or
improperly inflated can cause a crash in
which you can be seriously hurt or killed.
Follow all instructions in this owner’s
manual regarding tire inflation and
maintenance.
Table of Contents
494
uuChecking and Maintaining TiresuTire and Loading Information Label
Maintenance
Tire and Loading Information Label
The label attached to the driver’s doorjamb provides necessary tire and loading
information.
Tire Labeling
The tires that came on your vehicle have a
number of markings. Those you should be
aware of are described below.
Whenever tires are replaced, they should be replaced with tires of the same size.
1Tire and Loading Information Label
The tire and loading information label attached to the
driver’s doorjamb contains:
a The number of people your vehicle can carry.
b The total weight your vehicle can carry. Do not
exceed this weight.
c The original tire sizes for front and rear.
d The proper cold tire pressure for front and rear.
Label
Example
Example
Tire Size
Tire
Identification
Number (TIN)
Maximum
Tire Load
Maximum
Tire Pressure
Tire Size
Tire Sizes
1Tire Sizes
Following is an example of tire size with an
explanation of what each component means.
225/50R17 94V
225: Tire width in millimeters.
50: Aspect ratio (the tire’s section height as a
percentage of its width).
R: Tire construction code (R indicates radial).
17: Rim diameter in inches.
94: Load index (a numerical code associated with the
maximum load the tire can carry).
V: Speed symbol (an alphabetical code indicating the
maximum speed rating).
Table of Contents
495
uuChecking and Maintaining Tires uTire Labeling
Maintenance
The tire identification number (TIN) is a group of numbers and letters that look like
the example in the side column. TIN is located on the sidewall of the tire.
Cold Tire Pressure – The tire air pressure when the vehicle has been parked for at
least three hours or driven less than 1 mile (1.6 km).
Load Rating – Means the maximum load that a tire is rated to carry for a given
inflation pressure.
Maximum Inflation Pressure – The maximum tire air pressure that the tire can
hold.
Maximum Load Rating – Means the load rating for a tire at the maximum
permissible inflation pressure for that tire.
Recommended Inflation Pressure – The cold tire inflation pressure recommended
by the manufacturer.
Treadwear Indicators (TWI) – Means the projections within the principal grooves
designed to give a visual indication of the degrees of wear of the tread.
Tire Identification Number (TIN)
Glossary of Tire Terminology
1Tire Identification Number (TIN)
DOT B97R FW6X 2209
DOT: This indicates that the tire meets all
requirements of the U.S. Department of
Transportation.
B97R: Manufacturer's identification mark.
FW6X: Tire type code.
22 09: Date of manufacture.
Year
Week
Table of Contents
496
uuChecking and Maintaining TiresuDOT Tire Quality Grading (U.S. Vehicles)
Maintenance
DOT Tire Quality Grading (U.S. Vehicles)
The tires on your vehicle meet all U.S. Federal Safety
Requirements. All tires are also graded for treadwear, traction,
and temperature performance according to Department of
Transportation (DOT) standards. The following explains these
gradings.
Quality grades can be found where applicable on the tire sidewall
between tread shoulder and maximum section width.
The treadwear grade is a comparative rating based on the wear
rate of the tire when tested under controlled conditions on a
specified government test course. For example, a tire graded 150
would wear one and one-half (1 1/2) times as well on the
government course as a tire graded 100. The relative performance
of tires depends upon the actual conditions of their use, however,
and may depart significantly from the norm due to variations in
driving habits, service practices and differences in road
characteristics and climate.
Uniform Tire Quality Grading
Treadwear
1Uniform Tire Quality Grading
For example:
Treadwear 200
Traction AA
Temperature A
All passenger car tires must conform
to Federal Safety Requirements in
addition to these grades.
Table of Contents
497
uuChecking and Maintaining TiresuDOT Tire Quality Grading (U.S. Vehicles)
Maintenance
The traction grades, from highest to lowest, are AA, A, B, and C.
Those grades represent the tire's ability to stop on wet pavement
as measured under controlled conditions on specified
government test surfaces of asphalt and concrete. A tire marked
C may have poor traction performance.
The temperature grades are A (the highest), B, and C,
representing the tire's resistance to the generation of heat and its
ability to dissipate heat when tested under controlled conditions
on a specified indoor laboratory test wheel. Sustained high
temperature can cause the material of the tire to degenerate and
reduce tire life, and excessive temperature can lead to sudden tire
failure. The grade C corresponds to a level of performance which
all passenger car tires must meet under the Federal Motor Vehicle
Safety Standard No. 109. Grades B and A represent higher levels
of performance on the laboratory test wheel than the minimum
required by law.
Traction
Temperature
1Traction
Warning: The traction grade
assigned to this tire is based on
straight-ahead braking traction tests,
and does not include acceleration,
cornering, hydroplaning, or peak
traction characteristics.
1Temperature
Warning: The temperature grade for
this tire is established for a tire that is
properly inflated and not
overloaded. Excessive speed,
underinflation, or excessive loading,
either separately or in combination,
can cause heat buildup and possible
tire failure.
Table of Contents
498
uuChecking and Maintaining TiresuWear Indicators
Maintenance
Wear Indicators
The groove where the wear indicator is
located is 1/16 inch (1.6 mm) shallower than
elsewhere on the tire. If the tread has worn so
that the indicator is exposed, replace the tire.
Worn out tires have poor traction on wet
roads.
Tire Service Life
The life of your tires is dependent on many factors, including driving habits, road
conditions, vehicle loading, inflation pressure, maintenance history, speed, and
environmental conditions (even when the tires are not in use).
In addition to regular inspections and inflation pressure maintenance, it is
recommended that you have annual inspections performed once the tires reach five
years old. All tires should be removed from service after 10 years from the date of
manufacture, regardless of their condition or state of wear.
1Checking Tires
High speed driving
We recommend that you do not drive faster than the
posted speed limits and conditions allow. If you drive
at sustained high speeds (over 99 mph or 160 km/h),
adjust the cold tire pressures as shown below to
avoid excessive heat build up and sudden tire failure.
Tire Size 225/50R17 94V
Pressure 35 psi (240 kPa, 2.4 kgf/cm
2
)
Example of a Wear
Indicator mark
Table of Contents
499
uuChecking and Maintaining TiresuTire and Wheel Replacement
Maintenance
Tire and Wheel Replacement
Replace your tires with radials of the same size, load range, speed rating, and
maximum cold tire pressure rating (as shown on the tire’s sidewall). Using tires of a
different size or construction can cause the ABS and VSA® (vehicle stability assist)
system to work incorrectly.
It is best to replace all four tires at the same time. If that isn’t possible, replace the
front or rear tires in pairs.
Make sure that the wheel’s specifications match those of the original wheels.
1Tire and Wheel Replacement
3
WARNING
Installing improper tires on your vehicle can
affect handling and stability. This can cause
a crash in which you can be seriously hurt or
killed.
Always use the size and type of tires
recommended in this owner’s manual.
Table of Contents
500
uuChecking and Maintaining TiresuTire Rotation
Maintenance
Tire Rotation
Rotating tires according to the maintenance messages on the multi-information
display helps to distribute wear more evenly and increase tire life.
Tires without rotation marks
Rotate the tires as shown here.
Tires with rotation marks
Rotate the tires as shown here.
1Tire Rotation
Tires with directional tread patterns should only be
rotated front to back (not from one side to the other).
Directional tires should be mounted with the rotation
indication mark facing forward, as shown below.
Whenever tires are rotated, you must calibrate the
TPMS.
2 TPMS Calibration P. 447
FRONT
Direction Mark
Front
Front
Table of Contents
501
uuChecking and Maintaining TiresuWinter Tires
Maintenance
Winter Tires
If driving on snowy or frozen roads, mount all season marked M+S tires, snow tires,
or tire chains; reduce speed; and maintain sufficient distance between vehicles when
driving.
Be particularly careful when operating the steering wheel or brakes to prevent
skidding.
Use tire chains, snow tires, or all season tires when necessary or according to the law.
When mounting, refer to the following points.
For winter tires:
Select the size and load ranges that are the same as the original tires.
Mount the tires to all four wheels.
For tire chains:
Install them on the front tires only.
Because your vehicle has limited tire clearance, we strongly recommend using the
chains listed below:
Follow the chain manufacturer's instruction when installing. Mount them as
tightly as you can.
Check that the chains do not touch the brake lines or suspension.
Drive slowly.
Cable-type: SCC Radial Chain SC1036
1Winter Tires
NOTICE
Traction devices that are the wrong size or improperly
installed can damage your vehicle's brake lines,
suspension, body, and wheels. Stop driving if they are
hitting any part of the vehicle.
When tire chains are mounted, follow the chain
manufacturer's instructions regarding vehicle
operational limits.
If your vehicle is equipped with summer tires, be
aware that these tires are not designed for winter
driving conditions. For more information, contact a
dealer.
3
WARNING
Using the wrong chains, or not properly
installing chains, can damage the brake
lines and cause a crash in which you can be
seriously injured or killed.
Follow all instructions in this owner's
manual regarding the selection and use of
tire chains.
Table of Contents
502
Maintenance
12-Volt Battery
Checking the 12-Volt Battery
Check the battery terminals for corrosion
monthly.
The battery condition is being monitored by
the sensor on the negative terminal. If there is
a problem with the sensor, the warning
message on the multi-information display will
let you know. Have your vehicle checked by a
dealer.
If your vehicle's battery is disconnected or goes dead:
The audio system is disabled.
2 Reactivating the audio system P. 173
The clock resets.
2 Clock P. 110
The navigation system
*
is disabled.
2 Refer to the Navigation System Manual
Charging the 12-Volt Battery
Disconnect both battery cables to prevent damaging your vehicle's electrical system.
Always disconnect the negative (–) cable first, and reconnect it last.
112-Volt Battery
WARNING: Battery post, terminals,
and related accessories contain lead
and lead compounds.
Wash your hands after handling.
When you find corrosion, clean the battery terminals
by applying a baking powder and water solution.
Clean the terminals with a damp towel. Cloth/towel
dry the battery. Coat the terminals with grease to
help prevent future corrosion.
When replacing the battery, the replacement must be
of the same specifications.
Please consult a dealer for more information.
3
WARNING
The battery gives off explosive hydrogen
gas during normal operation.
A spark or flame can cause the battery to
explode with enough force to kill or
seriously hurt you.
When conducting any battery
maintenance, wear protective clothing and
a face shield, or have a skilled technician do
it.
* Not available on all models
Table of Contents
503
Maintenance
Remote Transmitter Care
Replacing the Button Battery
If the indicator does not come on when the button is pressed, replace the battery.
1. Remove the built-in key.
2. Remove the upper half of the cover by
carefully prying on the edge with a coin.
u Remove carefully to avoid losing the
buttons.
u Wrap a coin with a cloth to prevent
scratching the smart entry remote.
3. Make sure to replace the battery with the
correct polarity.
1Replacing the Button Battery
NOTICE
An improperly disposed of battery can damage the
environment. Always confirm local regulations for
battery disposal.
Replacement batteries are commercially available or
at a dealer.
Battery type: CR2032
Battery
Table of Contents
504
Maintenance
Climate Control System Maintenance
Dust and Pollen Filter
The climate control system is equipped with a dust and pollen filter that collects
pollen, dust, and other debris in the air. The Maintenance Minder
TM
messages will let
you know when to replace the filter.
We recommend that you replace the dust and pollen filter sooner when using your
vehicle in areas with high concentrations of dust.
1Dust and Pollen Filter
If the airflow from the climate control system
deteriorates noticeably, and the windows fog up
easily, the filter may need to be replaced. Please
contact a dealer for replacement.
Table of Contents
505
Continued
Maintenance
Cleaning
Interior Care
Use a damp cloth with a mixture of mild detergent and warm water to remove dirt.
Use a clean cloth to remove detergent residue.
Use a soft brush with a mixture of mild soap and warm water to clean the seat belts.
Let the belts air dry. Wipe the openings of the seat belt anchors using a clean cloth.
Cleaning Seat Belts
1Interior Care
Do not spill liquids inside the vehicle.
Electrical devices and systems may malfunction if
liquids are splashed on them.
Do not use silicone based sprays on electrical devices
such as audio devices and switches.
Doing so may cause the items to malfunction or a fire
inside the vehicle.
If a silicone based spray is inadvertently used on
electrical devices, consult a dealer.
Depending on their composition, chemicals and
liquid aromatics may cause discoloration, wrinkles,
and cracking to resin-based parts and textiles.
Do not use alkali solvents or organic solvents such as
benzene or gasoline.
After using chemicals, make sure to gently wipe them
off using a dry cloth.
Do not place used cloths on top of resin based parts
or textiles for long periods of time without washing.
Opening
Table of Contents
uuCleaninguInterior Care
506
Maintenance
The driver’s floor mat hooks over the floor
anchors, which keep the mat from sliding
forward. To remove a mat for cleaning, turn
the anchor knobs to the unlock position.
When reinstalling the mat after cleaning, turn
the knobs to the lock position.
Do not put additional floor mats on top of
the anchored mat.
Vacuum dirt and dust from the leather frequently. Pay close attention to the pleats
and seams. Clean the leather with a soft cloth dampened with a 90% water and
10% neutral soap solution. Then buff it with a clean, dry cloth. Remove any dust or
dirt on leather surfaces immediately.
Floor Mats
1Floor Mats
If you use any floor mats that were not originally
provided with your vehicle, make sure they are
designed for your specific vehicle, fit correctly, and
are securely anchored by the floor anchors.
Position the rear seat floor mats properly. If they are
not properly positioned, the floor mats can interfere
with the front seat functions.
Lock
Unlock
Maintaining Genuine Leather
*
* Not available on all models
Table of Contents
507
uuCleaninguExterior Care
Continued
Maintenance
Exterior Care
Dust off the vehicle body after you drive.
Regularly inspect your vehicle for scratches on painted surfaces. A scratch on a
painted surface can result in body rust. If you find a scratch, promptly repair it.
Wash the vehicle regularly. Wash more frequently when driving in the following
conditions:
If driving on roads with road salt.
If driving in coastal areas.
If tar, soot, bird droppings, insects, or tree sap are stuck to painted surfaces.
Fold in the door mirrors. Make sure to follow the instructions indicated on the
automated car wash.
Keep sufficient distance between the cleaning nozzle and the vehicle body.
Take particular care around the windows. Standing too close may cause water to
enter the vehicle interior.
Do not spray high pressure water directly into the engine compartment. Instead,
use low pressure water and a mild detergent.
Washing the Vehicle
Using an Automated Car Wash
Using High Pressure Cleaners
1Washing the Vehicle
Do not spray water into the air intake vents. It can
cause a malfunction.
Air Intake Vents
Table of Contents
uuCleaninguExterior Care
508
Maintenance
A good coat of automotive body wax helps protect your vehicle’s paint from the
elements. Wax will wear off over time and expose your vehicle’s paint to the
elements, so reapply as necessary.
If you get gasoline, oil, engine coolant, or battery fluid on resin coated parts, they
may be stained or the coating may peel. Promptly wipe it away using a soft cloth and
clean water.
Wipe using a glass cleaner.
Aluminum is susceptible to deterioration caused by salt and other road
contaminants. Use a sponge and mild detergent to wipe away promptly.
Be careful not to use harsh chemicals (including some commercial wheel cleaners) or
a stiff brush. They can damage the clear coat of the aluminum alloy wheels that
helps keep the aluminum from corroding and tarnishing.
Applying Wax
Maintaining the Bumpers and Other Resin Coated Parts
Cleaning the Window
Maintaining Aluminum Wheels
1Applying Wax
NOTICE
Chemical solvents and strong cleaners can damage
the paint, metal, and plastic on your vehicle. Wipe up
spills immediately.
1Maintaining the Bumpers and Other Resin Coated Parts
Ask a dealer about the correct coating material when
you want to repair the painted surface of the parts
made of resin.
1Cleaning the Window
Wires are mounted to the inside of the rear window.
Wipe along the same direction as the wires with a
soft cloth so as not to damage them.
Table of Contents
509
Handling the Unexpected
This chapter explains how to handle unexpected troubles.
If a Tire Goes Flat
Temporarily Repairing a Flat Tire....... 510
Power System Won’t Start
Checking the Procedure...................519
If the Smart Entry Remote Battery is
Weak..........................................520
Power System Off ............................ 521
Jump Starting.................................... 522
Shift Lever Does Not Move.............. 524
Overheating
How to Handle Overheating............. 525
Indicator, Coming On/Blinking
If the Low Oil Pressure Indicator Comes
On ............................................. 528
If the 12-Volt Battery Charging System
Indicator Comes On ....................... 528
If the Malfunction Indicator Lamp Comes
On or Blinks ................................... 529
If the Brake System Indicator (Red)
Comes On.................................. 530
If the Electric Power Steering (EPS) System
Indicator Comes On............................530
If the Low Tire Pressure/TPMS Indicator
Comes On or Blinks ....................... 531
Fuses
Fuse Locations ................................. 532
Inspecting and Changing Fuses........ 534
Emergency Towing........................... 535
Main Menu
510
Handling the Unexpected
If a Tire Goes Flat
Temporarily Repairing a Flat Tire
This vehicle is not equipped with a spare tire. If the tire has a large cut or is otherwise
severely damaged, you will need to have the vehicle towed. If the tire only has a
small puncture, from a nail for instance, you can use the temporary tire repair kit so
that you can drive to the nearest service station for a more permanent repair.
If a tire goes flat while driving, grasp the steering wheel firmly, and brake gradually
to reduce speed. Then stop in a safe place.
1. Park the vehicle on firm, level, and non-slippery surface and apply the parking
brake.
2. Put the shift lever in
(P .
3. Turn on the hazard warning lights and set the power mode to VEHICLE OFF
(LOCK).
1Temporarily Repairing a Flat Tire
The kit should not be used in the following situations.
Instead, contact a dealer or a roadside assistant to
have the vehicle towed.
The tire sealant has expired.
More than two tires are punctured.
The puncture or cut is larger than 3/16 inch (4mm).
The tire side wall is damaged or the puncture is
outside the tire contact area.
Damage has been caused by driving with the tire
extremely under inflated.
The tire bead is no longer seated.
The rim is damaged.
Do not remove a nail or screw that punctured the
tire. If you remove it from the tire, you may not be
able to repair the puncture using the kit.
When the puncture is: Kit Use
Smaller than 3/16 inch
(4 mm)
Yes
Larger than 3/16 inch
(4 mm)
No
Contact
Area
Table of Contents
Continued
511
uuIf a Tire Goes FlatuTemporarily Repairing a Flat Tire
Handling the Unexpected
1. Open the trunk floor lid.
2. Open the fastener and take the kit out of
the case.
3. Place the kit face up, on flat ground near
the flat tire, and away from traffic. Do not
place the kit on its side.
Getting Ready to Temporarily Repair the Flat Tire
1Getting Ready to Temporarily Repair the Flat Tire
When making a temporary repair, carefully read the
instruction manual provided with the kit.
In cold temperatures, the sealant may not flow easily.
In this situation, warm it up for five minutes before
using.
Instruction
Manual
Air Only Hose (Black)
Speed Restriction Label
Repair Notification Label
Pressure Relief
Button
Inflator Switch
Selector Switch
SEALANT/AIR side
Sealant/Air Hose (Clear)
AIR ONLY side
Power Plug
Pressure Gauge
Tire Sealant
Expiration Date
Fastener
Trunk Floor Lid
Tire Repair Kit
Table of Contents
uuIf a Tire Goes FlatuTemporarily Repairing a Flat Tire
512
Handling the Unexpected
1. Remove the valve cap from the tire valve
stem.
2. Remove the sealant/air hose from the
packaging.
3. Attach the sealant/air hose onto the tire
valve stem. Screw it until it is tight.
Injecting Sealant and Air
1Injecting Sealant and Air
In cold temperatures, the sealant may not flow easily.
In this situation, warm it up for five minutes before
using.
The sealant can permanently stain clothing and other
materials. Be careful during handling and wipe away
any spills immediately.
3
WARNING
Tire sealant contains substances that are
harmful and can be fatal if swallowed.
If accidentally swallowed, do not induce
vomiting. Drink plenty of water and get
medical attention immediately.
For skin or eye contact, flush with cool
water and get medical attention if
necessary.
Valve Stem
Valve Cap
Sealant/Air Hose
Valve Stem
Sealant/Air Hose
Table of Contents
Continued
513
uuIf a Tire Goes FlatuTemporarily Repairing a Flat Tire
Handling the Unexpected
4. Plug in the compressor to the accessory
power socket.
u Be careful not to pinch the cord in a
door or window.
5. Turn the power system on.
u Keep the power system on while
injecting sealant and air.
2 Carbon Monoxide Gas P. 68
6. Turn the selector switch to SEALANT/
AIR.
7. Press the inflator switch to turn on the
compressor.
u The compressor starts injecting sealant
and air into the tire.
8. When the sealant injection is complete,
continue to add air.
9. After the air pressure reaches front: 33 psi
(230kPa)/rear: 33 psi (225 kPa), turn off
the kit.
u To check the pressure, occasionally turn
off the compressor and read the gauge.
1Injecting Sealant and Air
NOTICE
Do not operate the tire repair kit compressor for
more than 15 minutes. The accessory power socket
and compressor can overheat and become
permanently damaged.
Until the sealant injection is complete, the pressure
shown on the pressure gauge will appear higher than
actual. After the sealant injection is complete the
pressure will drop and then begin to rise again as the
tire is inflated with air. This is normal. To accurately
measure the air pressure using the gauge, turn the air
compressor off only after the sealant injection is
complete.
If the required air pressure is not reached within 10
minutes, the tire may be too severely damaged for
the kit to provide the necessary seal and your vehicle
will need to be towed.
3
WARNING
Running the engine with the vehicle in an
enclosed or even partly enclosed area can cause
a rapid build-up of toxic carbon monoxide.
Breathing this colorless, odorless gas can
cause unconsciousness and even death.
Only run the engine to power the air
compressor with the vehicle outdoors.
SEALANT/AIR side
Pressure Gauge
ON
OFF
Table of Contents
uuIf a Tire Goes FlatuTemporarily Repairing a Flat Tire
514
Handling the Unexpected
10. Unplug the power plug from the accessory
power socket.
11. Unscrew the sealant/air hose from the tire
valve stem. Reinstall the valve cap.
12. Press the pressure relief button until the
gauge returns 0 psi (0 kPa).
13. Apply the repair notification label to the
flat surface of the wheel.
u The wheel surface must be clean to
ensure the label adheres properly.
1Injecting Sealant and Air
See a dealer for a replacement sealant bottle and
proper disposal of an empty bottle.
Sealant/Air Hose
Valve Stem
Repair Notification Label
Table of Contents
Continued
515
uuIf a Tire Goes FlatuTemporarily Repairing a Flat Tire
Handling the Unexpected
1. Apply the speed restriction label to the
location as shown.
2. Drive the vehicle for about 10 minutes.
u Do not exceed 50 mph (80 km/h).
3. Stop the vehicle in a safe place.
4. Attach the air only hose onto the tire valve
stem. Screw it until it is tight.
5. Turn the selector switch to AIR ONLY.
u Do not turn the air compressor on to
check the pressure.
2 Inflating An Under-inflated Tire P. 517
Distributing the Sealant in the Tire
1Distributing the Sealant in the Tire
Stop and recheck the air pressure after every 10
minutes of driving as necessary until you reach the
nearest service station where you are able to have the
tire permanently repaired or replaced.
3
WARNING
Running the engine with the vehicle in an
enclosed or even partly enclosed area can
cause a rapid build-up of toxic carbon
monoxide.
Breathing this colorless, odorless gas can
cause unconsciousness and even death.
Only run the engine to power the air
compressor with the vehicle outdoors.
Speed Restriction Label
Air Only Hose
Table of Contents
516
uuIf a Tire Goes FlatuTemporarily Repairing a Flat Tire
Handling the Unexpected
6. If the air pressure is:
Less than 19 psi (130 kPa):
Do not add air or continue driving. The leak is too severe. Call for help and
have your vehicle towed.
2 Emergency Towing P. 535
Front: 33 psi (230kPa)/rear: 33 psi (225 kPa) or more:
Continue driving for another 10 minutes or until you reach the nearest service
station. Do not exceed 50 mph (80 km/h).
u If the air does not go down after the 10 minute driving, you do not need to
check the pressure any more.
Greater than 19 psi (130kPa), but less than front: 33 psi (230kPa)/rear: 33 psi
(225 kPa):
Turn the air compressor on to inflate the tire until the tire pressure reaches front:
33 psi (230kPa)/rear: 33 psi (225 kPa).
Then drive carefully for 10 more minutes or until you reach the nearest service
station. Do not exceed 50 mph (80 km/h).
u You should repeat this procedure as long as the air pressure is within this
range.
7. Press the pressure relief button until the gauge returns to 0 psi (kPa).
8. Repackage and properly stow the kit.
Table of Contents
Continued
517
uuIf a Tire Goes FlatuTemporarily Repairing a Flat Tire
Handling the Unexpected
You can use the kit to inflate a non-punctured under-inflated tire.
1. Open the trunk floor lid.
2 Getting Ready to Temporarily Repair
the Flat Tire P. 511
2. Remove the kit from the case.
u Place the kit on flat ground near the tire
to be inflated, away from traffic.
3. Place the kit, face up, on flat ground near
the flat tire, away from traffic. Do not
place the kit on its side.
4. Remove the air only hose from the kit.
5. Remove the valve cap.
6. Attach the air only hose onto the tire valve
stem. Screw it until it is tight.
Inflating An Under-inflated Tire
1Inflating An Under-inflated Tire
NOTICE
Do not operate the temporary tire repair kit
compressor for more than 15 minutes. The accessory
power socket and compressor can overheat and
become permanently damaged.
Air Only Hose
Valve Cap
Valve Stem
Air Only Hose
Table of Contents
uuIf a Tire Goes FlatuTemporarily Repairing a Flat Tire
518
Handling the Unexpected
7. Plug in the kit to the accessory power
socket.
u Be careful not to pinch the cord in a
door or window.
8. Turn the power system on.
u Keep the power system on while
injecting sealant and air.
2 Carbon Monoxide Gas P. 68
9. Turn the selector switch to AIR ONLY.
10. Press the inflator switch to turn on the kit.
u The compressor starts to inject air into
the tire.
11. Inflate the tire to the specified air pressure.
12. Turn off the kit.
u Check the pressure gauge on the air
compressor.
u If overinflated, press the pressure relief
button.
13. Unplug the kit from the accessory power
socket.
14. Unscrew the air only hose from the tire
valve stem. Reinstall the valve cap.
15. Press the pressure relief button until the
gauge returns 0 psi (0 kPa).
16. Repackage and properly stow the kit.
1Inflating An Under-inflated Tire
3
WARNING
Running the engine with the vehicle in an
enclosed or even partly enclosed area can
cause a rapid build-up of toxic carbon
monoxide.
Breathing this colorless, odorless gas can
cause unconsciousness and even death.
Only run the engine to power the air
compressor with the vehicle outdoors.
AIR ONLY
side
ON
Pressure Relief Button
Table of Contents
519
Handling the Unexpected
Power System Won’t Start
Checking the Procedure
When the READY indicator does not come on and the Ready to Drive message
does not appear on the multi-information display, check the following items and
take appropriate action.
Checklist Condition What to Do
Check if the related
indicator or multi-
information display
messages come on.
The Temperature is Too Cold For Vehicle To Operate
message appears
2 Multi-Information Display Warning and
Information Messages P. 84
The To Start, Hold Remote Near Start Button message
appears
uMake sure the smart entry remote is in its operating range.
2 POWER Button Operating Range P. 133
2 If the Smart Entry Remote Battery is Weak
P. 520
The POWER SYSTEM indicator comes on Have your vehicle checked by a dealer.
Check the brightness
of the interior lights.
The interior lights are dim or do not come on at all Have the 12-volt battery checked by a dealer.
The interior lights come on normally Check all fuses, or have your vehicle checked by
a dealer.
2 Inspecting and Changing Fuses P. 534
Check the shift lever
position.
The shift lever is not in (P or (N Move the shift lever to the (P position.
Check the
immobilizer system
indicator.
When the immobilizer system indicator is blinking, the power
system cannot be turned on.
2 Immobilizer System Indicator P. 80
1Checking the Procedure
If you must start the vehicle immediately, use an
assisting vehicle to jump start it.
2 Jump Starting P. 522
Table of Contents
520
uuPower System Won’t StartuIf the Smart Entry Remote Battery is Weak
Handling the Unexpected
If the Smart Entry Remote Battery is Weak
If the beeper sounds, the To Start, Hold Remote Near Start Button message
appears on the multi-information display, and the indicator on the POWER button
flashes, the READY indicator does not come on.
Turn on the power system as follows.
1. Touch the center of the POWER button
with the H logo on the smart entry remote
while the indicator on the POWER button is
flashing. The buttons on the smart entry
remote should be facing you.
u The indicator flashes for about 30
seconds.
2. Depress the brake pedal and press the
POWER button within 10 seconds after the
beeper sounds and the indicator stays on.
u If you don’t depress the pedal, the mode
will change to ACCESSORY.
Table of Contents
521
uuPower System Won’t StartuPower System Off
Handling the Unexpected
Power System Off
The POWER button may be used to turn the power system off due to an emergency
situation even while driving. If you must turn the power system off, do either of the
following operations:
Press and hold the POWER button for about two seconds.
Firmly press the POWER button twice.
The steering wheel will not lock. The power mode changes to VEHICLE OFF with
the shift lever in
(P , and to ACCESSORY with the shift lever in any position other
than
(P .
Because turning off the power system also disables the power assist the power
system provides to the steering and braking systems, it will require significantly
more physical effort and time to steer and slow the vehicle. Use both feet on the
brake pedal, if necessary, to slow the vehicle and stop immediately in a safe place.
1Power System Off
NOTICE
Do not press the button while driving unless it is
absolutely necessary for the power system to be
turned off.
Table of Contents
522
Handling the Unexpected
Jump Starting
Turn off the power to electric devices, such as audio and lights. Turn off the power
system, then open the hood.
1. Connect the first jumper cable to your
vehicle's 12-volt battery + terminal.
2. Connect the other end of the first jumper
cable to the booster battery + terminal.
u Use a 12-volt booster battery only.
3. Connect the second jumper cable to the
booster battery - terminal.
4. Connect the other end of the second
jumper cable to the engine mounting bolt
as shown. Do not connect this jumper cable
to any other part.
5. If your vehicle is connected to another
vehicle, start the assisting vehicle's engine
and increase its rpm slightly.
6. Attempt to start your vehicle's engine. If it
turns over slowly, check that the jumper
cables have good metal-to-metal contact.
Jump Starting Procedure
1Jump Starting
Securely attach the jumper cables clips so that they
do not come off when the engine vibrates. Also be
careful not to tangle the jumper cables or allow the
cable ends to touch each other while attaching or
detaching the jumper cables.
12-volt battery performance degrades in cold
conditions and may prevent the engine from starting.
3
WARNING
A 12-volt battery can explode if you do not
follow the correct procedure, seriously
injuring anyone nearby.
Keep all sparks, open flames, and smoking
materials away from the 12-volt battery.
Booster Battery
Table of Contents
523
uuJump Startingu
Handling the Unexpected
Once your vehicle's engine has started, remove the jumper cables in the following
order.
1. Disconnect the jumper cable from your vehicle's ground.
2. Disconnect the other end of the jumper cable from the booster battery -
terminal.
3. Disconnect the jumper cable from your vehicle's 12-volt battery + terminal.
4. Disconnect the other end of the jumper cable from the booster battery +
terminal.
Have your vehicle inspected by a dealer.
What to Do After the Engine Starts
Table of Contents
524
Handling the Unexpected
Shift Lever Does Not Move
Follow the procedure below if you cannot move the shift lever out of the (P
position.
1. Set the parking brake.
2. Remove the built-in key from the smart
entry remote.
3. Wrap a cloth around the tip of a small flat-
tip screwdriver. Put it into the shift lock
release slot as shown in the image, and
remove the cover.
4. Insert the key into the shift lock release slot.
5. While pushing the key down, press the shift
lever release button and place the shift lever
into
(N .
u The lock is now released. Have the shift
lever checked by a dealer as soon as
possible.
Releasing the Lock
Slot
Cover
Release Button
Shift Lock
Release
Slot
Table of Contents
525
Continued
Handling the Unexpected
Overheating
How to Handle Overheating
Overheating symptoms are as follows:
The High Temperature. Power Reduced. message appears on the multi-
information display.
The Engine Temperature Too Hot message appears on the multi-information
display.
Steam or spray comes out of the engine compartment.
The High Temperature. Power Reduced. message appears on the multi-
information display when the power system temperature is high.
2 Multi-Information Display Warning and Information Messages P. 90
1. Immediately park the vehicle in a safe place.
u Move the shift lever to
(P , and set the parking brake. Turn off all accessories
and turn on the hazard warning lights.
2. Keep the power mode on, and wait until the message disappears.
u If the message does not disappear, have your vehicle inspected at a dealer.
The High Temperature. Power Reduced. Message Appears
on the Multi-Information Display
Table of Contents
uuOverheatinguHow to Handle Overheating
526
Handling the Unexpected
First thing to do
1. Immediately park the vehicle in a safe place.
2. Turn off all accessories and turn on the hazard warning lights.
u No steam or spray present: Keep the power system on and open the hood.
u Steam or spray is present: Turn off the power system and wait until it
subsides. Then open the hood.
The Engine Temperature Too Hot Message Appears on the
Multi-Information Display
1The Engine Temperature Too Hot Message Appears on the Multi-
Information Display
NOTICE
Continuing to drive with the Engine Temperature
Too Hot message on the multi-information display
may damage the engine.
3
WARNING
Steam and spray from an overheated
engine can seriously scald you.
Do not open the hood if steam is coming
out.
Table of Contents
527
uuOverheatinguHow to Handle Overheating
Handling the Unexpected
Next thing to do
1. Check that the cooling fan is operating and
turn the power system off once the Engine
Temperature Too Hot message
disappears.
u If the cooling fan is not operating,
immediately turn the power system off.
2. Once the engine has cooled down, inspect
the coolant level and check the cooling
system components for leaks.
u If the coolant level in the engine coolant
reservoir is low, add coolant until it
reaches the MAX mark.
u If there is no coolant in the engine
coolant reservoir, check that the radiator
is cool. Cover the radiator cap with a
heavy cloth and open the cap. If
necessary, add coolant up to the base of
the filler neck, and put the cap back on.
Last thing to do
Once the engine has cooled sufficiently, turn the power system on.
If the Engine Temperature Too Hot message does not appear, resume driving. If
it appears again, contact a dealer for repairs.
1The Engine Temperature Too Hot Message Appears on the Multi-
Information Display
If the coolant is leaking, contact a dealer for repairs.
Use water as an emergency/temporary measure only.
Have a dealer flush the system with proper antifreeze
as soon as possible.
3
WARNING
Removing the radiator cap while the
engine is hot can cause the coolant to spray
out, seriously scalding you.
Always let the engine and radiator cool
down before removing the radiator cap.
Engine
Coolant
Reservoir
MAX
MIN
Table of Contents
528
Handling the Unexpected
Indicator, Coming On/Blinking
If the Low Oil Pressure Indicator Comes On
Reasons for the indicator to come on
Comes on when the engine oil pressure is low.
What to do as soon as the indicator comes on
1. Immediately park the vehicle in a safe place.
2. If necessary, turn the hazard warning lights on.
What to do after parking the vehicle
1. Turn the power system off and let the engine sit for about one
minute.
2. Open the hood and check the oil level.
u Add oil as necessary.
3. Turn the power system on and check the low oil pressure indicator.
u The indicator goes off: Start driving again.
u The indicator does not go off within 10 seconds: Turn the power
off and contact a dealer for repairs immediately.
If the 12-Volt Battery Charging System Indicator
Comes On
Reasons for the indicator to come on
Comes on when the 12-volt battery is not being charged.
What to do when the indicator comes on
Turn off the climate control system, rear defogger, and other electrical
systems, and immediately contact a dealer for repairs.
1If the Low Oil Pressure Indicator Comes On
NOTICE
Running the engine with low oil pressure can cause
serious mechanical damage almost immediately.
Table of Contents
529
uuIndicator, Coming On/BlinkinguIf the Malfunction Indicator Lamp Comes On or Blinks
Handling the Unexpected
If the Malfunction Indicator Lamp Comes On or
Blinks
Reasons for the indicator lamp to come on or blink
Comes on when there is a problem with the engine emissions control
system, or the fuel fill cap is missing, or loose.
Blinks when engine misfiring is detected.
What to do when the indicator lamp comes on
Avoid high speeds and immediately get your vehicle inspected at a
dealer.
What to do when the indicator lamp blinks
Park the vehicle in a safe place with no flammable items and wait at least
ten minutes or more with the engine stopped until it cools.
The message appears on when:
An evaporative system leak is detected. This may be caused by the fuel fill cap being
loose or not being installed.
What to do when the message appears:
1. Turn the power system off.
2. Check if the fuel fill cap is fully installed.
u If not, loosen the cap, and then retighten it until it clicks at least once.
3. Drive for several days of normal driving.
u The message should go off.
When the malfunction indicator lamp comes on
The malfunction indicator lamp comes on if the system continues to detect a leak of
gasoline vapor. If this happens, check the fuel fill cap using the procedures described
above.
Tighten Fuel Cap Message
1If the Malfunction Indicator Lamp Comes On or Blinks
NOTICE
If you drive with the malfunction indicator lamp on,
the emissions control system and the engine could be
damaged.
If the malfunction indicator lamp blinks again next
time the engine starts, drive to the nearest dealer at
31 mph (50 km/h) or less. Have your vehicle
inspected.
Table of Contents
530
uuIndicator, Coming On/BlinkinguIf the Brake System Indicator (Red) Comes On
Handling the Unexpected
If the Brake System Indicator (Red) Comes On
Reasons for the indicator to come on
The brake fluid is low.
There is a malfunction in the brake system.
What to do when the indicator comes on while driving
Press the brake pedal lightly to check pedal pressure.
If normal, check the brake fluid level the next time you stop.
If abnormal, take immediate action. If necessary, downshift the
transmission to slow the vehicle using regenerative braking.
If the Electric Power Steering (EPS) System Indicator
Comes On
Reasons for the indicator to come on
Comes on when there is a problem with the EPS system.
What to do when the indicator comes on
Stop the vehicle in a safe place and turn on the power system again.
If the indicator comes on and stays on, immediately have your vehicle
inspected by a dealer.
1If the Brake System Indicator (Red) Comes On
Have your vehicle repaired immediately.
It is dangerous to drive with low brake fluid. If there
is no resistance from the brake pedal, stop
immediately in a safe place. If necessary downshift
the transmission.
If the brake system indicator (red) and ABS indicator
come on simultaneously, the electronic brake
distribution system is not working. This can result in
vehicle instability under sudden braking.
Have your vehicle inspected by a dealer immediately.
If both red and amber brake system indicators come
on, stop the vehicle in a safe place and have it
inspected by a dealer immediately.
U.S.
Canada
Table of Contents
531
uuIndicator, Coming On/BlinkinguIf the Low Tire Pressure/TPMS Indicator Comes On or Blinks
Handling the Unexpected
If the Low Tire Pressure/TPMS Indicator Comes On or
Blinks
Reasons for the indicator to come on or blink
A tire pressure is significantly low, or the TPMS has not been calibrated.
If there is a problem with the TPMS, the indicator blinks for about one
minute, and then stays on.
What to do when the indicator comes on
Drive carefully and avoid abrupt cornering and hard braking.
Stop your vehicle in a safe place. Check the tire pressure and adjust the
pressure to the specified level. The specified tire pressure is on a label on
the driver side doorjamb.
u Calibrate the TPMS after the tire pressure is adjusted.
What to do when the indicator blinks, then remains on
Have the tire inspected by a dealer as soon as possible.
1If the Low Tire Pressure/TPMS Indicator Comes On or Blinks
NOTICE
Driving on an extremely underinflated tire can cause
it to overheat. An overheated tire can fail. Always
inflate your tires to the prescribed level.
Table of Contents
532
Handling the Unexpected
Fuses
Fuse Locations
If any electrical devices are not working, set
the power mode to VEHICLE OFF, and check
to see if any applicable fuse is blown.
Located near the brake fluid reservoir. Push
the tabs to open the box.
Fuse locations are shown on the fuse box
cover. Locate the fuse in question by the
fuse number and box cover number.
Circuit protected and fuse rating
Engine Compartment Fuse Box
Circuit Protected Amps
1 Battery 150 A
2
EPS 70 A
ESB 40 A
Engine Electric Water Pump 20 A
Fuse Box Option 1 40 A
ABS/VSA Motor 30 A
RFC 40 A
IG Main 1 30 A
3
Headlight Low Beam Main 30 A
Left E-PT
*
(30 A)
IG Main 2 30 A
Wiper Motor 30 A
4 FI Main 15 A
5 PCU Electric Water Pump 7.5 A
6EVTC 20A
7 IG Hold 10 A
8 DBW 15 A
9 IG Coil 15 A
10 Stop Light 10 A
11 FI Sub 15 A
12
Fuse Box Main 2 60 A
Rear Defogger 50 A
Fuse Box Main 1 60 A
ABS/VSA FSR 40 A
Fuse Box 30 A
−−
Heater Motor 40 A
−−
Small Light 20 A
Fuse Box Option 2 40 A
13 PTC 4 40 A
14 PTC 2 40 A
15 Front Fog Light
*
(15 A)
16 Horn 10 A
17 IG Hold 3-L/R 15 A
Circuit Protected Amps
*1:Models with halogen low beam
headlights
*2:Models with LED low beam headlights
18 Interior Light 7.5 A
19 DRL (7.5 A)
20 Premium Amp
*
(20 A)
21 Back Up 10 A
22 Audio 15 A
23 Fan Timer 7.5 A
24 Right Headlight Low Beam
10 A
*1
15 A
*2
25 Left Headlight Low Beam
10 A
*1
15 A
*2
26
Circuit Protected Amps
* Not available on all models
Table of Contents
533
uuFusesuFuse Locations
Handling the Unexpected
Located under the dashboard.
Fuse locations are shown on the label on
the side panel.
Locate the fuse in question by the fuse
number and label number.
Circuit protected and fuse rating
Interior Fuse Box
Fuse Label
Circuit Protected Amps
1 A/C 7.5 A
2 DRL 7.5 A
3
4
5 Meter 10 A
6 SRS 7.5 A
7 Option 7.5 A
8
9 Fuel Pump 20 A
10 ABS/VSA 7.5 A
11
12 Front Wiper 7.5 A
13 ACG 15 A
14
Rear Accessory Power Socket
(Console Compartment)
20 A
15
Driver’s Power Seat
Reclining
20 A
16 Moonroof
*
(20 A)
17 Front Seat Heaters 20 A
18 Charge Lid
*
(10 A)
19
Passenger Side Door
Unlock
10 A
20
Driver Side Rear Door
Unlock
10 A
21 Driver’s Door Lock 10 A
22 Passenger Side Door Lock 10 A
23 Driver’s Door Unlock 10 A
24 SRS 10 A
25 Illumination 10 A
26 Key Lock 7.5 A
27 Parking Lights 10 A
28 Lumbar Support 10 A
29 Right Headlight High Beam 10 A
30 Washer 15 A
31 A/C Main 10 A
32 Driver’s Power Window 20 A
Circuit Protected Amps
33
Front Passenger’s Power
Window
20 A
34
Rear Driver Side Power
Window
20 A
35
Rear Passenger Side Power
Window
20 A
36 Driver’s Power Seat Sliding 20 A
37 ACCESSORY 7.5 A
38
39 Left Headlight High Beam 10 A
40
Front Accessory Power
Socket
(Console Panel)
20 A
41 Driver Side Rear Door Lock 10 A
42 Door Lock 20 A
a SMART 10 A
b Hybrid System
*
(15 A)
c Hybrid System 10 A
d Hazard 15 A
e
Passenger's Power Seat
Reclining
*
(20 A)
f
Passenger's Power Seat
Sliding
*
(20 A)
g Rear Seat Heaters
*
(15 A)
h
Circuit Protected Amps
* Not available on all models
Table of Contents
534
uuFusesuInspecting and Changing Fuses
Handling the Unexpected
Inspecting and Changing Fuses
1. Set the power mode to VEHICLE OFF
(LOCK). Turn headlights and all accessories
off.
2. Remove the fuse box cover.
3. Check the large fuse in the engine
compartment.
u If the fuse is blown, use a Phillips-head
screwdriver to remove the screw and
replace it with a new one.
4. Inspect the small fuses in the engine
compartment and the vehicle interior.
u If there is a burned out fuse, remove it
with the fuse puller and replace it with a
new one.
1Inspecting and Changing Fuses
NOTICE
Replacing a fuse with one that has a higher rating
greatly increases the chances of damaging the
electrical system.
Replace fuse with a spare fuse of the same specified
amperage.
Confirm the specified amperage using the charts on
P. 532 to 533.
There is a fuse puller on the back of the engine
compartment fuse box cover.
Combined
Fuse
Blown Fuse
Fuse Puller
Table of Contents
535
Handling the Unexpected
Emergency Towing
Call a professional towing service if you need to tow your vehicle.
Flat bed equipment
The operator loads your vehicle on the back of a truck.
This is the best way to transport your vehicle.
Wheel lift equipment
The tow truck uses two pivoting arms that go under the front tires and lift them off
the ground. The rear tires remain on the ground. This is an acceptable way to
tow your vehicle.
1Emergency Towing
NOTICE
Trying to lift or tow your vehicle by the bumpers will
cause serious damage. The bumpers are not designed
to support the vehicle's weight.
NOTICE
Improper towing such as towing behind a
motorhome or other motor vehicle can damage the
transmission.
Never tow your vehicle with just a rope or chain.
It is very dangerous since ropes or chains may shift
from side to side or break.
Table of Contents
536
Table of Contents
537
Information
This chapter includes your vehicle's specifications, locations of identification numbers, and other
information required by regulation.
Specifications.................................... 538
Identification Numbers
Vehicle Identification Number (VIN)...... 540
Engine Number and Motor Number... 540
Devices that Emit Radio Waves....... 541
Reporting Safety Defects................. 542
Emissions Testing
Testing of Readiness Codes.............. 543
Warranty Coverages ........................ 545
Authorized Manuals......................... 547
Customer Service Information......... 548
Main Menu
538
Information
Specifications
Vehicle Specifications
Model Honda Accord Hybrid
No. of Passengers:
Front 2
Rear 3
Total 5
Weights:
Gross Vehicle
Weight Rating
U.S.: 4,542 lbs (2,060 kg)
Canada: 2,060 kg
Gross Axle Weight
Rating (Front)
U.S.: 2,414 lbs (1,095 kg)
Canada: 1,095 kg
Gross Axle Weight
Rating (Rear)
U.S.: 2,161 lbs (980 kg)
Canada: 980 kg
Air Conditioning:
Refrigerant Type HFC-134a (R-134a)
Charge Quantity 13.6 – 15.3 oz (385 – 435 g)
Lubricant Type ND-OIL 11
Engine Specifications
Fuel
Washer Fluid
Displacement 126 cu-in (1,993 cm
3
)
Spark Plugs NGK ILZKAR7E11S
Fuel:
Type
Unleaded gasoline, Pump octane number
of 87 or higher
Fuel Tank Capacity 15.9 US gal (60 ℓ)
Tank Capacity
U.S.: 2.6 US qt (2.5 ℓ)
Canada: 5.1 US qt (4.85 ℓ)
Light Bulbs
*1: Models with halogen low beam headlights
*2: Models with LED low beam headlights
Headlights (Low Beam)
55 W (H11)
*1
LED
*2
Headlights (High Beam) 60W (HB3)
Parking/Daytime Running Lights LED
Front Turn Signal/Side Marker Lights 24/2.2CP (Amber)
Side Turn Signal Lights
(on Door Mirrors)
LED
Brake/Taillights LED
Rear Side Marker Lights LED
Taillights LED
Back-Up Lights 16W
Rear Turn Signal Lights 21W (Amber)
High-Mount Brake Light LED
Rear License Plate Lights 5W
Trunk Light 5W
Interior Lights
Map Lights 8W
Ceiling Light 8W
Vanity Mirror Lights 1.4W
Courtesy Lights 2CP
Table of Contents
539
uuSpecifications u
Information
Brake Fluid
Transmission Fluid
Specified Honda Heavy Duty Brake Fluid DOT 3
Specified
Honda ATF DW-1
(automatic transmission fluid)
Capacity Change 2.49 US qt (2.36 ℓ)
Engine Oil
Engine Coolant
Inverter Coolant
Recommended
·Genuine Honda Motor Oil 0W-20
·API Premium-grade 0W-20 detergent oil
Capacity
Change 3.7 US qt (3.5 ℓ)
Change
including
filter
3.9 US qt (3.7 ℓ)
Specified Honda Long-Life Antifreeze/Coolant Type2
Ratio 50/50 with distilled water
Capacity
1.41 US gal (5.33 ℓ)
(change including the remaining
0.19 US gal (0.71 ℓ) in the engine coolant
reservoir)
Specified Honda Long-Life Antifreeze/Coolant Type2
Ratio 50/50 with distilled water
Capacity
0.31 US gal (1.16 ℓ)
(change including the remaining
0.08 US gal (0.3 ℓ) in the filler tank)
Tire
Regular
Size 225/50R17 94V
Pressure
psi (kPa [kgf/cm
2
])
Front 33 (230 [2.3])
Rear 33 (225 [2.3])
Wheel Size Regular 17 x 7 1/2J
Table of Contents
540
Information
Identification Numbers
Vehicle Identification Number (VIN)
Your vehicle has a 17-digit vehicle identification number (VIN) used to register your
vehicle for warranty purposes, and for licensing and insuring your vehicle. See the
image below for the VIN locations.
Engine Number and Motor Number
See the image below for the locations of your vehicle's engine number and motor
number.
1Vehicle Identification Number (VIN)
The interior vehicle identification number (VIN) is
located under the cover.
Cover
Vehicle Identification Number
Engine Number
Certification Label/
Vehicle Identification
Number
Motor Number
Table of Contents
541
Information
Devices that Emit Radio Waves
The following products and systems on your vehicle emit radio waves when in
operation.
Each of the above complies with the appropriate requirements or the required
standards of FCC (Federal Communications Commission) and Industry Canada
Standard, described below:
As required by the FCC:
This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC rules. Operation is
subject to the following two conditions: (1) This device may not
cause harmful interference, and (2) this device must accept any
interference received, including interference that may cause
undesired operation.
Changes or modifications not expressly approved by the party
responsible for compliance could void the user's authority to
operate the equipment.
This device complies with Industry Canada Standard RSS-Gen/210/310. Operation is
subject to the following two conditions: (1) this device may not cause interference,
and (2) this device must accept any interference, including interference that may
cause undesired operation of the device.
Audio System
Bluetooth® Audio
Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink®
HomeLink® Universal Transceiver
Immobilizer System
Keyless Access System
Remote Transmitter
Table of Contents
542
Information
Reporting Safety Defects
In the U.S.
If you believe that your vehicle has a defect which could cause a crash or could cause injury or death, you
should immediately inform the National Highway Traffic Safety Administration (NHTSA) in addition to
notifying American Honda Motor Co., Inc.
If NHTSA receives similar complaints, it may open an investigation, and if it finds that a safety defect exists
in a group of vehicles, it may order a recall and remedy campaign. However, NHTSA cannot become involved
in individual problems between you, your dealer, or American Honda Motor Co., Inc.
To contact NHTSA, you may call the Vehicle Safety Hotline toll-free at 1-888-327-4236 (TTY: 1-800-424-
9153); go to http://www.safercar.gov; or write to: Administrator, NHTSA, 1200 New Jersey Avenue, SE.,
Washington, DC 20590. You can also obtain other information about motor vehicle safety from http://
www.safercar.gov.
In Canada
If you believe that your vehicle has a defect which could cause a crash or could cause injury or death, you
should immediately inform Honda Canada Inc. and you may also inform Transport Canada.
If Transport Canada receives similar complaints, it may open an investigation, and if it finds that a safety
defect exists in a group of vehicles, it may lead to a recall and remedy campaign. However, Transport Canada
cannot become involved in individual problems between you, your dealer, or Honda Canada Inc.
To contact Transport Canada’s Defect Investigations and Recalls Division, you may call 1-800-333-0510. For
more information on reporting safety defects or about motor vehicle safety, go to http://www.tc.gc.ca/
roadsafety.
Table of Contents
543
Continued
Information
Emissions Testing
Testing of Readiness Codes
Your vehicle has “Readiness Codes,” as part of the onboard self diagnostic system.
Some States use these codes as a test to see if your vehicle's emissions components
are working properly.
The codes may not be read properly if testing is performed just after the 12-volt
battery has gone dead or been disconnected.
To check if they are set, set the power mode to ON, without turning the power
system on. The malfunction indicator lamp will come on for several seconds. If it
then goes off, the readiness codes are set. If it blinks five times, the readiness codes
are not set.
If you are required to have your vehicle tested before the readiness codes are ready,
prepare the vehicle for retesting by doing the following:
1. Fill the gas tank to approximately 3/4 full.
2. Park the vehicle and leave the power system off for six hours or more.
3. Make sure the ambient temperature is between 40°F and 95°F (4°C and 35°C).
4. Turn the power system on.
1Testing of Readiness Codes
The readiness codes are erased when the 12-volt
battery is disconnected, and set again only after
several days of driving under a variety of conditions.
If a testing facility determines that the readiness
codes are not set, you may be requested to return at
a later date to complete the test.
If the testing facility determines the readiness codes
are still not set, see a dealer.
Table of Contents
544
uuEmissions TestinguTesting of Readiness Codes
Information
5. Select a nearby, lightly traveled major highway where you can maintain a speed
of 50 to 60 mph (80 to 97 km/h) for at least 20 minutes. Drive on the highway in
(D . Do not use cruise control. When traffic allows, drive for 90 seconds without
moving the accelerator pedal. (Vehicle speed may vary slightly; this is okay.) If you
cannot do this for a continuous 90 seconds because of traffic conditions, drive for
at least 30 seconds, then repeat it two more times (for a total of 90 seconds).
6. Drive in city/suburban traffic for at least 10 minutes. When traffic conditions
allow, let the vehicle coast for several seconds without using the accelerator pedal
or the brake pedal.
7. Park the vehicle and leave the power system off for 40 minutes.
Table of Contents
545
Continued
Information
Warranty Coverages
U.S. Owners
Your new vehicle is covered by these warranties:
New Vehicle Limited Warranty – covers your new vehicle, except for the
emissions control systems and accessories, against defects in materials and
workmanship.
Emissions Control Systems Defects Warranty and Emissions Performance
Warranty – these two warranties cover your vehicle’s emissions control systems.
Time, mileage, and coverage are conditional. Please read your warranty booklet for
exact information.
Seat Belt Limited Warranty – a seat belt that fails to function properly is covered
by a limited warranty. Please read your warranty booklet for details.
Rust Perforation Limited Warranty – all exterior body panels are covered for
rust-through from the inside for the specified time period with no mileage limit.
Accessory Limited Warranty – Honda accessories are covered under this
warranty. Time and mileage limits depend on the type of accessory and other
factors. Please read your warranty booklet for details.
Replacement Parts Limited Warranty – covers all Honda replacement parts
against defects in materials and workmanship.
Table of Contents
546
uuWarranty Coveragesu
Information
Replacement 12-Volt Battery Limited Warranty – provides prorated coverage
for a replacement battery purchased from a dealer.
Replacement Muffler Lifetime Limited Warranty – provides coverage for as
long as the purchaser of the muffler owns the vehicle.
Restrictions and exclusions apply to all these warranties. Please read the Honda
warranty information booklet that came with your vehicle for precise information on
warranty coverages. Your vehicle’s original tires are covered by their manufacturer.
Tire warranty information is in a separate booklet.
Canadian Owners
Please refer to the warranty manual that came with your vehicle.
Table of Contents
547
Information
Authorized Manuals
Service Express
For electronic copies of service publications, you can purchase a subscription to
Service Express. Visit www.techinfo.honda.com for pricing and options.
For U.S. Owners:
Manuals can be purchased from Helm Incorporated. You can order a manual by
phone at (800) 782-4356 (credit card orders only), or online at www.helminc.com.
1Authorized Manuals
For Canadian Owners:
Please contact a dealer to order any manuals that you
may require.
Table of Contents
548
Information
Customer Service Information
Honda dealership personnel are trained professionals.
They should be able to answer all your questions. If you encounter a problem that
your dealership does not solve to your satisfaction, please discuss it with the
dealership's service manager or general manager. If you are dissatisfied with the
decision made by the dealership's management, contact Honda Customer Services.
U.S. Owners:
American Honda Motor Co., Inc.
Honda Automobile Customer Services
Mail Stop 500-2N-7A
1919 Torrance Blvd.
Torrance, CA 90501-2746
Tel: (800) 999-1009
Canadian Owners:
Honda Canada Inc.
Customer Relations
180 Honda Boulevard
Markham, ON
L6C 0H9
Tel: 1-888-9-HONDA-9
Fax: 1-877-939-0909
E-mail: Honda_cr@ch.honda.com
In Puerto Rico and the U.S. Virgin
Islands:
Bella International
P.O. Box 190816
San Juan, PR 00919-0816
Tel: (787) 620-7546
1Customer Service Information
When you call or write, please give us the following
information:
Vehicle Identification Number
2 Vehicle Identification Number (VIN)
P. 540
Date of purchase
Odometer reading of your vehicle
Your name, address, and telephone number
A detailed description of the problem
Name of the dealer who sold the vehicle to you
Table of Contents
549
uuCustomer Service Informationu
Continued
Information
Music recognition technology and related
data are provided by Gracenote®.
Gracenote is the industry standard in music
recognition technology and related content
delivery.
For more information, visit
www.gracenote.com.
When music is recorded to the HDD from a
CD, information such as the recording artist
and track name are retrieved from the
Gracenote Database and displayed (when
available).
Gracenote may not contain information for
all albums.
Gracenote is an internet-based music
recognition service that allows artist, album,
and track information from CDs to display
on the HDD.
Gracenote users are allowed 4 free updates
a year. More information about Gracenote,
its features, and downloads are available at
Gracenote Music Recognition
Service (CDDB)
www.honda.com (in U.S.) or
www.honda.ca (in Canada).
CD and music-related data from Gracenote,
Inc., copyright © 2000 to present
Gracenote. Gracenote Software, copyright
© 2000 to present Gracenote.
One or more patents owned by Gracenote
apply to this product and service. See the
Gracenote website for a non-exhaustive list
of applicable Gracenote patents.
Gracenote, CDDB, MusicID, MediaVOCS,
the Gracenote logo and logotype, and the
“Powered by Gracenote” logo are either
registered trademarks or trademarks of
Gracenote in the United States and/or other
countries.
This application or device contains software
from Gracenote, Inc. of Emeryville,
California (“Gracenote”). The software
from Gracenote (the “Gracenote
Software”) enables this application to
perform disc and/or file identification and
obtain music- related information, including
name, artist, track, and title information
(“Gracenote Data”) from online servers or
Gracenote® END USER LICENSE
AGREEMENT
embedded databases (collectively,
“Gracenote Servers”) and to perform other
functions. You may use Gracenote Data
only by means of the intended End-User
functions or this application or device.
You agree that you will use Gracenote Data,
the Gracenote Software, and Gracenote
Servers for your own personal non-
commercial use only.
You agree not to assign, copy, transfer, or
transmit the Gracenote Software or any
Gracenote Data to any third party.
YOU AGREE NOT TO USE OR EXPLOIT
GRACENOTE DATA, THE GRACENOTE
SOFTWARE, OR GRACENOTE SERVERS,
EXCEPT AS EXPRESSLY PERMITTED HEREIN.
You agree that your non-exclusive license to
use the Gracenote Data, the Gracenote
Software, and Gracenote Servers will
terminate if you violate these restrictions. If
your license terminates, you agree to cease
any and all use of the Gracenote Data, the
Gracenote Software, and Gracenote
Servers.
Table of Contents
550
uuCustomer Service Informationu
Information
Gracenote reserves all rights in Gracenote
Data, the Gracenote Software, and the
Gracenote Servers, including all ownership
rights. Under no circumstances will
Gracenote become liable for any payment
to you for any information that you provide.
You agree that Gracenote, Inc. may enforce
its rights under this Agreement against you
directly in its own name.
The Gracenote service uses a unique
identifier to track queries for statistical
purposes. The purpose of a randomly
assigned numeric identifier is to allow the
Gracenote service to count queries without
knowing anything about who you are. For
more information, see the web page for the
Gracenote Privacy Policy for the Gracenote
service.
The Gracenote Software and each item of
Gracenote Data are licensed to you “AS IS.”
Gracenote makes no representations or
warranties, express or implied, regarding
the accuracy of any Gracenote Data from in
the Gracenote Servers. Gracenote reserves
the right to delete data from the Gracenote
Servers or to change data categories for any
cause that Gracenote deems sufficient. No
warranty is made that the Gracenote
Software or Gracenote Servers are error-
free or that functioning of Gracenote
Software or Gracenote Servers will be
uninterrupted.
Gracenote is not obligated to provide you
with new enhanced or additional data types
or categories that Gracenote may provide in
the future and is free to discontinue its
services at any time.
GRACENOTE DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES
EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING, BUT
NOT LIMITED TO, IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A
PARTICULAR PURPOSE, TITLE, AND
NONINFRINGEMENT. GRACENOTE DOES
NOT WARRANT THE RESULTS THAT WILL BE
OBTAINED BY YOUR USE OF THE
GRACENOTE SOFTWARE OR ANY
GRACENOTE SERVER. IN NO CASE WILL
GRACENOTE BE LIABLE FOR ANY
CONSEQUENTIAL OR INCIDENTAL
DAMAGES OR FOR ANY LOST PROFITS OR
LOST REVENUES.
© Gracenote 2009
Requirements to access Pandora®
Latest version of the Pandora application
installed on your mobile device. (Visit the
Apple iTunes® store or Google Play
Marketplace to download the latest
version.)
Registered Pandora account (you can
create a free account at
www.pandora.com <http://
www.pandora.com/> or on your
smartphone)
Connection to the internet via WiFi or
cellular data network.
Android devices must be connected to
the vehicle via Bluetooth, iPhone® devices
may be connected via Bluetooth or USB.
Disclaimer of Pandora®
Table of Contents
551
uuCustomer Service Informationu
Information
Limitations
Access to Pandora requires an active
internet connection
Ability to access Pandora through this
system is subject to change without
notice
Certain functionality of Pandora service is
not available when accessing the service
through this system including, but not
limited to, creating new stations, deleting
stations, emailing current stations,
buying songs, viewing additional text
information, logging in to Pandora, and
adjusting Cell Network Audio Quality.
Pandora internet radio is a music service
not affiliated with HONDA. More
information is available at http://
www.pandora.com <http://
www.pandora.com/>. Pandora, the
Pandora logo, and the Pandora trade
dress are trademarks or registered
trademarks of Pandora Media, Inc., used
with permission.
Mobile access requires a smartphone
with an active data plan. Standard data
rates may apply.
Pandora is only available in the United
States.
Table of Contents
Index
552
Index
Index
Numbers
12-Volt Battery Charging System
Indicator ............................................ 74, 528
A
ABS (Anti-lock Brake System)................... 454
Accessories and Modifications................. 462
Accessory Power Sockets.......................... 160
Acoustic Vehicle Alerting System ............ 423
Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC)................. 427
Additives
Coolant ........................................... 478, 480
Engine Oil................................................ 473
Washer.................................................... 483
Additives, Engine Oil ................................ 473
Adjusting
Armrest ................................................... 154
Clock....................................................... 110
Front Seats .............................................. 148
Head Restraints........................................ 151
Mirrors .................................................... 146
Steering Wheel........................................ 145
Temperature.............................................. 97
Aha
TM
Radio ...................................... 224, 277
Air Conditioning System (Climate Control
System) .................................................... 165
Changing the Mode ................................ 165
Defrosting the Windshield and
Windows ............................................... 166
Dust and Pollen Filter ............................... 504
Recirculation/Fresh Air Mode ................... 165
Sensors ................................................... 168
Synchronized Mode................................. 167
Using Automatic Climate Control............ 165
Air Pressure....................................... 494, 539
Airbags........................................................ 43
Advanced Airbags ..................................... 49
After a Collision ........................................ 46
Airbag Care............................................... 55
Event Data Recorder.................................. 29
Front Airbags (SRS).................................... 46
Indicator.............................................. 53, 76
Passenger Airbag Off Indicator .................. 54
Sensors ..................................................... 43
Side Airbags.............................................. 50
Side Curtain Airbags.................................. 52
AM/FM Radio............................ 182, 208, 247
Anti-lock Brake System (ABS) .................. 454
Indicator.................................................... 76
Armrest ..................................................... 154
Audio Remote Controls ........................... 174
Audio System............................................ 170
Adjusting the Sound................ 180, 206, 237
Auxiliary Input Jack.................................. 172
Error Messages........................................ 283
General Information................................ 289
HDD........................................................ 257
Internet Radio ......................... 190, 222, 275
iPod ........................................ 187, 218, 267
MP3/WMA/AAC...................... 192, 225, 278
Reactivating ............................................ 173
Recommended CDs ................................ 290
Recommended Devices ........................... 292
Remote Controls..................................... 174
Security Code ......................................... 173
Theft Protection ...................................... 173
Touch Screen .................................. 198, 231
USB Flash Drives...................................... 292
USB Port ................................................. 171
Authorized Manuals ................................ 547
Auto Door Locking/Unlocking ................ 121
Customize .............................. 106, 304, 322
Automatic Lighting.................................. 137
Auxiliary Input Jack ................................. 172
Average Fuel Economy .............................. 96
Average Fuel Economy Records ................ 98
Average Speed ........................................... 97
B
Battery .................................................. 8, 502
12-Volt ................................................... 502
12-Volt Battery Charging System
Indicator ................................................. 74
Charging (12-Volt Battery) ...................... 502
High Voltage....................................... 8, 451
Jump Starting ......................................... 522
Maintenance (Checking the 12-Volt
Battery) ................................................. 502
Maintenance (Replacing the Button
Battery) ................................................. 503
Belts (Seat).................................................. 36
Main Menu
553
Index
Beverage Holders..................................... 159
Bluetooth® Audio..................... 195, 228, 281
Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink® ............ 333, 370
Booster Seats (For Children)...................... 67
Brake System ............................................ 452
Anti-lock Brake System (ABS) .................. 454
Brake Assist System................................. 455
Fluid ....................................................... 482
Foot Brake .............................................. 453
Indicator ........................................... 72, 530
Parking Brake.......................................... 452
Brake System Indicator (Amber) ............... 72
Brake System Indicator (Red) .................... 72
Brightness Control (Instrument Panel) ... 141
Bulb Replacement.................................... 484
Brake/Taillights, Rear Turn Signal Lights, and
Rear Side Marker Lights......................... 488
Front Turn Signal/Side Marker Lights ....... 487
Headlights .............................................. 484
High-Mount Brake Light.......................... 490
Parking/Daytime Running Lights.............. 487
Rear License Plate Lights ......................... 490
Side Turn Signal/Emergency Indicator
Lights.................................................... 487
Taillights and Back-Up Lights................... 489
Bulb Specifications................................... 538
C
Carbon Monoxide Gas ............................... 68
Cargo Area ............................................... 162
Cargo Hook............................................... 161
Carrying Cargo.................................. 411, 413
CD Player................................... 184, 215, 254
Center Pocket ........................................... 158
Certification Label .................................... 540
Changing Bulbs......................................... 484
Child Safety................................................. 56
Childproof Door Locks............................. 120
Emergency Trunk Opener ........................ 125
Child Seat .................................................... 56
Booster Seats............................................. 67
Child Seat for Infants................................. 58
Child Seat for Small Children ..................... 59
Installing a Child Seat with a Lap/Shoulder Seat
Belt.......................................................... 63
Larger Children.......................................... 66
Rear-facing Child Seat ............................... 58
Selecting a Child Seat................................ 60
Using a Tether........................................... 65
Childproof Door Locks ............................. 120
Cleaning the Exterior ............................... 507
Cleaning the Interior................................ 505
Climate Control System............................ 165
Changing the Mode ................................ 165
Defrosting the Windshield and
Windows ............................................... 166
Dust and Pollen Filter............................... 504
Recirculation and Fresh Air Mode ............ 165
Sensors.................................................... 168
Synchronized Mode................................. 167
Using Automatic Climate Control ............ 165
Clock.......................................................... 110
Coat Hook................................................. 161
Console Compartment............................. 157
Controls..................................................... 109
Coolant (Engine) ...................................... 478
Adding to the Engine Coolant
Reservoir ............................................... 478
Adding to the Radiator............................ 479
Overheating ............................................ 525
Coolant (Inverter)..................................... 480
Coolant System......................................... 478
Creeping (Transmission)........................... 419
Cruise Control........................................... 424
Cup Holders .............................................. 159
Customer Service Information................. 548
Customized Features........................ 101, 293
D
Daytime Running Lights .......................... 139
Dead Battery (12-Volt)............................. 522
Defrosting the Windshield and
Windows ................................................. 166
Devices that Emit Radio Waves ............... 541
Dimming
Headlights............................................... 136
Rearview Mirror....................................... 146
Dipstick (Engine Oil)................................. 474
Directional Signals (Turn Signal) ............. 136
Display Button.......................... 176, 201, 233
Door Mirrors............................................. 147
Main Menu
554
Index
Doors ......................................................... 112
Auto Door Locking .................................. 121
Auto Door Unlocking............................... 121
Door and Trunk Open Message ................. 35
Keys ........................................................ 112
Locking/Unlocking the Doors from
the Inside............................................... 118
Locking/Unlocking the Doors from
the Outside............................................ 114
Lockout Prevention System ...................... 117
DOT Tire Quality Grading ........................ 496
Driving....................................................... 409
Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC) ................ 427
Braking.................................................... 452
Cruise Control ......................................... 424
Shifting.................................................... 420
Transmission............................................ 419
Turning on the Power.............................. 416
Driving Position Memory System............. 143
Dust and Pollen Filter............................... 504
E
Eco Assist System ........................................ 13
Eco Drive Display ........................................ 14
ECON Button............................................. 422
Elapsed Time............................................... 96
Electric Power Steering (EPS) System
Indicator............................................ 78, 530
Electronic Stability Control (ESC)............. 443
Emergency................................................. 535
Emergency Trunk Opener........................ 125
Emissions Testing (Readiness Codes)....... 543
Engine ....................................................... 540
Coolant................................................... 478
Jump Starting.......................................... 522
Oil........................................................... 473
Engine Coolant
Adding to the Engine Coolant
Reservoir ............................................... 478
Adding to the Radiator............................ 479
Overheating ............................................ 525
Engine Oil ................................................. 473
Adding.................................................... 475
Checking................................................. 474
Displaying Oil Life.................................... 467
Low Oil Pressure Indicator ................. 74, 528
Recommended Engine Oil ....................... 473
EPS (Electric Power Steering)
System ............................................... 78, 530
EV Button.................................................... 10
EV Indicator ................................................ 73
Exhaust Gas Hazard (Carbon
Monoxide)................................................. 68
Expanded View Driver’s Mirror ............... 147
Exterior Care (Cleaning)........................... 507
Exterior Mirrors ........................................ 147
F
Features .................................................... 169
Filters
Dust and Pollen....................................... 504
Oil .......................................................... 476
Flat Tire..................................................... 510
Floor Mats ................................................ 506
Fluids
Brake ...................................................... 482
Engine Coolant ....................................... 478
Inverter Coolant...................................... 480
Transmission ........................................... 481
Windshield Washer ................................. 483
Foot Brake ................................................ 453
Forward Collision Warning (FCW) .......... 435
Front Airbags (SRS) .................................... 46
Front Seats................................................ 148
Adjusting ................................................ 148
Fuel ..................................................... 24, 459
Economy................................................. 461
Gauge ...................................................... 92
Instant Fuel Economy ................................ 97
Low Fuel Indicator..................................... 76
Range ....................................................... 96
Recommendation.................................... 459
Refueling ................................................ 459
Fuel Economy ........................................... 461
Fuel Fill Cap........................................ 24, 460
Message ................................................. 529
Fuel Fill Door ...................................... 24, 460
Fuses ......................................................... 532
Inspecting and Changing ........................ 534
Locations ........................................ 532, 533
Main Menu
555
Index
G
Gasoline (Fuel)
Economy................................................. 461
Gauge ...................................................... 92
Information............................................. 459
Instant Fuel Economy ................................ 97
Low Fuel Indicator..................................... 76
Refueling ................................................ 459
Gauges........................................................ 92
Glass (care) ............................................... 508
Glove Box ................................................. 157
H
Halogen Bulbs .......................................... 484
Handling the Unexpected ....................... 509
HandsFreeLink® (HFL) ...................... 333, 370
Auto Answer .................................. 349, 385
Automatic Import of Cellular Phonebook and
Call History ................................... 351, 387
Automatic Transferring ................... 349, 385
Displaying Messages ....................... 365, 404
Editing User Name .................................. 384
HFL Buttons .................................... 333, 370
HFL Menus...................................... 336, 372
HFL Status Display........................... 335, 371
Limitations for Manual Operation.... 335, 371
Making a Call ................................. 355, 396
Options During a Call...................... 362, 401
Phone Setup ................................... 341, 376
Phonebook Phonetic Modification........... 391
Receiving a Call ............................... 361, 400
Receiving a Text Message/E-mail...... 363, 402
Ring Tone........................................ 350, 386
Selecting a Mail Account ................. 364, 403
Speed Dial ....................................... 352, 388
To Create a Security PIN .................. 348, 383
To Set Up a Text Message/E-mail
Options ......................................... 346, 381
Use Contact Photo .......................... 350, 386
Hard Disc Drive (HDD) Audio................... 257
Hazard Warning Button............................... 2
Head Restraints......................................... 151
Headlights................................................. 136
Aiming .................................................... 484
Automatic Operation............................... 137
Dimming ......................................... 136, 139
Operating................................................ 136
Heaters (Seat) ................................... 163, 164
HFL (HandsFreeLink®)....................... 333, 370
High Beam Indicator .................................. 79
High Voltage Battery ............................... 451
Hill Start Assist System ............................. 418
HomeLink® Universal Transceiver............ 331
Hybrid Vehicle
SPORT HYBRID i-MMD (intelligent Multi Mode
Drive)......................................................... 7
I
Identification Numbers
Engine and Motor ................................... 540
Vehicle Identification............................... 540
Illumination Control
Knob....................................................... 141
Immobilizer System.................................. 126
Indicator.................................................... 80
Indicators .................................................... 72
12-Volt Battery Charging System....... 74, 528
Anti-lock Brake System (ABS)..................... 76
Brake System (Amber) ............................... 72
Brake System (Red).................................... 72
ECON Mode...................................... 83, 422
Electric Power Steering (EPS)
System ............................................ 78, 530
EV............................................................. 73
EV Mode................................................... 73
Forward Collision Warning (FCW).............. 81
High Beam ................................................ 79
Immobilizer System ................................... 80
Lane Departure Warning (LDW)................. 82
Lights On .................................................. 79
Low Fuel ................................................... 76
Low Oil Pressure................................ 74, 528
Low Tire Pressure/TPMS............. 78, 447, 449
Malfunction Indicator Lamp............... 74, 529
Parking Brake and Brake System........ 72, 530
POWER SYSTEM........................................ 73
READY ...................................................... 73
Seat Belt Reminder.............................. 37, 75
Main Menu
556
Index
Security System Alarm ............................... 80
Shift Lever Position .................................... 75
Smart Entry System.................................... 83
Supplemental Restraint System ............ 53, 76
System Message ........................................ 79
Transmission.............................................. 75
Turn Signal and Hazard Warning ............... 79
Vehicle Stability Assist (VSA®)
System............................................. 77, 443
VSA® OFF .......................................... 77, 444
Information............................................... 537
Instant Fuel Economy ................................. 97
Instrument Panel ........................................ 71
Brightness Control................................... 141
Interface Dial ............................................ 230
Interior Lights ........................................... 155
Interior Rearview Mirror .......................... 146
Inverter Coolant........................................ 480
J
Jump Starting............................................ 522
K
Key Number Tag ....................................... 113
Keyless Lockout Prevention ..................... 117
Keys ........................................................... 112
Lockout Prevention.................................. 117
Number Tag ............................................ 113
Rear Door Won’t Open............................ 120
Remote Transmitter................................. 114
Types and Functions ................................ 112
Valet Key................................................. 124
Kickdown (Transmission) ......................... 419
L
Lane Departure Warning (LDW) ............. 439
LaneWatch
TM
............................................. 445
Language (HFL) ................................ 335, 371
LATCH (Child Seats).................................... 61
Lights................................................. 136, 484
Automatic ............................................... 137
Bulb Replacement ................................... 484
Daytime Running Lights........................... 139
High Beam Indicator.................................. 79
Interior .................................................... 155
Light Switches ......................................... 136
Lights On Indicator.................................... 79
Turn Signals ............................................ 136
Load Limits................................................ 413
Locking/Unlocking.................................... 112
Auto Door Locking/Unlocking.................. 121
Childproof Door Locks............................. 120
From Inside ............................................. 118
From Outside .......................................... 114
Keys ........................................................ 112
Using a Key ............................................. 117
Lockout Prevention System ..................... 117
Low Battery Charge (12-Volt).................. 528
Low Fuel Indicator...................................... 76
Low Oil Pressure Indicator................. 74, 528
Low Smart Entry Remote Signal
Strength.................................................. 113
Lower Anchors ........................................... 61
Luggage (Maximum Load Limit)............. 413
M
Maintenance ............................................ 463
12-Volt Battery ....................................... 502
Brake Fluid.............................................. 482
Cleaning ................................................. 505
Climate Control System .......................... 504
Coolant .......................................... 478, 480
Maintenance Minder
TM
............................ 467
Oil .......................................................... 474
Precautions ............................................. 464
Radiator.................................................. 479
Remote Transmitter ................................ 503
Replacing Light Bulbs .............................. 484
Safety ..................................................... 465
Service Items........................................... 469
Tires........................................................ 493
Transmission Fluid................................... 481
Under the Hood...................................... 471
Malfunction Indicator Lamp ............. 74, 529
Map Lights................................................ 156
Maximum Load Limit............................... 413
Meters, Gauges .......................................... 92
Main Menu
557
Index
Mirrors ...................................................... 146
Adjusting ................................................ 146
Door ....................................................... 147
Exterior ................................................... 147
Interior Rearview..................................... 146
Modifications (and Accessories).............. 462
Moonroof................................................. 132
Motor Number ......................................... 540
MP3................... 184, 192, 215, 225, 254, 278
Multi-Information Display......................... 94
Multi-View Rear Camera ......................... 457
N
Numbers (Identification) ......................... 540
O
Odometer ................................................... 96
Oil (Engine) .............................................. 473
Adding ................................................... 475
Checking ................................................ 474
Displaying Oil Life ................................... 467
Low Oil Pressure Indicator ................. 74, 528
Recommended Engine Oil ....................... 473
Viscosity.................................................. 473
Opening/Closing
Hood ...................................................... 472
Moonroof ............................................... 132
Power Windows...................................... 129
Trunk...................................................... 122
Outside Temperature Display .................... 97
Overheating.............................................. 525
P
Pandora® ................................... 191, 223, 276
Panic Mode ............................................... 128
Parking ...................................................... 456
Parking Brake ........................................... 452
Parking Brake and Brake System
Indicator ............................................ 72, 530
Passenger Airbag Off Indicator ................. 54
Passing Indicators ..................................... 136
POWER Button.......................................... 133
Power System
Turning on .............................................. 416
POWER SYSTEM Indicator.......................... 73
Power Windows........................................ 129
POWER/CHARGE Gauge ............................. 93
Precautions While Driving ....................... 419
Rain......................................................... 419
Pregnant Women ....................................... 41
Puncture (Tire) .......................................... 510
R
Radiator .................................................... 479
Radio (AM/FM).......................... 182, 208, 247
Radio (XM®) ...................................... 212, 251
Radio Data System (RDS).......... 183, 210, 249
Range .......................................................... 96
RDS (Radio Data System) ......... 183, 210, 249
Readiness Codes (Emissions Testing)....... 543
READY Indicator......................................... 73
Rear Defogger/Heated Door Mirror
Button ..................................................... 142
Rear Seat Heaters ..................................... 164
Rearview Camera ..................................... 458
Rearview Mirror ....................................... 146
Refueling .................................................. 459
Fuel Gauge................................................ 92
Gasoline.......................................... 459, 538
Low Fuel Indicator..................................... 76
Regulations............................... 449, 496, 541
Remote Transmitter ................................. 114
Replacement
Battery .................................................... 503
Bulbs....................................................... 484
Fuses............................................... 532, 533
Tires........................................................ 499
Wiper Blade Rubber ................................ 491
Reporting Safety Defects......................... 542
Resetting a Trip Meter ............................... 96
S
Safe Driving ................................................ 31
Safety Check ............................................... 35
Safety Labels............................................... 69
Safety Message........................................... 30
Main Menu
558
Index
Seat Belts..................................................... 36
Adjusting the Shoulder Anchor .................. 40
Automatic Seat Belt Tensioners.................. 38
Checking................................................... 42
Fastening................................................... 39
Installing a Child Seat with a Lap/Shoulder Seat
Belt.......................................................... 63
Pregnant Women ...................................... 41
Reminder................................................... 37
Warning Indicator................................ 37, 75
Seat Heaters...................................... 163, 164
Seats .......................................................... 148
Adjusting................................................. 148
Front Seats .............................................. 148
Seat Heaters .................................... 163, 164
Security System ......................................... 126
Immobilizer System Indicator ..................... 80
Security System Alarm Indicator ................. 80
SEL/RESET Button........................................ 95
Select Lever ................................................. 23
Operation.................................. 23, 420, 421
Releasing................................................. 524
Won’t Move ............................................ 524
Selecting a Child Seat................................. 60
Selector Knob (Audio)...................... 175, 197
Shift Lever ........................................... 23, 420
Shift Lever Position Indicator............. 75, 421
Shift Lever Positions
Transmission............................................ 420
Shifting (Transmission)............................. 420
Shoulder Anchor ........................................ 40
Side Airbags................................................ 50
Side Curtain Airbags .................................. 52
Smart Entry with Push Button Start
System ..................................................... 115
Snow Tires................................................. 501
Spark Plugs ............................................... 538
Specifications............................................ 538
Specified Fuel ................................... 459, 538
Speedometer .............................................. 92
SRS Airbags (Airbags)................................. 46
Steering Wheel......................................... 145
Adjusting ................................................ 145
Stopping ................................................... 456
Summer Tires ............................................ 501
Sunglasses Holder..................................... 162
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)........ 46
Switches (Around the Steering
Wheel)............................................. 2, 3, 133
SYNC Mode............................................... 167
System Message Indicator.......................... 79
T
Temperature
Outside Temperature Display..................... 97
Temperature Sensor........................... 97, 168
Time (Adjusting)....................................... 110
Tire Pressure Monitoring System
(TPMS) ..................................................... 447
Indicator............................................ 78, 531
Tire Repair Kit .......................................... 511
Tires .......................................................... 493
Air Pressure..................................... 494, 539
Checking and Maintaining ...................... 493
Inspection ............................................... 493
Labeling.................................................. 494
Puncture (Flat Tire) .................................. 510
Regulations............................................. 496
Rotation.................................................. 500
Summer.................................................. 501
Tire Chains.............................................. 501
Tire Repair Kit ......................................... 511
Wear Indicators....................................... 498
Winter .................................................... 501
Towing a Trailer....................................... 415
Towing Your Vehicle ............................... 415
Emergency.............................................. 535
TPMS (Tire Pressure Monitoring
System).................................................... 447
Indicator ........................................... 78, 531
Transmission..................................... 419, 420
Creeping................................................. 419
Fluid ....................................................... 481
Kickdown ............................................... 419
Operating the Shift Lever ........................ 421
Shift Lever Position Indicator ............. 75, 421
Shifting................................................... 420
Trip Meter .................................................. 96
Main Menu
559
Index
Troubleshooting ...................................... 509
Blown Fuse ..................................... 532, 533
Brake Pedal Vibrates ................................. 27
Buzzer Sounds When Opening Door ......... 28
Emergency Towing ................................. 535
Noise When Braking ................................. 28
Overheating............................................ 525
Power System Won’t Start ...................... 519
Puncture/Flat Tire .................................... 510
Rear Door Won’t Open ..................... 27, 120
Select Lever Won’t Move ........................ 524
Warning Indicators.................................... 72
Trunk ........................................................ 122
Lid .......................................................... 122
Light Bulb ............................................... 538
Main Switch............................................ 124
Turn by Turn Directions............................. 97
Turn Signals.............................................. 136
Indicators (Instrument Panel) ..................... 79
Turning on the Power ............................. 416
Does Not Activate ................................... 519
Jump Starting ......................................... 522
U
Unlocking the Doors................................ 114
Unlocking the Front Doors from
the Inside.................................................. 18
USB Flash Drives ....................................... 292
USB Port.................................................... 171
Using the Smart Entry with Push Button Start
System ..................................................... 115
V
Valet Key................................................... 124
Vanity Mirrors............................................... 5
Vehicle Identification Number ................ 540
Vehicle Stability Assist (VSA®).................. 443
OFF Button .............................................. 444
Off Indicator.............................................. 77
System Indicator ........................................ 77
Ventilation ................................................ 165
Viscosity (Oil) .................................... 473, 539
VSA® (Vehicle Stability Assist).................. 443
W
Warning and Information Messages......... 84
Warning Indicator On/Blinking ............... 528
Warning Labels........................................... 69
Warranties (Warranty Manual provided
separately)............................................... 545
Watts ......................................................... 538
Wear Indicators (Tire)............................... 498
Window Washers...................................... 140
Adding/Refilling Fluid............................... 483
Switch ..................................................... 140
Windows (Opening and Closing)............. 129
Windshield................................................ 140
Cleaning ................................................. 508
Defrosting/Defogging.............................. 166
Washer Fluid ........................................... 483
Wiper Blades........................................... 491
Wipers and Washers................................ 140
Winter Tires .............................................. 501
Snow Tires .............................................. 501
Tire Chains.............................................. 501
Wipers and Washers................................. 140
Checking and Replacing Wiper Blades..... 491
WMA................. 184, 192, 215, 225, 254, 278
Worn Tires ................................................ 493
X
XM® Radio ........................................ 212, 251
Main Menu
Main Menu
533

Brauchen Sie Hilfe? Stellen Sie Ihre Frage.

Forenregeln

Missbrauch melden von Frage und/oder Antwort

Libble nimmt den Missbrauch seiner Dienste sehr ernst. Wir setzen uns dafür ein, derartige Missbrauchsfälle gemäß den Gesetzen Ihres Heimatlandes zu behandeln. Wenn Sie eine Meldung übermitteln, überprüfen wir Ihre Informationen und ergreifen entsprechende Maßnahmen. Wir melden uns nur dann wieder bei Ihnen, wenn wir weitere Einzelheiten wissen müssen oder weitere Informationen für Sie haben.

Art des Missbrauchs:

Zum Beispiel antisemitische Inhalte, rassistische Inhalte oder Material, das zu einer Gewalttat führen könnte.

Beispielsweise eine Kreditkartennummer, persönliche Identifikationsnummer oder unveröffentlichte Privatadresse. Beachten Sie, dass E-Mail-Adressen und der vollständige Name nicht als private Informationen angesehen werden.

Forenregeln

Um zu sinnvolle Fragen zu kommen halten Sie sich bitte an folgende Spielregeln:

Neu registrieren

Registrieren auf E - Mails für Honda Accord Hybrid - 2014 wenn:


Sie erhalten eine E-Mail, um sich für eine oder beide Optionen anzumelden.


Das Handbuch wird per E-Mail gesendet. Überprüfen Sie ihre E-Mail.

Wenn Sie innerhalb von 15 Minuten keine E-Mail mit dem Handbuch erhalten haben, kann es sein, dass Sie eine falsche E-Mail-Adresse eingegeben haben oder dass Ihr ISP eine maximale Größe eingestellt hat, um E-Mails zu erhalten, die kleiner als die Größe des Handbuchs sind.

Ihre Frage wurde zu diesem Forum hinzugefügt

Möchten Sie eine E-Mail erhalten, wenn neue Antworten und Fragen veröffentlicht werden? Geben Sie bitte Ihre Email-Adresse ein.



Info